Norman Levine (Auth.) - Marx's Discourse With Hegel-Palgrave Macmillan UK (2012)
Norman Levine (Auth.) - Marx's Discourse With Hegel-Palgrave Macmillan UK (2012)
Norman Levine (Auth.) - Marx's Discourse With Hegel-Palgrave Macmillan UK (2012)
Divergent Paths: Hegel in Marxism and Engelsism (Rowman and Littlefield, 2006).
Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Norman Levine
© Norman Levine 2012
Softcover reprint of the hardcover 1st edition 2012 978-0-230-29334-2
All rights reserved. No reproduction, copy or transmission of this
publication may be made without written permission.
No portion of this publication may be reproduced, copied or transmitted
save with written permission or in accordance with the provisions of the
Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988, or under the terms of any licence
permitting limited copying issued by the Copyright Licensing Agency,
Saffron House, 6–10 Kirby Street, London EC1N 8TS.
Any person who does any unauthorized act in relation to this publication
may be liable to criminal prosecution and civil claims for damages.
The author has asserted his right to be identified as the author of this work in
accordance with the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988.
First published 2012 by
PALGRAVE MACMILLAN
Palgrave Macmillan in the UK is an imprint of Macmillan Publishers Limited,
registered in England, company number 785998, of Houndmills, Basingstoke,
Hampshire RG21 6XS.
Palgrave Macmillan in the US is a division of St Martin’s Press LLC,
175 Fifth Avenue, New York, NY 10010.
Palgrave Macmillan is the global academic imprint of the above companies
and has companies and representatives throughout the world.
Palgrave® and Macmillan® are registered trademarks in the United States,
the United Kingdom, Europe and other countries.
ISBN 978-1-349-33279-3 ISBN 978-0-230-36042-6 (eBook)
DOI 10.1057/9780230360426
This book is printed on paper suitable for recycling and made from fully
managed and sustained forest sources. Logging, pulping and manufacturing
processes are expected to conform to the environmental regulations of the
country of origin.
A catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library.
A catalog record for this book is available from the Library of Congress.
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
My last book was dedicated to all my children and now it is
the turn of all the grandchildren:
Acknowledgements viii
Notes 314
Bibliography 341
Index 354
vii
Acknowledgements
Norman Levine
December 2011
viii
Chapter One
A Programmatic Excursus
Part One
My intent in the original conception of Marx’s Discourse with Hegel was to describe
Karl Marx’s interpretation of Georg W. F. Hegel from 1836 to 1883 in terms of both
continuity and discontinuity. I know of no other work that has analyzed Marx’s
reading of Hegel throughout Marx’s lifetime.
Implicit in this enterprise was the awareness that the Hegel archive divided itself
into two parts: 1) The Visible Bibliography, or the manuscripts of Hegel published
during Marx’s lifetime that were accessible to Marx and which he did or did not
read; 2) The Invisible Bibliography, or those manuscripts of Hegel that were non-
existent to Marx and that only started to be published in the 20th century for the
most part. In other words, a substantial part of the Hegel archive was a vacancy
to Marx.
I began the original Marx’s Discourse with Hegel on the assumption that I could
interpret the impact of both the Visible and Invisible Bibliographies on Marx.
The approaches to each of these libraries would differ: the analysis of the Visible
Bibliography, because Marx read most of these works, would be textual and
exegetical, while the analysis of the Invisible Bibliography would be speculative.
Since Marx was ignorant of the Invisible Bibliography it was only possible to
speculate about the influence these vacant Hegel monographs might have exerted
upon him. Regarding the subjectivity of this speculative approach I maintain
that a knowledge of the Invisible Bibliography is important to understand Marx’s
reading of Hegel for two reasons: 1) The manner in which Marx comprehended
Hegel is more comprehensively defined by what he did not know of Hegel; 2) The
20th century renaissance of Hegel studies, basically stimulated by the publication
of the Invisible Bibliography, revolutionized previous estimations of the Hegel–
Marx relationship by bringing to light Hegelian texts which revised 19th-century
Idealist explications of Hegel and indicated a philosopher concerned with similar
economic and social issues that absorbed Marx. The Invisible Hegel established in
certain areas a community of interests, not necessarily conclusions, connecting
Hegel and Marx.
1
2 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
intent, can be regarded as expressing a common message, and I will identify this
monograph as ‘The Leipzig Council’ throughout the remainder of this book.
Just as the Hegel–Marx relationship must be perceived from the context of the
Visible and Invisible Bibliographies so it also must be discerned from the pre- and
post-Mega2 frame of reference. The Mega2 inaugurated a new era of Marx inter-
pretation and included in this new age of evaluation is the Hegel–Marx affilia-
tion. From the archival point of view Marx’s Discourse with Hegel will compare
the texts of the Visible Hegel Bibliography against the texts of the Visible Marx
Bibliography now brought to light in the Mega2.
The publication of the complete works of Hegel and Marx not only transformed
previous interpretations of the intellectual relationship between these two men,
but also enriched me with a plethora of primary sources. Even though I was grati-
fied to possess such a cornucopia of material it became apparent to me that I could
not satisfactorily diagnose both the massive Visible and Invisible Bibliographies of
both men for the years 1836–1883 in one volume. In order to satisfactorily probe
the deepest depths of the intellectual relationship between these two men it was
necessary to confine the investigative time span to the years 1836 to 1848, a man-
ageable time period, and these are the chronological borders of the present text.
I will not discuss ‘The Communist Manifesto’ because it is devoid of any reference
to Marx’s relation to Hegel, the gravitational center of this book, and it is essen-
tially an introduction to Marx’s absorption in political economy, the preoccupa-
tion of the 1850–1883 period of his life. The year 1849 was a vacuum in Marx’s
intellectual development because he was in transit from Belgium to London.
Marx’s Discourse with Hegel is not intended as a deep penetration into the ori-
gins and development of Hegel’s philosophy. It is not a study of the influences
that shaped Hegel’s mind, of the impact of Friedrich Hölderlein, Immanuel Kant,
Johann Fichte, Baruch Spinoza or Friedrich Schelling. It is not a study of the
epistemological viability of his dialectic, or the validity of his logical apparati. It
makes no effort to outline the historiography of Hegel interpretations from Karl
Rosenkranz–Rudolf Haym–Wilhelm Dilthey–Georg Lukács–Otto Pöggeler–Ludwig
Siep–Christoph Jamme–H. S. Harris–Rolf-Peter Horstmann–Dieter Heinrich, nor
does it seek to chart the imprint of Hegelian thought on subsequent philosophy
in Europe and America. It does not endeavor to trace the stages of Hegel’s internal
intellectual evolution, to account for the break between the Young Hegel of the
Jenaer Notebooks and the Mature Hegel of The Philosophy of Right.
Nor will this book put forth a history of the discovery and publication of the
complete works of Hegel. It does not pretend to be an introduction to, or narra-
tive account of, how and when the entirety of Hegel’s manuscripts were uncov-
ered and brought to print. This book also does not offer a historiography of the
interpretations of Hegel. However, since Marx’s Discourse with Hegel scrutinizes the
historiography of Marx’s interpretation of Hegel from 1836 to 1848 I will indicate
what Hegel texts were available to Marx, or were unavailable during this time
frame. The complete accounting of the historiography of Marx’s interpretation of
Hegel during the 1836–1848 period is impossible without knowing the access or
lack of access Marx had to the full Hegelian catalogue.
4 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
For those who are interested in the chronology of the publication of the texts
written by the Young Hegel I refer them to the article by Professor Gisela Schüler,
‘Zum Chronologie von Hegels Jugendschriften’.4
The purpose of my work is the reconstruction of Marx’s understanding of the
‘Parmenides of Berlin’. I use the phrase Parmenides of Berlin as a synonym for
Hegel because Hegel considered Parmenides as the first to discover that ‘Thought is
thus identical with being’,5 a concept Hegel borrowed and made the foundational
principle of his own philosophy. A second synonym I will apply to Hegel is ‘The
Master’. In attributing this synonym to Hegel I copy the example of Marx who
referred to Hegel as The Master in his dissertation on Epicurus and Democritus.6
The work of Hegel will be summarized in the following pages and this summary
employed as the backdrop against which Marx drew his image of Hegel.
The contemporary philosophical debates over the relationship between Hegel
and Marx divide into two camps, the School of Continuity and the School of
Discontinuity. The proponents of the School of Continuity see a direct influence,
although not in all areas, of Hegel on Marx, while the adherents of the School
of Discontinuity, such as Louis Althusser, stress the break between the two men.
Although huge gaps existed in Marx’s knowledge of Hegel, and although Marx
misinterpreted many dimensions of Hegel’s thought, Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
belongs to the School of Continuity and validates the thesis that Marx perpetu-
ated, most of all, the methodological tools of Hegel. My recent book, Divergent
Paths: Hegel in Marxism and Engelsism (2006) is an in-depth study of Hegel’s History
of Philosophy and Marx’s interpretation of this work found in his dissertation On
the Differences between Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature.7
Marx’s relation to Hegel divides itself into two eras: 1) His First Appropriation of
Hegel, 1836–1848; 2) His Second Appropriation of Hegel, 1850 to the year of his
death in 1883. In this context it is only possible to sketch the differences between
these two periods and the reader is referred to my book Divergent Paths: Hegel in
Marxism and Engelsism for a more penetrating analysis of this question.8 However,
I wish to acknowledge an important difference between Divergent Paths and Marx’s
Discourse with Hegel. In Divergent Paths I presented Hegel as a political conserva-
tive.9 After a more prolonged penetration into Hegelian politics, and with the aid
of K.-H. Ilting’s work in Hegelian political theory, I have changed my mind. Marx’s
Discourse with Hegel presents The Master as a German Liberal in the tradition of
Lorenz von Stein and Karl August Hardenberg.
Marx’s First Appropriation of Hegel covers the period of his initial absorption
of the Hegel bibliography as it existed during those years. His First Appropriation
of Hegel spanned the years 1836 to 1848, but within that twelve-year time frame
the years 1836 to 1844 are the most significant. During these years Marx stud-
ied the existent Hegel archive in depth as he wrote his doctoral dissertation On
the Differences between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature, which
was completed in 1841, the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, the
1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ and the 1844 The
Manuscripts which contained the seminal essay ‘A Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic
and Philosophy in General’. Marx continued to make comments on Hegel’s
A Programmatic Excursus 5
philosophy in The Holy Family (1845), ‘The Leipzig Council’ (1845–1846) and The
Poverty of Philosophy (1847) but these were reflections, applications and diatribes
against Bauer, Feuerbach and Stirner and no longer initial research. In his First
Appropriation Marx was primarily concerned with Hegel’s theories of labor and
alienation. Marx’s First Appropriation, the period of absorption and digestion,
comes to an end in 1849 when Marx leaves Belgium and resettles in London
because his relation to Hegel undergoes a transformation.
The present book is devoted to the period of Marx’s First Appropriation of Hegel.
However, even though the years 1836 to 1844 were seminal, it is necessary to rec-
ognize that October 1843 witnessed the transition of Marx’s primary intellectual
interest to political economy. In October 1843 Marx moved to Paris, attended
meetings of the German workers’ movement, discussed economics and Hegel with
Pierre-Joseph Proudhon and also took the first steps in transferring his intellectual
center of gravity from philosophy to Adam Smith and David Ricardo.
In traditional interpretations Marx’s transition to political economy was aligned
to his reading of James Mill’s Elements of Political Economy in early 1844. I wish
to amend this traditional interpretation and assert that the work of Friedrich
List should take precedence over that of Mill. List’s book, The National System
of Political Economy, was read by Marx by 1843 and I make this claim because
Friedrich Engels in his ‘Preface’ to the second volume of Das Kapital makes the
following assertion: ‘Marx began his economic studies in Paris in 1843 with the
great English and French writers; of the Germans he was familiar only with Rus
and List . . . .’10 In addition, by the end of 1843 Marx was involved in the issue of
free trade, an early indication of his immersion in economics. In his crucial essay
‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ Marx attacks protective
tariffs. This essay was written between late 1843 and early 1844 and in it Marx
attacked List.11 Finally, in Marx’s 1859 ‘Preface’ to his Critique Of Political Economy
Marx himself certifies that in 1842–1843 he turned for the first time to econom-
ics, specifically the debate over free trade and protectionism. In the ‘Preface’ Marx
wrote: ‘. . . and finally the debates on free trade and protective tariffs caused me in
the first instance to turn my attention to economic questions’.12 Since List’s book
presented the claims for protectionism I take Marx’s sentence as proof that he read
List while he was writing for the Rheinische Zeitung in 1842–1843. Both Engels and
Marx were in agreement as to the date of Marx’s acquaintance with List and their
concurrence established that Marx read List by late 1843. Therefore, when locat-
ing Marx’s transformation from philosopher to political economist I will credit
List as the initial causal agent.
‘The Manuscripts’ were scattered explorations, personal exercises, in Marx’s initial
speculations regarding the possibility of the conjoining of Hegel’s The Phenomenology
of Spirit, particularly the theories of labor and alienation, with Smith’s The Wealth of
Nations and Ricardo’s Principles of Political Economy and Taxation.
Marx’s Second Appropriation of Hegel, from 1848 to 1883, changes from
absorption to implementation.
Beginning in 1848 Marx devoted himself almost entirely to the study of politi-
cal economy, the launching of his journey to the composition of Das Kapital.
6 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
As the design of his writing of Das Kapital crystallized, as his creation of a new
methodology of political economy concretized, he applied the Hegelian logi-
cal apparati as the substructure for his redefinition of political economy. In his
Second Appropriation Marx was mostly involved with the exercise of Hegelian
methodology.
It is wrong to characterize Marx as a full-time scholar of Hegel. He did not
devote his entire life to a study of the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’. It is erroneous to
evaluate Marx’s understanding of Hegel as if it were the product of a professional
academic expert whose career depended upon the exactitude of his presentation
of this philosopher. Conversely, Marx’s interest in Hegel was a result of Hegel’s
philosophic prominence following his death and Marx’s contact with Eduard
Gans. Not only was Gans a close friend of Hegel, a member of ‘The Society of
the Friends of the Deceased’, but he was also an editor of the journal which Gans
helped publish with the approval and assistance of Hegel. While he was a student
at the University of Berlin Marx took two courses from Gans: in 1836–1837 semes-
ter a course in Criminal Law, and in the summer of 1838 a course in Prussian Civil
Law. Additionally, as a student at the University of Berlin Marx also entered into
the Hegelian world, first as a member of the ‘Doctors’ Club’, a group of admirers
of Hegel that met for beer and philosophical discourse, and then as a member
of the Left-Hegelian Movement, Bauer, Arnold Ruge and Feuerbach, in which he
participated from 1841 until 1843. From the books by Hegel that Marx read he did
acquire a deep knowledge, in terms of the books that were available at the time of
the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’, but beginning in late 1843 his interest began to shift
to political economy. Marx did not spend his entire life absorbed in the work of
Hegel, but his youthful knowledge of the Visible Hegel archive served as a perma-
nent foundation upon which he constructed his method of political economy.
The philosophical image Marx acquired of Hegel was directly related to the
Hegel archive available to him. The mental portrait Marx sketched of Hegel
derived from three sources: 1) the Visible Hegel Bibliography; 2) the influences of
Ruge, Bauer and Feuerbach; and 3) the schools of Hegel interpretation prevailing
during the years 1836–1848 of Marx’s life.
In terms of the Visible Hegel Bibliography, the first edition of Hegel manuscripts,
the Collected Works, was published between the years 1832 and 1845. Started after
Hegel’s death, the Collected Works was a joint project of the colleagues of Hegel
who formed ‘The Society of the Friends of the Deceased’, and Gans was a leading
member of this association. The Collected Works took thirteen years to complete
because some of the volumes were collated from the lecture notes of Hegel and
selecting and organizing these lecture materials was an arduous and time-consum-
ing task. Karl Ludwig Michelet was the compiler of Hegel’s History of Philosophy and
The Philosophy of Nature, and Gans was the editor of The Philosophy of History and
The Philosophy of Right. Many of the most important works of Hegel were published
in his lifetime as independent editions, but the 1832–1845 Collected Works was the
first assemblage of all the Hegel documents that were known at that time.
The publication of the Collected Works was not the only location from which
Marx could familiarize himself with the books and essays of Hegel. In terms of
A Programmatic Excursus 7
the separate publication of the books The Phenomenology of Spirit (1807), The
Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences (1817), The Science of Logic (first published
in three parts, 1812, 1813 and 1816) and The Philosophy of Right (1820), were all
available to Marx, and some of these works were held in his personal library as
later pages of this book will show.
In addition to the Visible Hegel Bibliography there was also an Invisible Hegel
and this was written material penned by Hegel that stretched from his matricula-
tion at the Tübingen Seminary in 1788 until 1807 when The Phenomenology of
Spirit was published. With the help of Schelling, Hegel received his first academic
appointment at the University of Jena where he remained from 1801 until 1807.
While at Jena, Hegel wrote what is now referred to as the Jenaer Outline and these
documents are the most important parts of the Invisible Hegel Bibliography
because they presage the origination of the Hegelian System. With one important
exception, Hegel’s articles in The Critical Journal of Philosophy, the Invisible Hegel
Bibliography was composed of material written before 1807 and the Visible Hegel
Bibliography was constituted of material written after 1807.
The 20th century witnessed the publication of the Jenaer Outline, which for
Marx belonged to the Invisible Hegel. The publication of the Jenaer Outline caused
a volcanic eruption in the evaluation of the Hegel–Marx relationship and Georg
Lukács’ book, The Young Hegel, illustrated how these Jena materials compelled a
total revision in the assessment of Hegel.
In order to facilitate a clear conceptualization of Marx’s knowledge of Hegel
I divide the Hegel archive into pre-1807 and post-1807 periods. Marx’s study of
Hegel begins with The Phenomenology of Spirit and therefore Marx’s familiarity with
the Hegel archive spans the post-1807 period of the Visible Hegel, the mature
years of Hegel’s career. Essentially, Marx knew the Mature Hegel. Although Marx’s
knowledge of Hegel began with The Phenomenology of Spirit it is important to note
that ‘The Manuscripts’ of 1844 was not the first time that Marx alluded to this
text. Marx’s initial reference to this Hegel masterpiece occurs in his 13 March 1843
letter to Ruge. In that letter Marx criticized the manner in which Bauer referred
to a chapter in The Phenomenology of Spirit as ‘The Happy Consciousness’. The full
title of this chapter is ‘Freedom and Self-Consciousness: Stoicism, Scepticism and
the Unhappy Consciousness’. A year before Marx wrote ‘The Manuscripts’, The
Phenomenology of Spirit was an active presence in Marx’s mind.
The conceptualization of the pre-1807 and post-1807 periods provides tools by
which to grasp Marx’s understanding of Hegel. The Young Hegel was lost to Marx
who knew nothing of Hegel’s intellectual trajectory from Stuttgart, Tübingen,
Berne and Frankfurt to Jena and this void extends most consequentially to Hegel’s
Jenaer Outline.
The years 1836 to 1844 was a decade in which Marx conducted his in-depth
discourse with Hegel. The were also the years of the Young Marx. Ironically, the
Young Marx was totally cut off from the Young Hegel. The Young Marx’s dialogue
with Hegel was conducted with the Mature Hegel.
Even though The Critical Journal of Philosophy was published during the pre-
1807 years I consider it a part of the Visible Hegel Bibliography because it was
8 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
available to Marx. Hegel co-edited this journal with Schelling and although Hegel
did not sign the articles he contributed to the journal; this periodical was available
to Marx and familiarity with this material was accessible to him if he pursued the
issue. The six articles Hegel published in The Critical Journal of Philosophy were:
The essay ‘The Difference Between Fichte’s and Schelling’s Systems’ was published
as a separate monograph.
Of the seven essays mentioned above, six were reprinted in the Collected Works.
The six essays that were reproduced in the Collected Works were:
Marx never alluded to any of the six essays contained in The Critical Journal of
Philosophy nor to the separate monograph ‘The Difference Between Fichte’s and
Schelling’s Systems’.
In addition, Marx never referred to the six Hegel essays contained in the Collected
Works. The six essays I listed above were contained in Volume One. Volume Two
was given over to The Phenomenology of Spirit, which was published in 1807. The
Hegel of 1807 is the point from which Marx’s perception of Hegel begins. Later
pages in this study will discuss the essay ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating
Natural Law’ as a means to illustrate the Hegelian ideas to which Marx remained
blind by not being able to become conversant with the Invisible Hegel. The reali-
zation that Marx was not an expert in Hegelian thought is further proven by the
fact he never mentioned Volume One of the Collected Works, but he also never
mentioned Volume Eighteen, the Philosophische Propadeutik, whose editor was Karl
Rosenkranz. In his 1837 letter to his father Marx wrote that he ‘got to know Hegel
from beginning to end’14 but the evidence indicates that the young 19-year-old
student was not telling the truth.
It is instructive to compare Marx and Rosenkranz in terms of the depth of
their involvement in the mastery of Hegel. Whereas Marx left Germany in 1843,
Rosenkranz contributed Volume Eighteen to the Collected Works and in 1844
published a biography of Hegel to which Marx never alludes.15 Later pages of
this book will discuss the significance of Rosenkranz and in those pages I will
A Programmatic Excursus 9
of the Collected Works, which contained the six essays mentioned above, and the
Philosophische Propadeutik, and assuming that Marx read certain parts of the Hegel
literary legacy as independent publications, Marx’s acquaintance with the Hegel
bibliography was confined to the first edition. Marx was a prisoner of archival
history and what ‘The Society of Friends of the Deceased’ retrieved was the infor-
mational substructure of Marx’s knowledge of Hegel. By creating the boundaries
of the knowledge of Hegel until the 20th century ‘The Society of Friends of the
Deceased’ cemented the parameters within which Marx’s relation to Hegel would
be conceived until the publication of the Jenaer Outline.
The above paragraphs provide a general picture of the Hegel sources available to
Marx, but we must sharpen our vision and identify the particular books of Hegel
that Marx read and the exact time frame in which he read them.
The standard I am using for the most part in determining if Marx read a specific
Hegel text is whether Marx mentioned that text in his own writings. This method
of verification can be referred to as the footnote system of proof. If no citation
exists in all of Marx’s writings referencing a singular manuscript of Hegel then
I generally assume that Marx had no knowledge of this text.
There are nine primary sources from which it is possible to reconstruct the
individual Hegel manuscripts Marx knew: his 1836 poem; the 1837 letter to his
father; the 1841 doctoral dissertation; the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of
Right’; ‘The Manuscripts’; the 1845 The Holy Family; the 1845–1846 ‘The Leipzig
Council’; the 1847 The Poverty of Philosophy and his personal library. These sources
will be used in depth in later portions of this book.
Marx’s essential approach to Hegel was characterized by five strategies: 1) the
influence of Ruge; 2) the influence of Bauer; 3) the role of Feuerbach; 4) the ques-
tion of the role of philosophy; 5) the relationship between System and Method.
4) Influenced by Ruge, Bauer and Feuerbach, Marx’s major concern in the area
of philosophy was the discernment of its proper role. Marx changed what he
thought to be the function of philosophy in Hegel. Marx believed that for Hegel
the locus of philosophy was mind, whereas for Marx the proper role of philosophy
was critique and praxis. Karl Löwith’s book From Hegel to Nietzsche24 is extremely
insightful in this regard. Löwith was one of the first to bring attention to the fact
that Marx revolutionized the role of philosophy and that for Marx philosophy
was united with praxis and not fully circumscribed inside mind.
Löwith’s From Hegel to Nietzsche and John Toews’ Hegelianism25 offer insightful
discussions of the relationship between reason and reality in Hegel. Although
Löwith stressed the religious aspects of Hegel’s thought, Löwith and Toews both
concurred that Hegel’s philosophy was an attempt to reconcile reason and real-
ity. Löwith writes that Hegel’s ‘philosophy of history is a theodocy of logic, a
representation of God in the abstract elements of pure thought’,26 while Toews,
forgoing the Christian aspects of Hegel’s thought, describes the Hegelian project
as the reunification of thought and reality, the transcendence of the dichotomy
between the empirical and the rational.27
Hegel wrote a philosophy of identity. The major thrust of Hegel’s speculations
was to establish the identity of mind and reality. Only when reason became an
element of reality did reality become comprehensible because only then could
reason rediscover itself in the real. According to Hegelian hermeneutics, reason
could only understand itself and thus reality only became fathomable when
subjective reason rediscovered itself in that part of reality in which reason had
become objective.
Marx’s philosophy was not a theory of identity, but a program of antithesis. Marx
did not seek to assert the similarity between thought and reality, but rather their
contradiction. Whereas Hegel presumed identity Marx presumed the antipodal.
Hegelian philosophy did not engage critique. Hegel’s philosophy was an out-
come of critique, of Kant’s critique. Kant’s philosophy explored the dissonance
12 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
between reality and the idea and liberated the idea from reality. Building on Kant’s
advance, Hegel took the freedom of thought as a presupposition but then attempt-
ed to reconcile mind in its freedom with reality. He sought to reconcile the two on
the ground of reason’s potency for objectification and reunification. Thus Hegelian
thought emphasized reunification and not critique because critique assumed the
discrepancy between thought and reality. Marx did exercise critique because he
took the discordance between reality and thought as a presupposition.
Marx’s essay ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ (1843)28 is
the site in which this renovation of the role of philosophy was consummated.
In this essay Marx attacks Speculative philosophy because it imprisons philoso-
phy in reason and so detaches philosophy from reality. Contrary to Hegel, Marx
averred that the proper role of philosophy was first to critique reality and then
to alter reality through praxis, through the intervention of thoughtful action in
the world.
5) Marx’s flight from Hegelian Speculative philosophy did not entail an escape
from Hegelian methodology. Marx’s approach to Hegel was based on the dis-
tinction between System and Method and whereas Marx refuted the Hegelian
System, or Idealist philosophy, he incorporated the Hegelian methodology. Marx
condemned Hegelian Speculative philosophy, the System, as the source of all
the errors in Hegel’s theories, but he simultaneously absorbed the methodology
of Hegel’s logic. I will describe the most important features of the Hegel–Marx
methodological umbilical cord in later sections of this book.
The distinction between System and Method is parallel to the distinction
between form and content. I will emphasize in later portions of this book that
content should be taken as a synonym for System and form as a synonym for
Method. In the rejection of Hegel’s Speculative philosophy Marx correspondingly
negated the Hegelian content, mind. Since mind was the substance of the Idealist
system Marx rejected mind as the content of human activity, or it was not mind
that predicated, but rather labor. Similarly, Marx retained many forms of the
Hegelian Method after they were shed of their Speculative content. Marx bor-
rowed the Hegelian form of essence, but first stripped it of its Speculative content
and redefined essence as the inherent movement of socio-economic formations.
The economic methodology by which Marx explained the operations of social
formations were Hegelian logical methodologies cleansed of their Speculative
content.
The founders of the School of Continuity between Hegel and Marx were Lukács
and Herbert Marcuse and I confirm my indebtedness to them. Lukács in his book
The Young Hegel29 and Marcuse in his book Reason and Revolution30 focused on the
similarities between these two men. Reacting to the publication in the 20th cen-
tury of many previously unknown manuscripts of Hegel, the Jenaer Outline, both
Lukács and Marcuse concentrated on the similarities between Hegel and Marx.
Both portrayed Marx’s reformulation of Hegelian Speculative philosophy into a
philosophy of praxis as not only a correct statement of the Hegelian mission, but
as a justifiable evolution of Hegelian principles. While Lukács and Marcuse were
A Programmatic Excursus 13
to point out the similarities connecting Hegel and Marx, while they were the
originators of the School of Continuity, they did neglect to discuss the disparities
between Hegel and Marx. Although the main focus of Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
falls on the continuity of methodological forms between these two men it will
also target the polarities that separated these two epochal figures.
This book will fill a gap found in the works of Toews’ Hegelianism and Warren
Breckman’s Marx, the Young Hegelians and the Origins of Radical Social Theory.31 Even
though I learned a great deal from both these books, and both these books deal
with the relationship between Hegel and Marx, neither of them take account of
the vacant Hegel bibliography. Both the Toews and Breckman books were written
after all the Hegel and Marx manuscripts were discovered and made known, but
neither author deals with the question of how this vacuum affected Marx. Marx’s
Discourse with Hegel is the first book to study the Hegel–Marx relationship from
the point of view of this void.
In addition, I find Breckman’s presentation of the relationship between Hegel
and Marx to be seriously flawed. Although his argument concerning the role
personalism played in the development of Left Hegelianism is insightful, his
emphasis on personalism serves to distort. Breckman claims that Marx broke with
Hegel during his journalistic tenure at the Rheinische Zeiting. I completely disagree
with this interpretation and maintain that Breckman falls into this error because
he fails to draw a distinction between Right, Center and Left Hegelianism. As
I point out in later chapters, when Marx wrote for the Rheinische Zeitung he joined
Hegel in the Center, German Liberalism, but this did not make Marx a republi-
can in 1843. Lastly, by concentrating so completely on the issue of personalism,
Breckman overlooked the far more important intellectual trend that encouraged
Marx’s break with Hegel, the question of property. Whereas Hegel defended the
right of private property, Marx came to call for its abolition and he does so not
because of his rejection of personalism, but because of his legal studies with Gans
who pointed out to him that property did not derive from will, as Hegel main-
tained, but rather had a historicity. According to Gans, ownership was a historical
product which differed in terms of the civilization in which it found itself. Marx
did not negate private property because it was an expression of personalism, but
because claims regarding the eternal nature of private property were philosophic
fictions.
Fueled by the recent archival excavations of both the full bibliographies of Hegel
and Marx, the debate regarding the continuity or discontinuity between these
two men is a major issue within contemporary Marxism. As I mentioned earlier
I am an advocate of School of Continuity. The two most prominent protagonists
of this school are Christopher Arthur and Tony Smith and they encapsulated their
approach to the Hegel–Marx problematic under the title of Systematic Dialectic.
I will discuss the work of Arthur in subsequent pages. Published in recent years,
two other books entered the Hegel–Marx problematic, their contributions
14 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
published work Marx offered a critique of the Jacobins – they confused their
temporal placement, they sought to be Roman plebeians in a time zone that was
not ripe for plebian radicalism. The actual political conditions of France in 1789
would not support a plebeian insurrection, and Robespierre and St Just were not
the brothers Gracchus.33
Regardless of these shortfalls Kouvelakis’s book makes a persuasive contribution
to the School of Continuity. Concerned with the discipline of politics, Philosophy
and Revolution correctly displays the movement of Marx out of Hegelian theory to
a philosophy of praxis. Hegelian speculation in itself presupposed the antinomy
between philosophy and actuality, or philosophy-in-itself annulled the past soci-
ety that brought it into existence. For Hegel, philosophy was a child of its time,
but when the present passed into yesterday, philosophy became retrodiction, or
retrodiction revealed the fault lines of past philosophical systems.
In Hegel, however, the antinomy between philosophy and actuality remained
restricted to self-consciousness. The antinomy was the awareness of self-
consciousness and it lacked an agent of political praxis. This was the nexus for
Marx’s rupture with Hegel, for Marx supplied this contradiction between phi-
losophy and politics with a rationale and an agent. As articulated in ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, theory, self-consciousness, was
replaced by practical activity and the designation of a social class, the proletariat,
as the subject of this practical activity.
The debate between the Schools of Continuity and Discontinuity extends
itself into the question of textual prioritization. David Leopold’s The Young Karl
Marx34 pits two early texts of Marx, the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of
Right’ and ‘The Manuscripts’ against each other and concludes that the former is
a better guide to the thought of the Young Marx than the latter. Leopold adds a
new dimension to the Hegel–Marx debate and this new aspect can be labeled the
‘Battle over Textual Prioritization’.
The first publication of ‘The Manuscripts’ appeared in 1932 in Ryazanov’s
Marx–Engels Gesamtausgabe (Mega1). However, these 1844 manuscripts did not
comprise a complete text, but were intercalated by Ryazanov from disparate drafts
written by Marx during 1844. By interpolating diffuse drafts, notebooks and com-
ments, Ryazanov created a text which acted as one of the incubators of Western
Marxism in the 1960s. However, in the 1980s, Rojahn, a scholar working at the
Amsterdam International Institute of Social History, which possessed the original
Marx drafts and notebooks, published two articles that challenged the authentic-
ity of ‘The Manuscripts’ as a coherent and unitary text.35 Leopold, building on the
scholarship of Rojahn, and because of the lack of certainty as to the meaning of
‘The Manuscripts’ demotes the importance of these writings. Conversely, because
the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ is a more coherent text and its
authorship is undisputed, Leopold prioritizes it over ‘The Manuscripts’.
However, the Battle of Textual Prioritization contains a greater meaning than
the positioning of texts. ‘The Manuscripts’ is a source that lends credence to the
continuity thesis. Hegel is a significant presence in ‘The Manuscripts’ and to dis-
prove their existence as a unitary text presents a serious challenge to the viability
16 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
of the continuity thesis. Leopold opts to take this path and one of the results of
The Young Karl Marx is to weaken the continuity thesis. The Young Karl Marx does
not negate the presence of Hegel in the early Marx, but it does reduce and relo-
cate its impact. Leopold argues that a more definitive evaluation of the influence
of Hegel on Marx is found in the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ and
in making this claim Leopold shifts the center of the Hegel–Marx relationship
from the phenomenology of labor and alienation, the axial thesis of the ‘The
Manuscripts’, to the question of Hegelian politics, the axial theme of the ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’. A Hegel–Marx continuity exists in Leopold’s book,
but the ground of the continuity is shifted.
Leopold’s concentration on Hegelian politics leads him to analyze the distinction
between civil society and state that performs such crucial roles in The Philosophy of
Right. For Hegel civil society was the realm of family, private property and capital-
ist industrial relations, while the state was the domain of ethics. Leopold contends
that The Philosophy of Right constructs a strict separation between civil society and
state, but also that Hegel was aware of some of the inhumanities of capitalist civil
society even though he never wavered in his support of private property.
Leopold is correct to emphasize the significant impact that Hegel’s idea of civil
society exerted on Marx. A pivotal theme of the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy
of Right’ was the call by Marx for the abolition of the state, which meant that
a democratically organized civil society would replace the state and assume its
legislative and administrative functions.
But Leopold’s exposition of the civil society dimensions of the thought of
Hegel and Marx suffers from three errors. First, Marx’s knowledge of civil society
did not solely derive from Hegel, although Hegel was the most important con-
tributor. Marx was acquainted with the Scottish School of History – Ferguson,
James Steuart, Adam Smith and Francis Hutchinson – who wrote on the four-
stage theory of the evolution of civil society and state.36 In addition, Smith and
Ricardo were also aware of civil society, or of an economic realm that operated
autonomously from political life. In addition, Hegel himself did not invent the
idea of civil society, rather he elaborated on a concept that he found in previ-
ous authors, such as Charles de Secondat Montesquieu, as well as his knowledge
of some of the members of the Scottish School of History.37 Second, Leopold is
wrong in claiming that Hegel drew a firm barrier between civil society and state.
A reading of Hegel’s description of Athenian civil society in The Philosophy of
History38 documents Hegel’s awareness of how civil society acted as the founda-
tion of political structures. In The Philosophy of Religion Hegel discerned how the
patriarchal nature of Chinese civil society evolved into Confucian ethics as well
as the patriarchal hierarchy of Imperial China.39 Marx’s theory of the anatomy of
social formations rested upon conviction that the state was merely a projection
of the socio-economic structure of civil society. Third, Leopold totally ignored
the ethical nature of both Hegel’s and Marx’s theory of the political. Whereas
morality related to individual subjectivity, ethics related to the intersubjective and
the economic-political. Ethics, or politics, was the site in which the individual
subjective antagonisms were reconciled in the intersubjective and communal
A Programmatic Excursus 17
nature of politics. The heritage of Athens, the polis, lived on in Hegel, but Leopold
remained blind to this Aristotelian legacy.
Contrary to the School of Continuity, Leopold assigns Feuerbach a crucial role
in the development of the Young Marx. Although Leopold affirms the problem-
atic nature of the 1844 ‘The Manuscripts’, he sees Feuerbach’s influence in these
inconclusive writings as the key to Marx’s theory of alienation. Leopold defends
the idea that Feuerbach’s concept of species being is the instrument through
which Marx hoped to overcome alienation, or that Feuerbach promulgated an
ideal of social harmonization upon which Marx’s idea of communism rested, a
formulation first announced in the 1844 ‘On the Jewish Question’. By centering
the Feuerbachian influence, Leopold takes a decidedly anti-continuity posture,
because the School of Continuity is predisposed towards limiting the influence
of Feuerbach. The School of Continuity stresses the role of methodology and not
Feuerbachian philosophical anthropology.
By imprisoning the Young Marx into the years 1843 to 1845 Leopold created a
chronological frame that substantiated his bias. By excluding ‘The Manuscripts’ as
evidence, Leopold ensured that the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ rose
to the rank of uncontested authority, and that this critique contained the Young
Marx’s most decisive criticism of the Speculative philosophy of Hegel. By defining
the Young Marx as only existing between the years 1843 and 1845, by invalidating
the 1844 ‘The Manuscripts’ as evidence, Leopold created a documentary archive
confirming Marx’s distance from Hegel because the archive only contained
documents Marx wrote from this vantage point.
But the Young Marx was surely young in 1841, which raises the question of why
Leopold excluded the years 1841 to 1843 from the chronology of the life of the
Young Marx. From 1841 until 1843 Marx wrote his dissertation On the Difference
between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature and spent October 1842
until March 1843 as Editor of the Rheinische Zeitung. Leopold’s exclusion of the
texts from the 1841–1843 period was done to eliminate material that disproved
his arguments regarding the rupture between Hegel and Marx primarily over the
issue of Speculative philosophy.
Although it is possible to challenge the authenticity of Marx’s dissertation
because it is written in the hand of an unknown person, the weight of academic
opinion accepts the validity of this document as the work of Marx. The disser-
tation is the site in which Marx’s praise of and continuity with Hegel is most
clearly averred. Consequently, when Leopold sets the dissertation off-limits he
arbitrarily removes the most important source that disproves his interpretation of
the Hegel–Marx relationship.
Furthermore, Marx’s journalism in the Rheinische Zeitung is totally devoid of any
criticism of Hegel. As later portions of this book show, most of the political posi-
tions Marx advocated in the Rheinische Zeitung were perfectly consummate with
positions put forth by Hegel. By not addressing the journalism of the Rheinsche
Zeitung Leopold again arbitrarily excluded evidence that disproved his claims.
Even though I interpret The Young Karl Marx as an attack on the School of
Continuity I recognize that the thrust of its critique is on Speculative philosophy
18 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
and politics. I agree with Leopold that Marx distanced himself from Hegel in these
intellectual territories.
My disagreement with Leopold lies in the terrain of methodology, about which
he is totally silent. My argument is that Marx did divorce himself from Hegelian
metaphysics and politics, but not from Hegelian methodology.
The thesis that I develop in Marx’s Discourse with Hegel differs from those of
Kouvelakis and Leopold because whereas these two authors are concerned with
Marx’s politics I am engrossed in Marx’s methodology, or his philosophy of expla-
nation in the social sciences. In examining the presence of Hegel in Marx both
Kouvelakis and Leopold dwell on the impact Hegel exerted on Marxian politics
while my focus of concentration is on Hegel’s influence on Marx’s philosophy of
explanation.
Marx’s Discourse with Hegel is an exemplification of the School of Continuity,
or more precisely I place myself within the School of Systematic Dialectic. Other
members of this academy are Smith, Geert Reuten, Patrick Murray and Arthur.
None of these men are in total agreement with each other, nor am I in total agree-
ment with any of them, but we are all joined together by a common thread – that
the methodological principles of Marx’s Das Kapital, indeed of his theory of expla-
nation in the social sciences, evolve out of Hegel’s The Science Of Logic, and one of
the purposes of Marx’s Discourse with Hegel is to prove this interpretation.
In explicating the protocols of the School of Systematic Dialectic I rely most
heavily on the work of Arthur. In two books, The Dialectic of Labor, and The New
Dialectic and Marx’s Capital, Arthur provides a clear analysis of how the regime of
Systematic Dialectic led to a re-interpretation of Marxism. Although I have res-
ervations about Arthur’s use of ‘ontology’ when describing Das Kapital and I will
expound on these reservations in later sections of this chapter, Arthur’s work
provides a clear guide into the heuristic principles of this school.
The School of Systematic Dialectic is characterized by four principles: 1) The
opposition to a linear interpretation of Marxism; 2) The textual prioritization of Das
Kapital over The Phenomenology of Spirit and ‘The Manuscripts’; 3) The redefinition
of the Theory of Value from labor to commodity exchange; 4) The understanding
of a social formation as a totality.
Engels, lent support to the linear idea that capitalism evolved through successive
developmental stages and that ‘simple commodity production’ was the primary
stage of this long evolutionary process.
divorced himself. Marx was a social science theorist and he believed in the historic-
ity of social formations. He prioritized historical movement, that every social for-
mation was temporary because its conditions of existence were in constant motion
over time. I seek to maintain the importance of constant development and so
I reject the usage of concepts like ‘ontology’ and ‘metaphysics’ which, because they
are associated with the eternal, negate the reality of temporality and succession.
1) Totality
The concepts of essence and totality are interrelated and as I explained in pre-
vious paragraphs essence is telos, it is the immanent demiurge that activates a
social formation. According to Hegel and Marx, every social system possessed an
essence, or every social system functioned in terms of a universal principle that
organized that system. For Hegel and Marx essence, totality and universality are
synonymous.
In The New Dialectic and Marx’s Capital, Arthur provides an excellent summary
of Marx’s concept of totality. Basing his argument on the Hegelian thesis of con-
tradiction, that the dialectic is a movement that develops from inherent opposi-
tion, Arthur summarizes the hierarchy of a totality in the following manner:
Both poles are essential to each other as a matter of their very definitions;
The totality is constituted out of its movements, but the totality reproduces
itself in and through its movements even when the material reduced to single
moments existed in some sense prior to the constitution of the totality.43
2) Abstraction
In Chapter Three of my book Divergent Paths, I draw a distinction between Marx’s
method of inquiry and his method of presentation. The method of presentation
22 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
concerns Marx’s written description of the results of his research, while the
method of inquiry concerns the research practices of Marx, the procedures of
investigation he used in the scrutiny of his object. The confines of this chapter
only permit me to discuss the method of inquiry, or Marx’s scientific protocols.
Abstraction is a hierarchical procedure. It is a movement of the stages of gener-
ality. As it investigates a phenomenon, abstraction studies different stages of that
phenomenon on the assumption that each level will yield greater generality. The
final stage of generality, a generality which describes all the preceding stages, is
the universal.
Abstraction is the activity that produces a generality. For example, the attempt
to decipher the universality of the Caucasian ethnicity begins at the level of
skin color and at this level the generality granted by the investigation concludes
that the Caucasian ethnicity is characterized by white skin. But this is only the
primary stage of conceptualization and in order to reach the level of universality
it is necessary to pass through additional levels of hierarchical abstractions. The
process of abstraction must continue to a higher level of investigation onto the
question of the average height of the Caucasian and when the discovery is made
that the average of the Caucasian is 5ft 10in then this inquiry has advanced to
a higher level of generalization, to a hierarchy that is now more inclusive of all
particularities regarding the Caucasian ethnicity. The process of inquiry continues
until it has reached the apex of the hierarchy, until a generality has emerged that
encompasses all the particularities of a specific field of investigation.
3) Synchronic-Diachronic
Marx’s method of inquiry is synchronic and opposed to the diachronic pro-
cedure; the latter is linear, it defines an object by its place in a linear develop-
ment. Synchronic explanation is hierarchical, it explains ascending stages, it
seeks to show how more general categories incorporate lesser general categories.
Synchronic advance is not linear, but perpendicular, an advance of categories into
more inclusive generalizations until an all-encompassing universal is attained.
The end of the synchronic is essence.
4) Determination
In terms of Marx’s theory of totality the concept of determination refers to the
power of the essence to configure all the elements in an organic system. The cause
of determination is essence, or essence is the prius of a social organism. The con-
sequence of the determinations of essence is that particularities are assigned two
roles in synchronic explanation; first, particularities are reflections of the essence,
or they are attributed particular functions by the essence; second, particularities
provide cement to the system because in fulfilling the roles assigned to them by
essence, the particularity supports the synchronic structure of the whole.
5) Universal-Particular
Previous paragraphs described the mutuality between universal and particular
and I will not repeat this analysis here. I will only mention that a synonym for
A Programmatic Excursus 23
Marx recognized that the infinite valorization of capital was the essence of capitalism.
For Hegel the essence of logic was the Idea, that form or shape of self-consciousness
that provided meaning to a particular. The Idea in Hegel was a universal, was that
horizon that conjoined particulars thereby attributing meaning to them. Hegel’s
Idea or Marx’s self-valorization of value were therefore parallelisms; each performed
a similar function. As essence Hegel’s Idea bestowed a form, the basis of meaning,
and as essence Marx’s valorization assigned meaning to a social totality. Both Idea
and valorization performed coequal functions, attributing essence to form, and
therefore both were correlates.
In The New Dialectic and Marx’s Capital, Arthur appears as a leading advocate of
the School of Continuity, specifically in relation to methodology, but this does
not mean he was a blind devotee of Marx. The fact that Arthur correctly defended
the Hegel–Marx continuity did not mean that Arthur was myopic in terms of
Marx’s misreading of specific Hegelian texts. In his The Dialectics of Labor,45 Arthur
was also one of the first to perceive that Marx’s ‘The Manuscripts’, particularly the
section, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, was plagued by
a misreading of Hegel’s The Phenomenology of Spirit. In particular, Arthur isolates
two areas of The Phenomenology of Spirit that Marx misunderstood, the Hegelian
terrains of subjective labor and the critique of bourgeois society.
I am in total agreement with Arthur that Marx was blind to Hegel’s interest
in subjective labor and the critique of bourgeois society and I would extend
Marx’s misreading of Hegel to additional areas within the entirety of Hegel’s
philosophical system. At this point, however, I will briefly explore dimensions of
24 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Marx’s misreading of Hegel that Arthur does not investigate. Later pages of Marx’s
Discourse with Hegel will offer an exhaustive enumeration of Marx’s misinterpre-
tation of Hegel, a task that is missing in Arthur’s work and a task that must be
carried out. However, before putting this forth this it is necessary to call attention
to two points.
It must be recalled that this book concentrates on the Young Marx, or the years
1836–1848. These were years of acquisition, years in which Marx read Hegel and
selected those modes of Hegelian logic he found fertile. Although this book fre-
quently calls attention to the method of social science explanation in the Mature
Marx, the Marx of 1850–1883, the center of gravity of this monograph is on the
Young Marx’s process of acquisition, his intellectual choice of specific Hegelian
categories.
The fundamental cause of the Young Marx’s erroneous appropriation of Hegel
arose because he focused on Hegelian metaphysics. When Marx approached Hegel
from this bias, when he concentrated on annulling the metaphysical aspects of
Hegelian philosophy, he remained blind in regard to the subjectivity of Hegelian
thought. Marx interpreted Hegel from the vantage point of Baruch Spinoza,
or he approached Hegel as continuing the Spinozist metaphysics of substance.
Hegel defined Spinoza’s substance independent of materiality, as Idea, and this
was the exact target of Marx’s refutation of the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’. This is the
perspective that Arthur does not pursue.
I will only discuss four instances of Marx’s miscalculations and in my exegesis
I will reference The Phenomenology of Spirit and The Philosophy of Mind. These four
instances are: 1) Speculative philosophy; 2) The theory of labor; 3) The ethicality
of the state; 4) The critique of the bourgeois world.
1) Speculative philosophy
Marx read Hegel as an exponent of Speculative Idealism, or as a Spinozist who
looked upon the Idea as constituting the substance of actuality. According to
Marx, the Idea in Hegel was not an expression of the in-itself of subjectivity,
but rather of a substance external to subjectivity. Marx read Hegel as reiterating
Baruch Spinoza’s interpretation of substance as an external and universal power
independent of humankind.
In the 1844 The Holy Family Marx wrote the following paragraph on the
Fichtean and Spinozist influence on Hegel:
The dispute between Strauss and Bauer over Substance and Self-Consciousness
is a dispute within Hegelian speculation. In Hegel there are three elements,
Spinoza’s Substance, Fichte’s Self-Consciousness and Hegel’s necessary and
antagonistic oneness of the two, the Absolute Spirit. The first element is meta-
physically travestied nature severed from man; the second is the metaphysically
travestied spirit severed from nature [. . .]
Strauss expounds Hegel from Spinoza’s point of view and Bauer from Fichte’s
point of view in the domain of theology, both with perfect consistency. They
both criticized Hegel insofar as with him each of these two elements was
A Programmatic Excursus 25
falsified in the other, while they carried each of these elements to its one-
sidedness and hence consistent development.46
the transformation of the content, but he was a Fichtean in terms of relocating the
Hegelian Idea into subjectivity, the transformation of the agent of action.
In spite of Marx’s own reconfiguration of Hegel’s idea of labor, the transmu-
tation from the labor of Idea to the labor of the industrial working class, he
continued to remain ignorant of Hegel’s own awareness of subjective activity,
or the economic work of the individual. Whereas Hegel’s texts, particularly The
Phenomenology of Spirit, as well as The Philosophy of Mind, possess numerous pas-
sages referring to the need and productivity of human work, Marx never com-
ments on these passages. Whereas Hegel was cognizant of the role labor played
in the anthropological evolution of the human species, Marx never demonstrates
any recognition of these paragraphs.
b) Subjective labor
This section itself will be divided into two parts: b1) Subjective Spirit; b2) Objective
Spirit. The purpose of these two sections is to demonstrate that Hegel wrote about
subjective labor both in the realms of Subjective Spirit and Objective Spirit. Since
I will discuss Hegel’s concept of subjective work and labor at greater length in later
chapters of this book my comments here will be brief.
I) In this return into self there comes to view its second relationship, that of desire
and work in which consciousness finds confirmation of that inner certainty of
itself which we know it has attained, by overcoming and enjoying the existence
alien to it; viz. Existence in the form of independent things. But the Unhappy
Consciousness merely finds itself desiring and working; it is not aware that to
find it in this way implies that it is in fact certain of itself, and that its feeling
of the alien existence is the self-feeling . . . that confirmation which it would
receive through work and enjoyment in therefore equally incomplete . . .49
The world of actuality to which desire and work are directed . . .50
The second quote below is taken from the section on ‘Pleasure and Necessity’ in the
chapter ‘The Actualization of Rational Self-consciousness Through Its Own Activity’.
II) Its action is only in one respect an action of desire. It does not aim at the
destruction of objective being in its entirety, but only at the form of its
otherness or its independence, which is a show devoid of essence; [. . .] It
attains therefore to the enjoyment of pleasure, to the consciousness of its
actualization in a consciousness which appears independent.51
A Programmatic Excursus 27
The theme of these paragraphs and the chapters of The Phenomenology of Spirit
from which they are taken is the development of self-consciousness to Subjective
Spirit. The maturation of Subjective Spirit unfolds in three stages.
The first stage is the overall telos of the process which is the movement from self-
consciousness to selfhood. To become an instrument of action, to become an agent
of activity in the empirical world, self-consciousness must first gain a Self, it must be
an Individuality inspired by a will. For Hegel will was synonymous with Selfhood.
The second stage was the utilization of a specific implement to achieve this
Selfhood. The implements that Hegel mentions in these paragraphs are need,
desire, action, enjoyment, pleasure, work and labor. As self-consciousness inter-
venes in the external world using the instruments described above it develops a
sense of Self, or it becomes aware of itself as a Self that modifies the external.
The third stage is the culmination into Subjective Spirit, or subjective labor is
the womb of Subjective Spirit. It is through the modification introduced into the
external world by subjective labor that Subjective Spirit is born.
The opening chapters of The Phenomenology of Spirit describes the genesis of
Subjective Spirit, but Marx remained oblivious to this discussion. Marx’s ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ is devoid of any reference to
Hegel’s theory of subjective labor and this absence reveals Marx’s blindness to the
theme of subjective labor throughout Hegel’s work.
B.I The particularity of the person includes in the first instance their wants. The
possibility of satisfying these wants is here laid on the social fabric, the gen-
eral stock from which all derive their satisfaction. In the condition of things
in which this method of satisfaction by indirect adjustment is realized,
immediate seizure (pa. 488) of external objects as a means thereto exists
barely or not at all: the objects are already property. To acquire them is
only possible by the intervention, on the one hand, of the possessor’s will,
which as particular has in view the satisfaction of their variously defined
interests; while on the other hand, it is conditioned by the ever continuous
production of fresh means of exchange by the exchanges over labor. This
instrument, by which the labor of all facilitates the satisfaction of wants,
constitutes the general stock.52
28 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
These two quotations offer good insights, although brief, regarding the palingen-
esis of Objective Spirit out of objective labor. It is objective labor that supplies the
pneumatics for the emergence of Objective Spirit and the primary realization of
Objective Spirit is civil society. By Objective Spirit Hegel referred to the origin of
human social life.
In these two paragraphs Hegel demonstrated his recognition of economic
intersubjectivity. In his ventures into economic theory Hegel recognized that the
‘exchange of labor’ led to the creation of a ‘general stock’ and this ‘general stock’
was the reservoir out of which the ‘satisfaction of wants’ flowed.
It is important to distinguish between subjective and objective labor. Subjective
labor referred to the Self’s first interventions in its material environment. At this
stage subjective labor was pastoral, or hunting. Objective labor was the activity of
workers who exchanged in a more advanced economic environment, an economic
level in which manufacture had occurred. Production was no longer individual, but
rather objective labor was intersubjective, or was executed by workers cooperating
by specializing in specific functions in the production of goods to sustain life.
Hegel was cognizant of the ‘division of labor’. Hegel was a capitalist and strenu-
ously defended the rights of private property. The factory system depended upon
the cooperation of workers and industrial labor was the exemplification of inter-
subjectivity, the Self’s awareness that the new context of self-consciousness was
societal.
Replicating his ignorance in terms of Hegel’s concept of subjective labor, Marx
was also myopic as to Hegel’s concept of objective labor. Even though Marx read
the texts in which Hegel expounded his ideas regarding objective labor, Marx
did not allude to these vital aspects of Hegelian thought in either his ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, or in the entirety of ‘The Manuscripts’, or in any
other of his writings in which he analyzes Hegelian thought. Marx remained
hostage to the Speculative interpretation of Hegel.
When the State or our country constitutes a community of existence; when the
subjective will of man submits to laws . . . the contradiction between Liberty
A Programmatic Excursus 29
and Necessity vanishes . . . The objective and the subjective will are then rec-
onciled, and present one identical homogeneous whole. For the morality of
the State is not of that ethical reflective kind in which one’s own conviction
bears sway; this latter is rather the peculiarity of the modern time, while the
true antique morality is based one the principle of abiding by one’s duty [to
the state at large].54
The second quote is taken from the second volume of The History of Philosophy in
a chapter dealing with the political philosophy of Plato:
. . . but it is of man’s moral nature that he treats in the Republic. Man’s moral
nature seems to us to have little to do with the State; to Plato, however, the
reality of mind . . . that is, of mind as opposed to nature . . . appeared in its
highest truth as the as the organization of the state, which, as such is essentially
moral; and he recognized that the moral nature (free will in its rationality)
comes to its right, to its reality, only in an actual nation.55
In order to fully grasp the congruence between ethics and the state in Hegel it is first
necessary to distinguish between morality and ethics. Morality functioned in the
realm of the subject. Morality concerned actions by an individual whose outcomes
were either Good or Bad. Ethicality, conversely, concerned the actions of an indi-
vidual inside a community. Ethicality related to the world of the intersubjective, it
concerned the interaction of a Self with an Other.
For Hegel the state, or politics, was the actualization of the ethical. The state, or
nation, was inherently an ethical organism because it was devoted to the creation
of intersubjective harmony. The state promulgated laws and law was the ground
out of which intersubjective reciprocity would emerge.
In his political philosophy Marx continued the tradition of Plato and Aristotle.
These Athenian philosophers were among the first to draw the correlation between
ethics and the state. Children of Athens, Plato and Aristotle were cognizant of
how the social unity of the polis acted as the ground of the ethical. In the polis
the ethical – duty to and obedience to the community – was the presupposition
of the state. Hegel understood his mission as resurrecting the glory of the polis in
the 19th century. Hegel sought to demonstrate how the Greek idea of ethicality
could be realized in the post-Industrial Revolution state.
Marx remained blind to the ethical nature of Hegel’s political theory. He never
referred to Hegel’s theory of the state as a instance of ethical principles. Marx read
practically all of the Collected Works of Hegel and where relevant in these published
works Hegel repeatedly combined political philosophy with the ethical. Regardless
of Hegel’s constant assertions of the ethical, Marx remained a prisoner of the inter-
pretation of Hegel as a Speculative Idealist, a gross distortion of the Hegel texts.
a German Liberal. Hegel defended the rights of private property as well as the need
for class divisions. He vehemently opposed socialism and communism and justified
the unequal distribution of wealth which led to the stratification of classes.
These attitudes do not mean, however, that Hegel was blind to the corrup-
tions of capitalist bourgeois society. Hegel was not opposed to the acquisition of
wealth but warned that wealth corrupted. Hegel was not a political revolutionary
or a social radical, but as a deeply moral person he was aware that the rabid and
unchecked acquisitiveness of capitalist society was toxic.
In The Phenomenology of Spirit, which Marx commented upon extensively in
his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, Hegel wrote in
paragraph 519:
Wealth thus shares its dejection with the recipient; but in place of rebel-
lion appears arrogance . . . in this arrogance which fancies it has, by the gift
of a meal, acquired the self of another ‘I’ and thereby gained for itself the
submission of that other’s inmost being, it overlooks the inner rebellion of the
other; it overlooks this state of sheer disruption in which, the self-identity of
being-for-itself having become divided against itself, all identity, all existence,
is disrupted, and in which the sentiment and view-point of the benefactor
suffer most distortion. It stands on the very edge of this innermost abyss, of
this bottomless depth in which all stability and Substance have vanished, and
in this depth it sees nothing but a common thing, a plaything of its whims,
an accident of its caprice. Its Spirit is a subjective opinion wholly devoid of
essentiality, a superficiality from which Spirit has fled.56
I make these confessions because it will help the reader place the central arguments
of this book within contemporary debates over Marxism.
A Programmatic Excursus 31
The collapse of Stalinist Russia in 1991 was an act of liberation for the thought
of Marx. Stalinist ideology was a debasement of Marxism and it was necessary for
the Stalinist dictatorship to disintegrate in order for Marxist thought to be freed
and to renew its authentic historical journey. The publication of Marx’s Discourse
with Hegel takes place in an Age of the Rebirth of Marxism. Emancipated from the
Stalinist distortion of Marxism the Age of the Rebirth of Marxism is characterized
by a return to the Marxist texts in order to read them uncontaminated by Stalinist
politico-ideological strategic exploitation.
My refutation of Stalinism is not simultaneously an annulment of Leninism as
I draw a distinction between Stalinist Bolshevism and Leninist Bolshevism. The
relation between Stalinism and Leninism is a complex one that is impossible for
me to enter into in these pages, but readers who want to pursue my thinking on
this matter are advised to consult the chapter ‘Hegelianized Leninism’ in my book
Dialogue within the Dialectic.60 One corruption of the thought of Marx perpetuated
by Stalinist Bolshevism was the attribution of the phrase ‘dialectical materialism’
to encapsulate Marx’s system. I will not use this phrase in this book because it is
entirely misleading.
Similarly, I will not use the phrase ‘historical materialism’ to characterize Marx’s
system of thought. Although the phrase ‘historical materialism’ does not misrep-
resent Marx’s thought to the same degree as ‘dialectical materialism’ it also serves
to shift attention away from the essential properties of Marx’s system, specifically
the study of the totalities of social formations.
The phrase that will appear in this text is the ‘Method of Explanation in the
Social Sciences’. In order to make this definition clear it is necessary to divide it
into four parts.
1) Marx’s Method of Explanation in the Social Sciences was finalized during the
years 1850–1883, or during his Second Appropriation of Hegel. The years 1836–
1848, his First Appropriation of Hegel, was his period of acquisition, the time in
which he digested Hegelian logical categories.
The logical categories the Young Marx absorbed from Hegel were organized
into a Method of Explanation in the Social Sciences during the years of the
Mature Marx, 1850–1883. Marx’s Discourse with Hegel, as previously mentioned,
deals with the Young Marx as it sets forth the categories Marx adopted from
Hegel that were later incorporated into a Method of Explanation in the Social
Sciences.61
4) Marx invented new protocols of study for political economy. He rejected the
empirical and positive approach as represented by Smith and Ricardo. In place of
the protocols of classical English political economy Marx substituted new inves-
tigative paradigms that penetrated to the prius of an organic social formation.
The deficiency of historical materialism arises from its preoccupation with linear
development, whereas I maintain that Marx stressed the synchronic analysis
of social totalities. Marx was not primarily interested in chronology, but with
synchronic organic anatomies.
Keeping this explanatory hierarchy in mind it is now possible to more fully
describe four features of Marx’s Method of Explanation in the Social Sciences.
1) Marx was not writing specialized economics. The subtitle of Das Kapital Volume
One was ‘A Critique of Political Economy’ and Marx continued the tradition of
political economy that emerged in the 18th-century Scottish School of histori-
ography that found its origin in the works of Montesquieu. Marx did not write
economics as detached from politics, or economics as isolated from the general
structures of a social formation, but he wrote political economy as an organic
science, the investigation of a society as a total structure.
2) Das Kapital was not intended as a fixed and final statement on the capital-
ist system, but rather the initiation of Marx’s Method of political economy. Das
Kapital was an exemplification, a realization of Marx’s Method of Explanation
in the Social Sciences. Indispensable to the understanding of Das Kapital are not
the reflections on the performance of the stock, but rather the fathoming of the
instrumentality of the Method of political economy.
4) Hegel’s logic provided the method for Marx’s historicism of social totalities. The
Science of Logic, as well as the Smaller Logic of The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical
Sciences, offered him the analytic devices upon which to construct his Method.
More precisely, it is essentially from ‘The Doctrine of Essence’ in The Science of
Logic that Marx borrowed the logical forms upon which he built his methodol-
ogy. Without understanding the function these logical modes performed in ‘The
Doctrine of Essence’ it is impossible to understand Marx’s Method. The key to Das
Kapital lies in The Science of Logic.
Chapter Two
Marx’s Incomplete Quest
Part I: The works of Hegel available during Marx’s lifetime that Marx knew
Part II: The works of Hegel available during Marx’s lifetime that Marx did not
know
Part III: The works of Hegel published after Marx died
Part IV: The creation of the Invisible Hegel
Part I offers a complete listing of the works of ‘The Master’ that Marx read.
A careful reading of Marx’s texts from 1836 until 1848 permits one to reconstruct
the exact books of Hegel of which Marx had knowledge.
Part II is also a complete listing because modern research has uncovered all the
material Hegel published during Marx’s lifetime, making it possible for the first
time to decipher those published books, articles and journalism of Hegel that
escaped Marx’s attention.
In Part III I have taken the liberty of simply noting the most significant works
of Hegel that were first published in the 20th century and that probably would
have compelled Marx to revise his interpretation of Hegel had Marx had the
opportunity to read them. Part III is simply intended to give the reader a sense of
the Hegel bibliography that was undisclosed to Marx.
In Part IV I will interpret Marx’s creation of the Invisible Hegel.
I will make comments in Part I whenever it is important to highlight a particu-
lar significance a Hegel text carried for Marx.
I will also make comments in Part II only to point out why an undisclosed text
could have reformulated Marx’s reception of Hegel.
These are the works of Marx from which it is possible to reconstruct the Visible
Hegel bibliography that Marx knew:
1) the 1836 poems;
2) the 1837 letter to his father;
33
34 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
3) the 1841 doctoral dissertation, On the Difference between the Democritean and
Epicurean Philosophy of Nature
4) the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’
5) ‘The Manuscripts’;
6) The works of the 1845–1850 period: the 1845 The Holy Family; the 1845–1846
‘The Leipzig Council’; and the 1847 The Poverty of Philosophy.
In addition, it is vital to keep in mind that the first Collected Works of Hegel, 18 vol-
umes in total, were completed in 1845. Thus, by 1845 all the extant manuscripts
of Hegel were available to Marx in the Collected Works.1
2) In his 1837 letter to his father Marx wrote that he ‘got to know Hegel together
with most of his students from beginning to end’.3 Regardless of Marx’s statement,
I maintain that Marx did not ‘get to know Hegel from beginning to end’. Marx
did not read the four Hegel essays contained in Volume 1 of the Collected Works,
nor did he read Volume 18, Philosophische Propaedeutic. In addition, Marx did not
read the essays as well as the journalism written by Hegel concerning contempo-
rary German politics that were contained in Volumes 16 and 17. I will discuss all
the black holes in later paragraphs of this chapter. However, the 1837 letter does
contain Marx’s first reference to Friedrich Karl Savigny and the German Historical
School of Law.
All these works played important roles in Marx’s reception of Hegel, and later sec-
tions of this chapter will more comprehensively trace how they infiltrated into
the various works of Marx.
For example, The History of Philosophy formed the scaffolding for the Young
Marx’s dissertation and his views on the historiography of philosophy. And
The Philosophy of Right became the target of Marx’s 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right’.
It is, however, The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences that draws our atten-
tion. This work consists of three volumes, The Logic, The Philosophy of Nature
and The Philosophy of Mind. The Young Marx’s exzerpte establishes that he read
Volume 2, Philosophy of Nature, because in 1839 Marx made a four-page sketch of
Hegel’s speculations regarding the material universe.5 While the Young Marx was
preparing to write his dissertation, which dealt with the Greek and Roman phi-
losophies of nature, he read and took notes on Volume Two of The Encyclopedia of
the Philosophical Sciences. This exzerpte was placed in the fifth notebook the Young
Marx used in the preparation of his dissertation.
In Chapter Three I single out the Young Marx’s acquaintance with The Philosophy
of Nature because in the 1839–1841 period, the years when the Young Marx wrote
his dissertation, he was intensely involved with the problem of a philosophy of
nature and these two or three years witnessed the origins of his materialism.
Marx’s essay, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, con-
tained in ‘The Manuscripts’, is another important guide to his knowledge of
Hegel. In this short essay Marx epitomizes his comprehension of Hegel. This dis-
tillation focuses on three Hegelian texts, The Phenomenology of Spirit, The Science
of Logic and The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, with an emphasis on The
Philosophy of Nature and The Philosophy of Mind. The fact that Marx in his ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ assumed he could encapsulate
the essence of Hegelian thought from these manuscripts again indicates that
all his information on Hegel was drawn from the boundaries established by the
1832–1845 edition of Hegel’s Collected Works. This edition formed the parameters
beyond which Marx’s reading of Hegel could not pass.
4) Marx devoted the entirety of ‘The Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’,
written in early 1843, to a refutation of Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right.6 References
to The Philosophy of Right also appear in ‘On the Jewish Question’.7
5) ‘The Manuscripts’: a disconnected and exploratory commentary on Hegel’s
The Phenomenoly of Spirit. Marx wrote these notebooks as forms of self-exploration
into Hegel’s masterpiece. They are exercises, internal dialogues on the best way to
critique Hegel’s The Phenomenology of Spirit.8
6) The works of the 1845–1848 period. This subdivision will specify the works
of Hegel that Marx cited in The Holy Family, ‘The Leipzig Council’ and The Poverty
of Philosophy (references to original editions).
Marx’s citation here refers to the three volume The Science of Logic. Marx’s dis-
sertation does not allude to The Science of Logic, or ‘Larger Logic’, but only to the
‘Smaller Logic’ of the Encyclopedia, so The Holy Family reference is Marx’s initial
reference to The Science Of Logic, or the ‘Larger Logic’.
The Holy Family also mentions the Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences,
The Philosophy of Right, The Phenomenology of Spirit and The History of Philosophy
and the editions of these works listed in The Holy Family match up with those in
the dissertation. The 1845 Marx used the same editions of these works that he
originally used in 1841.10
I can find no specific citation in either the 1836–1844 or 1844–1848 periods that
Marx read Volume 1 of the Encyclopedia, ‘The Logic’ or Smaller Logic, but since Marx
refers repeatedly to the Encyclopedia and since he singles out Volumes 2 and 3, The
Philosophy of Nature and The Philosophy of Mind, it is reasonable to assume that he
also knew the ‘Smaller Logic’, or Volume 1 of the Encyclopedia. Furthermore, Marx
had a copy of the Encyclopedia ‘Smaller Logic’ in his private library at the end of his
life. For a more complete reference to this particular volume see the next section.
It is this absolute Method that Hegel speaks of in these terms: ‘Method is abso-
lutely unique, supreme, infinite force, which no object can resist, it is the ten-
dency of reason to find itself again, to recognize itself in every object.’ (Logic,
Vol. III). All things being reduced to a logical category, and every movement,
every act of production, to method, it follows naturally that every aggregate
of products and production, of objects and of movement, can be reduced to
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 37
a form of applied metaphysics. What Hegel has done for religion, law, etc.
M. Proudhon seeks to do for political economy.
But once it has managed to pose itself as a thesis, this thesis, this thought,
opposed to itself, splits up into two contradictory thoughts; the positive and
the negative, the yes and the no. The struggle between these two antagonistic
elements compressed in the antithesis constitutes dialectical movement. The
yes becoming no, the no becoming yes, the yes becoming both no and yes, the
contradictories balance, neutralize, paralyze each other.
Just as from the dialectic movement of the simple categories is born the
group, so from the dialectical movement of the groups in born the series, and
from the dialectical movement of the series is born the entire system.19
Without a deep probe, which will come later, into the full meaning of these para-
graphs two smaller, but important, factors deserve attention at this point. First,
these passages document definitively that Marx read the chapter on ‘Method’
in Book III of The Science of Logic. Marx’s knowledge of the ‘Method’ chapter of
Book III in 1847 is vital when trying to assess the origins of Marx’s new method-
ology of social formations and its derivation from the Hegelian System. Second,
this passage also contains Marx’s first allusion to the dialectic of thesis–antithesis–
synthesis. In the context of Marx’s Discourse with Hegel it will be impossible to
track the subsequent historiography of the dialectic of thesis–antithesis–synthesis,
but The Poverty of Philosophy is the starting point of this journey.
The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Theil 1. Die Logik. hrsg. vom
Leopold von Henning (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot 1840). (Werke. Vollst.
Ausg. Durch einen Verein von freunden der Verewigten), Bd. 6.
The History of Philosophy, hrsg. vom Carl Ludwig Michelet. Theil 2.3.2 verb.
Saufl. (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot 1842–1844). (Werke. Vollst. Ausg. Durch
einen Verein von Freunden der Verewigten . . . 2Aufl), Bd. 14, 15.
The reader’s attention is called to the fact that the copy of The History of
Philosophy Marx had in his private possession is different from the copy he
used when writing his dissertation. In his library Marx had the Michelet edi-
tion published in Berlin by Duncker and Humblot, 1842–1844, while for his
dissertation Marx used the Hegel Collected Works, Volume 14, published in
Berlin in 1833.
The Philosophy Of History, hrsg. vom Eduard Gans (Berlin: Duncker und
Humblot), 1837 (Werke, Vollst. Ausgabe durch einen Verein von Freunden des
Verewigten), Bd. 9.
38 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The Science of Logic, hrsg. vom Leopold von Henning, 2., unverant. Augl.
(Berlin: Duncker und Humblot 1840–1844). (Werke, Vollst. Ausg. Durch einen
Verein von Freunden des Ewigten. 2Aufl.), Bd. 3–5.
The reader’s attention is drawn to the fact that The Science of Logic in Marx’s own
library is the same edition as that quoted in The Holy Family.20
Notice needs to be brought to the additions (Zusatze) made to the Hegelian texts
by his editors. The additions were supplements introduced into the text by the
editors who acquired this material from his own attendance, or from the notes
of other students who were in the auditorium, when Hegel lectured on these
subjects. Gans edited the 1833 edition of The Philosophy of Right, but there are no
additions in this original edition. However, the three-volume Encyclopedia of the
Philosophical Sciences is different. Published in 1840, the Logic contains additions
supplied by Leopold von Henning; published in 1842, The Philosophy of Nature
contains additions by Michelet; published in 1845, The Philosophy of Mind con-
tains additions by Ludwig Boumann. Specifically, the additions of Michelet and
Boumann are the most important from the perspective of this book because they
are extensive and relate to the question of subjective activity in Hegel. Moreover,
these Michelet and Boumann editions were both published as part of the first
Collected Works of Hegel, 1832–1845, and were thus accessible to Marx.
1) The Difference of the Fichtean and Schellingean System of Philosophy. Hegel moved
to Jena in 1801 and in that year Seidler’s Academic Bookstore published this
pamphlet of over 100 pages. This long essay was Hegel’s first publicly recognized
publication. This article was a comparison of the philosophic systems of Fichte
and Schelling and marked the moment ‘The Master’ emancipated himself from
the influence of Schelling and embarked upon his own theoretical quest.21
3) Schelling left the University of Jena in 1803, but between the years 1802–1803
he and Hegel co-edited a journal called The Critical Journal of Philosophy. During
these two years Hegel published six articles in this journal and Marx never read
them. The unread articles are:
All these essays documented the stages of the Young Hegel’s philosophical devel-
opment. With the exception of ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’
they depicted episodes in the evolution of Hegel’s logic, as well as his relation to
the philosophers Fichte, Kant and Schelling. A seventh essay that Marx failed to
read, ‘The Difference of the Fichtean and Schellingian System of Philosophy’, was
published in 1801 as a separate pamphlet bearing Hegel’s name and therefore
accessible to Marx (see above).
It is important to note that of the six essays mentioned above three were con-
tained in Volume 1 of the Collected Works. These were: ‘Faith and Knowledge’,
‘On the Relationship of Natural Philosophy and Philosophy in General’, and
‘On The Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’. In addition, Volume 1 also
contained the essay ‘The Difference of the Fichtean and Schellingian System of
Philosophy’.
Volume 16 of the Collected Works contained three of the essays mentioned
above: ‘On The Nature of Philosophic Criticism’, ‘How Common Sense Construes
Philosophy’, and ‘The Relation of Scepticism to Philosophy’. If Marx had read
Volume 16 he would have familiarized himself with all three essays. Volume 16
also contained Hegel’s dissertation.
The reader must be made aware that the Hegel essays in The Critical Journal
of Philosophy were unsigned, so if Marx had read this journal he could not have
automatically attributed their authorship to Hegel. Nevertheless, these essays were
included in the Collected Works, edited by ‘The Society of Friends of the Deceased’,
so Marx’s knowledge of the Collected Works was sufficient to make him aware of
Hegel’s authorship. In other words, if Marx’s knowledge of Hegel had been limited
to The Critical Journal of Philosophy he would not have known that Hegel was the
originator of these articles, but since Marx was familiar with the Collected Works
this should have provided him with confirmation of Hegel’s authorship.23
Even though Marx was involved in an intensive study of Hegel from 1839 to
1841, the years of his writing of his dissertation, he did not read these essays
and there are two primary reasons for this. First, regardless of Marx’s mastery of
the Hegelian material that related to his doctoral dissertation he did not plan to
write a biography of Hegel, or a monograph on the entire system of Hegelian
thought and so these essays that were maps to Hegel’s early development held
no interest for him. Second, the gravity of Marx’s interest in Hegel fell upon The
Phenomenology of Mind, The Science of Logic, The Philosophy of Law, The Encyclopedia
of the Philosophical Sciences, The History of Philosophy and The Philosophy of History,
and Marx was mostly concerned with Hegel’s logical, historical and political theo-
ries. The Phenomenology of Spirit drew his attention because of its speculations on
subjective labor and Hegel’s portrayal, patterned upon Diderot’s Rameau’s Nephew,
of alienation in bourgeois society; The Science of Logic attracted him because it
provided a method, analytic tools, by which to analyze the structure of social
40 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
totalities; The Philosophy of Right was the epitome of Hegel’s social and political
philosophy; The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences contained the ‘Smaller
Logic’ and insights into Hegel’s philosophy of nature; The History of Philosophy
provided him with Hegel’s interpretation of the evolution of philosophy, Greek
philosophy in particular, and acted as the background to Marx’s dissertation; The
Philosophy of History offered insights into Hegel’s theory of historicity, or Hegel’s
belief that historicity defined every human endeavor and that philosophy itself
was the curriculum vitae of the human mind. Marx studied the ‘Parmenides of
Berlin’ because of Hegel’s stature in Germany and because he hoped that he would
offer him instruments for a critique of social structures, politics and the develop-
ment of capitalist society. Hegel’s own process of philosophical maturation was
not Marx’s predominant concern.
In addition to the essays listed above there were four other essays published by
Hegel that were available to Marx and that he did not read:
To summarize, Marx did not read any of the sources contained in Volumes 1, 16,
17 and 18 of Hegel’s Collected Works.
Hegel lived from 1770 until 1831 and Marx lived from 1818 until 1883 so the
composition of these works can either date prior to or after Marx’s birth. The
works listed below are either completed works which were not published until
after Marx’s death, or incomplete drafts, letters, diaries or notes. Furthermore,
the list of books, diaries, essays and correspondence cited below is not intended
as an encyclopedic recounting of every instance of Hegel’s writing published
after Marx’s death, but its purpose is to alert the reader as to the vast amount of
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 41
Hegel material that was brought out of the black hole after Marx died as a means
of illustrating the limited knowledge of Hegel that Marx possessed in his own
lifetime.
The years 1836 to 1850 formed an epoch in which Marx conducted an extended
discourse with Hegel. They were also the years of the Young Marx. Ironically, the
Young Marx was totally cut off from the Young Hegel. The Young Marx’s discourse
with Hegel was conducted with the Mature Hegel.
For the most part, in the remainder of this chapter I will discuss Hegel mate-
rial that was available to Marx, but that he allowed to disappear in the black
hole of absence. I begin with a discussion of Hegel’s essay ‘On the Scientific
Method of Treating Natural Law’. I will then proceed to discuss three books of
Karl Rosenkranz, Hegel’s Life, the Philosophical Propaedeutic, or Volume 18 of the
Collected Works, and Psychology: or the Science of Subjective Spirit. In particular,
Rosenkranz’s biography of Hegel contained crucial references to a book Hegel
had read, James Steuart’s Inquiry into the Principles of Political Economy, as well as
to three vital Hegel essays, ‘Proceedings of the Estates Assembly in the Kingdom
of Württemberg’, ‘The German Constitution’ and ‘The English Reform Bill’.
Marx had no knowledge of the books written by Rosenkranz or the Hegel essays
mentioned by Rosenkranz.
I will discuss each of these texts because they are the best illustrations of the
losses Marx suffered in his appreciation of Hegel due to being unfamiliar with
these sources. The deficit Marx incurred by not reading them contributed to his
misshapen interpretation of Hegel, and this is a pivotal theme of Marx’s Discourse
with Hegel. These texts form the center of gravity of the Invisible Hegel.
As a means of providing the complete bibliography which led to the gestation
of the Invisible Hegel I will briefly comment on Rudolf Haym’s biography of
Hegel and Thaulow’s collection of Hegel exzerpte and notes. Both of these books
were in print while Marx was alive but in exile in London. Furthermore, in order
to fully account for the Invisible Hegel archive I will also briefly comment upon
Hegel’s publication of Cart’s Confidential Letters and his journalistic article ‘On
The Recent Domestic Affairs of Württemberg and the Municipal Constitution
in Particular’, although these last two Hegel sources were published after Marx’s
death.
On the positive side, however, this consciousness is the singularity and sepa-
rateness of the individual. But this inherent negativity (consciousness as such),
of which the distinctions just made are merely its two aspects, is absolutely
taken up into the positive; its separateness and infinity, or ideality, is absolutely
and perfectly taken up into the universal and real. This unity (of universal
and particular) is the Idea of the absolute life of the ethical. In this oneness of
infinity and reality in the ethical organization, the divine nature . . . of which
Plato says, ‘It is an immortal animal whose soul and body are eternally bound
together’ . . . seems to display the wealth of its multiplicity both in the highest
energy of infinity and in unity which is the wholly simple nature of the ideal
element.28
In this paragraph Hegel puts forth his own suppositions of the ethical. Contrary
to Kant’s individualism, the ethical for Hegel is the result of a combination of the
individual and the universal. To be ethical the individual must act as a member of
a totality, a fusion of the private and the communal. Contrary to Rousseau, Hegel
defined the universal not as a natural state, but as a man-made state, or the social.
Following the Greeks, Hegel defined man as a ‘political animal’, that is, as a being
who by nature cannot be separated from the social.
In order to fully understand the historical emergence of ethicality in Hegelian
thought it is necessary to describe the four stages in this evolutionary process:
intersubjectivity, recognition, morality and ethicality. I will discuss each of these
stages below
Intersubjectivity relates to the stage of human development in which the indi-
vidual must relate to an Other. A relationship to an Other began on economic
grounds. When the survival of the Self was only possible by means of a rela-
tion to an Other, intersubjectivity presented itself. Intersubjectivity and mutual
dependence were synonymous. One of the earliest expressions of intersubjectivity
44 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
in the work of Hegel was the chapter ‘Independence and Dependence of Self-
Consciousness: Lordship and Bondage’ in The Phenomenology of Spirit which is
devoted to the ‘Master-Slave’ relationship, but in this chapter intersubjectivity is
portrayed as enslavement, rather than the harmony of the Greek polis.
The existence of intersubjectivity was the ground out of which recognition
arose. Mutual recognition was the understanding that survival of both the Self
and the Other depended upon the co-existence of a Self and an Other. Mutual
recognition was the consciousness that both Self and Other was a necessity if both
Self and Other were to survive.
Morality related to individual behavior. Morality concerned the codes of actions
adopted by an autonomous Self.
Ethicality became an actuality when a Self connected to a universality. The
production of a code of behavior based upon the principle that an individual
must be congruent with the collective, or universal, was ethicality. The definition
of ethicality for Hegel was the conjoining of the subjective with the universal, or
the state.
Returning to the Greeks for inspiration, Hegel quoted from Aristotle’s The
Politics:
The state comes by nature before the individual, if the individual in isolation is
not anything self-sufficient, he must be related to the whole state in one unity,
just as the other parts are in their whole. But a man is incapable of communal
life, or who he is so self-sufficing that He does not need it, is no part of the state
and must be either a beast or a god.29
Hegel’s 1802–1803 essay ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ pro-
vided the scaffolding for his mature political philosophy found in The Philosophy
of Right. Influenced by Aristotle’s The Politics, Hegel defined politics as an exercise
in the ethical. An admirer of the Athenian polis, Hegel sought to recapture the
synthesis of homme and citoyen that the polis symbolized.
In order to arrive at this definition of the state Hegel embarked upon two
strategies of displacement. He must replace the Kantian individual with a social
collectivity and he must replace Kantian moral legislation with intersubjectivity.
In his second strategy Hegel must displace Rousseau’s state of nature with civil
society. Whereas Rousseau believed in a mythical social contract through which
individuals transcended the state of nature and legislated a sovereignty, Hegel
replaced political mythology with sociology. Hegel rebutted the state of nature,
accepted the evolutionary theories describing the ascent of man from hunter to
civil society. Based on the principle of economic interdependence civil society was
the social form that corresponded with the interconnected economic relations
created by the commercial revolution of the 17th and 18th centuries.
Hegel drew a distinction between civil society and state. Civil society related
to the familial, to economic activities, class and to legal and police functions.
In Hegel’s time the police were not limited to combating crime, but also per-
formed administrative operations such as the dispensing of public welfare to the
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 45
impoverished. The concept of the state related to the political organization of civil
society. Indeed, the structure of civil society provided the conditions upon which
the state was built. Hegel asserted a historicist view of civil society and state: the
socio-economic structure of civil society was constantly changing as a result of
the change in the mode of production and the state was also a historicist product
because the form of the state constantly altered so as to correspond to the form
of civil society.
In the 1802–1803 ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ Hegel again
demonstrated his awareness of political economy, a subject he first became aware
of when he was a tutor in Berne. This essay contained the following passage:
There are physical needs and enjoyments which, put again on their own
account in a totality, obey in their infinite intertwining one single necessity
and the system of universal mutual dependence in relation to physical needs
and work and the amassing (of wealth) for their needs. And this system, as a
science, is the system of the so-called political economy that in a people the
commonweal has to see to it that every citizen shall have sufficiency, and that
there be perfect security and ease of gain. This last proposition, understood in
an absolute principle, would be on the contrary exclude a negative treatment
of the system of possession, and would allow the system full sway to entrench
itself absolutely.30
Hegel read political economy from the perspective of ethicality. Hegel was conscious
of the unequal distribution of wealth in a capitalist society, but he justified the
capitalist economic system because it gave rise to mutual recognition. The division
of labor, the cooperative arrangements between the agrarian countryside and the
industrial urban centers, were the wombs of social interdependence.
Political economy, for Hegel, was not merely the realm of commerce and
manufacture, but also the foundational moment of the ethical. The inception
of ethical life started in civil society, at the level of political economy, because it
was instance at which human interdependence started. The need to produce and
exchange goods was the ground out of which human relationships commenced,
or civil society was the moment at which individuals were forced to relate to a
social network larger than themselves.
Hegel extended his definition of ethicality beyond ‘On the Scientific Method of
Treating Natural Law’ to his major notebooks from the Jena Period. Even though
it is beyond the remit of this book, it is worth observing that one of these Jenaer
Outlines carried the title of ‘The Ethical System’ and was a description of the
economic activities of man, the recognition that the survival of humankind was
dependent upon its ability to satisfy its physical needs. Nevertheless, Hegel enti-
tled these politico-economic manuscripts ‘The Ethical System’ because his ultimate
goal was to construct an ethical system and he was aware that interdependence,
even economic, was the foundation of the ethical.
The sophistication of Hegel’s grasp of political economy was made apparent
by his inclusion of property and class in his discussion. Hegel defended private
46 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
In ‘The Scientific Ways of Treating Natural Law’ Hegel attacked the Historical
School of Law because of its positivism. True to his historicism, true to his belief that
legal systems changed in terms of the civilization in which they found themselves,
Hegel drew an analogy between systems of philosophy and law. Just as each histori-
cal organism gave rise to its own philosophic perspective, so each historical organ-
ism encouraged the development of system of laws that corresponded to the spirit
of that historical totality. Law was not static, it too underwent transformation.35
While he was Editor of the Rheinische Zeitung, Marx published, in August 1842,
‘The Philosophical Manifesto of the Historical School of Law’; in general he refut-
ed the entire Historical School of Law, but in particular one of the major mem-
bers of this school, Gustav Hugo.36 As I indicated in the preceding paragraphs,
Marx remained uninformed about Hegel’s refutation of the Historical School of
Law in ‘On the Scientific Ways of Treating Natural Law’, and Marx also made no
reference to Hegel’s denunciation of the Historical School of Law and of Hugo
contained in his 1820 The Philosophy of Right. I have established that Marx had
read The Philosophy of Right by 1841 because it is listed as a source in the bibli-
ography to his dissertation. In the ‘Introduction’ to The Philosophy of Right Hegel
wrote several pages attacking the theoretic presuppositions both of Hugo and the
Historical School of Law, but Marx does not call upon Hegel as a confirming voice
in his own ‘The Philosophical Manifesto of the Historical School of Law’. While
Marx critiqued Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right in 1843, one year earlier, in 1842,
he did not call upon Hegel’s work as a reference or support for his own essay in
the Rheinische Zeitung.
Marx mentioned Savigny in his 1837 letter to his father and in the same year
Marx took Savigny’s lecture course on the Roman Pandects. The year 1837 was
important in the intellectual maturation of Marx because during this time he
was introduced to the legal philosophy of the Historical School of Law due to his
attendance at Savigny’s lectures and his reading of Savigny’s book on property,
and to the countervailing legal philosophy of Eduard Gans, whose course he also
took at the University of Berlin.37
The consequence of Marx failing to read ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating
Natural Law’ was that he remained blind to important elements of Hegelian
thought, elements that might have altered his vision of Hegel as a Speculative
philosopher. A knowledge of this essay would have revealed to Marx a Hegel
in which the practical, the political-economic and the notion of the evolution
of the state out of the practices of civil society played crucial roles. In addition,
a knowledge of this essay would have brought to light a Hegel who understood
the ethical nature of the state.
In my book Divergent Paths38 I examined Marx’s reading of Hegel’s The Philosophy
of Right. Marx’s ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ begins with paragraph
261 of Hegel’s book, that is, Marx devoted his entire commentary to Hegel’s
theory of the state, and omitted any reference to Hegel’s discussion of ‘civil
society’, which runs from paragraphs 182 to 256. However, in his commentary
Marx wrote a sentence indicating that in a future work he would return to The
Philosophy of Right and offer a critique of Hegel’s theory of civil society: ‘This will
48 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
be further considered in the section on “civil society”’.39 I maintain that the com-
mitment Marx made in 1843 in Germany he fulfilled in 1844 in France because
‘The Manuscripts’ is the promised ‘section on “civil society”’ but buttressed at this
point by Marx’s greater familiarity with Ricardo and Smith, or English political
economy in general.
A pivotal concept in Marx’s Method of social analysis is the distinction between
civil society and state. An understanding of Marx’s theory of politics, of the state
and communism, is simply impossible without presupposing the civil society–
state differentiation. Marx appropriated this dichotomy from his reading of The
Philosophy of Right.
The Hegelian division between civil society and state contributed to Marx’s
discovery of his Method of social analysis. By 1844 Marx learned about the clash
between the means and mode of production from Wilhelm Schulz’s book, The
Movement of Production and to this insight he added the economic historicism of
Hegel, that the galvanizing force in history was the metamorphosis of civil society
and that political superstructures were themselves reflections of civil society.
Granting that Marx’s ignorance of ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural
Law’ did not ultimately prevent him from grasping the foundational role civil
society played in Hegel’s historical perceptions it is nevertheless true that this
ignorance caused a delay. If Marx had read this Hegelian essay his awareness of the
centrality of civil society would have developed earlier. On the question of civil
society the issue was one of timing and degree.
This conclusion does not hold in relation to the topic of political economy. By
not reading ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ Marx remained
uninformed about Hegel’s interest in political economy. Marx’s interest in politi-
cal economy was manifested for the first time in his 1844 exzerpte on List and
Mill, but if he had read the 1802–1803 Jena ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating
Natural Law’ his engagement with political economy might have started earlier.
Marx was unaware both in the pre-1807 and post-1807 periods of Hegel’s interest
in political economy.
In addition, Marx was non-conversant with the regard of ‘The Master’ for
Montesquieu as articulated in ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’.
Leaving this essay aside for a moment, Marx did read Hegel texts that did express
Hegel’s high regard for Montesquieu. In the research he undertook for his dis-
sertation Marx read Hegel’s The History of Philosophy, and Volume 3 of this work
contains a short but laudatory paragraph on Montesquieu. Hegel wrote that in
The Spirit of the Laws Montesquieu ‘regarded the nations from this important view,
that their constitution, their religion, in short everything that is to be found in a
state, constitutes a totality’.40 The Philosophy of Right also contained several pages
in which Hegel praised this 18th-century French philosopher.41
Marx’s earliest comments on Montesquieu occur in 1842. In an article he
wrote for the Rheinische Zeitung in that year, ‘Debates over the Freedom of the
Press’, Marx alludes to Montesquieu for the first time.42 His essay, ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ also makes reference to Montesquieu43 as does his
journalistic foray ‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’.44
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 49
both The Philosophy of Mind and The History of Philosophy so he was certainly aware
of Hegel’s respect for Aristotle’s perspective on human psychology.
Additionally, the Young Marx knew Aristotle in his own right. In his 1837 letter
to his father the 19-year-old Marx writes that he ‘partially translated Aristotle’s
“Rhetorik”’.49 In addition, Marx himself made exzerpte from Aristotle’s ‘The Soul’
in approximately 1843.50
Aristotle’s ‘The Soul’ accentuated the practical aspects of human psychology.
Aristotle described human behavior as the movement from potential to actual,
the inherent tendency of humans to intervene in the external, and this portrayal
of human psychology emphasized the subjective activity of the individual. Even
though Marx read both The Philosophy of Mind and The History of Philosophy, he
refused to acknowledge Hegel’s appropriation of the subjective, practical and
pneumatological aspects of Aristotle’s portrait of humanity.
However, Marx was familiar with Hegel’s glorification of Greek culture. Part Two,
‘The Greek World’, in Hegel’s The Philosophy of History immortalizes the Greeks as
the discoverers of subjectivity. This subjectivity assumes three forms: the idoliza-
tion of the human form in painting and sculpture; the embodiment of heroic
virtue in the epic and tragedy and the unity of the subjective and the communal
in their political theory. Chapter Three of ‘The Greek World’, is subtitled ‘The
Political Work of Art’ and was a hymn to the political genius of the Athenians.51
Volume 2 of Hegel’s The History of Philosophy is devoted for the most part to
an analysis of the philosophy of Plato and Aristotle. In particular, Hegel extols
Aristotle’s politics because it attempts to create a synthesis between the subject
and the community. For Aristotle politics was a branch of practical philosophy
and as such it was a prolegomena to the ethical; in this manner the Athenian polis
was a work of beauty and art.52
Marx knew Hegel’s The Philosophy of History, The History of Philosophy and The
Philosophy of Right and both Marx and Hegel shared the Aristotelian project of
perpetuating politics as an ethical domain.53 Although Hegel and Marx shared this
goal they took different paths to this end. In transforming the polis Hegel sought
to maintain individuality and to preserve the Self’s rational essentialism, while
Marx, influenced by Feuerbach, saw man as anthropologically social and replaced
rational essentialism with labor.
Marx’s advance to the ethico-political was predicated on two axioms that contra-
dicted Hegel, the inherent social nature of humankind and the universality of labor.
In Marx, the social collectivity took precedence over the individual. Influenced by
Feuerbach’s concept of species being Marx began from the normative basis that
human existence was social and not individual. Marx also rejected all forms of
rational essentialism. Humanity was not distinguished by reason, but by practice,
and practice in Marx was focused on economic labor. The intersubjective basis of
society emanated from labor.
In The Politics Aristotle strove for the unification of the zoon oikonikon, the per-
son of the household, and the zoon politikon, the person involved in the affairs of
the state.54 Aristotle’s dream lived on in Rousseau’s The Social Contract in which
Rousseau envisioned the ethical nature of the state as arising from the conjoining
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 51
of homme and citoyen. Hegel and Marx, although by means of different strategies,
also sought the homogenization of zoon oikonikon and zoon politikon. The vision
of Hegel and Marx can best be described as the polis transformed as a means to
accommodate both the industrial and capitalist revolutions.
Marx knew the most important works in which ‘The Master’ sought to config-
ure ethics and politics, to assume the role of a 19th-century German Aristotle.
In his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ Marx made the following two
comments: 1) ‘namely, in that Hegel passes off the state which is based on such
a morality for the actual idea of ethical life’;55 2) ‘But Hegel is content that in the
state which he demonstrates to be the self-conscious mode of being of ethical
spirit . . .’56 In terms of the problematic of ethics and politics in Hegel I fault Marx
on two accounts. First, Marx seems skeptical and dismissive of Hegel’s attempt to
conjoin ethics and politics; Marx’s strategy is to judge Hegel’s Aristotelianism as
just another projection of ‘logical pantheism’. Second, due to his disbelief, Marx
fails to devote sufficient time to the exploration of this aspect of Hegelian politics.
It is impossible to understand The Philosophy of Right correctly unless the ethical
dimension is given appropriate weight. On this problematic the absence of ‘On the
Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ took a serious toll and helped to initiate
this black hole. The gestation of the Invisible Hegel saw the light of day.
2) Political economy
Marx’s failure to read ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ only
delayed his own study of political economy. It did not leave a permanent gap
as he returned to this subject as early as early as late 1843 and the beginning of
1844 in his exzerpte on List and Mill. Nevertheless, Marx’s ignorance of ‘On The
Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ kept him uninformed about Hegel’s
investment in political economy. The side of Hegel who was interested in practical
activity, concerned about the evolutionary products of human economic activity,
was buried to Marx.
3) Civil society
Marx’s ignorance of ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ merely
delayed his awareness of the importance of civil society. As I pointed out earlier,
Marx already in his 1843 essay ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ prom-
ised to take up the issue of civil society, and in his autumn 1843 ‘On the Jewish
Question’ and his August 1844 ‘Critical Marginal Notes on the Article “The King
of Prussia and Social Reform” by a Prussian’ he started to address the issue of civil
society even before the completion of ‘The Manuscripts’.
4) The state
Leaving aside the issue of ethics, I separate civil society and state because both
Marx and Hegel were aware of this distinction. I devote a separate subdivision to
the concept of the state because it is impossible to understand Marx’s definition
of communism without an initial understanding of what he means by the
dichotomy between civil society and state.
52 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Hegel was one of the first to inform Marx of the difference between civil soci-
ety and state. Like the Scots who influenced him, Hegel understood civil society
as the terrain of the family and economics, while the state was a political entity
whose organization reflected the structure of civil society. Just as history produced
different civil societies, hunting, agriculture and commerce so history gave rise to
separate forms of the state which were outgrowths of these variegated civil socie-
ties. Marx also adopted this paradigm, which ran from Montesquieu to Ferguson.
Recapitulating the Scots and Hegel, Marx was convinced that states were trans-
figurations of civil society, or just as there was a historiography of civil society so
there was a corresponding historiography of the state.
Marx’s deep probe into the theory of the state begins in March 1843 with his
‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’. The theory of the state continued to be
of central concern to Marx until August 1844 when his interests began to shift to
political economy. Within this sixteen-month period Marx not only completed
his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, but also ‘On the Jewish Question’
(Autumn 1843), ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ ( January
1844) and ‘Critical Marginal Notes on the Article “The King of Prussia and Social
Reform” by a Prussian’ ( July 1844), all of which are indispensible to fathoming
Marx’s theory of the state and politics. The fact that Marx had no knowledge
of ‘On the Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’ merely delayed Marx’s
entrance into the sphere of a theory of the state.
Having drawn this separation between civil society and state it is impossible for
me to discuss in depth at this point Marx’s definition of the state because such
an analysis requires a volume of its own and will divert us from the issues before
us at this point.
5) Montesquieu
As previous paragraphs indicated, Marx did not need Hegel to introduce him to
Montesquieu. Nevertheless, Hegel and Montesquieu elevated Marx’s awareness
of the importance of civil society and encouraged him to read more deeply into
18th-century social theory and the Scottish School of Historiography. Marx’s
acquaintance with the Scottish School, Smith, Ferguson, Steuart, Hutchinson,
brought his attention to the historiography of societies, the transformations
socio-economic formation underwent over time, and as Marx read into Scottish
historical sociology he found Montesquieu of greater interest. The historiography
of societies of the Scottish School and Montesquieu were precursors of Marx’s
Method of political economy and social explanation.
ridiculed the Historical School of Law in this article. Furthermore, in his 1831 ‘The
English Reform Bill’ Hegel continued his nullification of the Historical School of
Law. But Marx never read the ‘Proceedings of the Estates Assembly in the Kingdom
of Württemberg’ or ‘The English Reform Bill’, and as a consequence he detached
himself from the above-mentioned three sources in which Hegel expressed his
antipathy to Savigny’s school.
However, Marx’s lack of knowledge of Hegel’s denunciation of the German
Historical School of Law was only a temporary loss to him.
Marx’s antipathy to the German Historical School of Law came from different
sources, in particular Gans. A professional colleague as well as a personal friend
of Hegel, Gans continued the Hegelian tradition of invalidating the German
Historical School of Law. When Marx was a student at the University of Berlin
he took two courses from Gans and probably was introduced to the Hegelian-
Gans aversion to the Historical School of Law. The coursework Marx took from
Gans served as a preparation for the writing of his 1842 article ‘The Philosophical
Manifesto of the Historical School of Law’.
Karl Rosenkranz
Marx did not read any of the books published by Rosenkranz, a prolific com-
mentator on the work of Hegel. In particular, there were three books published
by Rosenkranz that Marx was ignorant of and this lacuna caused enormous inac-
curacies in Marx’s understanding of Hegel. One of these books was Rosenkranz’s
Hegel’s Life,57 published in 1844, and the second was the Philosophical Propaedeutic,
Volume 18 of the Collected Works,58 published in 1840 at the time Marx was writ-
ing his dissertation. The third, published in 1837, was Psychology: or the Science of
Subjective Spirit.59 It is important to remember that Marx and his new wife Jenny
left Germany in October 1843 to resettle in Paris and Marx’s resettlement in France
symbolized his movement out of Hegelian debates and into the controversies of
political economy.
Rosenkranz’s Hegel’s Life, the Philosophical Propaedeutic and Psychology: or the
Science of Subjective Spirit are extremely significant in understanding those parts of
the Hegel corpus Marx did not know and so I will discuss them according to the
following outline:
1) Hegel’s Life
a) Philosophy
b) Politics
c) Hegel’s Reading of James Steuart’s Inquiry into the Principles of Political
Economy.
d) ‘Proceedings of the Estates Assembly in the Kingdom of Württemburg,
1817–1818’.
e) ‘The English Reform Bill’ (1831)
f) ‘The German Constitution’
2) Philosophical Propaedeutic
3) Psychology: or the Science of Subjective Spirit
54 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
1) Hegel’s Life
a) Philosophy Rosenkranz belonged to the Hegelian Loyalists who defended The
Master against the attacks of Schelling and those who accused Hegel of being an
apologist for the Prussian Crown.60 To a Hegel partisan like Engels, Rosenkranz
was an active participant in the Schelling–Hegel debates and whereas Schelling
advocated a philosophy of identity, Rosenkranz presented a Hegel preaching the
duality between the concept and the actual.
In his 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ Marx defined Hegel as a
‘logical pantheist’, but on this issue Rosenkranz contradicts Marx. Rosenkranz
absolves Hegel of all ‘logical theism’,61 claiming that Hegel denied all forms of
theology. Rather than ‘logical theism’ or ‘logical pantheism’ Hegel recognized the
antinomies between idea and actuality. According to Rosenkranz, the Hegel of The
Science of Logic offered an explanation of how the antithesis between concept and
reality was overcome in the Idea.
The contribution of ‘The Master’ was a philosophy of reconciliation. Even
though he began with the presupposition of the separation of materialism and
rationality, of empiricism and thought, Hegel maintained that the antipodes
could be reconciled by reason. The Science of Logic was a description of the pro-
ductive activity of reason, or the modes by which reason achieved the unification
between itself and reality in the Idea.
Hegelian philosophy was a description of the practice of the Idea. It was a
recording of the stages through which Idea must pass in order to arrive at the
unity of concept and reality.62 When this unity was attained the dualism between
mind and actuality was overcome and the oneness of these distinct realms was
accomplished.
But the historical nature of reality meant that the praxis of reason was also
historical. Reality was in a constant process of transformation and reason had to
comprehend these ceaseless historical mutations and therefore in itself became
historical. As reason was presented with different historical totalities reason was
required to accept this historicity in order to turn these objects into objects reason
could enter.
Reason was the immanence of history. This did not mean that every aspect of
reality was constructed by reason, that the totality of reality was rational. Rather,
it meant that those particularities of the cosmology of reality were inserted into
the real by reason. Since reason could only understand reason then the rationality
of the real was the immanence of reason.
Rosenkranz denied that Hegelian philosophy was an ‘ontological purism’.63 He
constantly stressed the historicity of philosophy and the praxis of the concept
to adjust to this historicity. He wrote that The Master believed that there could
‘never be a final system of philosophy’.64
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 55
b) Politics Most of the members of ‘The Society of the Friends of the Deceased’
were Liberal Monarchist – the Hegelian Center – and since they claimed descent
from Hegel it was to be expected that they defined him as the originator of this
political position.
Rosenkranz pictured Hegel as a descendent of the German Reform movement
led by Stein and Hardenberg. After Napoleon inflicted devastating military defeats
on the Prussian Crown, Stein and Hardenberg became convinced that aspects of
the Prussian state were residues of the Middle Ages. In order to modernize the
Hohenzollern Monarchy, to render it politically and militarily capable of self-
preservation against Napoleonic armies, Stein and Hardenberg proposed a series
of internal political reformations.
Hegel perpetuated the reformist legacy of Stein and Hardenberg and in addi-
tion he supported Napoleon in the Emperor’s attempt to uproot medievalism
in Germany. Hegel was aware of the dangers of the overreaching ambitious of
the French Emperor, but after Napoleon’s victory at the Battle of Jena in 1806
he claimed that Napoleon was ‘the world spirit on horseback’. Despite his fears
of Napoleon, Hegel welcomed his political reformism. When he evicted Prussia
from the left bank of the Rhine, Napoleon carried French revolutionary reforms
to Germany, careers open to talent, the beginning of the centralization of the
legal code, the ending of medieval particularism, the separation of Church and
State, and the granting of self-government to local cities and communities. The
Napoleonic victories, even though they entailed the subjugation of Germany to
French will, also entailed the beginning of the modernization of Germany, and
Hegel was a advocate of such modernization.65
The reform movement of Stein and Hardenberg was not democratic and neither
was Hegel. Possessing an ambivalent attitude toward Rousseau, Hegel adhered
to Rousseau’s principle of individual will,66 but not to the Rousseauist ideal of
democracy. The lowest levels of society – Hegel referred to them as ‘pobel’, or
rabble67 – were uneducated, unemployed, lacking any awareness of, or engage-
ment in, politics and should not vote. Hegel believed that voting should be
restricted to the educated, those classes who had an interest in and a knowledge of
politics. The pobel were encased in extreme subjectivity, or were driven by poverty
to focus on their own self-preservation and such subjectivity was destructive of
the state. Throughout his life Hegel viewed extreme subjectivity as the antipode
to the ethical, or the universality of the state.
The 19-year-old Hegel was an enthusiast for the 1789 French Revolution.
Rosenkranz describes how the three close friends of the Tübingenstift, Hegel,
Hölderlein and Schelling, supported the early revolutionary events in Paris.68
When Marx did not read the Rosenkranz biography he remained a stranger
to the Young Hegel’s political radicalism.69 But the Young Hegel’s pro-uprising
sentiments of 1789 did not mean that he advocated a 1793 Jacobin Reign of
Terror. The Young Hegel was more a Girondist than a Robespierrean.70 As Hegel
matured he grew suspicious of all forms of revolutionary activity and in his 1807
The Phenomenology of Spirit denounced Jacobinism.71 In 1819 a radical student
organization, a secret society which advocated democracy, the Burschenschaft
56 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
I draw a distinction here between practice and praxis. Both concepts are oppo-
sitional to theory, but they differ in terms of the areas of their activity. Practice
is subjective activity directed at civil society, the production of conditions con-
ducive to human well-being. In his The Philosophy of Mind Hegel understands
the goal of the practical as the attainment of human happiness, eudemonism
in the sense of Aristotle, or a social condition encouraging a sense of personal
fulfillment.77 Conversely, praxis is subjective activity directed at the political.
Praxis is an endeavor to modify political structures for the purpose of increasing
the expanse of human freedom. While Hegel acknowledged the role of practical
activity in the advance of civil society, Marx applauded praxis as the best means
to achieve the proletarian revolution.
Hegel thus bequeathed a reformist agenda to his partisans in ‘The Society of
the Friends of the Deceased’. In the period of the Restoration the legacy of Liberal
Hegelianism called for the modernization of the Hohenzollern Monarchy and this
was one of the reasons that Frederick William IV called upon Schelling to come
to the University of Berlin to discredit Hegel. These were the political camps of
Vormarz Prussia.
Marx’s failure to read Rosenkranz’s Hegel’s Life augmented three deficiencies in
his view of Hegel.
First, Marx remained unresponsive to the dialogue concerning the ethical nature
of the state in Hegel. Hegel’s Life was unequivocal and would have compelled Marx
to confront this vital aspect of Hegelian political theory. Marx was led to distort
Hegel’s philosophy of politics when he refused to fully engage with Hegel’s ethi-
cal definition of the state. When Marx described Hegel as a ‘logical pantheist’ he
totally misrepresented The Master’s thought.
Second, Marx read Hegel as a theoretical philosopher. His failure to read
Rosenkranz isolated him from the interpretation of Hegel as a practical philoso-
pher. Marx himself embraced practical philosophy for the first time in his 1843
‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, but one of the reasons
that he never explored the dimension of practical philosophy in Hegel was his
unfamiliarity with Rosenkranz’s text.
Third, Marx also did not comment on the Hegelian concept of historicity. Hegel
was primarily interested in the succession of organic systems, the amalgamation of
art, religion and philosophy into a total system. Rosenkranz drew attention to the
concept of historicity in Hegel, but the Rosenkranz lacuna meant that Marx did
not pursue this Hegelian terrain. Hegel applied historicity to cultural formations,
the Greco-Roman World, the Chinese World, the Hindu World and the Germanic
World, but Marx did not comment upon this line of Hegelian speculation.
c) Hegel’s reading of Steuart’s Inquiry into the Principles of Political Economy The fail-
ure of Marx to read Rosenkranz carried additional consequences, including Marx’s
failure to familiarize himself with Hegel’s initial contact with political economy.
While he was a tutor in the household of Carl Friedrich von Steiger from 1793
to 1796 in Berne, Switzerland, Hegel read Steuart’s two-volume Inquiry into the
Principles of Political Economy.78
58 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
consumption in his Inquiry into the Principles of Political Economy, which he pub-
lished ten years before Adam Smith.’81
Furthermore, Hegel and Marx were both acquainted with Ferguson’s Essay on
the History of Civil Society. Hegel read this work when he worked in Berne as a
tutor in the household of Steiger from 1793 to 179782 and Marx read Ferguson in
approximately 1845 when he was expelled from France and resettled in Brussels.83
Hegel, however, never mentions Ferguson’s Essay on the History of Civil Society in
his own work so it was impossible for Marx to learn of Hegel’s knowledge of this
outstanding member of the Scottish Enlightenment. Regardless, it is of interest
to observe the important role Ferguson played in the independent evolutions of
Hegel’s and Marx’s awareness of civil society and political economy. Both Hegel
and Marx were responding to the same theoretical breakthroughs, the emergence
of political economy as a discipline for understanding the structure of modern
civilization.
When Marx failed to read Rosenkranz and learn of Hegel’s interest in Steuart’s
Inquiry into the Principles of Political Economy he condemned himself to ignorance
regarding Hegel’s interest in political economy. He remained unaware of the
parallelism between Hegel’s and his own studies. A new world of capitalism was
born and both the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ and Marx were attempting to compre-
hend this revolutionary upheaval. The failure of Marx to read ‘On The Scientific
Method of Treating Natural Law’ imprisoned him in the vision of Hegel as a
Speculative philosopher.
But Marx read Jean-Baptiste Say, Smith, Ricardo and Montesquieu and so did the
Mature Hegel. In paragraph 189, entitled ‘The System of Needs’, in the 1820 The
Philosophy of Right Hegel drew attention to Smith, Say and Ricardo.84 Hegel men-
tions Montesquieu four times in The Philosophy of Right.85 Marx read the Mature
Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right; his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ was a
diatribe against The Philosophy of Right, but he never credits the Mature Hegel with
a knowledge of these authors.
had been stifled. In the proceedings of of the Württemberg Estates we see the
same struggle between these principles, only the roles are reversed. In France
most of the Estates of the Realm and the popular party upheld the rights of
reason and demanded their restoration while the government was on the side
of privileges . . .89
The application of the positive law theory of the German Historical School of Law
to Germany in 1816–1817 was a validation of the powers of the feudal aristocracy.
In the Middle Ages custom and normative practice was the epiphenomenon of
feudal political privilege. The political domination of the feudal aristocracy was
based on custom and normative practice and so the acceptance of custom and
normative practice, the law of the Middle Ages, was simply a means to rationalize
the contemporary privileges of this medieval landed class.
For both Rousseau and Hegel will was the energy of the Self. Right was the
legal guarantee of the self-expression of the will. Hegel maintained a doctrine
of rational rights and this meant that the self-determination of the will must
be rational, or subject to the laws of reason. When Hegel wrote of rights he did
not mean an autonomous Self, a Self totally immersed in its own gratification.
For Hegel the complete autonomy of the Self was instantiated by Robespierre
and the butchery of the Reign of Terror. Hegel did not believe in a voluntaristic
interpretation of rights, but rather maintained that right became rational when
right recognized the intersubjective nature of socio-political existence.90 Rational
rights, for Hegel, did not mean decision-making solely based upon the dictator-
ship of the Self, but rather rights that were rational, or that carried an obligation
to the community.
Historicity was also a factor in the theory of rational rights. History was the
womb of numerous cultures and rights must accord with these cultures. The right
of the Athenians who lived in the age of Aristotle were vastly different than the
rights of a citizen of Berlin in 1820. Right was not a gift of nature and therefore
unchanging. The principle of right was the progress of self-determination to ethi-
cality, but this endeavor was mediated by the historical context in which the will
was located.91
Hegel was a representative of the Aufklärung (Enlightenment). True to the
European Enlightenment Hegel maintained that reason was the foundation of
law, government and state and Hegel interpreted the 1789 French Revolution as
the struggle between medieval positive law and the rational reformist tendencies
of the Enlightenment. Hegel was an exponent of the rational principles of the
Enlightenment in its struggle to reform the vestiges of German feudalism.
This is one reason for Hegel’s advocacy of the reforms Napoleon brought
to Germany. In the Württemberg journalism Hegel appended the following
footnote:
The great teacher of constitutional law sits in Paris . . . The German princes
have not yet grasped the concept of free monarchy, nor attempted to realize it.
Napoleon will have to organize all this.92
62 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
e) ‘The English Reform Bill’ Hegel’s article ‘The English Reform Bill’ appeared in
the journal Allgemeine Preussiche Staatszeitung in April 1831, shortly before his
death.95 This article was in print for Marx to read during Marx’s entire lifetime, but
he never took advantage of the opportunity. Marx suffered additional losses from
his failure to read the Rosenkranz biography of Hegel because the book references
‘The English Reform Bill’.96
‘The English Reform Bill’ was a proto-Marxist document. Class struggle is the
central theme. In England this class struggle raged between the medieval landed
aristocracy and both the urban and agricultural disenfranchised and this domina-
tion of the Middle Ages over the Industrial Revolution was executed by the aristo-
cratic control of ‘rotten boroughs’. Although Hegel did not write the Communist
Manifesto, although Hegel does not mention the proletariat, he was keenly aware
of the class confrontation in a nascent capitalist society. ‘The English Reform
Bill’ is also an analysis of British imperialism in Ireland advocated by the English
aristocracy. The Irish Question was an important discourse in this journalistic
essay and Hegel correctly surmised that the colonization of Ireland was a result
of the class greed of the English nobility. Prior to Marx, Hegel entered into the
imperialism debate. ‘The English Reform Bill’ was also a study of the interdepend-
ence of class structure and political ideology. Hegel’s essay manifested how the
English landed nobility perpetuated the juridical claims of the school of positive
law because positive law legitimized their rights to property. Even though he used
different terminology, Hegel adumbrated Marx’s theory of the relation between
the substructure and the superstructure. In the realm of ideology Hegel also drew
attention to the symbiosis between the landed aristocracy and the Anglican
Church, the support given by the Church to the class hegemony of the medieval
aristocracy. The ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ had a sophisticated grasp of how cultures
and political theories were shaped by the social underpinnings of class structure.
In the 1830s a large majority of the English male population was excluded from
voting because they did not possess the necessary property qualifications. Wealth,
either in agriculture or trade, was the basis of active political participation. In
addition, ‘rotten boroughs’ were widespread throughout England. These were
electoral districts under the control of the old feudal aristocracy, or the industrial
affluent. They did not have sufficient population to be considered a valid electoral
district, but the wealth of the agricultural feudal class and the urban rich were able
not only to preserve these invalid districts, but they also used their money to buy
votes in these districts to ensure members of parliament friendly to their interests
were sent to Westminster. The Reform Bill Hegel discussed in 1831 became law in
1832 when it was ushered through Parliament by Sir Robert Peel and it introduced
both the reapportionment and redistricting of seats. Hegel died before the 1832
Reform Bill passed, but his article showed his cognizance of class struggle and of
how money corrupted politics.
Not only did the corruption of English of politics originate among the landed
gentry and the urban capitalists, but also devolved from the Anglican Church.
Germany and other continental states had already abolished the tithe, but
the Anglican Church was still a beneficiary of the tithe. Originally the tithe,
64 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
a medieval invention, was used to pay religious teachers, maintain church schools
and help the poor. But in England in the 18th and early 19th centuries the tithe
was seen as a source of personal income for the clergy and led to the debauchery
and immorality of this ecclesiastical class. Hegel not only called for the separa-
tion of Church and State, but for the eradication of the tithe as a means to end
the abuse of these funds by the clerical establishment. The Anglican Church was
another example of the class exploitation of the poor.97
Hegel was also conversant with the Irish Question. Almost two decades before
Marx and Engels drew attention to the Irish Question, Hegel had perceived the
unique impoverishment of Ireland. According to Hegel one of the reasons for this
unprecedented destitution of Ireland was the near impossibility of Irish farmers
to acquire property and this barrier was wholly due to the laws passed by English
aristocratic colonizers who legislated impediments to the private acquisition of
land by the colonized Irish.98 Hegel’s 1831 analysis resembled nothing as much as
Frantz Fanon’s and those of the anti-colonization campaigns of the post-Second
World War decades; that it was the desire to preserve English feudal advantages
that prevented the Irish from acquiring private property.
Hegel’s exposure to class rapacity did not mean he was a democrat. He
disavowed universal suffrage,99 defended the disenfranchisement of the pobel
(rabble),100 championed property qualifications as the basis of the right to vote101
and repeated his denunciation of Robespierre and the Jacobins.102 Furthermore,
he praised the constitution Napoleon gave to the Kingdom of Italy in which
Napoleon distributed the right of representation in terms of three groups, govern-
ment bureaucrats, the aristocracy and the business class.103 Napoleon’s representa-
tive system was similar to the corporate representation Hegel proposed in his 1820
The Philosophy of Right.
Not only did Hegel present England as a nation under the hegemony of the
landed and capitalist aristocracy, but he also called into question the educational
capacities of the classes that governed. In this regard, Hegel displayed his German
nationalism. While the English landed and commercial aristocracies were simply
guided by the principle of self-interest, the Germans benefited from the tradition
of Bildung. The administrative decision-making of the English medieval and capi-
talist ruling strata were determined by the law of self-aggrandizement, while the
German bureaucracy, enriched by the tradition of Bildung, had the expertise, the
professional competence, to make better-informed administrative decisions. Hegel
looked upon the bureaucracy as a ‘universal class’,104 a class trained for and whose
skills were cultivated for the tasks of proper administrative decision-making and
in the service of the general welfare. Compared to the German ‘universal class’,
the British administrative and executive strata were untutored and lacked the
requisite skills for their jobs.105
The Master possessed a sophisticated understanding of how the class structure
of a society determined the religion, art, politics and philosophy of a civilization.
The cultural levels of the civilization were not autonomous, self-generating, but
were influenced and shaped by the social stratification that formed their founda-
tion. For example, in ‘The English Reform Bill’ Hegel again attacked the German
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 65
Historical School of Law, and he refuted the positive theory of law that Savigny
and his cohorts defended. The positive theory of law asserted custom, normative
social practice, as the legitimating criteria of law. ‘The English Reform Bill’ showed
how the theory of positive law buttressed the class interests of the landed and
commercial aristocracies.
Hegel was aware that the culture-philosophic hierarchies of art, religion, phi-
losophy, law and the state were realms molded by the underlying social structure.
Class preferences partially sculptured the levels of culture and philosophy. Hegel
recognized that social structures were foundational, were the scaffoldings upon
which the culture-philosophic levels arose. Hegel understood a civilization as a
relationship between two structures: the socio-economic basis of a society was
foundational and primary; the higher culture-philosophic levels were influenced
by the foundational level. By recognizing and advancing the priority of the socio-
economic foundational level Hegel prepared the way for Marx.
The socio-economic analysis contained in ‘The English Reform Bill’ was pre-
proletarian. Hegel wrote this essay seventeen years before the 1848 Revolution. His
analysis of the socio-economic conditions of England did not carry a proletarian
perspective, but rather a bourgeois vision. Hegel did not call for the emancipation
of the proletariat, but rather for the enfranchisement of the propertied bourgeois.
His analysis looked back to 1789 in France and not forward to 1848 in Paris or
Frankfurt.
‘The Master’ presents himself in ‘The English Reform Bill’ as a Liberal reformer.
Throughout the pages of this essay Hegel ridiculed the notions of equality
and democracy,106 and was particularly critical of ‘the Year III in France under
Robespierre’.107 ‘The English Reform Bill’ was an anti-revolutionary document. The
intent of Hegel was to prevent England from experiencing a Jacobin revolution
and the most efficient way to escape such a catastrophic denouement was moder-
ate reform. It is well to bear in mind that Hegel wrote ‘The English Reform Bill’ in
1831, one year after the French revolution of 1830, of which he disapproved.
Marx’s failure to read Rosenkranz is difficult to comprehend. Rosenkranz was
a major figure in the Hegelian Center and was widely read by the Hegelian Left.
Although Ruge later deserted the Hegelian Left he was one of its founding mem-
bers and was the co-editor with Marx of the Paris-published Deutsch-Französiche
Jarhbücher in 1844. Additionally, Marx and Ruge exchanged correspondence as early
as 1842108 and Ruge was in correspondence with Rosenkranz beginning in 1837.109
Ruge did read Hegel’s ‘Proceedings of the Estates Assembly in the Kingdom of
Württemberg’ as well as ‘The English Reform Bill’. Ruge does comment on both
these pieces of Hegelian journalism in an article in 1842 called ‘Hegel’s Philosophy
of Right and the Politics of Our Time’.110 Marx and Ruge were friends and intel-
lectual compatriots from 1842 until 1844 so it is a mystery why Ruge read these
essays and Marx failed to do so.
The importance of Rosenkranz to the Hegelian Left was further revealed by the
esteem with which Engels regarded him. As early as 1840 Engels placed Rosenkranz
in the company of Gans and Ruge, demonstrating the influence Ruge exerted
within the Left and Center Hegel cadres. In his letter to his close friend Friedrich
66 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
2) Philosophical Propaedeutic
In addition to not reading Rosenkranz’s Hegel’s Life Marx also failed to read
Rosenkranz’s publication of Hegel’s Philosophical Propaedeutic. Rosenkranz dis-
covered this manuscript in 1838 and published it in 1840 as Volume 18 of the
Collected Works. Marx never mentioned the Philosophical Propaedeutic even though
it was part of the Collected Works. This seems to contradict the statement Marx
made in his 1837 letter to his father in which he claimed that he had read Hegel
‘from beginning to end’. It is worth reiterating that along with Volume 18 Marx
never read Volumes 1, 16 and 17 of the Collected Works.
The Philosophical Propaedeutic is an instructor’s manual for the teaching of phi-
losophy to the students at the Gymnasium Nuremberg at which Hegel was Rector
from 1808 to 1815. Hegel structured this philosophic curriculum in terms of the
ages of the gymnasium students: the 14 to 15-year-olds were taught the science
of law, morality and religion; the 15 to 18-year-olds were introduced to the phe-
nomenology of mind while the more mature 18 to 20-year-olds were initiated
into the science of the concept and the science of logic.115 More important than
the pedagogical design of the lectures is the fact that they were an embryonic
form of Hegel’s Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, published in 1817. The
Philosophical Propaedeutic was a summary of the complete System of the Mature
Hegel and essentially was an abbreviation of the three-volume Encyclopedia of the
Philosophical Sciences.
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 67
instincts that propelled the personality outward, that made the person a pneu-
matological energy. Rosenkranz presented a picture of the external world as the
outcome, the realization of human psychological drives.118
It is also informative to compare Rosenkranz and Marx’s reading of Hegel’s
Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences. Marx read Volume 1, the ‘Smaller Logic’
and Volume 2, The Philosophy of Nature. Rosenkranz does not mention either
of these volumes in his Psychology: or the Science of Subjective Spirit. However,
Rosenkranz’s book was an amplification of the ‘Mind Subjective’ in Volume 3 of
The Philosophy of Mind. While Marx read Volume 3 he does not comment on it in
any of his work. Marx does comment on the ‘Smaller Logic’ and The Philosophy
of Nature, but Marx never makes any reference to Hegel’s ruminations on human
anthropology or psychology or to Hegelian pneumatology.
By only showing interest in the ‘Smaller Logic’ and The Philosophy of Nature Marx
displayed himself as a captive to the interpretation of Hegel as a Speculative phi-
losopher. By not reading Psychology: or the Science of Subjective Spirit he barricaded
himself against any evidence showing the practical aspects of Hegelian thought.
Whereas Rosenkranz eschewed Hegelian pantheism, Marx never relinquished this
formatting of Hegel.
The diaries, fragments and exzerpte included in Rosenkranz’s biography were not
comprehensive, and a complete publication of these Hegel sources had to wait
until Thaulow’s book Hegel’s Views on Education and Instruction, which I will briefly
comment upon below.
Marx’s Incomplete Quest 69
It is not necessary to discuss every item contained in these ten sections and
I will refer to just a few items as a way of illustrating what the Young and Mature
Marx did not know about the Young Hegel. It should also be noted that the
Rosenkranz collection is not the complete assemblage of all the written materials
of the Pre-Jena Young Hegel since subsequent scholars of Hegel, particularly in
the 20th century, uncovered additional texts. Furthermore, Harris’s biography
contains a listing of the Hegel exzerpte uncovered by Rosenkranz.119
Hegel wrote numerous exzerpte on theological matters, but this was to be expect-
ed from a student at a Protestant seminary. These exzerpte are important materials
tracing Hegel’s confrontation with religious positivism. During his pre-Jena period
the Young Hegel abandoned religious positivism in favor of religious subjectivity,
but regardless of how important this transition was for the individual develop-
ment of Hegel this theological aspect of Hegel’s life carried no interest for Marx
who was not concerned with Lutheran inwardness but rather with social labor.
Of interest to Marx, however, were the many references to and exzerpte Hegel
made from Greek and Roman authors. The works of Socrates, Euripides, Aristotle,
Plato, Epictetus, Tacitus, Sophocles, a comparison between Greek and Roman
religion, are either alluded to or copied in part. In itself such attention paid to the
Classics was expected of a German student at the end of the 18th century. This
was an expression of the importance Antiquity held in the German educational
system, the addiction to Johann Winckelmann, the type of education to which
Marx himself was exposed.
Irrespective of knowledge of the Aristotle-Rousseau influence on Hegel, Marx
never alludes to this aspect of Hegelian political theory. Marx adopted a policy of
absolute silence regarding the influence of Aristotle and Rousseau on Hegel, and
the preservation of the ethical polis ideal on Hegel. Marx’s 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right’ is basically devoted to presenting Hegel as an exponent of the
theory of the state as a predication of the Idea, as a rational abstraction, but Hegel’s
attempt to further explore Aristotle’s union of ethics and politics is ignored.
Even though he bypassed the Hegelian connection to Aristotle, Marx found
his own bridge to Athens. Marx followed two strategies in terms of the polis: the
silencing of any Hegelian influence, while at the same time pursuing the same
goal of Hegel, which was the presentation of the state as an ethical community.
Hegel and Marx pursued the same end, but Marx refused to acknowledge that he
and Hegel were on the same voyage.
Rudolf Haym
It is instructive to note the importance Rosenkranz’s Hegel’s Life exercised on
future 19th-century studies of Hegel. It became an indispensible archive of source
material on Hegel that no researcher could afford to bypass. Haym’s Hegel and
His Time120 was greatly dependent on the Hegelian source materials preserved by
Rosenkranz.
Haym’s biography was published in 1857. By that time Marx was living in
London and in 1857 Marx was beginning the composition of the Grundrisse. Marx
never read Haym’s book.
70 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Since the Confidential Letters were not ascribed to Hegel until 1909 neither Marx
nor any other Hegel scholars prior to that date knew of its existence as a text of
Hegel. Although it is not possible to admonish Marx for not reading this book
since it was unknown to be a Hegel manuscript, it is possible to now comment
on the text as indicating the political attitudes of Hegel when he was 28 years
old. The Confidential Letters tell us something about the Young Hegel’s politics
and these 1798 attitudes correspond to his beliefs as expressed in the other docu-
ments already analyzed in this chapter. The Confidential Letters confirm the Young
Hegel’s German Liberalism.
In the Confidential Letters the Young Hegel translated the letters of J. J. Cart,
a French-speaking Swiss, and added a commentary of his own. Living in Berne,
Switzerland, as a tutor in the house of the Steiger family, Hegel gained first-
hand experience regarding the oligarchic hegemony of the Berne nobility. The
Confidential Letters comprised a diatribe against the Bernese aristocracy for their
domination of the inhabitants of the Vaud. The book praised the American
Revolution, and during the period of the Directory in Paris excoriated the anach-
ronistic interests of the Berne aristocracy. In his first published work the Young
Hegel displayed himself as a Liberal reformer. Writing at the same time as the
French Directory, Hegel exhibited his German Liberal contempt for the aristocracy
and his reformist advocacy of the nascent bourgeoisie. The Young Hegel matured
during the early years of the French Revolution, carried its imprint throughout his
life, and this was an aspect of Hegel’s intellectual biography that Marx misread.
*********
pantheist’ and believed that Hegel accounted for the existence of the state as a devo-
lution of the Idea. Marx never abandoned this view of Hegel and one of the reasons
Marx never surrendered his interpretation of Hegel as a Speculative philosopher was
his failure to acquaint himself with Hegel’s views, such as those contained in ‘The
English Reform Bill’, concerning social class, class stratification and the influence of
the socio-economic base upon cultural spheres such as art, politics and philosophy.
Marx also remained myopic regarding the subjective-practical aspects of Hegelian
thought and this vacancy manifested itself in two areas, economic and political.
On the economic level Marx’s failure to read Hegel’s ‘On the Scientific Method
of Treating Natural Law’ left him unacquainted with the role subjective-practical
human activity played in Hegel. In this essay, as well as in other writings, Hegel
showed his recognition of political economy, and his awareness that the practical
interchange between man and nature was the primary factor in the sustenance of
life. For Hegel, economic practice was the foundation out of which the evolution
of Spirit was born.
On the political level Marx’s failure to read Hegel’s ‘Proceedings of the Estates
Assembly in the Kingdom of Württemburg’ condemned him to a void in regard
to political practice in Hegel. In this journalistic endeavor Hegel displayed his
awareness of the practice of class politics, his appreciation that within a capitalist
society the subjective activity of the financially privileged would be directed at
increasing their own gain. Hegel was convinced that the subjectivity of political
action in a capitalist society was primarily directed at the augmentation of per-
sonal gain and this was the major reason for his denunciation of contemporary
individualism. It was also one of the reasons for the hope he placed in Bildung.
Marx also cut himself off from Hegel’s definition of politics as an ethical prac-
tice by not reading ‘On The Scientific Method of Treating Natural Law’. Marx
subjected himself to significant lacunae regarding the relation between ethics
and politics in Hegel as well as the importance of Aristotle in Hegelian thought.
This void in the knowledge of the ethical in Hegel made it impossible for Marx to
assess Hegel’s theory of the state correctly.
Subject to all these vacancies – other absences will be added later – Marx could
only judge Hegel as a Speculative philosopher. Marx was wedded to and refused to
abandon the idea that Hegel was a Speculative theoretician and remained remote
from other terrains of Hegelian thought. Marx refused to familiarize himself with
any information that contradicted this Speculative interpretation; here lies the
origin of the Invisible Hegel.
However, Marx’s misreading of Hegel in the areas of practice, subjectivity and
ethics does not mean that he distorted the Hegelian distinction between System
and Method. Marx confined the Hegelian System within the Speculative, which he
rejected, but he still recognized the validity and applicability of the Hegelian Method.
While the System distorted the actual, the Method was a productive metric by which
to measure the actual. Marx separated the actual from the System, but maintained
that the actual was made comprehensible by the application of the Method.
Chapter Three
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew
During the years 1836 to 1848 Marx’s thought passed through interrelated stages.
In order to highlight the interconnected episodes of Marx’s intellectual develop-
ment I divide Chapter Three into Phases and I do this to emphasize the consist-
ency in his development. Chapter Three is composed of six Phases and they are:
Marx’s first written comment on Hegel occurred in his 1836 epigram ‘On Hegel’
and testified to the difficulties the 18-year-old was experiencing in his attempt to
comprehend Hegel’s aesthetic theory. The movement of Marx’s 1836 negation of
Hegel to a positive appropriation of aspects of Hegelian thought is charted in his
1837 letter to his father written from the University of Berlin to which he had
transferred from the University of Bonn.1
In this letter he acknowledged his 1836 rejection of Hegel, when he wrote these
words: ‘I had read fragments of Hegel’s philosophy and had found its grotesque
craggy melody unpleasing.’2
However, by November 1837 Marx underwent a fateful conversion and became
a student of Hegelian Speculation. Marx confessed to this transformation in the
following paragraphs:
Setting out from idealism which, let me say in passing, I had compared to and
nourished with that of Kant and Fichte I hit upon seeking the Idea in the real
itself. If formerly the gods had dwelt above the world, they had now become
its center.3
73
74 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Marx accepted the Hegelian principle that the actual was the embodiment of
rationality.4
Remnants of Marx’s dialogue ‘Cleanthes’ still exist and are reprinted in the MECW,
Vol. I, but what is more germane to the thesis of this book is that in the above quota-
tion Marx connected himself to the philosophy of Hegel when he admitted that ‘My
last sentence was the beginning of the Hegelian System’. A little later in the letter
Marx provided validity to this assertion when he confessed that ‘While out of sorts,
I had got to know Hegel from beginning to end, and most of his disciples as well’.6
This 1837 letter gives further testimony to Marx’s embrace of Hegelianism. Near
the end of the letter Marx wrote:
The discussion up to this point established that by November 1837 Marx ‘got
to know Hegel from beginning to end’ and that he converted to Hegelianism,
although it is still necessary to determine to what form of Hegelianism he convert-
ed, but that question will be answered further on in Phase Three of this chapter.
The November 1837 letter also documents that Marx rejected the Historical School
of Law, and Savigny was the leading exponent of this school. The November 1837
letter to his father contains extremely important insights into Marx’s philosophy
of law at that time, a philosophy that was influenced by Hegel; I will discuss this
aspect of the 1837 letter in Phase Two. At this point I employ the November 1837
letter to document the date of Marx’s conversion to Hegelianism.
The 1837 letter already shows the influence of Gans upon Marx’s first appro-
priation of Hegel. Gans was a Professor of Law at the University of Berlin and
Gans, who was a student, colleague and friend of Hegel, carried on the Hegelian
tradition after the death of Hegel in 1831 and decisively influenced the manner
in which Marx perceived Hegel in the 1837 period. Gans belonged to the Hegelian
Center8 and Marx interpreted Hegel as a member of the Hegelian Center.
A German Jew, Gans refined his instincts for political reform in his struggle to
deepen the emancipation of Jewry in Germany, to facilitate the cultural assimi-
lation of the Jewish community into German culture. Gans entered the School
of Law at the University of Berlin in 1816, while Hegel became a Professor of
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 75
upholding the German Liberal interpretation of the human saga as a march from
primitivism to Spirit, or to self-determination. The progressivism of the Hegelian
Center did not define freedom as egalitarianism, or as utilitarianism, but rather
as self-determination. For Hegel, Gans and Michelet, self-determination did not
mean unrestrained individualism, but rather decision-making in terms of the Self,
but a Self that was a part of a community and a tradition and that recognized its
obligations to that community and tradition. This German Liberal view of his-
toriography was based upon the assumption that reason was a dynamic force in
social evolution. Gans and Michelet did not believe that reason was the universal
substance of the world, did not apply a Spinozist interpretation to reason, but
they did believe that the pragmatics of reason and subjective activity were the
only dynamics out of which progressive development could emerge.
In order to understand the theory of progress in Hegel it is first necessary to
recognize that philosophy for the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ was a process of self-
education. The inherent drive in philosophy, reason, was to objectify itself, to
enter into reality, or to take possession of reality. In order to know itself it was
necessary for mind to observe the predications it originated in the past, and phil-
osophical knowledge was retrodiction.
When reason took title of reality the self-learning process started. Hermeneutics
was a vital element in Hegelian philosophy as ‘The Master’ believed that reason
could only know itself. When reason claimed ownership of reality, this meant reason
could understand reality because it was able to recognize itself in reality. Knowledge,
for Hegel, was the self-identity of reason, or the in-itself recognizing its simultaneous
co-existence in mind and reality. Hegel pursued a philosophy of identity.
Hegel thought in cultural holistic terms. On the philosophical level the Middle
Ages were dominated by Catholic theology and as a consequence the philosophy
of this historical period was metaphysics. This meant that the universe itself was
the creation of a supernatural force and that the foundational principle of the
universe was an ontological, non-historical substance.
But a subsequent cultural age disproved the metaphysical philosophy of the
Middle Ages. Rather than an adamantine spiritual substance, Enlightenment sci-
ence proved that the universe was material and historical. One cultural age con-
tradicted an earlier cultural holism. The self-observation of reason proved that the
reason of the Middle Ages was incorrect. The process of self-observation required
that medieval philosophy be annulled and a new philosophico-cultural holism be
introduced, while simultaneously realizing that the Enlightenment itself would
be superseded in the future.
Hegelian historicism rested on the principle of supersession. Retrospection
led to the awareness of contradiction. The self-knowledge of reason expanded
as the self-observation of reason’s past objectifications grew. This expanded self-
knowledge led to the contradiction and negation of these outmoded past objecti-
fications and supersession was the result. A more informed reason, enriched by its
own self-learning process, superseded the lower level of self-consciousness.
Hegel espoused a theory of non-congruence, or he recognized that a severance
existed between reason and reality. The function of reason was to transform
78 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
this two-volume work, Strauss presented a secularized portrayal of Jesus free from
any theological adornments. At a deeper level, however, The Life of Jesus sepa-
rated theology and philosophy. Strauss rebelled against the medieval ecclesiastical
preemption of philosophy and not only detached the two disciplines, but also
asserted the supremacy of philosophy. Strauss’s book precipitated the bifurcation
of the Hegelian school into Right and Center. The Hegelian Right upheld the
supremacy of theology, while the Hegelian Center supported the superiority of
reason. Strauss’s book ignited the 19th-century warfare between these two oppos-
ing camps, those who proposed that ultimate truth lay in religion and those who
proposed that philosophy in itself was the summit of truth.
Hegel regarded philosophy as the medium for the reconciliation of the Idea and
reality. Even though a perfect identity of the Idea and reality was an impossibility,
the agency working to fulfill this reconciliation was philosophy. The impossibil-
ity of the absolute identity between Idea and reality was the dialectic, negation
or non-congruence. Hegel did not employ critique, but rather contradiction. One
of the reasons Hegel never developed critique was his suspicion of free subjectiv-
ity. Nevertheless, Hegel made critique a possibility by recognizing the cleavage
between thought and reality, but it was a cleavage that could be overcome by the
phenomenology of reason.
Bauer extended Kantian critique and he re-created critique by modifying Hegel
in three categories: subjectivity, free self-consciousness, and philosophy itself, and
philosophy itself became a target of critique.
Bauer upheld the right of subjectivity. Whereas Hegel denounced Socrates for
his assertion of his individuality, Bauer looked upon unrestrained subjectivity as
the ground of philosophy. Bauer defended the right of the personality over the
compromises of the social.16
Commensurate with his defense of subjectivity was Bauer’s justification of
free self-consciousness. Benefiting from the ultimate license of subjectivity, self-
consciousness was endowed with the entitlement to nullify, to contradict all
systems of thought. Even though Bauer continued to regard the discipline of phi-
losophy as the unblemished doorway to truth, he opened up philosophical beliefs
themselves to contradiction. Whereas Hegel considered philosophy above nullifi-
cation Bauer opened up philosophical belief systems to dialectical negation.
The three elements, subjectivity, free self-consciousness and the scrutiny of
philosophical beliefs, formed the substructure of critique. For Bauer critique was
directed at the alteration of philosophical beliefs; personal behavior would be
modified not through the transcendence of philosophy as a discipline, but by
means of the modification of self-consciousness. Whereas Hegel and Bauer disa-
greed over the exercise of critique, Hegel and Bauer were in agreement over the
centrality of thought. Change, personal or social, evolved out of the modification
of mentality, of consciousness.
Marx continued the Bauerian tradition of critique, but made three vital altera-
tions; the target of critique, the agent of critique and the purpose of critique.
Marx’s program for the realignment of critique, his break with Bauer, was first
enunciated in the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction.’17
80 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
For Marx the target of critique was those institutions in society which contrib-
uted to the exploitation of the industrial working class. Contrary to Hegel and
Bauer, Marx did not accept philosophy as the foundation of human motivation.
Rather, Marx judged social labor as the presupposition of human endeavor and
therefore, for him critique should target those socio-economic institutions which
defined the method of labor in a given society. It was not consciousness which
defined the human, but rather the politico-economic structure of society.
The fact that Marx repositioned the central target of critique from philosophy
to social institutions did not mean that he wished to abolish philosophy. Rather,
it only meant that Marx wished to alter the purpose of philosophy. Marx wished
to retain philosophy, but to direct its purpose not to metaphysical conundrums,
the existence of a divinity or the powers of reason, but rather to questions of
materialism, the nature of labor, the substance of economic value and the ques-
tion of private property.
While Hegel and Bauer looked upon the agent of non-congruence as a philoso-
pher, or at individual consciousness, Marx looked upon the agent as a social class.
Whereas Bauer placed critique within a subject, in self-consciousness, Marx saw
the source of critique as the proletariat. Marx moved the source of critique from
the person to a social class.
Essentially, Marx was involved in a critique of political economy, but this meant
that he was engaged in an endeavor to redefine political economy so that it would
cease being an apology for private property and become an instrument for the
democratization of the means and mode of production. For Marx critique was a
justification for praxis, or a validation of proletarian revolution.
Marx redefined the Hegelian concept of practice. Hegel’s The Philosophy of Mind
contains a chapter on ‘Practical Mind’.18 As opposed to theoretical mind Hegel
understands ‘Practical Mind’ as related to individual action, as composed of feel-
ing, impulse, choice, and happiness. In his understanding of practical mind Hegel
was consonant with Aristotle.19 Marx, however, rebelled against the Aristotelian-
Hegelian tradition. For Marx praxis meant political activism. Whereas Aristotle
and Hegel made practice a subdivision of human psychology, Marx re-situated
practice into the realm of politics, as a strategy of political reformation.
I maintain that Hegel himself was the founder of the Hegelian Center. Gans
and Michelet were the legitimate heirs of Hegel, or the Hegelian essence was
most closely approximated by Gans and Michelet. Obviously, differences existed
between Hegel and these two epigones, but the message of Hegel was best repli-
cated in the language of Gans and Michelet.
Politically I also maintain that Marx believed Hegel to be a member of the
Hegelian Center, or that Marx viewed Hegel as a Liberal Monarchist. Marx did
not perceive Hegel as a tribune of the Restoration. Marx’s attitude toward Hegel’s
advocacy of constitutional monarchy passed through different stages.
As I will point out in greater detail in the phase dealing with Marx’s dissertation,
until the year 1841, when Marx completed the writing of the dissertation, he was
an apologist for Hegelian politics. In 1842 Marx was already a convert to Bauer, but
in the dissertation Marx embraced the philosophical methodology of Hegel and
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 81
remained silent on Hegelian politics. In 1841 Marx was most concerned with pre-
serving the validity of Hegelian methodology and ascribed any failures of Hegelian
politics to the inevitable fate of all philosophy when it confronts reality: an una-
voidable corruption. At this stage Marx adhered to Bauer’s protocols of critique.
Marx’s overt attacks on Hegelian politics are syncopated with the oppression
he suffered under the government of Frederick Wilhelm IV, who came to the
throne in 1840. After the government of Frederick Wilhelm IV prevented Marx
from attaining a university position Marx articulated his first direct criticism of
Hegel and monarchism in Prussia. On March 5, 1842 Marx wrote to Ruge: ‘I am
preparing a critique of the idea of natural rights in Hegel, as far as it concerns the
internal constitution. The central thesis is to fight the contradictory and super-
ficial nature of constitutional monarchy. It is impossible to translate res republica
into German.’20 This letter was written in anger and before Marx joined the staff
at the Rheinische Zeitung. It also shows that Marx considered Hegel a supporter of
‘constitutional monarchy’. Even when Marx moved into an oppositional posture
vis-à-vis Hegelian politics he still regarded Hegel as a Liberal Monarchist within
the parameters of the Hegelian Center
Prohibited from pursuing a professional career in the university, Marx did
find a position as editor-in-chief of the Rheinische Zeitung from October 1842 to
March 1843. The Rheinische Zeitung was a Liberal newspaper and the editorials
Marx wrote for it were Liberal Monarchist. Marx wrote editorials calling for the
freedom of the press, defending the rights of small farmers against the predatory
landed aristocracy and for the liberalization of marriage laws. He even called for
the unification of the codes of law within Prussia, but in this Marx was in accord
with Hegel since the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ also wanted a single national law code
for Prussia. Furthermore, imitating Hegel, Marx also attacked Savigny and the
Historical School of Law.
Marx was brought to the Rheinische Zeitung to move the paper editorially to a
Hegelian Center position and as the consternation he expressed in his March 5,
1842 letter dissipated he again assumed the role of Defender of Hegel. The two
previous editors of the Rheinische Zeitung were Hess and Rutenberg, who were
both of the Left. The owners of the Rheinische Zeitung hired Marx to purge the
newspaper of this Leftism and cement the paper into a moderate centrist political
position.
Marx fulfilled this anti-Left crusade and the article that he published in the
October 16, 1842 issue of the Rheinische Zeitung was a denunciation of socialism
and communism. In the article, ‘Communism and the “Augsburg Daily News”’,
Marx wrote that socialist and communist ideas must be ‘subject to a fundamental
critique’.21 He also averred that neither socialist nor communist ideas contained
any theoretical or practical relevance in their present form.22
Marx’s relation to Rutenberg is also indicative of his centrist posture at the
Rheinische Zeitung. In Marx’s 1837 letter to his father he credited Rutenberg with
introducing him to the Berlin Hegel ‘Doctor’s Club’ and referred to Rutenberg
as ‘one of the colleagues’.23 However, this early friendship did not prevent Marx
from later removing Rutenberg from the staff of the Rheinische Zeitung.
82 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
One of the major reasons Marx dismissed Rutenberg was Rutenberg’s associa-
tion with the ultra-Left Berlin Freien. In two letters to Ruge, one written on July
9, 1842 and the second on November 30, 1842, Marx denounced the socialism
and communism of the Berlin Freien.24 Not only did Marx separate himself from
Rutenberg but also from Eduard Meyen. Marx accused Rutenberg and Meyen of
seeking to turn the Rheinische Zeitung into a voice of the Berlin Freien. As a means
of deterring any attempts by the Berlin Freien to seize control of the paper Marx
terminated Rutenberg’s employment.
Marx’s detachment from the Berlin Freien was also one of the reasons that his
first meeting with Engels was so unproductive. Engels was a member of the Berlin
Freien when he came to visit Marx in Cologne in the fall of 1842. This first meet-
ing ended without any wish on the part of Marx to continue his relationship with
Engels, for the same reason that Marx terminated his relationship with Rutenberg.
Marx sought to sanitize the Rheinische Zeitung of any influence from the Berlin
Freien. The paper, and Marx, would remain at the Hegelian Center.
Consequently, until Marx resigned in March 1843 from the Rheinische Zeitung,
a resignation brought about by Marx’s disapproval of the newspaper’s owners’
subservience to the censorship of the Prussian government, Marx remained
within the camp of the Hegelian Center and continued to see Hegel as a Center
Hegelian.
Even before Marx became the editor-in-chief of the Rheinische Zeitung he wrote
articles for the newspaper. On July 14, 1842, as part of a longer series called ‘The
Leading Article in No. 179 of the “Kölnische Zeitung”’, Marx published an impor-
tant component of this series, and in this component he praised Hegel:
Philosophy has done with regard to politics what physics, mathematics, medi-
cine, and each science have done in their respective spheres. Bacon of Verulam
declared that theological physics was a virgin consecrated god and sterile: he
emancipated physics from theology and it became fertile. You should no more
ask a politician if he is a believer than you would put this question to a doc-
tor. In the period that proceeds and immediately follows the great discovery by
Copernicus of the true solar system, the law of gravity of the state was also dis-
covered. Its center of gravity was found to be in itself, and the different European
governments tried to apply this discovery with the superficiality of every first
practical trial, in the system of the balance of powers. Similarly, first Machiavelli
and Campenella, then later Hobbes, Spinoza, Hugo Grotius, through to Rousseau,
Fichte and Hegel began to consider the state through human eyes and deduced
its natural law from reason and experience and not from theology . . .25
This paragraph makes two important points. First, it separates Hegel from religion.
Just as Bacon of Verulam detached religion from science, so philosophy since the
Scientific Revolution divorced itself from religion. An important principle of the
Hegelian Center was that religion and philosophy were two separate enterprises
and on this issue Marx himself not only occupied the Hegelian Center but saw
Hegel himself as one of the originators of this distinction.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 83
Second, Marx praised Hegel. Marx saw Hegel as also distinguishing between
politics and religion. The proper location of politics was in the sphere of philoso-
phy and Hegel had allied political theory with ‘reason and experience and not
theology’.
This paragraph, written in July 1842, demonstrates that at this time Marx saw
Hegel and himself as members of the Hegelian Center. This paragraph also makes
clear that Marx had read Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right and evaluated it as a docu-
ment of political reform. Hegel was not an accommodationist, but a philosopher
who incorporated political theory within philosophy and in so doing opened up
the possibilities of reform, since philosophy itself was always in contradiction
with reality.
Marx abandoned the Hegelian Center in March, 1843 and his desertion was
due to the continued repression of the government of Frederick Wilhelm IV. The
unremitting censorship by the Prussian autocracy compelled Marx to sever his
ties with the Rheinische Zeitung in March 1843. When Marx saw that Frederick
Wilhelm IV would never reform the Prussian state Marx concluded that the
Hegelian Center would never bring about the liberalization of the Prussian monar-
chy and that reform could only arise from a more oppositional camp, the legions
of democracy.
When Marx saw the helplessness of the Hegelian Center he detached himself
from Hegel, but only on the political level. Marx recognized that on the political
level Hegel was a constitutional monarchist and never changed this interpreta-
tion. But when Marx came to the conclusion that Frederick Wilhelm IV would
never reform the state, he finally accepted the impotence of German constitu-
tional monarchy in itself.
Throughout Marx’s Discourse with Hegel I will continue to position Hegel
within the Hegelian Center. I do this primarily as a means of identification,
to clearly establish boundaries between the Center, Left and Right Hegelian
camps. However, my use of the phrase Hegelian Center should not be taken as
an indication that I am unaware of the political reformist tendencies within this
Center. Although it was Monarchist the Center advocated reforming the Prussian
crown in a Liberal German direction. In order to achieve the liberalization of the
Hohenzollern throne the Center did theorize the historical supersession of the
feudal conservatism of the Crown, and Toews in his book Hegelianism refers to
Gans as the ‘godfather’ of the desire for transformation.26 Taking both of these
considerations into account I will continue to identify Hegel, Gans, Michelet
and Rosenkranz as the Center as a means of erecting clear territories between the
Center, Left and Right.
However, this historical supersession of Hegelian politics was an important
element of the Center. Gans, Michelet and Rosenkranz used the philosophical
strategy of historical supersession to launch the negation and annulment of the
Protestant Hohenzollern domination of Prussia.
It is necessary, however, to distinguish between the non-congruence of the
Hegelian Center and Marx’s critique in 1841. When Marx was writing his disser-
tation he was already a convert to Bauerism and this meant that Marx replaced
84 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
the Hegelian Idea with Bauer’s self-consciousness. By 1841 Marx had rejected the
Hegelian position that contradiction arose from the disparity between Idea and
appearance, but maintained that contradiction was the result of the activity of
subjective self-consciousness. By 1842 Marx was also under the influence of Ruge
and altered the target of critique. Whereas Hegel used non-congruence to invali-
date Ideas Marx used critique to invalidate political institutions and this was the
origin of his Left Hegelianism. The non-congruence of the Hegelian Center was
basically directed to Ideas, while the critique of the Hegelian Left emerged out of
subjective self-consciousness and was directed at the alteration of reality. By 1842
Marx was also under the influence of Feuerbach and replaced Idea with species
being. It was no longer thought that was the propellant force in the universe;
instead it was social man.
Marx’s position on Hegel’s political theory changes in early 1843. At this time
Marx changes from an apologist for Hegel to a strident critic. The beginning
of Marx’s anti-Hegelian politics dates from early 1843. The full force of Marx’s
critique of Hegelian politics is found in his summer 1843 notebook ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’.
Marx’s embrace of Left Hegelianism was inspired by Bauer and Ruge. From
Bauer Marx took the strategy of subjective critique, but Bauer situated the bat-
tle lines against Prussian autocracy in philosophy and self-consciousness. Ruge
supplied a new horizon for Marx, because the battle lines shifted to politics. The
liberation of man could not be conquered in the realm of self-consciousness, but
only in the realm of the real. Marx’s move to the Left did not negate his belief that
the politics of Hegel were still in the Center.
Left Hegelianism was populated by Bauer, Ruge and Feuerbach. Marx entered
the ranks of the Left Hegelians in the summer of 1843 but left by February
1844. In that month Marx published ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right:
Introduction’, which marked his baptism as a communist. Neither Bauer, nor
Ruge, nor Feuerbach were communists and Marx’s conversion to communism also
marked his renunciation of Left Hegelianism.
Marx’s indebtedness to Left Hegelianism as well as his ultimate repudiation of
this school is a major subject of interrogation throughout this entire text, and
thus there is no need to discuss it at this point.
Not only was Gans a prime mover in the founding of The Journal of Scientific
Critique but after Hegel’s death he also organized ‘The Society of the Friends of
the Deceased’, which assumed the task of publishing the first collected works of
Hegel, that is, all the works of Hegel that were known at that time. As a major
force in ‘The Society of the Friends of the Deceased’, Gans wrote the ‘Introduction’
to both Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right and The Philosophy of History. Gans’s efforts
to propagate the ideas of Hegel not only testifies to his high personal esteem in
which he held his friend, but also to the depth of his commitment to Hegelianism
as a philosophy and to his belief that his interpretation of Hegel corresponded to
the true intellectual intent of his friend.
Gans’s actions and writings provided the contours of the Hegelian Center.
According to Gans the Hegelian Center was composed of the following ten
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 85
2) Reason in history
In The Philosophy of Right Hegel wrote that ‘The Real is Rational, and The Rational
is Real’28 and this defined the Hegelian Center. Gans rejected the idea of a perfect
symmetry and instead believed that ruptures existed between the real and the
rational. According to Gans, reality was not the perfect embodiment of reason.
Reality manifested reason, reality was one of the results of reason, but this did
not mean, as the accommodationists held, that reality and reason were perfectly
synchronized. It was possible to argue that reality demonstrated a progress toward
rationality without maintaining that reality was totally rational. There was no
contradiction in affirming that reason was a part of reality and at the same time
recognizing that parts of reality were non-rational.
3) Non-congruence
The Hegelian Center recognized the ruptures between the actual and the rational
and the existence of these fissures was proof of the utility of non-congruence.
Non-congruence was the device through which the contradiction between
essence and appearance were exposed and the attempt made to bring appearance
into greater accord with thought. Historical progress was measured by the degree
to which actuality was brought into fuller commensurability with the Idea.
Non-congruence was essentially reformist. The exposure of the fault lines
between the rational and reality required that actuality be brought into greater
harmony with the rational, and this process of harmonization necessitates politi-
cal reform.
4) Historicity
The idea of development was central to Gans’s appreciation of Hegel. Like his
teacher, Gans recognized that development defined the nature of reality.
86 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The Hegelian system was predicated on the unity of thought and history. The
dialectic proceeded in triadic stages, first a thesis, secondly a negation and thirdly
a transcendence. The Hegelian dialectic was process and the notion of develop-
ment was required if the dialectic was to unfold. The existence of historicity was
a precondition if the dialectic was to complete itself, because the temporal was
necessary if the movement from affirmation, negative and transcendence was to
occur.
5) Natural rights
Following Hegel, Gans also rejected the doctrine of natural rights. They both
attacked Rousseau and argued that the theory of natural rights was a distortion of
the anthropological conditions of humankind. Excessive individuality led to the
decay of community, and in his ‘Introduction’ to Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right
Gans claimed that Rousseau’s was not the final statement of political theory and
Hegel’s concept of ethicality superseded Rousseau.29
In the antique world the division between individual rights and politics was
unknown: the ancients only concerned themselves with a community, with a
universality and in The Republic of Plato, just like The Politics of Aristotle, the
principles of subjectivity and politics were considered as interconnected. When
the state is looked upon as the foundation of individual freedom then those
who live outside of the state can only be seen as living in barbarism.30
Not only did Gans applaud Hegel’s return to the principles of antique politi-
cal thought, but he also looked upon this return as providing the beginnings
of a new age of political theory. Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right transcended the
Enlightenment and initiated a new era of political theory based on the presup-
position that state, community and individuality were congruent.
describe Hegel’s approach to the state was ‘anatomy’;32 the evolution of history
had produced a series if state forms, a sequence of the ‘shapes’ of the state. The
state must be comprehended in historicist terms and Gans designated the 17th
and 18th centuries as the period in which state and politics were presented as two
separate entities.33
If the state is ‘anatomy’ then politics are ‘physiology’.34 While the state was
related to forms, politics were related to the actions of statesmen.
When Gans drew the distinction between state and politics he was essentially
paraphrasing the Hegelian distinction between state and civil society, or Hegelian
social methodology. Gans was aware that the political structure conformed to the
contours of civil society. He acknowledged that in a political totality the political
superstructure conformed to the social substructure. Gans incorporated the Hegelian
Method of analyzing a historical phenomena, the unity of content and form.
10) Property
Private property was a crucial ingredient in Hegelian political and ethical theory.
Private property was foundational to the concepts of will, subjectivity and right.
In order to become an individual subject it was necessary for that person to pos-
sess a will. The ‘I’ was synonymous with will because the will was the power that
enabled the ‘I’ to maintain itself.
Property is the result of the will entering an object. A table made by a craftsman
becomes the property of that craftsman because he/she placed their will in that
88 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
table. Will creates property and then property protects and nourishes the will and
the Self. When a table belongs to an individual Self that property preserves that
Self because, by law, the property cannot be expropriated from the Self.
Property was thus the basis of individual freedom and also the founding princi-
ple of Hegel’s constitutionalism, or theory of the state. One of the major axioms of
Hegel’s political theory was the defense of private property because this was vital
to the protection of individual freedom.
Gans and the Hegelian Center agreed with this formulation of Hegel. Through
his justification of private property Hegel was a defender of bourgeois industrial
society, but only because he understood bourgeois society as a stage in the evo-
lution of freedom, or self-determination. Hegel favored political reforms that
advanced the movement toward freedom. All members of the Hegelian Center
concurred with Hegel on this goal – the liberalization of government as an
advance toward freedom.
As I indicated in previous paragraphs Gans joined Hegel in the refutation of
Savigny and the Historical School of Law. However, neither Hegel nor Gans were
the first to initiate such repudiations. In his book, Das Erbrecht in weltgeschichtli-
che Entwicklung,36 Gans attributed the discovery that law, right, was governed by
historicity to Montesquieu, but a more immediate precursor was Anton Friedrich
Justus Thibaut,37 a Professor of Law at the University of Heidelberg. Gans drew the
evolutionary descent of the school of legal historicism/the philosophy of law from
Montesquieu–Thibaut–Hegel and himself.
Thibaut was a pivotal figure in the development of the school of legal histori-
cism/the philosophy of law. Thibaut and Hegel first met when they lectured at the
University of Jena from 1802 to 1805. Thibaut left Jena before Hegel, and went to
the University of Heidelberg, where he worked diligently to recruit Hegel to that
institution. He succeeded and Thibaut and Hegel were reunited as colleagues at
Heidelberg from 1816 to 1818, when Hegel left to go to the University of Berlin.38
Hegel’s embrace of the historicity of law/the philosophy of law was influenced by
Thibaut.39
Furthermore, Gans completed his doctoral dissertation in law at the University
of Heidelberg in 1819 and Thibaut was his mentor.40 Gans later perpetuated the
juridical legacy of Thibaut in his own refutation of Savigny’s Historical School of
Law and his own embrace of the historicity of law was articulated in Das Erbrecht
in weltgeschichtliche Entwicklung. Attention must be drawn to the fact that Marx
took two courses from Gans when he was a student at the University of Berlin and
undoubtedly became aware of Gans’s attacks on Savigny and Gans’s commitment
to legal historicism/the philosophy of law. The evolutionary line running from
Montesquieu to Thibaut to Hegel to Gans must be extended to include Marx. In
Marx’s 1837 letter to his father he mentions Thibaut. In that letter Marx wrote:
The two were closely linked that, on the one hand, I read through Heineccius,
Thibaut, thus for instance, I translated the first two books of the Pandects into
German, and, on the other hand, tried to elaborate a philosophy of law cover-
ing the whole field of law.41
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 89
By 1837 Marx was introduced through Thibaut to the concept of the historicity
of law and property.
Thibaut was additionally a perfect example of the reformist inclinations of the
Hegelian Center. In 1838 he published Über die sogenannte historische und nicht-
historische Rechtsschule.42 In this essay Thibaut called for a unified legal code for
Germany. He pointed to Napoleon who created a unified legal code for France and
Thibaut, in this regard, wanted to Napoleonize Germany. Thibaut understood that
a unified legal code would offer more equal rights to the entire German population.
Thibaut’s call for a unified legal code was echoed in the work of Hegel and Gans
and was an instantiation of the reformist tendencies of the Hegelian Center.
Gans’s own repudiation of the Historical School of Law paralleled those of Hegel
and Thibaut. Gans labeled the Historical School of Law as the ‘science of law’,43
or legal positivism. In the term ‘science of law’ Gans drew an analogy between
Savigny and the empiricism of the natural sciences. For Savigny, law, or right, was
the normative behavior of a people, it was the customary. Right was the social
traditions of a people and therefore the study of law was based upon the positive
identification of normative social behavior.
Contrary to Savigny’s ‘science of law’, Gans expounded the ‘history of law’, or
the ‘philosophy of law’, and this enterprise was composed of two parts. First, the
‘history of law’ involved the comparative study of right, or how different organic
civilizations defined right. Whereas the goal of the ‘science of right’ was a singu-
larity, the positivity of custom, the goal of the ‘history of law’ was the Idea of right
as it was transmuted through different civilizations.
Second, the ‘history of law’ comprised the application of philosophy to right.
Just as philosophy was the study of the ideas objectified by reason over time, so
the ‘history of law’ was the study of the Idea of right throughout human history.
Right was inherently an Idea and the Idea of right took on different meanings
dependent upon the civilization in which it was located, and so the ‘history of
law’ was simultaneously the philosophy of the Idea of right.
In order to explain his vision of the ‘history of law’ Gans employed Hegelian
methodology. Michelet and Henning utilized the same methodology in their
own works. This Hegelian methodology became the explanatory protocols of the
Hegelian Center.
The methodology Gans adopted from Hegel compelled him to look upon the
historical process as the evolution of organic systems. Each system, Oriental, Greco-
Roman, Germanic-Christian, was an organic unit in which a universal principle
defined that organicism. For example, the Greco-Roman organicism witnessed the
emergence of the idea of subjectivity. In the Orient, in the civilizations of India
and China, free subjectivity did not exist because individuality was still a captive
of nature.
The organicism of Gans equipped him to perceive the particularities of a civili-
zation as reflections of a universal principle. In the Greco-Roman organicism the
particularity of art was an expression of the universal principle of subjectivity.
Greco-Roman sculpture glorified the human form, and the Greco-Roman warrior
hero displayed the same divine qualities as the Olympian gods.
90 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
A child of the Enlightenment, Gans, like Hegel, united the concept of organi-
cism to that of progress. History, for Hegel, was the development of freedom, or
the self-determination of the subject. For Gans, each organic civilization expand-
ed the right, the self-determination of the subject, or the ‘history of right’ was
characterized as the expansion of the realm of self-determination and thereby the
progress of freedom.
In their scholarly endeavors Gans, Michelet and Henning employed the same
Hegelian methodology. Michelet applied the methodology both to the exposition
of the history of philosophy and the controversy between natural and rational
rights, Henning employed this methodology in his diagnosis of morality and
Gans exercised this methodology in his investigation of the laws of inheritance.
The unity of the Hegelian Center was revealed by the fact that all three profes-
sors utilized the same Hegelian methodology, but applied it to different terrains
of study. Marx was also a practitioner of this methodology, but Marx made it an
instrument for the analysis of the historicity of the process of production.
Private property was not eternal. It was a historical product and came into being
when the family changed its character. When the extended family as a commune
disappeared, when the nuclear family of a single father and mother made its
historical appearance, inheritance came into existence. As the communal family
fragmented so communal property fragmented and parts of the former collectiv-
ity passed down to the nuclear family by means of inheritance; inheritance was
merely a precursor to private ownership.
Gans was aware of the historicity of property. The first period of the history of
property was the communal era, the age of the gens or of collective ownership by
the extended family. The second period was the age of private property, or inher-
itance as a means of distribution. Private property was initially distributed to the
male of the nuclear family. Gans, as well as Hegel and Marx, were the beneficiaries
of the development of anthropology in the late 18th century. A German anthro-
pologist, P. F. Stuhr,44 recognized the historicity of property, drawing a distinction
between the communal ownership of the gens and the private ownership of the
Roman family. Hegel himself knew the work of Stuhr and in The Philosophy of
Right, which both Gans and Marx read, commented on the gens. By 1820 Hegel
knew of the of the two-stage development of private property, from the collectiv-
ity of the gens to the private ownership of the patriarchal family.45
Gans began Das Erbrecht in weltgeschichtliche Entwicklung with the Romans and
he did this because the Romans were the first to draw a distinction between public
law and private law. The Romans were the first to provide the subject with juridi-
cal rights and one of these was the right to private property. Within Roman civili-
zation the development of inheritance and the juridical right of the subject fused,
thus creating the legitimacy of private property. Private property was the overlap
between the right of inheritance and the right of the subject, jus privatum, and this
became a universal principle of right in the Germanic-Christian world.
Gans was familiar with the existence of class struggle due to his acquaintance
with the French Revolution of 1789 and the subsequent Terror. Das Erbrecht in
weltgeschichtliche Entwicklung was published in 1824 and in it Gans recognized
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 91
the presence of class struggle in the Roman world. Within the Roman Republic
class struggle was represented by the clash between plebeians and patricians46 and
the confrontation over property; property was the economic basis of this class
struggle. Gans identified the Roman plebeians with Aristotle’s demos,47 thereby
demonstrating his German Liberal tendencies.
Gans portrayed the plebeians as the class of subjectivity and the patricians as
the class of authority and aristocracy. The class of subjectivity was also the embod-
iment of progressive activity and reform while the class of authority was simulta-
neously the class of stagnation and conservatism.48 The dialectic between reform
and the status quo was an eternal political logic in the historical process and Gans
identified himself with Aristotle’s demos and the plebeian quest for reform.
As well as Gans, Michelet was another prominent member of the Hegelian
Center. Marx had high regard for Michelet. In the ‘Saint Max’ section of the ‘The
Leipzig Council’, the section in which Marx attacks Stirner’s The Ego and Its Own,
Marx penned three laudatory comments on Michelet. In the subsection entitled
‘The Unique and His Property’ Marx wrote: ‘. . . in no other than the young
“Stirner”, the studious Berlin youth, busy with Hegel’s Logic and gazing admir-
ingly at the great Michelet.’49 In the subsection entitled ‘Hierarchy’ Marx wrote:
‘The cornerstone of the magnificent cathedral . . . as the great Michelet puts
it . . .’50 In the same ‘Hierarchy’ subsection Marx again applauded Michelet: ‘. . .
the realm of spirits whose history was written by Herr Bayrhoffer and for which
the great Michelet collected the statistical data.’51
The intensity and seriousness of Marx’s reading of Michelet is further testi-
fied to by his quotation from the actual text of Michelet. The above-mentioned
quote ‘The cornerstone of the magnificent cathedral’ is taken from Michelet’s
two-volume work Geschichte der letzten Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von
Kant bis Hegel.52 The exact quote was copied from page nine of Volume One of
the Michelet work.
Michelet was a prolific writer and I list here five of his works. I selected these
books for four reasons: 1) They illuminate the major principles of the Hegelian
Center; 2) They illustrate Marx’s relation to this Center; 3) They illustrate some of
the main causes of Marx’s misreading of Hegel; 4) They capture the specific areas
of Marx’s misreading of Hegel.
These books are:
a) Geschichte der letzten Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis Hegel,
and this was the work Marx cites in ‘The Leipzig Council’;
b) Anthropologie und Psychologie der Subjektiv Spirit;
c) Naturrecht oder rechts-philosophie als die praktische Philosophie;
d) Die Ethik der Aristotle in ihrem Verhältnisse zum Systeme der Moral;
e) Die Lösung der gesellschaftliche Frage.53
letzten Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis Hegel. Yet in ‘The Leipzig
Council’ he overlooked specific references Michelet made to essays, journals and
newspaper articles by Hegel that would have enlarged Marx’s assessment of the
‘Parmenides of Berlin’. Marx read Michelet’s text citations to Hegelian manu-
scripts which are today considered indispensible to any comprehension of Hegel,
but which Marx chose to ignore.
All the essays and newspaper articles that I mention in the following paragraphs
date from Hegel’s Jena and post-Jena years. Michelet knew nothing of Hegel’s pre-
Jena writing.
Michelet’s bibliography of Hegel’s authorship appears in the Third Book of the
Geschichte der letzten Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis Hegel. I will
divide my mapping of this material under the following headings; 1) Journals;
2) Dissertation; 3) Essays; 4) Newspaper articles; 5) Identifying the Camp of the
Hegelian Center.
Chapter Four of this study, ‘Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel’ will offer a comprehen-
sive depiction of those areas of Hegel’s philosophy that Marx misunderstood. Since
Marx’s mis-reading of Hegel is vital to understanding the Hegel–Marx relationship
I will also pause and draw attention to examples of this mis-reading in appropriate
moments of this text. At this point, before proceeding to discuss Michelet as an exam-
ple of the Hegelian Center, I will stop and briefly comment upon the losses Marx
suffered in two areas by failing to read the Hegel material mentioned in Michelet’s
book: 1) Articles; 2) Marx’s dismissal of Michelet’s interpretation of Hegel
1) Articles
a) Marx failed to pursue the perspectives on Hegel that Michelet opened to him.
When Marx rebuffed Michelet, when failed to read Hegel’s articles in the Bamberger
Zeitung, which supported the progressive reforms Napoleon brought to Germany,
or the significant article ‘Proceedings of the Estates Assembly in the Kingdom of
Württemberg’, he denied himself insights into Hegel’s German Liberalism.
b) Marx did not follow Michelet in reading ‘The Difference Between Fichte’s and
Schelling’s System of Philosophy’. This was a serious failure on the part of Marx
because he denied himself insight into Fichte’s influence on Hegel. When Marx
did not read this article he remained uninformed of Hegel’s receptivity to Fichtean
subjectivity, to the pneumatic force of the ‘I’. Marx’s recognition of the Fichtean
impact on Hegel could have prevented Marx from misinterpreting Hegel as a ‘logi-
cal pantheist’.
1) Subjectivity
Michelet accentuates the Fichtean moment in Hegel. The subject or the ‘I’ was the
medium through which spirit externalized itself. The subject was the cause of the
movement of spirit and substance. In order to support his claim that the subject
was the instrument for the realization of spirit, Michelet quoted from Hegel, the
best authority on this matter: ‘According to my perspective, the Truth must be
interpreted and expressed as subject and not as substance. The individual is the
standpoint from which to grasp the inner, substantial spirit.’65
2) Practical philosophy
Since the subject was the primary tool for the realization of spirit, Michelet
believed that the center of gravity of Hegel was practical philosophy. The subject
carried the burden of overcoming the non-congruent, of applying reason to reality
with the hope of constructing the congruence between reason and the external.
Michelet recognized the difference between theory and practice, but maintained
that Hegel prioritized practice. The activity of the subject, the actions of the indi-
vidual, were the strategies by which non-congruence would be overcome.66 The
greatness of Hegel did not derive from his contribution to theoretical philosophy,
but rather from his Aristotelianism, the awareness that subjective activity was the
prius of the social world.
In 1866 Michelet published the book Naturrecht oder rechts-philosophie als die prak-
tische Philosophie.67 Marx could not have read this book because he was in London
totally absorbed in finishing the first volume of Das Kapital, which was published a
year later in 1867. Nevertheless, I will allude to Michelet’s book because it is a clear
exposition of Michelet’s adherence to practical philosophy and his interpretation
of Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right as an instantiation of practical philosophy.
Michelet’s Naturrecht oder rechts-philosophie als die praktische Philosophie applied
the Hegelian concept of historicity to the issue of rights. Rejecting Rousseau’s the-
ory of natural rights and Savigny’s program of positive rights, Hegel defined right
as a historical product. As I mentioned previously Hegel looked upon history as a
succession of cultural totalities, including Greco-Roman, Medieval and Germanic-
Christian, and he maintained that the idea of right underwent transformations
as it adjusted to the historical totality in which it was temporally located. Hegel
used the term rational rights and meant that the definition of right experienced
a rational adjustment, a process of reclassification depending upon the cultural
organism in which it was embedded. Right was a form, but the content of that
form was supplied by a cultural totality.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 95
The title of Michelet’s book, Naturrecht oder rechts-philosophie als die prak-
tische Philosophie presents the doctrine of rational rights, and Hegel, as practical
philosophy. This was another attempt to define Hegel as an advocate of subjective
action. The emphasis on subjective agency was another principle of the Hegelian
Center.
The program of rational right was intended as a justification for practice; in
other words, the attainment of the reform agenda of the Hegelian Center could
only be attained through practice. The goals of German Liberalism could not be
achieved without the active participation of citizens. Freedom could not be spread
by means of philosophy, but only through the practice of the subject.
In his 1866 book Michelet confronted the theory of non-congruence in Hegel.
Michelet recognized the non-congruence between reason and reality, the chasm
between the political program of the Hegelian Center and the actualities of the
Prussian monarchy, the divergence between political philosophy and political
reality. Michelet understood the task of practical philosophy as bringing about the
congruence between reason and the state. Philosophy could be realized through
the practical action of the subject. Politics was a branch of practical philosophy.
It was Michelet’s belief that he had perpetuated the tradition of Hegel in terms
of practical philosophy.
of Subjective Spirit in the social world, the universe of family and civil society;
Absolute Spirit was the domain of art, religion, philosophy and state. Michelet’s
Anthropologie und Psychologie der Subjektiv Spirit does not ascend to either Objective
or Absolute Spirit, but Michelet maintained that Subjective Spirit was the founda-
tion of both Objective and Absolute Spirit.
Subjective Spirit commences with the emancipation of spirit from nature. The
first level of Subjective Spirit is anthropology, the point at which spirit’s emanci-
pation from nature begins. It is the level of tribes and the differentiation of the
human species into races, each race with its own quality of mind.
The second stage of the evolution of Subjective Spirit is the psychological. In
this copying of Hegel, Michelet expounds on the appearance of human drives,
desires and will. Drives and desires, the need of sustenance, propelled the subject
to intervene in nature, and they also acted as the substructure of will. For both
Hegel and Michelet will was the ground of personality.
The final stage of the evolution of Subjective Spirit was the personality, or the
‘I’. The ‘I’ was necessary before social life, or Objective Spirit, could begin. The
existence of a multitude of subjective ‘I’s was a precondition for the construction
of social life because a multitude of ‘I’s introduced the struggle for mutual recog-
nition, and intersubjectivity was the glue of social life and Objective Spirit. With
the conquest of personality, Spirit was ready to ascend to the next evolutionary
stage of Objective Spirit.
Aristotle’s ‘The Soul’ was the dominant influence not only on Hegel, but also on
Michelet. Like Hegel, Michelet also appropriated the Aristotelian vision of subjec-
tive life as a teleological process. The end of the subject was self-determination
and the practices of the subject were directed toward this end. Human practice
embodied an entelechy and that purpose was the creation of the autonomy of
the Self.
In the biography of Spirit the birth of Spirit occurs with the separation of the
subject from the object. In the most primitive stages of human existence human-
kind was synthesized with nature, but that conjoining was essentially broken,
bringing into being a subject, an individual, and an object, the natural world.
Nature and subject became distinct. The coming-to-be of the dichotomy between
subject and object was the foundation of the genesis of practice, because the
subject must intervene in the objective to manufacture an environment more
conducive to the survival of the subject.
The emancipation of the subject from nature inaugurated the freedom of
humankind from natural phenomena. This is the anthropological stage of the
evolution of the subject and at this level humankind not only divides into races,
but also develops the capacity for sensitivity. Feelings emerge, dreaming, waken-
ing, the naturalistic basis of human behavior.
The psychological stage of Subjective Spirit witnesses the emergence of con-
sciousness, sensation and perception. The psychological level was a preparatory
stage, a step toward the appearance of self-consciousness and an ‘I’. The psycho-
logical stage gave birth to all the necessary preconditions for the coming-to-be of
a self-conscious Self.
98 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The highest stage of Subjective Spirit was the development of Selfhood. The
ingredients of Selfhood were desire, drive and need. These instincts of the Self
were the foundation of will and will was synonymous with the ‘I’. Self-determina-
tion, or freedom, was impossible without a will because it was impossible to make
a self-determination without knowing the desires of the will. In addition, will was
the ground of practice, or practice was the outcome of self-determination. It was
necessary to have a knowledge of the end, or purpose, toward which a will aspired
before a practice could be decided. Practice was the attempt to realize the will.
This three-stage evolution of Subjective Spirit was a prerequisite for the initiation
of Objective Spirit. It was necessary for an ‘I’ to exist before a community could
come into existence. Social life was impossible without a population of ‘I’s.
a member of the Hegelian Center. Until 1843, up to which time Marx abided by
these nine categories, he also did two things: He interpreted Hegel as a founder of
the Hegelian Center and he identified himself as a member of the Hegelian Center
until he wrote his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’.
The reader should juxtapose these nine Michelet categories with the ten catego-
ries I discussed earlier in this chapter in relation to Gans to acquire an inclusive
picture of the major principles of the Hegelian Center. I will not include any
reference in my following discussion to the ideas of subjectivity, practical phi-
losophy, anthropology-psychology and the ethical nature of the state because, as
I indicated earlier, Marx nullified them and by so doing erased them from his own
understanding of the Hegelian Center.
1) Historicity
According to Michelet, Hegel invented the discipline of the history of philosophy.
Other scholars chartered the narrative of philosophy but these accounts were pri-
marily biographical, or were studies of the output of individual philosophers. For
Hegel, historicity was the presupposition of knowledge and philosophy was the
knowledge of the evolutionary objectifications of reason. In order to gain knowl-
edge reason must observe its own past outputs.
Michelet’s dedication to the Hegelian idea of historicity was strengthened by
his editorship of Hegel’s three-volume The History of Philosophy in the 1832–1845
Collected Works. Hegel lectured on the history of philosophy during his last years
at the University of Berlin and Michelet collated these lectures into the three
volumes, which were published in 1833. Michelet’s dedication to the collation of
these lectures was a further learning process that deepened his conviction of the
centrality of the idea of historicity in Hegel’s thought. For Michelet the history of
philosophy provided a model for the history of the world. Just as historicity was
a presupposition for understanding philosophy, so historicity was the presupposi-
tion for comprehending the evolution of global culture.
Michelet praised other members of the Hegelian Center because of their appli-
cation of historicity to law and morality. He praised Gans because of his applica-
tion of the idea of historicity to the study of property rights and he commended
Henning for relating historiography to the examination of morality.
2) Organicism
Organic units were composed of whole and parts. The whole of an organic unit
was its universal operating procedure. A principle, a drive, tendency, which was
the cohesive, unifying energy of an organic unit, was its universal. However, the
organic unit was also composed of parts and these particularities were made con-
sistent with the whole by the universal principle.
Adopting the structure of Hegel’s The Philosophy of History the Hegelian Center
looked upon the Oriental, Greco-Roman and Germanic-Christian civilizations as
organic units. Each of these civilizations was based on a universal principle and
that universal principle was the magnetic force that enabled the particularities –
religion, art, philosophy – to be supporting elements of the totality.
100 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
3) Method
Michelet drew a distinction between epistemology and method. Epistemology was
Kantian, or concerned the examination of the relation between sense perception
and the Idea. According to Michelet, Hegelian logic was not epistemology, but
methodology.
The dialectic in Hegel was based on the principle of negation. Hegel was a
Spinozist in the sense that he concurred with Spinoza that ‘determination is also
negation’. Definition, the coming forth of a singularity, was dependent upon
negation. A ‘thing’ could only appear through its own limitation.
The dialectic of negation was the basis of historicity. If the being of a ‘thing’
arose only when it was negated then historicity was a result of negativity. History
meant the passing on to something else and negation was the cause of that
passing on.
Michelet understood Hegel’s Method as a protocol of explanation. This Method
consisted of four parts: a) the dialectic of negation; b) negation produced histo-
ricity and civilizations were products of historicity; c) civilizations were organic
units, or history was the chronicle of the historicity of organic civilizations; d)
organic units were constructed of a whole and parts and the explanation of these
historical units required the depiction of how these parts were determined by the
whole and conversely how these parts determined the whole.74
reality was impossible, but it was possible to reform reality to a greater commen-
surability with reason.
Neither Michelet nor the Hegelian Center considered it possible to unite phi-
losophy and religion. The aim of philosophy was not the justification of religion,
but rather the purification of the real. Philosophy was not connected to the super-
natural, but rather was an instrument of practice.
5) Political reform
The Hegelian Center stood for political reform. The Center’s advocacy of political
reform was an expression of its definition of philosophy and history. Since phi-
losophy was the attempt to make reality commensurate with reason then political
institutions must also be brought into greater approximation to reason, they must
have a history.
Michelet agreed with both these propositions and in 1837 called for the reform
of the feudal-aristocratic Prussian constitution. His book Geschichte der letzten
Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis Hegel contained this paragraph:
The highest expression of individual freedom, in which Right attains its great-
est success, without damaging the unity of the state, is the representative con-
stitution. The universal history of Right shows a progressive development of
individual states, national spirits, or they gradually evolve to this goal.75
In 1837, seven years after the French Revolution of 1830, Michelet sought to
reform Prussia from a Restoration hegemony of Throne and Altar into a consti-
tutional monarchy resting upon, not a democratic suffrage, but a representative
parliament.
In addition, the reformist mentality of Michelet was further demonstrated in
his response to the 1848 Revolutions in Prussia. In an article written in 1849, Die
Lösung der gesellschaftliche Frage, which Marx did not know, Michelet appeared,
not as a communist – he does not mention The Communist Manifesto – but as
a social democrat. In this essay Michelet called for the unification of Germany,
universal suffrage and, exhibiting a knowledge of French socialism, Proudhon in
particular, as well as ‘my friend Cieszkowski’, and using the word ‘proletariat’,
he advocated greater social benefits for that exploited class. I mentioned Die
Lösung der gesellschaftliche Frage as a means of demonstrating Michelet’s reformist
passions, but this does not mean that Hegelian Center in general became social
democrat in response to the 1848 Revolution.
But in 1837 Michelet was not yet a social democrat and Geschichte der letzten
Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis Hegel does not mention the ‘prole-
tariat’, Proudhon or Cieszkowski. Michelet’s intellectual boundaries in 1837 were still
circumscribed by Hegelianism and this is demonstrated by his adherence to Hegel’s
definition of the state as an ethical organism. In his 1837 book Michelet wrote that
Hegel ‘conceived of Right and the State as objective representations of morality’.76
Like Hegel, Michelet looked upon the state as that totality based on the condition
of mutual recognition and intersubjectivity and ethical life was an expression of
102 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
the necessity of these two factors. Michelet’s agreement that the state was an ethi-
cal organism also revealed his awareness of the importance of Aristotle in Hegelian
thought. Michelet understood that Hegel sought to adopt the principles of Aristotle’s
The Politics to the conditions of Prussia in the first quarter of the 19th century.
7) Property
Like Hegel, Michelet defended private property. According to both Hegel and
Michelet private property was a protector of subjectivity and will and therefore
was a pillar of freedom. Private property was the legal guarantee that subjectivity
and will could not be preempted. According to Michelet a state that recognized the
right of property was a state in which one condition of freedom was actualized.
Michelet’s commitment to the principles of will, subjectivity and property pre-
vented him from becoming a communist. Michelet did become a social democrat,
but he never espoused the total eradication of private property. I make this point
in order to define the differences that caused Marx to abandon the Hegelian
Center. The Center remained loyal to private property and subjectivity while
Marx’s break with the Center occurred when he abandoned the principles of pri-
vate property, subjectivity and individual will.
Attention should be paid to the fact that the 1837 publication of Michelet’s
Geschichte der letzten Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis Hegel coincid-
ed with Marx’s entrance into the Hegelian circles at the University of Berlin. Earlier
paragraphs of this chapter referenced Marx’s 1837 letter to his father in which he
told of his membership in the ‘Doctor’s Club’, a Hegelian discussion group at the
University of Berlin. At this time Michelet was a professor at the university.
Since his relation to the Hegelian Center played such an important role in the
maturation process of the Young Marx I will extend my discussion of the Hegelian
Center to include brief references to Bayrhoffer, Henning and Hinrich.
The most important books Bayrhoffer published during his academic career
were Beiträge zur Naturphilosophie77 and Die Idee und Geschichte der Philosophie.78
My comments here are concerned completely with the latter and are intended
only as a brief summary.
The second book is essentially a reiteration of Hegel’s three-volume The History
of Philosophy, collated by Michelet. Following Michelet’s organization, Bayrhoffer
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 103
divided the history of philosophy into three periods, Oriental, Greco-Roman and
Germanic-Christian. Duplicating Michelet, Bayrhoffer judged each of these three
periods as organic, total systems, the particularities of which always reflected the
universal essence.
I point out the continuity between Michelet and Bayrhoffer because it allows
us to understand the comment on Bayrhoffer that Marx made in ‘The Leipzig
Council’: ‘. . . the realm of spirits whose history was written by Herr Bayrhoffer
and for which the great Michelet collected the statistical data.’79 Marx understood
Bayrhoffer as a replication of Michelet. The formulation of Hegel’s The History of
Philosophy supplied by Michelet was faithfully adhered to by Bayrhoffer.
In addition to establishing the Hegel–Michelet–Bayrhoffer school of interpreta-
tion, Die Idee und Geschichte der Philosophie was also an articulation of the Hegelian
Center, and I will refer only to two points to illustrate this assertion.
First, Bayrhoffer championed the political reform of the Hohenzollern monar-
chy. The book noted that the ‘necessary demand of the historical moment called
for the equalization of the monarchist-aristocratic form with the democratic form
of government based on the equality of the many’.80 Bayrhoffer maintained that
the constant historical adjustment of reality to reason required the renovation of
the Hohenzollern governing system.
Second, Bayrhoffer, imitating the Hegel–Michelet line, believed that the state
was an ethical institution. Prioritizing the importance of subjectivity, Bayrhoffer
looked upon the state as offering the grounds for the ethical principle of mutual
recognition.81
Another important member of the Hegelian Center was Henning. Not only was
Henning the editor of Hegel’s three-volume The Science of Logic, and ‘The Logic’ of
the Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences in Hegel’s Collected Works, but he also
published an important book, Prinzipien der Ethik in historischer Entwicklung.82
Henning took the Hegelian ideas of historicity and organicism and applied them
to ethics. A historicist interpretation of ethics required the investigator to assume
the evolutionary nature of ethics. True to Hegel, Henning identified three stages
in the historicity of ethics, Oriental, Greco-Roman and Germanic-Christian.
Applying the concept of organicism, Henning looked upon these three periods
as totalities. Each organic system was defined by a universal ethical principle and
all other ethical microcosms within that system reflected the universal.83
True to the syllabus of the Hegelian Center, Henning assessed subjectivity as
the basis of ethics. Ethics was based on human actions and action did not occur
without will. The propellant of individual behavior was will and the ethical was a
means to harmonize the infinity of wills.84
The institution within which the process of harmonization occurred was the
state. In agreement with Michelet, Hegel and the Hegelian Center, Henning
assessed the state as an ethical entity.85
The entire historicity of the ethical was the unfolding of the philosophy of the
ethical. The philosophy of the ethical needed to unfold itself in the temporal and
thus unfolding produced its historicity. Philosophy was the cause of the reforma-
tion of the ethical.
104 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The core issues of the Hegelian Center were further illustrated in the work
of Hinrichs. Four concepts that contributed to the definition of the Hegelian
Center were subjective activity, practice, rational rights and the separation
between religion and philosophy. In three of his works, Geschichte der Rechts- und
Staatsprinzipien,86 Politische Vorlesungen,87 and Das Leben in der Natur,88 Hinrichs
perpetuated these principles and in so doing contributed to the definition of the
Hegelian Center. Hinrichs was a German Liberal.
In his Geschichte der Rechts- und Staatsprinzipien Hinrichs defended the Hegelian
principle of rational rights. Hinrichs’ book is a history of the definition of right
in the works of Gottfried Leibniz, Christian Thomasius and Johannes Müldener
in an effort to demonstrate that the meaning of right was an evolution, that
reason redefined right in the course of history. Like Hegel and Michelet, Hinrichs
opposed the natural rights of Rousseau and the positive rights of Savigny. In his
two-volume Politischen Vorlesungen, Hinrichs extolled reason as the most accurate
path to truth and therefore as the most reliable tool to define right and freedom.
Reaffirming the Hegelian Center, Hinrichs defined freedom as the unity of the Self
and community, or nation.
From the perspective of this phase, however, Hinrichs’ most important manu-
script was Das Leben in der Natur because it repeats the major ideas of Michelet in
his Anthropologie und Psychologie der Subjektiv Spirit. Hinrichs and Michelet were in
accord in selecting the principles of subjectivity and practice as the pre-eminent
ideas of Hegel’s philosophy, and in this concurrence they made subjectivity and
practice the defining characteristics of the Hegelian Center.
Hinrichs’ Das Leben in der Natur was an attack in the mechanistic interpretation
of human life. Hinrichs rebelled against the teachings of Gustav Liebig and Jakob
Moleschott. Both of these scientists used the models of chemistry and physics to
interpret human life, applying an inorganic paradigm in their explanations of
organic existence. Hinrichs repudiated this mechanistic approach.
Hinrichs drew a distinction between inorganic and organic existence. Organic
existence was not physics-chemistry, but rather operated in terms of purpose. The
uniqueness of organic life, human life, was its inherent teleology, its movement
toward a desired end. Hinrichs’ vision of organic existence was practical, it pos-
sessed a goal and designed a practice to fulfill that goal. In his book Hinrichs was
an advocate of the vision of human existence of Aristotle, Hegel and Michelet.
Hinrichs is important not only because of his adherence to the Hegelian Center,
to German Liberalism, but also because Marx called upon him for intellectual sup-
port. As I will document when discussing ‘The Leipzig Council’, Marx called upon
him for help in his dispute with Bauer, and the above discussion of Hinrichs’ work
should clarify why Marx made such an appeal.
********
The formation of the Hegelian School began in the 1820s. The unity of the School
was shattered in 1835 with the publication of Strauss’s book The Life of Jesus, and
beginning in 1835 a Right and Center Hegelianism emerged. I have defined the
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 105
Hegelian Center and I will now proceed to epitomize the Hegelian Right. Left
Hegelianism, the school to which Marx was associated, did not arise until 1841
and only enjoyed a brief lifespan of two years, from 1841 until 1843. I will be dis-
cussing here the contrasts between the Right and Center of the Hegelian School,
in the years between 1820 and 1841; the Hegelian Left therefore plays no role.
My analysis of the Hegelian Right focuses on Philipp Marheineke. A leading
figure of the Hegelian Right, Marheineke was both a member of ‘The Society of
the Friends of the Deceased’ and the editor of Hegel’s The Philosophy of Religion in
the Collected Works.
The two books of Marheineke I will discuss are his Bedeutung des Hegelschen
Philosophie in der christlichen Theologie and System der christlichen Dogmatik.
The major cleavages between Center and Right arose over two points, the legacy
of Strauss and the role of philosophy.
The Center perpetuated the legacy of Strauss and divorced religion and philoso-
phy. Continuing Enlightenment secularization the Center ended the medieval
unity of philosophy and religion and directed philosophy as a tool for the inter-
vention in reality. Philosophy would no longer justify theology. The Right rejected
Strauss and sought to retain the unity of philosophy and religion. For the Right,
philosophy was a device to validate religion; philosophy must be theologized.
In his book Hegelianism Toews set forth the following analysis of Marheineke:
not only did he reject the Center, but also the Left. By 1841 Bauer had abandoned
the Center, joined the Left and espoused critique, or the use of subjective self-
consciousness as a weapon against reality and religion. Bauer’s book, Die Posaune
des jüngsten Gerichts über Hegel, den Atheisten und Antichristen was published in
1841 and in his Bedeutung des Hegelschen Philosophie in der christlichen Theologie,
published one year later, Marheineke attacked Bauer.93
I mention Bauer’s book at this point not only to illustrate how Marheineke
defined the role of philosophy, but also to document the Young Marx’s posi-
tion in the fragmentation of the Hegelian school into Left, Center and Right.
The original plan of Die Posaune des jüngsten Gerichts über Hegel, den Atheisten und
Antichristen called for it to consist of two parts; the Posaune was the first part and
the second part was supposed to be an essay by Marx called ‘Treatise on Christian
Art’.94 Marx’s essay was never completed, but the fact that the original design
called for its inclusion shows the early closeness of Marx and Bauer – which was
later broken – as well as Marx’s awareness of the Left–Center–Right civil wars of
the Hegelian School.
By July 1843 Marx had completely rejected both Marheineke and the Hegelian
Right. In a letter written to Ruge on July 9, 1842 Marx wrote: ‘It is necessary to
conclude that the old Marheineke has proven before the whole world the total
impotence of the Old Hegelianism.’95
Not only did Marheineke seek to reconcile philosophy and religion, something
that both the Left and Center abjured, but he was also an accomodationist.
Whereas Left and Center were reformist, the Right accommodated itself to the
Prussian Crown.
Neither Left, Center nor Right should be confused with the Anti-Hegelianism
of Heinrich Leo or Ernst Wilhelm Hengstenberg. The Center and Right never
cut their links to Hegel, and the Left, as represented by Marx, only broke with
the Idealism and politics of Hegel in 1842. By the 1830s, however, Leo and
Hengstenberg were already denouncing Hegel as a Christian heretic. In 1838
Leo published a book, Die Hegelingen, which denounced Hegel and his follow-
ers as anti-Christian, while Hengstenberg was the editor of the Evangelische
Kirchenzeitung, a newspaper that defended evangelical orthodoxy. The anti-
Hegelianism of Leo and Hengstenberg was based on the unbridgeable schism
between religious dogma and philosophy. Marx was aware of the writings of Leo,
and probably of Hengstenberg, and in his article on the Historical School of Law
placed Leo in the reactionary camp of Friedrich Julius Stahl and Karl Ludwig von
Haller.96
In addition to their campaign for the religious usurpation of philosophy, the
Anti-Hegelians advocated the Restoration synthesis, the alliance of Throne, Altar
and Aristocracy. Although reform, even in different metrics, was the slogan of the
Left and Center, the Anti-Hegelians stood for the continuation of the medieval
trinity of the incarnation of Throne-Aristocracy and Lutheran Church.
This Phase has so far described the Hegelian school which exerted the most
influence on Marx. It is now necessary to show how Marx himself interpreted
Hegel. Is it possible to distill from Marx’s writings during the 1841–1844 period
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase One 107
whether he read Hegel as either Center or Right? What was Marx’s own view of
Hegel?
Marx looked upon Hegel as a member of the Hegelian Center. Marx never saw
Hegel as a member of the Hegelian Right, nor of the Hegelian Left. This does not
mean that Marx never criticized Hegel himself, but it does mean that Marx never
separated himself from Hegelian methodology. Many of Marx’s writings, ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, ‘On the Jewish Question’, ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, and the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and
Philosophy in General’, the last chapter of ‘The Manuscripts’, were caustic attacks
on the Hegelian System, but Marx continued with the Hegelian Method, as well
as other dimensions of Hegelian thought. Marx was aware of the errors committed
by Hegel in terms of System and Speculative philosophy, but he remained influ-
enced by and perpetuated those terrains of Hegel he thought irreplaceable tools
for understanding the functioning of social formations.
In order for me to clearly outline the argument I am presenting here it is neces-
sary for me to first distinguish the following three concepts: methodology, politics
and system.
By the term methodology I mean a program of explanation in the social sci-
ences. Hegel used this methodology to explain every phenomenon in the natural
world, but I am limiting this concept to the social sciences. Later portions of this
book will detail exactly all the elements that Marx incorporated from Hegel to
construct his program of explanation, but at this point I will only outline three
Hegelian antecedents; the organic, the universal and the particular.
The organic image lay at the heart of Hegel’s Method of explanation. Limiting
myself to the domains of history and the socio-political, Hegel conceived of histor-
ical formations as totalities. The history of the Greco-Roman world was one such
organic unit, and the history of the Oriental world was another such holistic unit.
When Hegel analyzed these culturo-political organisms he applied the concept of
universality to them. Each of these historic organisms were pervaded by a universal
idea or substance that established the laws by which that holism functioned.
A huge gulf separated Hegelian methodology from Hegelian politics. Hegelian
politics was an expression of the Stein-Hardenberg reform ethos and that ethos
projected itself into the Vormärz period. I maintain that there is no contradic-
tion in simultaneously rejecting Hegelian politics while incorporating Hegelian
methodology. It is entirely possible to accept the methodology with which Hegel
describes Chinese and Indian civilization while at the same time refuting his
defense of constitutional monarchy. This is precisely the path that Marx took and
the central thrust of this book is to trace the means through which Marx distin-
guished between Method and politics.
It is also possible to disengage Hegelian methodology from the inclusiveness
of the Hegelian System. It is true that the methodology formed one aspect of the
System, but Marx’s approach to Hegel was stamped by his severing of the meth-
odology from the System.
The Hegelian System was a form of Speculative philosophy, or, rather, one major
part of the System was Hegel’s belief in a universal substance. In this regard Hegel
108 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
was under the influence of Spinoza. The uniqueness of Hegel’s belief in a universal
substance derived from his Fichtean idea that thought was the original generator
of this substance. Substance was the objectification of thought, the externaliza-
tion of thought that came to shape the real. Marx himself in ‘The Leipzig Council’
described Hegel as a combination of Spinoza and Fichte97 and I will discuss this
comment in detail in later sections of this book.
It is impossible to differentiate the Hegelian System from the idea of substance;
put another way, the Hegelian System was coequal with Hegel’s Speculative
philosophy. Marx’s debates with Hegelian Speculative philosophy begin with
his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ and end in ‘The Leipzig Council’,
and Marx concludes these internal ruminations by severing all contact with
Speculative philosophy.
Marx’s voyage was to discover that it was possible to refute Hegelian politics,
Speculative philosophy and System, but to rescue Hegelian methodology. One of
the areas to which Marx returned to Hegel was in his search for a paradigm by
which to explain social formations. For Marx, in order to fulfill his mission to con-
struct a scientific analysis of capitalist society, required an explanatory protocol,
and for help in erecting this protocol he returned to Hegel.
Marx drew a distinction between form and content, the Method and System of
Hegelian thought. Marx appropriated the form and Method of Hegelian thought,
but he rejected the content and System. For example, in The Phenomenology of
Spirit98 Hegel writes about work and labor as intrinsic energies of the subject,
but assumes that it is Spirit, self-awareness of self-consciousness, which works
and labors through the subject. Marx appropriated the Hegelian form – he also
regarded work and labor as intrinsic energies of social man – but he rejected the
assertion that it was Spirit that labored – the content – and substituted a new
content of social labor. The Philosophy of Right illustrates the Hegelian Method, the
gradual supersession of family and civil society until this dialectical transcendence
leads to the justification of the state and the warfare of sovereignties in the bat-
tleground of world history. Marx accepted the Hegelian methodology – bourgeois
capitalism negated and superseded aristocratic feudalism – but he canceled the
Hegelian systematic of substance and substituted political economy. Marx adhered
to the Hegelian form and Method, but he discarded the content, substance, and
the systematic, the advance of the Absolute Idea. In essence, Marx borrowed some
of the tools of the transformative critique that Feuerbach applied to Hegel.
The remaining portions of this book will substantiate that Marx borrowed the
form but not the content of Hegel’s methodology. In this way it will be possible to
demonstrate the various forms of Hegelianism that Marx incorporated and at the
same time reveal those categories of Hegelianism that Marx abandoned.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 109
In Phase One, ‘Hegel and Marx in the Center’, I drew attention to the importance
of Marx’s November 10–11, 1837 letter to his father. Whereas Marx’s 1836 poetry
expressed his frustration with the arcane qualities of Hegel’s Aesthetics the 1837
letter is vital because it definitively establishes 1837 as the date of Marx’s move-
ment toward Hegelianism. Marx’s break with the ‘logical pantheism’ of Hegel does
not occur until the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’. The 1837 letter
contains the now famous self-confession of Marx:
While I was ill I got to know Hegel from beginning to end, together with most
of his disciples. Through a number of close friends in Stralow I came across
a Doctor’s Club, which includes some university lecturers and my most inti-
mate Berlin friend, Dr Rutenberg. In controversy here, many conflicting views
were expressed, and I became ever more firmly bound to the modern world
philosophy from which I had thought to escape.
However, I am by no means abandoning this plan, especially since all the aesthet-
ic celebrities of the Hegelian school have promised their collaboration through
the help of university lecturer Bauer, who plays a big role among them, and of
my colleague, Dr Rutenberg.1
The Bauer mentioned in this letter was Bruno Bauer who was then a lecturer on
theology at the University of Berlin. This was Marx’s first meeting with Bauer
who played an important role in Marx’s early philosophical development. In the
winter term of 1838–1839 Marx took a course from Bauer on Isaiah. Even after
Bauer left the University of Berlin to go to the University of Bonn, Marx continued
a correspondence with Bauer.2 Bauer encouraged Marx to write his doctoral dis-
sertation on the Democritean and Epicurean philosophy of nature. In addition,
Bauer asked Marx to contribute a second part to Bauer’s book, Die Posaune des
jüngsten Gerichts über Hegel, den Atheisten und Antichristen, which appeared in 1841.
Marx’s contribution was to be called Treatise on Christian Art, but Saxon censorship
forbade the publication of Marx’s proposed essay and so it was never completed.
Marx’s interest in aesthetics lasted until 1841, the year he received his doctorate
in philosophy. However, the Marx–Bauer relationship collapsed in 1843 when
Marx published his ‘On the Jewish Question’, a vehement denunciation of Bauer’s
program for religious equality.
In order to properly assess the 1837 letter it must be approached as part apology
and part description of the intellectual odyssey of a 19-year-old student. As an
apology Marx was seeking to placate Heinrich Marx, his father. Heinrich wanted
Karl to be a lawyer, but Marx’s transfer in 1836 from the University of Bonn to
the University of Berlin was an initial statement that Karl’s interests were shifting
toward philosophy. Furthermore, the letter describes a three-stage development
in Marx’s intellectual interests; the first stage was aesthetics, the second stage was
law and the final stage was philosophy.
110 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
In the first stage Marx was absorbed in lyrical poetry. His love for Jenny von
Westphalen, to whom he sent love poetry, was the basis of this Romantic out-
pouring.3 The second stage was the study of law, a gesture he made toward his
father, but this second stage was superseded by the third stage in which he began
his study of philosophy. In his letter Marx summarized this intellectual odys-
sey in the following sentence: ‘Poetry, however, could be and had to be only an
accompaniment; I had to study law and above all felt the urge to wrestle with
philosophy.’4
Even though the letter of 1837 must be read as a diary of intellectual curiosity
the direction toward which this curiosity pointed was undeniable. Irrespective
of his desire to assuage his father, Marx was most interested in philosophy and
although he had not yet made a full commitment to Hegelianism he was moving
consistently toward that consummation.
Relinquishing Romantic poetry, Marx turned to law. His study of law, however,
was predicated upon the need to apply philosophy to law. In his 1837 letter Marx
wrote how he ‘tried to elaborate a philosophy of law covering the whole field of
law. I prepared this with some metaphysical propositions by way of an introduc-
tion and continued this unhappy opus as far as public law, a work of almost 300
pages’.5
In the attempt to outline a philosophy of law Marx rejected the approach of
both Fichte and Kant. Fichte’s philosophy of law was a ‘metaphysics’6 because it
simply dealt with concepts, ‘divorced from all actual law and every actual form
of law’.7 Marx also found Kant’s classification of contracts in Part One of The
Metaphysics of Morality as unsatisfactory because of its inability to connect form
and content.
Not only did Marx reject the approaches of Fichte and Kant to law, but also that
of Savigny. As I indicated in Phase One, by the winter term of 1836–1837 Marx took
Savigny’s course on Pandects and Gans’s course on Criminal Law and in 1838 Gans’s
course on Prussian Law at the University of Berlin and was already familiar with the
controversy over the Historical School of Law. In his 1837 letter Marx pinpointed
Savigny’s defining error, his separation of matter and form. Savigny neglected the
form, the philosophical concept, and merely dealt with matter, or civil custom.8 For
Marx, as early as 1837, it was impossible to dispense with form, or the concept.
Marx’s transfer to the University of Berlin exerted a profound influence on his
intellectual development. His matriculation brought him into contact with Gans
and Savigny, the controversies dealing with the Historical School of Law and the
work of Thibaut. In addition, Marx read Roman Law and the Roman distinction
between private and public law and their definition of private property.
In relation to Roman Law, the 1837 letter establishes that Marx ‘translated the
first two books of the Pandects into German’.9 The Pandects was a compilation
of Roman civil law commissioned by Justinian, the Emperor of the Byzantine
Empire. Marx’s knowledge of the Pandects strengthened his understanding of the
distinction the Romans drew between jus privatum, private law, and jus publicum,
or public law. Marx devoted two pages of his 1837 letter to an outline of the split
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 111
between jus privatum and jus publicum.10 In one subsection of this outline dealing
with contractual private law Marx wrote about the ‘Law of persons in relation to
property’.11 In another reference to Roman positive law Marx noted that he read
Savigny’s book Das Recht des Besitzes.12 For the Romans private property fell under
the rubric of jus privatum and that was the origin of property in the Germanic-
Christian world.
By 1837 Marx had already entered the controversies over private property, the
positivist approach of Savigny, and the historicity of law approach of Thibaut
and Gans. Marx was already cognizant of the fundamental issues involved in the
debates over the Historical School of Law, although he had not yet written on this
issue. Nevertheless, his acquaintance with Gans, Savigny and Thibaut brought the
issue of the positivity or historicity of private property to his attention and it was
never to depart from his consciousness.
The third stage of Marx’s 1837 intellectual trajectory took him to philosophy,
or the application of philosophy to law. The 19-year-old Marx saw the necessity
of relating philosophy to law, or reality, and this was the formula of Hegel and
the Hegelian Center. However, his desire to apply philosophy to law, although
a Hegelian paradigm, still leaves open the question of the exact philosophical
categories Marx borrowed from Hegel.
The passage to Hegel led past Kant and Fichte. In the 1837 letter Marx wrote:
From the idealism, which, by the way, I compared and nourished with the Idealism
of Kant and Fichte, I arrived at the point of seeking the Idea in reality itself.
If previously the gods dwelt above the earth, now they become its center.13
The concept is indeed the mediating link between form and content. In a phil-
osophical treatment of law, therefore, the one must arise in the other; indeed,
the form should only be the continuation of the content.14
112 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The revisions that Marx introduced to Hegel’s The History of Philosophy were
numerous. Marx moved from Hegelian non-congruence to Bauerian critique.
Hegel’s attitude to materialism was complex. On the one hand Hegel praised
Thales for introducing the study of nature into Greek thought, but on the other
hand Hegel was suspicious of materialism as empiricism because empiricism, the
Locke and Hume wing of the Enlightenment, reduced reason to a mere reflux of
sense perception, thus eliminating the primacy of the Idea. From this perspec-
tive Hegel attacked the materialism and empiricism of Epicurus and overlooked
the role that subjective self-consciousness played in Epicurus. Contrary to Hegel,
Marx embraced the materialism of Epicurus as opening new horizons in Western
philosophy after the otherworldliness of the Middle Ages. Marx also emphasized
the centrality of subjective self-consciousness in Epicurus. Hegel’s The History
of Philosophy judged Epicurus and Democritus as symbols of the decay of the
Platonic-Aristotelian apex of Greek speculation, while Marx looked upon Epicurus,
his advocacy of critique and materialism, as contributing instruments to Western
philosophy that encouraged socio-political progressivism.
Regardless of the revisions Marx made to Hegelian philosophy, Marx still looked
upon Hegel as belonging to the Hegelian Center. These revisions were consist-
ent with other representatives of the Hegelian Center, such as Gans, Michelet
and Hinrichs. To revise does not mean to reject. The new perspectives Marx put
forth were not intended to remove Hegel from the Hegelian Center, but rather to
uncover previously unforeseen potentialities of the Hegelian Center.
The formula of uniting critique and materialism, not empiricism, remained at the
core of Marx’s methodology throughout his life. In order to understand this state-
ment it is necessary to draw a distinction between empiricism and materialism.
As articulated by Locke and Hume empiricism sought to explain the origin of
ideas from sense perception. Its basic concern lay with the etiology of ideas and it
reduced Idea to sense experience.
Materialism as articulated by the Frenchmen Claude Helvétius and Paul d’Holbach
possessed a broader vision of the capacities of the human mind. Materialism rec-
ognized that sense perception was only one component of thought, but also drew
attention to environmental factors in explaining the etiology of thought. The
materialism of the early 19th century was a form of sociology, because in account-
ing for human thought it not only included sense perception but also sociological
conditioning.
Marx’s unification of critique and materialism was the launching pad for
political praxis. One determinant of human thought was the social environment;
therefore in order to alter human thought it was necessary to reconfigure social
conditions, and this was called political praxis.
Marx’s unity of critique and materialism was not reductive, did not reduce
thought to sense impressions. As we have discussed, Marx’s materio-critique still
recognized the need of philosophy, of thought as a determining agent. Marx did
not seek to abolish philosophy, but rather supply philosophy with a new mission,
the task of uncovering the sociological causes of oppression.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 115
On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature con-
stitutes Marx’s first deep probe into the philosophy of Hegel. The dissertation con-
cerns Hegel’s three-volume The History of Philosophy, but is specifically a detailed
exegesis of the second volume, ‘Plato and the Platonists’, which contained not
only a discussion of Plato and Aristotle, but also Hegel’s assessment of the Stoics
and Epicureans.
The original Marx manuscript of his dissertation no longer exists and what
did come down to the present is an incomplete copy in the handwriting of an
unknown person. The incompleteness of the dissertation is evinced by the fact
that the fourth and fifth chapters of Part One are missing. However, each chapter
of Part One and Two have their own footnotes as well as Marx’s dictated notes
confirming that Marx reviewed and authorized the copy. Assuming that the
transcription is accurate, these notebooks are useful because Marx’s commentar-
ies, even though fragmentary, contain interesting statements revealing Marx’s
thought at the time.
In his ‘Introduction’ to The History of Philosophy Hegel divided this narrative
into three large periods: 1) Greek Philosophy; 2) The Philosophy of the Middle
Ages; and 3) Modern Philosophy.17 He did not include Oriental thought, Chinese
and Indian, into his periodization because he did not believe Chinese or Indian
scholars were philosophers; they failed to make the transition from substance,
nature, to subjective self-consciousness.
However, Hegel additionally subdivided Greek philosophy into three compart-
ments; 1) From Thales to Aristotle; 2) Greek Philosophy in the Roman World; and
3) Neo-Platonic Philosophy.18 From the point of view of my discussion I will pres-
ently focus on compartment 2, ‘Greek Philosophy in the Roman World’ because in
this segment Hegel discusses the Stoics and Epicureans. Hegel discussed Democritus
in compartment 1, ‘From Thales to Aristotle’ and he understands Democritus as
an empirical philosopher, as someone who believed that ideas exclusively arose
from sense perception. In comparing Epicurus and Democritus Marx’s dissertation,
following the Hegelian periodization, jumped from compartment 1, ‘Thales to
Aristotle’ to compartment 2, ‘Greek Philosophy in the Roman World’ or from the
early Ionic and Eleatic interest in nature philosophy to the Roman Empire.
Hegel referred to philosophy as ‘the true theodicy’19 and ‘the simplest revelation
of the World spirit’.20 He meant that the development of philosophy recounted
the stages through which the subject and object, the Idea and reality, became one,
the Absolute Idea, and consequently absolute freedom. In order to reach absolute
freedom it was necessary for philosophy to pass through a learning process and
the first stages of this self-education of thought were in the Greek period. In
this first stage thought became aware of nature, Thales and Democritus, the self-
determination of the concept, Plato and Aristotle, and free subjectivity, Socrates.
In the second period of self-knowledge, the Middle Ages, abstract theology over-
came, preempted, both nature and subjective concept. However, in the third
epoch of the curriculum vitae of thought, Modern Philosophy rediscovered nature
by separating the physical universe from the theological. This detachment of
116 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Bauer’s Die Posaune was a polemic against the Protestant Wing of the Prussian
Restoration who represented Hegel as a supporter of religious belief.27 These
Lutheran Restorationists sought to provide validity to the Prussian Crown by
using Hegel as a demonstration that religion could be justified through philoso-
phy. In Die Posaune Bauer attacked this proposed marriage of Altar and Throne
by portraying Hegel as both an atheist and an anti-Christ. According to Bauer,
Hegel redefined the role of philosophy and rather than conjoining philosophy
with Christology Bauer located the purpose of philosophy in critique as practiced
by an independent self-consciousness. Thought was the dynamic prius of the uni-
verse and thought must discover the fissures that divided reason from actuality.
Whereas Marx eventually moved to the position that praxis must be the outcome
of philosophy, that human action was required to actually change external cir-
cumstances, Bauer never advanced to the practical-praxis position. Nevertheless,
Bauer did introduce the principle of subjective freedom and critique into Left
Hegelian consciousness.
Marx applied the Bauerian methodology of critique in three forms in his dis-
sertation. First, Marx critiqued Hegel and, second, he interpreted Epicurus as an
exponent of critique. In relation to Hegel himself Marx praised the ‘Parmenides
of Berlin’ because he ‘on the whole correctly defined the general aspects of’28
Epicurean, Stoic and Sceptic philosophy. In the ‘Foreword’ to the dissertation Marx
additionally recognized Hegel as the inventor of the history of philosophy.29 Marx
acknowledged that Hegel invented a new science. Third, the dissertation contains
the first occasion in which Marx used the weapon of critique against a specific
philosophy. As I mentioned previously, Marx’s dissertation was a critique of Hegel’s
The History of Philosophy, but Marx did not designate that his dissertation embod-
ied this particular purpose. However, the dissertation contained two additions and
both additions carried the title ‘Critique of Plutarch’s Polemic against Epicurean
Theology’. One addition carried the subtitle ‘The Eternal Life of the Individual’30
and the second addition the subtitle of ‘The Relation of Man to God’.31 I single
out these instances because they are the first times that Marx identified himself
as employing the strategy of critique in his philosophical debates. Critique even-
tually became a central philosophical weapon for Marx, distinguishing his work
from 1843 onward. Marx’s activation of critique in his dissertation is an important
moment because it is the origin of a crucial philosophical maneuver of Marx.
However, Marx also censored Hegel for devaluing the importance of these phi-
losophers, including the earlier thought of Democritus, who invented both the
atomic theory and the theory of the void. Hegel interpreted Epicureans, Stoics
and Sceptics as instances of the decline of Greek philosophy, but Marx rebuked
the Parmenides of Berlin on this issue. Specifically, on two points, the philosophy
of nature and subjective self-consciousness, Marx judged Epicurus as the central
figure of his dissertation, as introducing a new age in the history of philosophy.
Building upon Democritus, Epicurus advanced the study of the philosophy of
nature, particularly in the area of physics. Epicurus thus left a buried treasure in
the course of Western thought, a treasure rediscovered by Pierre Gassendi and
that served as the historical precedent for the Enlightenment investigation of
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 119
nature. Marx did not believe that Epicurus represented the decline Greco-Roman
philosophy, but that he was an ancient spirit that again came to life in the birth
of modern materialism.
Additionally, Epicurus discovered the power of self-consciousness. In the
‘Foreword’ to his dissertation Marx wrote: ‘. . . its own aphorism against all heav-
enly and earthly gods who do not acknowledge human self-consciousness as the
highest divinity.’32 In Part One of the dissertation Marx wrote: ‘Is it an accident
that with the Epicureans, Stoics and Sceptics all moments of self-consciousness
are represented completely, but every moment as a particular existence? Is it an
accident that these systems in their totality form a complete structure of self-
consciousness?’33
Marx’s dissertation provided historiographic validity for Bauer’s idea of free self-
consciousness. Marx interpreted Epicurus as the intellectual precursor of Bauer.
He showed that the origins of critique were to be found in antiquity and that
it should be used as one of the central methodologies of contemporary Western
philosophy. Critique should be allied with materialism and Epicurus was also an
exemplar of how materialism and critique could be conjoined. Then the union of
materialism and free self-consciousness would provide contemporary philosophy
with a new role, the critique of actuality from a materialist perspective.
The fact that Marx assessed Epicurus, as well as the Stoics and Sceptics, as the
prophets of the freedom of self-consciousness, was made irrefutably clear in the
‘Draft of a New Preface’ he wrote to his dissertation in late 1841 and early 1842.
In this ‘New Preface’ Marx affirmed:
Only now the time has come in which the systems of the Epicureans, Stoics and
Sceptics can be understood. They are the philosophers of self-consciousness.34
If according to Hegel [see Gesamtausgabe, Vol. 14, p. 492] the Epicurean philoso-
phy of nature deserves no great praise when judged by the criterion of objective
120 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
gain, from the other point of view, according to which historical phenomena do
not stand in need of such praise, the frank, truly philosophical consistency with
which the whole range of inconsistencies of his principle in itself is expounded,
is admirable. The Greeks will forever remain our teachers by virtue of this mag-
nificent objective naiveté, which makes everything shine, as it were, naked in
the pure light of its nature, however dim that light may be.36
No statement by Marx exists indicating his reason for choosing Democritus and
Epicurus as the pillars of his dissertation. Due to the lack of positive evidence
it is impossible to assert with certainty why Marx decided to focus upon Greek
materialism and therefore only an inference is possible. I maintain that Feuerbach
played a significant role in Marx’s decision to concentrate on Greek atomism.
The bibliography to Marx’s dissertation lists two works by Feuerbach, Geschichte
der neuern Philosophie von Bacon von Verulam bis Benedict Spinoza and ‘Vorläufige
Theses zur Reform der Philosophie’.37 Even though it was written approximately
five years after the dissertation, ‘The Leipzig Council’ contains important clues
regarding the reasons for Marx’s 1839–1841 interest in Greek atomism. In ‘The
Leipzig Council’ Marx wrote: ‘Philosophy was opposed to metaphysics as Feuerbach,
in his first decisive attack on Hegel, opposed sober philosophy to drunken specula-
tion.’38 When Marx referred to Feuerbach’s ‘first decisive attack on Hegel’ he was
alluding to ‘Vorläufige Theses zur Reform der Philosophie’, as well as ‘Grundsätze der
Philosophie der Zukunft’, two works he singles out in the ‘Critique of the Hegelian
Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, the last essay in ‘The Manuscripts’.39 In
‘Vorläufige Theses zur Reform der Philosophie’, Feuerbach attacks Hegel’s Speculative
philosophy as a form of theology and seeks to replace Hegel’s ‘logical pantheism’
with materialism.
In addition, Marx learned from Feuerbach’s Geschichte der neuern Philosophie
von Bacon von Verulam bis Benedict Spinoza that Feuerbachian materialism, which
Marx admired, found its ancient origins in Democritus and Epicurus. In The
Holy Family Marx wrote: ‘Metaphysics of the seventeenth century, represented
in France by Descartes, had materialism as its antagonist from its very birth. It
personally opposed Descartes in Gassendi; the restorer of Epicurean materialism.
French and English materialism was always closely related to Democritus and
Epicurus.’40
Clearly, the Marx of 1841 was not the Marx of the 1844 The Holy Family
and the 1845–1846 ‘The Leipzig Council’. The Marx of 1844–1846 approached
Hegel from an entirely different vantage point than the Marx of 1841. But
these statements of the 1844–1846 period, I surmise, establish the reasons that
Marx’s attention was turned toward Greek atomism and materialism in general.
Influenced by Feuerbach and having read Gassendi, who is listed in the disserta-
tion bibliography, Marx decided to study the origins of Western materialism in
Greek antiquity. I do not say that in 1841 Marx reached the sophisticated level
of understanding of materialism he displayed in the works 1844–1846. I do say
that in 1841 his curiosity was stimulated, and under the influence of Feuerbach
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 121
Marx’s dissertation was a mission statement regarding his place within the
Hegelian Center. The dissertation was a prolegomena regarding his role within the
philosophical trajectory of Hegelian philosophy. In the ‘Notebooks on Epicurean
Philosophy’, research notes that Marx took as he prepared to write his disserta-
tion, he made this unequivocal assertion:
Marx’s self-proclaimed purpose was the liberation of nature ‘from the shackles
of servile faith’, and the metaphysics of Idealism. Marx wished to return the
Hegelian Center and contemporary philosophy in general to an Ionian position,
that nature must be studied as an existence independent of mind. The Scientific
Revolution had abrogated the theological pre-emption of nature that occurred
during the Middle Ages and the Hegelian Center must release nature from the
secrecy of the metaphysical and thereby resurrect antique materialism. When
Marx studies Epicurus and Democritus he was engaged in a project to win the
independence of nature from Speculative philosophy. Greek atomism would
liberate the contemporary world from the mysticism of Idealism.
However, the independence of nature from thought did not mean that nature
had meaning in-itself. Only thought was determinate. Separation and determina-
tion concerned two different processes. Separation related only to the external,
while determination related to form. Nature was both external to thought, yet
it was determined, given a shape, by thought. Only thought was the force, the
potentiality, that imparted form on that which lay outside of thought.
Marx’s materialist methodology was in absolute accord with the Hegelian para-
digm. The Absolute Idea in Hegel could only result from the harmonization of
thought and actuality. The methodological principles that Marx designed for the
study of nature were in perfect agreement with the Hegelian paradigm. Marx’s
venture into materialism was a reaffirmation of the Hegelian Center.
Epicurus was the instrument Marx used to resurrect antique materialism. But
this rebirth took place within the Hegelian protocol of unifying thought and the
exoteric.
In order to make Marx’s Hegelian interpretation of Epicurus transparent it is first
necessary to outline some of the essentials of Epicurean atomism and this involves
differentiating between Democritus and Epicurus. In Volume I of The History
of Philosophy Hegel claimed that Leucippus was the founder of atomic theory44
and that ‘Democritus perfected what the former began’.45 Indeed, Democritus is
reduced to a secondary status on The History of Philosophy. Conversely, in Marx’s
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 123
was the Bauer of the Greco-Roman world, prior to Bauer’s exit from the Hegelian
Center.
Marx’s juxtaposition of Democitus and Epicurus offered him the opportunity
to distinguish between dogmatism and positivism on the one hand and free
self-consciousness on the other. The Democritean philosophy of nature should
be excluded from theoretical employment because it was limited to sense percep-
tion. It remained frozen at the level of the empirical. The Epicurean philosophy
of nature should become the standard of theoretical use because it was grounded
in the freedom of self-consciousness. For Epicurus thought was not a mirror of
nature, but an active force for the determination of nature.
The assessment that Marx made of Democritus and Epicurus differed from
Hegel’s evaluation. The History of Philosophy situated Democritus and Epicurus
in the same philosophic school as they were both instances of dogmatism and
positivism. Like Marx, Hegel did recognize that Epicurus originated the idea of
the declination of the atoms,46 but this perception did not prevent Hegel conclud-
ing that Democritus and Epicurus were fundamentally alike because they both
regarded sensory stimulation as the ultimate initiator of ideas.
In order to fully explicate Marx’s adherence to the philosophic principles of the
Hegelian Center I will divide my discussion of Marx’s dissertation into the fol-
lowing subdivisions: 1) Marx and The Science of Logic; 2) Hegel and Marx and the
historiography of philosophy; 3) Marx and the historiography of critique; 4) Marx
and the defense of Hegel; 5) Marx’s first evaluation of the political.
used the concepts of real possibility and abstract possibility. Although Hegel dis-
cusses possibility in the Small Logic he does not include the difference between
real and abstract possibility. The only book in which Hegel expounds upon real
and abstract possibility is The Science of Logic, the Greater Logic. Since the ideas
of real and abstract possibility only appear in the Greater Logic and since Marx
utilizes both of these ideas I conclude that Marx was acquainted with The Science
of Logic.
Before investigating the concepts of real and abstract possibility and necessity
I will begin my discussion of Marx’s indebtedness to The Science of Logic with refer-
ence to the categories of concept and existence. In the dissertation Marx needed
to explain how Epicurus progressed from the concept of atom to the real existence
of the atom, The concept of the atom was a product of theoretical mind because
in antiquity the atom was not seen, but rationally surmised. The concept of the
atom in-itself had no qualities, but the concept evolved into existence and in this
transition from concept to existence the concept acquired properties. These prop-
erties did not exist in the original concept and therefore a contradiction existed
between concept and existence. Contradiction was a term for delimitation, or the
moment of distinguishing, or exposing the separation between the properties of
concept and the qualified existent.
The development from the unqualified concept to the qualified existent passed
through appearance. Epicurus assigned the properties of size, shape and weight
to the atom and these properties were attributes of appearance. Before existence
received its being it must first transit appearance, or must become qualified in-
itself. Existence was the negation of concept, because it negated the property
concept.
The atom was ‘pure-being-for-self’.47 It was the absolute singularity, the uni-
versal particularity. In order for the atom to come into existence as ‘pure-being-
for-self’ the logical category of repulsion was required. Repulsion, the negation
of attraction, was a force that multiplied oneness. In order for there to be many
it was first necessary to have the one and repulsion isolated singularities so that
the one could appear. Repulsion was the power of differentiation, of isolating one
singularity from another, and this was the precondition of individuality.
Interestingly, atomism played an important role in both Hegel’s The Science of
Logic and the Smaller Logic. Hegel understood Greek atomism as supplying the
empirical justification of the concept of the one and this concept of the one was
a necessary presupposition for the concept of the many and the whole arena of
quantity and measurement. In The Science of Logic and the Smaller Logic Hegel dis-
cusses the one in ‘The Doctrine of Being’.48 and in the Small Logic in paragraphs
96 and 97.49 The concept of the one is important for Hegel not only as a necessary
step to the creation of measurement, of repulsion and attraction, but also as a pre-
condition for the establishment of the Self. The concept of the one is the founda-
tion of the idea of ‘Being-for Self’.50 Without an awareness of a one there would
be no logical foundation for a Self. Atomism thus helped the establishment of the
Hegelian notion of Self as well as the Epicurean notion of self-consciousness, or
the entire discourse of subjectivity.
126 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The contradiction between existence and essence, between matter and form,
which is inherent in the concept of the atom, emerges in the individual atom
itself once it is endowed with qualities. Through the quality the atom is alien-
ated from its concept, but at the same time is perfected in its construction. It
is from repulsion and the ensuing conglomeration of the qualified atoms that
the world of appearance now emerges.
In this transition from the world of essence to the world of appearance the con-
tradiction in the concept of the atom clearly reaches its highest realization. For
the atom is conceptually the absolute, essential form of nature. This absolute
form has now been degraded to absolute matter, to the formless substrate of
the world of appearance.51
In this quote Marx describes the genesis of appearance. These two paragraphs are
a summary of the doctrine of appearance as it is presented in The Science of Logic,
another proof of Marx’s deep reading of Hegel’s treatise. Book Two of The Science of
Logic, ‘The Doctrine of Essence’, describes the evolution from Essence to Actuality,
and the mid-point of this progression is appearance. Section Two of Book Two is
entitled ‘Appearance’. A synonym for appearance is reality, or the external. Reality
does not in itself possess an inner, an implicit, but it shows, it shines, it makes
itself visible to the senses.
In his analysis of appearance Hegel gives an account of how appearance makes
itself known to the senses. Appearance displays itself because it takes on qualities,
or properties. Examples of qualities are size, weight and shape and these qualities
are visibilities, or they can be apprehended by the five human senses.
In the two paragraphs quoted above Marx accounts for the appearance of a con-
glomeration of atoms. This creation of appearance takes the following steps; an
atom is first an unqualified concept; but this concept in its transition to appear-
ance will take on qualities and in so doing becomes matter; the concept becom-
ing matter is an instance of the alienation of concept and matter because matter
can never fully clone the concept; the process of appearance is then a moment
of contradiction for it illustrates the divergence between concept and appearance.
Since a synonym for appearance is existence these two paragraphs also testify to
the opposition between concept and existence.
This description of the origination of appearance is a restatement of Chapter
One of Section Two of Book Two of The Science of Logic.52 The Small Logic does
contain two paragraphs, Paragraphs 131 and 132, which do discuss appearance,
but make no mention of the ideas of quality and property.53 Therefore, the only
source which located the interconnection between appearance, property, quality,
matter, was The Science of Logic.
In order to document beyond dispute Marx’s incorporation of numerous epis-
temological modalities of Hegel I will analyze Marx’s discussion of chance and
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 127
necessity in Democritus and Epicurus, but to make this distinction clear it is first
required to delve into the meaning of possibility and necessity. Marx enters upon
this discussion in section three of his dissertation.54
Marx asserts that in order to arrive at necessity it is first required to postulate
possibility and he then divides possibility into two parts, real possibility and
abstract possibility. Real possibility has boundaries, it is limited. Concerned with
objects, real possibility is conditioned. Conversely, abstract possibility resides in
the mind, in imagination and has no constraints, is infinite. Abstract possibility
exists in the subject and is unrestrained by any conditionality.
Relative necessity is associated with real possibility, or relative necessity is the
actualization of real possibility. Relative necessity is the achievement of what is
latent in real possibility. Just as real possibility is limited so also is relative neces-
sity confined inside borders. However, abstract possibility is horizon, it allows for
alternatives. Abstract possibility is not confined by boundaries, but enjoys the
possibility of multiple outcomes.
Epicurus believed in abstract possibility and thus favored chance. In his physics
Epicurus accounted for the congealing of the atoms in terms of chance. On the
other hand, Democritus believed in relative necessity and accounted for the
conglomeration of atoms in terms of necessity. Relative necessity was the condi-
tioned, the limited and therefore the amalgamation of atoms was best explained
by the restriction of outcomes.
Marx’s discussion of possibility and necessity in his dissertation is a restatement
of Hegel’s methodology in Section Three of Book Two, ‘The Doctrine of Essence’
in The Science of Logic. Section Three is entitled ‘Actuality’ and is the culmination
of the movement of Essence. Thought advanced by Essence through ‘appearance’
to ‘Actuality’. Chapter Two of Section Three contains a full discussion of possibil-
ity and necessity. For Hegel ‘Actuality’ was the union of the inner and outer, the
implicit and explicit, and since it contained an in-itself it contained necessity. Hegel
wrote: ‘What is actual is possible’,55 and he meant that since actuality possessed an
essence, a self-determination, it was activated by absolute necessity. Essence must
be realized, must become an actuality, and absolute necessity was that inherent
that fulfilled the development of essence into actuality. Absolute necessity was the
determination of telos. Without absolute necessity the telos would be aborted.
Marx’s discussion of the atomic physics of Democritus and Epicurus was a copy
of Hegel’s arguments in the ‘Actuality’ chapter, Chapter Two of Section Three in
The Science of Logic.56 In the Smaller Logic, paragraphs 142 and 143 are devoted
to a short analysis of actuality, possibility and necessity, but there is no mention
in either paragraphs 142 or 143 of the concepts of real and abstract possibility
and relative or absolute necessity. Therefore, Marx could only come across Hegel’s
discussion through a reading of The Science of Logic.
The preceding paragraphs outlined a partial lexicon of Hegelian logical catego-
ries used by Marx in his dissertation. This partial listing of Hegelian epistemologi-
cal modalities included; negation, contradiction, concept, existence, appearance,
being, alienation, property, essence, realization, form, quality, real and abstract
possibility and relative and absolute necessity.
128 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
atom, even though it was impossible for him to see an atom. Marx combined all
these, the schism between the concept and the concrete with the Epicurean exer-
cise of free self-consciousness, and thereby confirmed Bauer’s ideal of critique.
For Marx history progressed not by the Speculative unfolding of consciousness,
but rather by the application of the free self-consciousness of critique. Political
reform, according to Marx, was dependent on the syllabus of critique. Such a syl-
labus validated the program of political reform of the Hegelian Left. Philosophy
always stood in opposition to reality and this duality was the essential dialectic
of history.59
Marx describes the origins of critique as a specific determination of philosophy.
Critique emerges out of the duality, the splitting, the historical destiny of any
philosophical system. One wing of a system relates itself to the existent, intermin-
gles with reality, while a second wing remains encased in the implicit, the esoteric.
The wing that penetrates into the existent is the practical wing, while the wing
that chooses to maintain its inner-directed vision represents the theoretical wing
of philosophy.
Critique evolves out of the practical wing. The practical wing is caught in the
paradox of essence and existence. The practical energy seeks to make the existent
conform to the concept, to transform the existent into a close approximation
of the concept. This can never be done and in the attempt of transformation
critique is contaminated by reality. When it enters the world critique is polluted
by the world. In spite of this impurity the reform of the existent, the bringing
of the existent into closer conformity with the concept, is the achievement of
critique.
Philosophic Liberals are the adherents of critique because Liberals seek to change
reality. German Liberals are the party of reform because when they seek to make
the existent accord with essence they necessarily embrace change. If the exist-
ent is to conform to the essence the existent must be transformed. Philosophic
positivists, those who restrict themselves to theory, refuse to relate theory to the
practical, are conservatives, or conservatives are philosophic positivists because
they do not confront reality.
Marx identified Hegel with the German Liberal camp. Marx applied a Bauerian
interpretation of Hegel, and used the Bauerian idea of critique as a measure for
defining the philosophic endeavor. Nevertheless, the fact that Marx assumed that
it was possible to graft Hegel and Bauer to each other illustrated that Marx saw the
‘Parmenides of Berlin’ as a member of the Hegelian Center.
Although Hegel himself did not practice critique his philosophy possessed those
instruments that led to critique. The philosophical presuppositions of Hegelianism
contributed to the generation of the transformative power of critique and there-
fore Hegel was a member of the Center as well as being-in-himself a German
Liberal. The idea that a wing of philosophy could turn itself against the world was
Hegelian and so Hegel not only prepared the way for Bauer, but also for German
Liberal reformism. The dissertation was the first occasion in which Marx used the
duality of theory and practice. Early in his career Marx was involved in the contro-
versy over theory and practice and it is clear that he favored the practical side.
132 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Additionally, the paragraphs quoted above from Marx’s dissertation are filled
with a Hegelian vocabulary. Marx employed such Hegelian terms as ‘immanent
determination’, ‘self-consciousness’, ‘totality’, ‘appearance’, ‘essence-existence’ and
‘realization’. Marx could not explain his definition of critique without using this
lexicon and this illustrates both Marx’s dependence on and perpetuation of Hegelian
ideas. The fact that Hegel originated these ideas, the whole theme of the concept
reconstructing the existent, proves that Hegel in-himself laid the basis of Liberal
Hegelianism.
‘accommodation’ was not carried out on any intellectual grounds, but rather
revealed a weakness in Hegel’s moral stature since Hegel’s alleged movement to
the Right was purely executed on the basis of his own self-interest and vanity.
Marx rebuked those who vilified Hegel for their hypocrisy, disloyalty and
narrow-mindedness. In his view they were deceitful because they forgot that in
the immediate past they were students of Hegel and were passionate supporters of
his philosophy. They moved precipitously from being apostles of Hegel’s philoso-
phy to indictors of Hegel’s morality.
Marx referred to Hegel as ‘The Master’ and in using this phrase alluded to the
former loyalty pupils exercised toward Hegel. Marx decried the fact that the for-
mer loyalists of Hegel now admonished ‘The Master’, but Marx condemned the
admonitions as an ‘un-philosophical trend’, in other words not worthy of serious
consideration. Marx himself chose to remain an adherent of Hegel.
Marx also felt that these new opponents were also too subjective, that their cri-
ticisms of Hegel did not conform to sound philosophical principles. A criticism
must be objective, must relate to the internal principles of a philosophic dis-
course, but recent opponents of Hegel eschewed the objective and relied only
upon their personal judgments. Without any substantial basis to their arguments
these enemies of Hegel merely revealed their opinions as ‘mere ignorance’ or
superficiality.
In his defense of Hegel, Marx charged these who impugned Hegel as shallow. For
example, these prosecutors compared Hegel to Socrates and in drawing this anal-
ogy attempted to show that just as Socrates was guilty of subverting the Athenians’
gods so Hegel was guilty of undermining the Prussian Crown. To some critics he
was an ‘accommodationist’, while to others he subverted the legitimacy of the
Prussian Crown. Regarding the Socratic parallel Marx wrote: ‘It is self-evident how
stupid was the comparison drawn in recent times between the relation of Hegelian
philosophy to the life and case of Socrates, from which the justification for con-
demning the Hegelian philosophy was deduced.’62
His dissertation must be assessed as an indicator of the contending forces that
caused the disintegration of Hegelianism. Marx offered two reasons for the disappear-
ance of a totalizing philosophic System, historical and immanent development.
Viewed from the temporal perspective, history offers many illustrations of the
disintegration of a total philosophical system. The greatness of Plato and Aristotle
was followed by the decline of Roman thought. Marx’s dissertation was an exam-
ple of the fragmentation that follows as a total system declines. The appearance of
Epicureanism, Stoicism and Scepticism were the individual systems that splintered
off from Platonic and Aristotelian universality.
Previous paragraphs described Marx’s analysis of the immanent development of
a philosophic system, the internal dualism between the exoteric and esoteric. His
dissertation also contains passages in which Marx describes the immanent devel-
opment of philosophers in themselves, and these persons also suffer from an inter-
nal dualism, or ‘these individual self-consciousnesses always carry a double-edged
knife, one edge turned against the world and the other against philosophy in
itself’. Like the duality of a total philosophic system the subjective consciousness
134 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
In Heft I of his exzerpte, ‘Epikur an Herodit’, to his dissertation Marx copied the
following two quotes from Epicurus:
2) For all forms of life which have not concluded a contract preventing a
person from either inflicting harm or suffering harm there is neither Right
nor Injustice.64
Four years later Marx confirmed that he read these political statements of Epicurus
as a precursor to social contract theory. In ‘The Leipzig Council’ Marx acknowledged
that he read Epicurus as a thousand-year-old antecedent to Rousseau when Marx
wrote: ‘. . . it is sufficient to mention that the idea that a state rests on the mutual
agreement of people, on a contrat social, is found for the first time on Epicurus.’65
Epicurus may have introduced Rousseau and contract theory to Marx, but
not to the question of ethicality and the state. In terms of the second context
the Marx of 1841 and of 1843 completely overlooked the significance ethicality
played in Hegelian political philosophy. Neither in the 1841 ‘Notebooks on
Epicurean Philosophy’ nor in the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’
does Marx ever allude to the ethical nature of the state in Hegel. Marx ignored
the pre-eminent role ethics played in Hegel’s concept of the state. Additionally,
a difference existed between how Marx dealt with Hegel’s ‘Idea-as-Subject’ formula
in his 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ and his 1841 ‘Notebooks on
Epicurean Philosophy’. Marx’s denunciation of Hegel’s philosophy of state in 1843
devolved directly from his complete refutation of the formula of ‘Ideas-as-Subject’
and therefore ‘State-as-Predicate’, while in 1841 the modality of ‘Idea-as-Subject’
played no role. In 1841 Marx remained true to the Hegelian concept of substance,
but in 1843 he abandoned this logic.
In Volume II of The History of Philosophy Hegel refers to the state as a ‘moral
organism’.66 In previous paragraphs I documented that Marx read The History of
Philosophy because his dissertation was a revision of both that work in general and
in particular of Hegel’s evaluation of Epicurus.
Ethicality was the product of intersubjectivity, or ethicality could not arise
before the existence of sociability. Civil society was a precondition of ethicality,
because ethicality only developed from the mutual recognition of distinct individ-
ualities. Hegel passionately denounced the theory of natural rights, Rousseau in
particular, because of its radical individualism and its contract theory of the state.
Ethicality, for Hegel, was not the product of individual conscience, but rather the
recognition of a multitude in civil society that required intersubjective respect.
Ethicality then progressed into substance and substance was the unity of univer-
sality conscience, the common presuppositions that gave rise to a culture. Substance
was that universal conviction that created unity between individuals, or an inher-
ent belief that transcended the particular and engendered a social collectivity.
136 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Substance was a product of the evolution of Spirit as it traversed its three stages,
Subjective Spirit, Objective Spirit and Absolute Spirit. Substance belonged to the
stage of the Objective Spirit, the level at which Spirit organized civil society and
the state. Objective Spirit advanced beyond Subjective Spirit because Subjective
Spirit concerned only the atomistic behavior of the subjectivity. A conflict existed
between the evolutionary stages in the teleology of Spirit, between atomism and
substance. Whereas the subject was the atom, substance was the communitarian.
Whereas the subject valued the particular over the collectivity, substance pre-
sumed the superiority of a political association over the isolated and self-absorbed
subject obeying his own will.
The greatness of Hellenic culture derived from the Greek discovery of subjectiv-
ity. Whereas the Oriental World never recognized subjectivity because of its total
immersion in metaphysics, the Hellenic world, beginning with their art and reli-
gion, was able to discover the freedom of the subject. Hegel maintained the Seven
Sages, of which Solon was one, proclaimed the discovery of subjectivity, even
though Greek subjectivity had not won its independence from nature.67
In The History of Philosophy Hegel depicts the typology of the ‘wise man’ as the
inauguration of radical subjectivity in Greece. Initially articulated by the Sophists,
the social model of the ‘wise man’ extolled the search for private tranquility, the
escape from any source of disquiet. This search for psychological repose entailed
the withdrawal of the person from the affairs of the polis. Tranquility was the
antipode to the zoon politikon of the polis. The ‘wise man’ consequently retreated
from substance. The state was substance and when the ‘wise man’ withdrew from
substance he surrendered any engagement in the affairs of state and, therefore, all
involvement in the ethical life of the community. The charge that Hegel brought
against the ‘wise man’ of the Sophists he also enlarged to include the ‘wise man’
of the Sceptics and Epicureans.68
The clash between subjectivity and substance received its classical formulation
in Hegel’s portrayal of Socrates. Hegel agreed with the Athenian court that con-
demned Socrates. Since the Athenian court represented the substance of the polis,
when Hegel expressed his agreement with the court he defended the sovereignty
of substance over the claims of self-centered subjectivity.
The History of Philosophy recognizes the genius of Socrates. In preparing the way
for Plato and Aristotle, Socrates laid the foundation for the Golden Age of Greece.
In his dialogic method Socrates also introduced one element of dialectic thought.
The dialogues of Plato portray Socrates as employing negation and opposition and
therefore Socrates was the first to use contradiction as a dialectical tool.
But Socrates also exemplified radical self-consciousness. He carried the right of
subjectivity to an extreme and this challenged the substantive principles of the
Greek polis. The tragedy of Socrates illustrated the clash between a consciousness
that was responsible only to the Self and the trans-individual nature of substance.
A consciousness only responsive to the ‘I’ was singularly corrosive to the univer-
sality of substance. The ‘I’ of Socrates abrogated the socio-political duty of the zoon
politikon. In this jurisdiction the Athenian court had no choice but to find Socrates
guilty of subverting the young because the court had to uphold the priority of
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 137
substance over subjectivity. The decline of Greece after the trial of Socrates proved
that the court acted correctly.69 For Hegel it was justifiable that the substance of
the state took precedence over the atomism of self-conscious subjectivity that led
only to self-seeking and the pursuit of private interests over general well-being.
In dealing with the antithesis between substance and subjectivity, Marx, con-
trary to Hegel but true to Bauer, defended the priority of subjectivity. In his disser-
tation Marx was an acolyte of Socrates, and recognized Socrates as the apotheosis
of self-consciousness. In the debate over Socrates, Marx abandoned Hegel and
embraced Bauer, or Marx judged Socrates as an ancestor of Bauer.
Interestingly, in his dissertation Marx does not directly address the Hegelian
Idea of the state as ethical substance. Marx read The History of Philosophy, The
Philosophy of History and The Philosophy of Right and in all these texts Hegel defines,
at length, ethicality as the substance of the state. In 1841 Marx does not discuss
this issue. In 1843 Marx nullifies Hegel’s philosophy of state on the grounds that
it was a predicate of the Idea rather than deal with the issue of ethicality.
This omission is particularly surprising because in the 1841 dissertation Marx
has a footnote that references paragraph 552 in the Encyclopedia of the Philosoph-
ical Sciences and this paragraph in located in Volume Three, or The Philosophy of
Mind.70 This paragraph occurs in a subdivision of the book entitled ‘The Moral
Life or Social Ethics’ and paragraph 552 describes the evolution of the Athenian
zoon politikon, clearly stipulating that the state was in its substance an ethical
association.71 In spite of the fact that Marx was cognizant of the Hegelian Idea of
the state as an ethical organism, by 1841 he ignores this issue in his dissertation
and in 1843 he rejects Hegel’s political theory for entirely different reasons.
But Marx is pro-Socratic. He views Socrates as a precursor to Bauer, or he sees
Socrates as an exponent of subjective self-consciousness. Socrates becomes a wedge
between Marx and Hegel, for whereas Hegel refuted Socrates’ defense of self-
consciousness, Marx applauds Socrates’ espousal of free subjectivity. Marx drew a
line of continuity between Socrates and Epicurus and saw them both as exponents
of free self-consciousness.
The fact that Marx declared his loyalty to free self-consciousness does not mean
he rejected the Spinoza–Hegel ideas of substance. In Marx substance underwent
a transmutation, but this metamorphosis did not occur until the 1844 ‘The
Manuscripts’. In these manuscripts subjectivity was defined as labor, and labor
was taken as the source of substance. Marx retained the Hegelian form of sub-
stance, but he changed its content. Substance still existed, but substance was now
labor, or labor was that emanation which formed the cohesiveness of reality.
Free self-consciousness was the launching pad for the critique of reality. Marx’s
self-definition placed him as an inheritor of the Socratic–Epicurean traditions.
Whereas Hegel saw these traditions as in decline, Marx saw them as rejuvenating
the philosophy of the time.
Marx’s adherence to the Socratic–Epicurean–Bauerian tradition of critical
self-consciousness lasted from 1841 until February 1844 when he published his
‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’. In this 1844 work Marx
moves from critical self-consciousness to the class consciousness of the proletariat.
138 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
As I indicated earlier, by 1844, in his ‘On the Jewish Question’, Marx detached
himself from Bauer. This does not mean that Marx surrendered the idea of cri-
tique, but he did surrender the idea of subjective self-consciousness. Marx kept
the instrument of critique, but he changed the agent from subjectivity to the
proletarian class.
. . . and the modern rational outlook on nature must first raise itself to the point
from which the ancient Ionian philosophy, in principle at least, begins . . . the
point of seeing the divine, The Idea, embodied in nature.73
This was the exact same sentiment that Marx expressed in his 1837 letter when
he wrote that that he was ‘seeking the Idea in reality itself ’.
In terms of the vantage point of reason Marx agreed with Hegel that nature or
materialism could only be fathomed according to the architecture of thought.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Two 139
and out of this reconciliation an individuality emerges. Hegel applied the ‘Smaller
Logic’ to nature and the tripartite division of Idea into universality, particularity
and individuality is mirrored in nature as mechanics, physics and organics.
I am not claiming here that Marx converted to Hegel’s Idealistic syllogistic
interpretation of nature. I employ Marx’s ‘Plan of Hegel’s Philosophy of Nature’
to establish Marx’s awareness of the organizing capacity of thought. When Marx
wrote that he looked for ‘Idea’ in reality he asserted his conviction that empiri-
cism was incapable of supplying meaning. What is central to my argument is
Marx’s commitment to the principle that thought endowed the external world
with comprehensibility. Reason was the methodology for rendering the external
comprehensible.
I maintain that Hegel himself was the founder of the Hegelian Center. Gans and
Michelet were the legitimate heirs of Hegel; the Hegelian essence was most closely
approximated by Gans and Michelet. Obviously, there were differences between
Hegel and these two epigones, but the message of Hegel was best replicated in the
language of Gans and Michelet.
142 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Zeitung Marx, for the most part, did not defend Hegel himself, as this could be a
provocation to the Prussian censor, but Marx did advocate the same policies Hegel
advanced. Marx championed the causes of free speech, free press, separation of
Church and State, the right to divorce and emancipation of the Jews, and these
were all policies supported by Hegel in The Philosophy of Right. Within the con-
text of the reactionary policies of the Hohenzollern Throne and the Evangelical
Church the justification of Hegelian policies was also a justification of Hegel him-
self and of the Hegelian Center. This stance formed the core of Marx’s journalism
in the Rheinische Zeitung.
Cologne was the center of Rhineland Liberalism and the Rheinische Zeitung
was the mouthpiece of this Rhineland Liberal business class. Fearful of the out-
reach of the Prussian reaction the owners of the newspaper needed the paper to
espouse moderate Liberal positions. Marx was brought to the paper to preserve
its centrist position. The owners, as well as Marx, feared that an extreme Liberal
posture would bring about the repression of the paper and thus the survival of
the newspaper was contingent upon its moderation. Indeed, on February 10, 1842
Marx wrote a letter to Ruge requesting that an article he submitted to the Deutsche
Jahrbücher not carry his name, his authorship not be made public.2
In addition to the politico-philosophical circumstances surrounding the
Cologne newspaper Marx’s approach was also conditioned by two other factors:
his 1841 reading of Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right and his relationship to Ruge.
The Mega2 contains an extremely important document relating to Marx’s
knowledge of The Philosophy of Right. Division IV, Subdivision I (Mega2 IV/1)
contains an exzerpte Marx copied in 1841.3 This exzerpte consists of, among other
references, a few brief comments Marx wrote, condensations of his impressions,
of The Philosophy of Right. I will not evaluate this exzerpte here because the content
is more appropriate to the later portions of this book.
However, I make reference at this point to this exzerpte for two reasons: first,
it establishes that by 1841 Marx was already conducting an in-depth reading of
Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right; second, by 1842–1843 Marx was writing journal-
ism on Hegelian politics for the Rheinische Zeitung and therefore these exzerpte
comments are important clues concerning Marx’s evaluation of both Hegelian
politics and Hegelian political philosophy. In his brief impressions Marx described
The Philosophy of Right as a form of ‘logical mysticism’, and as displaying a ‘mysti-
cal manner of expression’.4 Marx felt that in Hegel’s philosophy of politics ‘The
Idea was subject’ and ‘The real Subjects were reduced to mere names’.5 Marx’s
evaluation of Hegel’s political philosophy in 1841 was exactly the same as his
1843 assessment in the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ when he called
Hegel’s political philosophy a ‘logical pantheism’.
In order to understand Marx’s relation to The Philosophy of Right it is necessary
to draw a distinction between Hegel’s politics and Hegel’s political philosophy.
Hegelian politics concerned the theory of the state and during his involvement
with the Rheinische Zeitung Marx concurred with Hegel’s theory of the state.
Marx rejected Hegelian political philosophy because he saw it as an expression of
Speculative philosophy. For Hegel the Idea was the ultimate source of predication
144 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
and the external was mere names. Marx did apply philosophy, or reason, to
politics, but not Idealism. Both Hegel and Marx were German Liberals and both
upheld the principles of a constitutional monarchy. During the Rheinische Zeitung
period Marx and Hegel agreed on the politics of the state, but not the philosophy
of politics.
Marx’s appropriation of Hegel’s theory of the state is affirmed in an insightful
article by Andrew Chitty, ‘The Basis of the State in Marx in 1842’.6 Chitty correctly
recognized that Marx agreed with Hegel’s theory of the state throughout most of
his Rheinische Zeitung journalism. Chitty wrote: ‘Thus, echoing Hegel almost to
the word, Marx can say that law “is right because it is the positive existence of
freedom”.’7 Later in the same essay Chitty reaffirmed his belief in the continuity
between Hegel and Marx, writing: ‘So far it looks as if Marx’s conception of the
essence of the state in 1842 in close to Hegel’s.’8 Chitty’s opinion is in accord
with the interpretation put forth earlier by Michael Löwy in his book The Theory
of Revolution in the Young Marx.9
Reiterating Hegel, Marx in 1842–1843 viewed politics and the theory of the
state as branches of philosophy. In paragraph 258 of The Philosophy of Right Hegel
wrote:
To fully grasp the relationship between Marx and Hegel regarding the intercon-
nection between the state and philosophy it is necessary to divide this issue into
three parts: politics, political philosophy and philosophy-in-itself.
Both Marx and Hegel assumed politics to be a synonym for the state. Politics
meant the institutional structures of the state. From the vantage point of Germany
Marx and Hegel were in complete accord and both were German Liberals and both
sought to reform Germany in the direction of a constitutional monarchy with a
representative parliament. During Marx’s tenure at the Rheinische Zeitung he was
a defender of Hegelian politics.
Marx repudiated Hegelian political philosophy. For Hegel political philosophy
was the study of how Idea predicated reality. As a Speculative philosopher Hegel
maintained that the Idea was subject, that the external were merely a projection
of the Idea. Marx rejected both Hegelian Speculative philosophy and his political
philosophy and did not think the state as creation of the Idea. Marx’s negation of
Speculative philosophy was already accomplished in his dissertation because his
adoption of Bauerian critique was simultaneously a nullification of Speculative
philosophy.
However, Marx’s rebuttal of Speculative philosophy was not a refutation of
philosophy-in-itself. Marx never denounced philosophy-in-itself and he did apply
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 145
philosophy-in-itself to the state, but never claimed that the Idea was either the
substance, or the essence, of the state. In his journalism Marx looked upon the
state as rational, as the institutionalization of rational principles, but this is vastly
different than proposing that the state was solely a determination of the Idea.
For Marx applying reason to the state meant designing a political organism that
resulted in the self-determination of its inhabitants. Depending upon the histori-
cal circumstances of the time, adjusting to the political conditions of the epoch,
the application of philosophy to the state meant creating an organization in
which every branch functioned to realize the will and rights of its citizens. Marx’s
demolition of Hegel’s Speculative philosophy did not mean that he additionally
repudiated Hegelian methodology. The last pages of this Phase will itemize the
exact categories of Hegelian methodology that Marx perpetuated.
Hegel’s paragraph 258 in The Philosophy of Right quoted above defended the
state as founded in reason and as a universality. When Hegel applied the concept
of universality to the state he conceived of the state as an organism, as a total-
ity, unified under a common principle. Marx concurred with Hegel’s theory of
rationality and universality and in 1842–1843 Marx approached the state from
the perspective of these two philosophic prerequisites.
Marx’s Liberal Hegelianism was also visible in his 1842–1843 correspondence
with Ruge. This correspondence is indispensible to an understanding of the
development of the Young Marx and Ruge’s own journalism. In this regard Marx’s
March 5, 1842 letter to Ruge is pivotal.
First, the letter contains the following sentence: ‘Another article which I also
intend for the Deutsche Jahrbücher is a criticism of Hegelian natural law . . .’11
Marx’s assimilation of Bauerian critique played an enormous role in his philo-
sophical maturation and it is impossible to correctly understand the March 5,
1842 letter to Ruge without summarizing Marx’s movement toward critique.
Therefore, in the following paragraphs I will briefly chart the early evolution of
critique in Marx’s thought.
Marx began writing for the Cologne newspaper in January 1842 after he was
denied a teaching position at a Prussian university. His March 5, 1842 letter to
Ruge was written in anger at the Prussian repression and did express Marx’s wish
to write a ‘critique of Hegelian natural rights’.12 In August, 1842 Marx wrote to
Dagobert Oppenheim about a ‘criticism’ he planned to write about Hegel’s poli-
tics.13 Three months after writing this letter to Oppenheim, after he was made
editor of the Rheinische Zeitung, Marx published an article, ‘A Contribution to the
Debate over the Divorce Law’ in the November 15, 1842 issue of the newspaper.
Marx appended the following subtitle to this article, ‘Critique of a Critique’.14
The subtitle used in this article was an echo of the subtitle he appended to his
1845 The Holy Family which read ‘Critique of Critical Critique’. Marx’s use of the
formula of critique was perfected in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’
which he wrote between March and October 1843, while he lived with his in-laws
in Kreuznach. In terms of Marx’s adoption of critique a line of continuity runs
through this period from the dissertation to the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy
of Right’, and it was only in this essay that Marx declared his independence from
146 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
both Hegelian politics and the definition of the state. Critique became an indis-
pensible instrument in Marx’s definition of philosophy, allowing him to embark
upon his own search for a politics and theory of the state, allowing him to over-
throw the discipline of political economy as practiced by Smith, Ricardo and Jean-
Baptiste Say, and establish his own method of social explanation.
Second, the March 5, 1842 letter to Ruge contains additional sentences to the
one I quoted above that are crucial to an understanding of the evolution of the
Hegel–Marx relationship. It is necessary to quote them in full because of their
importance. After I quote them I analyze them one sentence at a time.
Another article which I also intended for the Deutsche Jahrbücher is a criticism
of Hegelian natural law, insofar as it concerns the internal political system.
(1) The central point is the struggle against constitutional monarchy as a
hybrid which from beginning to end contradicts and abolishes itself. (2) Res
publica is quite untranslatable into German. (3)15
Sentence (1) states that Marx’s criticism of Hegel relates only to the ‘internal
political system’. Marx does not intend to criticize constitutional monarchy in-
itself, but only the internal system.
Sentence (2) asserts the battle against constitutional monarchy is fruitless as
such a confrontation only ‘contradicts and abolishes itself’. It is best not to wage
warfare against the monarchy in-itself.
Sentence (3) is not a demand for a German republic, or the overthrow of monar-
chy. It is rather a declaration that Prussia is not ready for a republic, or that Prussian
socio-political conditions will not support a republican form of government.
These three sentences disavow any republican intentions on the part of Marx.
They affirm his awareness that constitutional monarchy is the appropriate form
of government for Prussia and any criticism of the Hohenzollern regime should
be directed at its internal affairs and not at the philosophical foundations of mon-
archy in-itself. Marx’s position was in complete compliance with Hegel and the
Hegelian Center and is emblematic of Marx’s adherence to the Hegelian Center.
Additional proof that Marx thought Hegel a constitutional monarchist is found
in Marx’s August 25, 1842 letter to Oppenheim. In that letter Marx wrote that
he planned to ‘give this criticism, as a supplement to my article against Hegel’s
theory of constitutional monarchy’,16 which was the article Marx failed to write
for Ruge or for the Rheinische Zeitung. His criticism finally made its appearance
in the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’. The sentence quoted above
proves that Marx regarded Hegel as a constitutional monarchist. Furthermore, the
criticisms Marx mentioned related only to the internal constitution of the mon-
archy, as he stated in his March 5, 1842 letter to Ruge, and not to the theoretic
validation of monarchy in-itself.
This point is made abundantly clear in the last letter Marx wrote to Ruge on
March 13, 1843, just four days before he announced his resignation from the
Rheinische Zeitung. In his letter to Ruge, Marx disclaimed any desire to return to
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 147
the Rheinische Zeitung, but asserts that the fight against the internal policies of the
Hohenzollern Throne must continue. Marx wrote: ‘The theory is to make as many
breaches as possible in the Christian state and to smuggle in as much as we can
of what is rational.’17
This sentence does not ask for the overthrow of constitutional monarchy. It
does not call out for the creation of a republic.
Rather it is a strategy of German Liberal reform within a constitutional monar-
chy. Marx does not call for a revolution against Frederick Wilhelm IV, but rather
for ‘breaches’, or small reformist steps within the framework of a constitutional
monarchy. Furthermore, the ‘breaches’ brought forth by the tactics of Liberal
reform must be ‘rational’, and here again Marx shows his congruence with Hegel.
In March 1843 Marx still adhered to the Hegelian principle that philosophy pro-
vided the rationality of the state.
Another example of Marx willingly assuming the role of advocate of Hegel
and the Hegelian Center relates to Ruge’s significant series of articles, ‘Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right and the Politics of Our Time’. These articles were published
in June 1842 while Marx wrote for the Rheinische Zeitung, but before he became
editor. Although Marx at no time acknowledged reading Ruge’s long essay I think
it certain he did. ‘Hegel’s Philosophy of Right and the Politics of Our Time’ was
widely discussed in its time and was a defining document of Left Hegelianism.
Ruge published this article in the Deutsche Jahrbücher and Marx kept abreast of this
publication. Indeed, Marx himself submitted his own articles to this Ruge journal
and Ruge himself wrote a condensation of Engels’ long pamphlet ‘Schelling and
Revelation’ and published this summary in the Deutsche Jahrbücher in May 1842.18
Ruge and Marx kept up an active correspondence and ultimately joined each
other in exile in Paris in late 1843 and through their collaboration one issue of
the Deutsch-Franszösische Jahrbücher appeared. It is reasonable to assume that all
these contacts provided Marx with the interest and opportunity to read ‘Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right and the Politics of Our Time’.
Ruge’s attack on Hegel concentrated upon the metaphysics of Hegelian political
theory. Hegel did not see state forms as historical products, according to Ruge, but
rather as the relation between Idea and reality. For Hegel the substance of the state
was the Idea and for Ruge this turned The Philosophy of Right into a logical exercise.
Hegel’s state was detached from historical determination.19
The result of Hegel’s Speculative cooption of political theory was the elimi-
nation of the possibility of practical political reform. If the state was a logical
projection of the Idea, change in the state could only result from philosophical
transformations. Ruge maintained that philosophic speculations must be replaced
by political practice because it was only through the actual engagement of sub-
jects in political activity that political change occurred.20
The formula Ruge bequeathed to Left Hegelianism was the unification of cri-
tique and practice. Critique was aimed not at metaphysics, not Kant, but at reality,
and critique revealed the defects of a political system. After critique uncovered the
political malignancies in a society, practice endeavored to change them.
148 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Ruge’s paradigm for Left Hegelianism was known to Marx by the summer of 1842.
However, in his journalism and editorship of the Rheinische Zeitung he ignored it.
Rather than incorporate the reformist instruments of critique and practice into his
journalism, Marx continued to present the Prussian state as a determination of rea-
son. But Marx did declare his independence from Hegelian political philosophy.
What Marx failed to do during his tenure at the Cologne newspaper he suc-
ceeded in accomplishing in the summer of 1843 when he wrote his ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’. This essay marks Marx’s departure from the Hegelian
tradition of theorizing the state from the perspective of Speculative philosophy.
Marx no longer viewed the state as a determination of metaphysics, but as a deter-
mination of the social.
Marx embraced Ruge’s program for Left Hegelianism. It must be pointed out the
‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ did not espouse Ruge’s theory of practice
and Marx’s adoption of the theory of practice needed to wait until the Fall/Winter
of 1843 when Marx wrote ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’.
By the summer of 1843 Marx fulfilled the program outlined by Ruge and divorced
himself from Hegel’s Speculative philosophical theory of the state. Marx’s ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ reiterated the thesis of Ruge’s ‘Hegel’s Philosophy of
Right and the Politics of Our Time’ that Hegel’s theory of the state was a branch
of metaphysics.
Not only did Marx continue the Hegelian tradition of the rational state during
his association with the Rheinische Zeitung, but also Hegel’s method of social expla-
nation. While Marx disposed of Hegel’s political philosophy of the state in 1843
his adherence and utilization of Hegelian methodology continued throughout
his life. In order to substantiate these assertions I will divide the following discus-
sion into six subdivisions: I) Defender of Hegel; II) Marx as a Hegelian Centrist:
Politics; III) Marx as a Hegelian Centrist: Philosophy; IV) Characteristics of the
state; V) ‘The Philosophical Manifesto of the Historical School of Law’; VI) The
political unity of Marx and Hegel.
I) Defender of Hegel
In the articles he published during the Rheinische Zeitung period Marx never criti-
cized Hegel; rather, Marx’s writings contained only praise for Hegel. ‘The Leading
Article in No. 179 of the Kölnische Zeitung’, a series of editorials appearing in
the Rheinische Zeitung from July 10 to July 14, 1842, is an extremely important
statement of Marx’s views. Among other opinions expressed in these editorials
are statements of praise Marx made about Hegel, specifically the German Liberal
desire of ‘The Master’ for the separation of politics and religion.21
Marx saw Hegel as a representative of the Enlightenment, as a descendent of
Strauss, as a participant of the movement to divorce the religious from political
science. The laws of the state should be deduced from ‘reason‘ and ‘experience’
and not from theology. Furthermore, the picture of Hegel presented in this quote
is of a man of the Center and of neither the Hegelian Right nor the theological
Restorationist Right. Rather, Hegel belonged to the rationalist Enlightenment tra-
dition and this was the position of the Hegelian Center.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 149
Marx reiterated his defense of Hegel in his February 12, 1843 article ‘Marginal
Notes to the Accusations of the Ministerial Rescript’. A long quote is in order:
First of all, it is said that there prevailed in the Rheinische Zeitung ‘the unmistak-
able intention to attack the basis of the state constitution’. It is well known,
however, that there unmistakably prevails a great diversity of opinion on the
Prussian constitution and its basis. Some deny that the basis has any constitu-
tion, others that the constitution has any basis.
One view is held by Stein, Hardenberg, Schön, another one by Rochow,
Arnim and Eichhorn. Hegel in his day believed that he had laid the basis for
the Prussian constitution in his philosophy of law, and the government and
the German public concurred in this belief. One way by which the government
proved this was the official dissemination of his writings; the public, however,
did so by accusing him of being the philosopher of the Prussian state, as one
read in the old Leipzig conversational dictionary. What was believed at that
time, Stahl believes today. In 1831, by a special order of the government Hegel
lectured on the philosophy of law.
In 1830, the Staats-Zeitung declared that Prussia was a monarchy surrounded
by republican institutions. Today it says Prussia is a monarchy surrounded by
Christian institutions.
Far from intending to attack the basis of the Prussian constitution, therefore,
the ‘Rh. Z. on the contrary was convinced that it was attacking only deviations
from this basis.’22
3) By 1840 the theoretical basis of the Prussian constitution changed and by the
time of Frederick Wilhelm IV it was a ‘monarchy surrounded by Christian institu-
tions’ and Friedrich Julius Stahl was its leading tribune. In the years between 1830
and 1840 Prussia fell victim to a religious reaction.
general contained in his article ‘Communism and the Augsburg Allgemeine Zeitung’
of October 15, 1842. Marx’s attitude toward Hess was ambiguous, for, on the one
hand, he ridiculed him in 1842 and on the other hand in his 1844 ‘Preface’ to
‘The Manuscripts’ he praised the essays by Hess published in Georg Herwegh’s
Einundzwansig Bogen aus dem Schweiz.29 Rutenberg, a member of the editorial staff
under Marx, took inappropriate political stands and in order to comply with the
Prussian censor Marx terminated his employment. Rutenberg, who demonstrated
a ‘complete lack of critical sense’, created an impression that the Rheinische Zeitung
was a mouthpiece for the ‘Berlin Free’, a position which drew the ire of the Prussian
censor; in order to maintain the Rheinische Zeitung in the Center of the political
debate, Marx fired Rutenberg.30
In addition to disavowing any connection to the communist-socialist Left, Marx
also refused to have any contact with Meyen of the ‘Berlin Free’. On November
29, 1842 he published a short paragraph in the Rheinische Zeitung satirizing the
‘rowdiness’ of the ‘Free’.31 And one day later, on November 30, 1842 he mailed a
letter to Ruge admonishing ‘The Free’ for their defective reasoning and their inap-
propriate ‘sans-culotte-like’ exhibitionism.32
By rejecting both the Hegelian Right and the Restorationist Right, and the com-
munist-socialist and anarchist Left represented by ‘The Free’, Marx positioned
himself as the voice of the Hegelian Center – a moderate constitutional monar-
chist position. Marx’s refutation of the communist-socialist and anarchist Left of
‘The Free’ did not mean that Marx was not a Young Hegelian. According to Marx
the Young Hegelians were different to the communist-socialist Left and ‘The Free’
and it was possible to be both a Young Hegelian and a member of the Hegelian
Center. Within the political context of Prussia in 1842 the Hegelian Center was
Liberal and the word Liberal meant the acceptance of constitutional monarchy
with the desire to increase the domain of individual rights and freedom of expres-
sion. German Liberalism in 1842 did not call for the overthrow of the monarchy,
but a specific form of German Liberalism existed, the Hegelian Center, and Marx
saw the role of the Rheinische Zeitung as advancing the cause of a non-revolution-
ary reformist German Liberalism. In a letter he authored, but which bears the title
‘Renard’s Letter to Oberpräsident von Schaper’, Marx wrote:
For that very reason, however, I must reject the reproach leveled at me in the
rescript that the RH.Z. has sought to spread French sympathies and ideas in
the Rhineland. The RH.Z. has, on the contrary, made its main task to direct
towards Germany the glances which so many people still fastened on France,
and to evoke a German instead of a French Liberalism, which can surely not be
disagreeable to the government of Frederick Wilhelm IV.33
Since every true philosophy is the intellectual quintessence of its time, the time
must come when philosophy not only internally by its content, but also exter-
nally through its form, comes into contact and interacts with the real world of its
day. Philosophy then ceases to be a particular system in relation to other particu-
lar systems, it becomes philosophy in general in relation to the world, it becomes
the philosophy of the contemporary world. The extinct forms which confirm that
philosophy has attained this significance, that it is the living soul of culture, that
philosophy has become philosophical, has been the same in all ages.36
The constitution of the state is, in the first place, the organization of the state
and the self-related process of its organic life, a process whereby it differentiates
its moments within itself and develops them to self-subsistence.39
In two articles, ‘The Supplement to No. 335 and 336 of the Augsburg Allgemeine
Zeitung on the Commission of the Estates in Prussia’ and in the ‘Leading Article in
No. 179 of the Kölnische Zeitung’, Marx continued this Hegelian definition. In his
newspaper articles he defined ‘the state as the great organism’,40 and that the distinc-
tions of the estates ‘are dissolved at every moment in the unity of the whole’41 and
that ‘the real organic life of the state should not be suddenly abandoned’ in local
particularities.42 In 1841–1843 Marx stood in total agreement with Hegel regarding
the universality of the state and like Hegel he applied an organic image to the state
as a whole, a universal, which subsumed parts, particularities, into the totality.
The Hegel methodology of universal–particular exercised singular importance
in the development of Marx’s theory of the state. In his 1843 essay ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ Marx arrived at his own theory of the state on the
basis of the universal–particular logical apparatus. The difference between 1842
and 1843 was that in 1842 Marx, imitating Hegel, still accepted the existence
of the particular, the estates, but in 1843 Marx jettisoned the role of the estates
and embraced only the idea of the universal. In 1843 the state became solely the
universal, and the only means to attain the universal was through democracy, or
universal suffrage.
wrote the ‘Introduction’ to two books of Hegel published in the first Collected
Works, The Philosophy of Right and The Philosophy of History. In his ‘Introduction’
to The Philosophy of Right, Gans defended the Hegelian interpretation of law. For
Gans, law was the Idea of right as it unfolded in history; the content of law was
always the rational. Gans served as the transmission belt between Hegel and Marx
and the theory of rational right flowed out of Hegel through Gans to Marx.
Marx’s advocacy of the Hegel–Gans school of the philosophy of law and the
state is initially expressed in Marx’s rejection of natural law theory. In ‘The
Philosophical Manifesto of the Historical School of Law’ Marx rejected the 18th-
century tradition of natural law and natural rights, and even though in this essay
Marx does not mention Rousseau by name it is clear his attacks on ‘the other
Enlighteners of the eighteenth century’43 includes Rousseau as an example of
incorrect political theory.
Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right also rejected Rousseau and the natural law tradi-
tion. In addition in paragraph 258 Hegel wrote of ‘the false theories, mentioned
above, emanating principally from Rousseau’.44 Although Hegel felt Rousseau was
correct to ground his theory of law and the state on the basis of individual will,
Hegel censured Rousseau because the French philosopher never advanced beyond
individual will to will in its universal form as the Idea of will. Rousseau never
stepped beyond a naturalistic exposition of a singular will to a philosophy of will
as universal content.
Hegel and Marx not only agreed in their assessment of Rousseau’s theory of
natural rights, but also in reproaching the politics and critique of Kant. The
‘Philosophical Manifesto of the Historical School of Law’ demonstrated an aware-
ness of the development of critical philosophy from Kant to Hegel. Marx disap-
proved of critical philosophy as exercised by Kant because when ‘we cannot know
what is true we consequently allow the untrue, if it exists at all, to pass as fully
valid’.45 Kant’s critical philosophy was deficient according to Marx because it did
not allow the concept to unify with the object. Marx annulled the critical philoso-
phy of Kant because he had not ‘arrived at the point of seeking the Idea in reality
itself’.46 This phrase, taken from Marx’s 1837 letter to his father, is further verifica-
tion that at the age of nineteen, following Hegel, Marx defined non-congruence
as the awareness that history produces contradiction, that the retrodiction of
thought is a constant sources of negating the past.
Not only did Hegel reject Kant’s version of critique, but he also negated Kant’s
philosophy of law. According to Hegel, Kant’s definition of law was deficient
because it dealt with particulars, because it defined right as mutual adherence to a
universal code of laws. Kant defined right as a non-aggression pact. Hegel in para-
graph 29 of the ‘Introduction’ to The Philosophy of Right distinguished his definition
of right from Kant’s on the basis he began with the universal, the mind as abso-
lute.47 Right was determined by rational necessity, or the necessity of the universal
to incorporate the individual. Indeed, The Philosophy of Right charts the course of
the advancement of the Idea of right to its universal form as absolute right.
Hegel and Marx were also in agreement in 1842–1843 on the definition of
right and for both men right was an expression of reason. Previous paragraphs
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 155
described both Hegel’s and Marx’s repudiation of Savigny’s and Hugo’s Historical
School of Law. Savigny and Hugo defined right as customary practice while Hegel
defined right as an instance of reason.48 Kant defined right as universal moral leg-
islation, but Hegel thought of right as the rational principle of civil society. Marx
agreed with Hegel and I will juxtapose quotes from them in order to illustrate
their absolute concurrence on the philosophy of law during Marx’s Rheinische
Zeitung period.
The first quote is taken from Marx’s ‘The Philosophical Manifesto of the
Historical School of Law’ and is an assault on Savigny’s and Hugo’s positivism as
well as an assertion that reason must be taken as the foundation of right.
The second quote is taken from the 1837 letter to his father evincing Marx’s
conversion to Hegelianism:
The concept is indeed the mediating link between form and content. In a phil-
osophical treatment of law, therefore, the one must arise in the other; indeed,
the form should only be the continuation of the content.50
The subject matter of the philosophical science of right is the Idea of Right,
i.e. the concept of right together with the actualization of that concept.
a) Marx and Hegel agreed that divorce should be legalized. Marx’s advocacy of
divorce was articulated in two articles he wrote for the Rheinische Zeitung, one
entitled ‘The Divorce Bill’, that carried the subheading ‘Criticism of a Criticism’,
and published on November 15, 184252 and the second carrying the same title and
published on December 19, 1842.53 Hegel’s recognition that divorce must be legally
recognized was described in paragraph 176 of his The Philosophy of Right in which
he wrote: ‘There can be no compulsion on people to marry: and on the other hand,
there is no merely legal or positive bond which can hold the parties together once
their dispositions and actions have become hostile and contrary.’54
For Hegel marriage was a primary foundation of ethical life and in The Philosophy
of Right Hegel discusses marriage in the section ‘The Family’ that immediately pre-
cedes the section on ‘Civil Society’.55 Marriage was an initial stage in the develop-
ment of intersubjectivity, of the recognition of otherness, the connectivity between
husband and wife and children.56 For Marx marriage was a ‘moral relationship’.57
Nevertheless, regardless of the ‘ethical’ and ‘moral’ nature of marriage both
Marx and Hegel defended the legality of divorce. Dead relationships should not
be maintained and in this regard Marx and Hegel asserted religion should be
separated from law and politics. They rebuked the religious opposition to divorce
and did so on the ground that religion was not the criteria from which to judge
human social institutions.
Marx and Hegel made philosophy the standard from which to assess the law.
Just as Hegel and Marx looked upon philosophy as supplying the principle of the
state so they looked upon philosophy as offering the principle of law.
In his December 19, 1842 version of the article ‘The Divorce Bill’ Marx wrote:
Hegelian logic was used by Marx to justify the legality of divorce. The relationship
between the concept and the existent was not perfect, the existent was separated
from the concept; therefore since disparity existed between the existent marriage
and the concept of marriage, divorce was philosophically and legally justified,
that is, divorce was the recognition of the lack of commensurability between the
concept and the existent.
In the December 19, 1842 form of the article of ‘The Divorce Bill’ Marx
wrote: ‘. . . that the conditions under which the existence of a moral relationship
no longer corresponds to its essence’.59 Marx used the Hegelian logical modalities
of the contradiction between essence and appearance to establish the law of
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 157
b) Free press
The Rheinische Zeitung, as a Liberal Reformist newspaper in the Rhineland, and Marx
as its Editor, were under constant pressure from the feudal Christian monarchy of
Frederick Wilhelm IV to curtail their calls for modifying the Prussian state. As an
exponent of Hegel’s theory of non-congruence, Marx fought off Prussian repression
by defending the principle of a free press. In three articles, ‘The Ban on the Leipziger
Allgemeine Zeitung’,60 published between January 1 and 16, 1843; ‘Comments on
the Latest Prussian Censorship Instruction’,61 published in Ruge’s Anekdota in 1843;
and ‘Debates on Freedom of the Press’,62 published in the Rheinische Zeitung in May
1842, all are instances of Marx’s Liberalism during this period of his life.
Marx’s championing of a free press was in perfect accord with Hegel’s thought
on this issue. In paragraphs 314 to 320 of The Philosophy of Right Hegel defended
the right of free speech and a free press.63
Hegel’s advocacy of free speech and a free press did not come without some
reservations. As a representative of academic culture Hegel drew attention to the
frequent distortions and simplifications of complex events and debates in the
popular newspapers. He was concerned that the press popularized ideas, offered
opinions rather than facts and in this manner misled public attitudes. Even with
these caveats, Hegel defended the free expression of ideas because it was the major
medium through which public information spread.
Hegel was also aware that the public media could often resort to ‘slander,
abuse and contemptuous caricature’64 of public officials. In these instances Hegel
favored some form of punishment or criminal procedures against the perpetrators
of such outrageous affronts.
Nevertheless, regardless of these qualifications Marx and Hegel spoke in a single
voice regarding freedom of speech and press. Their positions were commensurate
with German Liberalism.
Crown issued an edict emancipating the Jews from all political and legal disabilities.
In his 1820 The Philosophy of Right Hegel asserted that Jews should enjoy complete
‘civil rights’.66 In his article ‘On The Jewish Question’, which was published in the
Deutsch-Französische Jahrbücher in 1844, Marx also advocated the emancipation of
the Jews. The Prussian monarchy ignored Hegel’s protestations and in 1822 revoked
the emancipation decree of 1812 and again excluded Jews from the exercise of full
civil liberties. Hegel’s championing of Jewish emancipation was manifested in his
support of Gans’s struggle to gain a faculty position at the University of Berlin.
Even though Marx’s writings in the Rheinische Zeitung period are free of an
explicit call for a national codification of the law, his editorial ‘Debates on the
Law on Thefts of Wood’ is an implicit call for such codification. In addition to
presenting Marx as a tribune for the impoverished, the essay is also a long tirade
against customary law, the foundation of the German Historical School of Law.
In his long editorial Marx denounces customary law, a product of the Medieval
period, because it was easily exploited by the propertied to increase their profits.
In the editorial Marx distinguished between legal right and customary right and
the language of legal right was not only Hegelian but also a phrase supporting
codification, the establishment of a centralized code of law.
Marx wrote:
The so-called customs of the privileged classes are understood to mean customs
contrary to law . . . When the privileged classes appeal from legal right to their
customary rights, they are demanding instead of the human content of right,
its animal form, which has now lost its reality and become a mere animal
mask.70
In this paragraph Marx drew the antithesis of custom and law and when he drew
this distinction he was contrasting customary law and a national codified law.
Customary law was the tool of the aristocracy, but only a codification was univer-
sal and as such applied to all of the German population equally and only a code
that was equal was law.
As Liberal constitutional monarchists Marx and Hegel, recognizing those aspects
of the French Revolution and Napoleon that were progressive and modernist, the
Code Napoleon, favored the modernization of the German legal codes. Both rec-
ognized feudalism was dead and that a unified national state was the project of
the future and that codification was one part of this historical advance.
Further proof that Marx was a member of the Hegelian Center can be culled
from his writings on the poverty question. Marx’s acquaintance with the prob-
lems of poverty, property and class during his months at the Rheinische Zeitung
was enormously significant for him because they became the pivot of his future
development into the realm of political economy. Marx himself recognized this
and in his 1859 ‘Preface’ to his A Contribution to the Critique of Political Economy he
described this period in these terms:
Even though the episode at the Rheinische Zeitung hinted in the direction of
his later concentration on political economy and social revolution Marx still
remained loyal to the Hegelian Center and this is made abundantly clear if we
study Marx’s positions on the questions of civil society, state, property, class,
proletariat, critique and the philosophy of law. At no time during the Rheinische
Zeitung period did Marx approach these questions from the vantage point of the
socialist or communist Left.
Marx mentions nothing in his journalism from January 1842 to March 1843
about ‘civil society’. The idea of civil society, which was indispensible to his future
theoretical development, is first mentioned in his manuscript ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right’, written between March and August 1843. It was impossible
for Marx to make the transition to communism without activating the concept
of ‘civil society’ as an analytic tool, and the absence of this concept from January
1842 to March 1843 substantiates the claim that Marx stood in the Hegelian
Center during his fourteen months at the Rheinische Zeitung.
Marx mentions nothing regarding the overthrow of the state and his first
mention of the dissolution of the state takes place in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right’. The political change leading to the dissolution of the state
was universal suffrage, or democracy. However, there is a difference between call-
ing for universal suffrage, full democracy, and calling for the abolition of the state
sui generis. In the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ Marx was a democrat
and it is only in ‘On the Jewish Question’, written in late 1843, that he called for
the replacement of the state sui generis by civil society.
In the journalism of the January 1842 to March 1843 period Marx does exten-
sively comment on the role of property in the affairs of state and does enumer-
ate the control that property exerts over the state. Nevertheless, nowhere in
the journalism of January 1842 to March 1843 does he call for the abolition of
private property. Marx’s first direct, unequivocal assertion that private property
must be eradicated occurs in the essay ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right:
Introduction’ which was written between the end of 1843 and the beginning of
1844.72
Marx does use the word ‘class’ during the Rheinische Zeitung days, but the word
class and the word estate are employed interchangeably. Marx did not use class as
a universal sociological term, as a social grouping defining economic stratification
in a capitalist world. He still did not see that capitalism had restructured social
divisions and that the capitalist revolution had totally replaced estates with class.
Nowhere is his Rheinische Zeitung journalism does Marx assert the need to abolish
class, and the first time Marx articulates such a program occurs in his ‘ Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’.73
Although Marx used the word class in his Rheinische Zeitung journalism he does
not use the term ‘proletariat’. The first time he does employ this term was in his
‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’.74
The concept of capitalism never appears in the Rheinische Zeitung period. The
word capital appears in Marx’s ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’,75 but the
generic term, the term describing the existence of a total economic system, does
not appear until his summer 1844 notebook, ‘On James Mill’.76
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 161
Even though Marx does allude to the terms property, class and estate in the
Rheinische Zeitung journalism he remained blind to Hegel’s grasp of political
economy in The Philosophy of Right. Marx focused on the political and state in his
Rheinische Zeitung journalism and completely ignored Hegel’s limited but insight-
ful comments on political economy contained in this book. In paragraph 189
Hegel drew attention to the work of Smith, Ricardo and Say; in paragraph 204
he enters the debate on money, exchange and value, and in paragraph 203 he
discusses the nature of capital. Most importantly, Marx refused to acknowledge
the subsection on ‘Civil Society’ and just one year later this subsection became
the gravitational center of the 1844 ‘The Manuscripts’. Marx’s decision to over-
look Hegelian political economy demonstrates that during the Rheinische Zeitung
period he was totally absorbed by the issues of politics and the state.
Previous paragraphs documented that Marx did employ the term critique in
the journalism of the Rheinische Zeitung and before. But Marx’s use of critique
in the 1842–1843 years did not have the same purpose as the critique employed in
‘The Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’. The critique of the Rheinische Zeitung
journalism was synonymous with censure, or reproach. However, the critique of
the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ was synonymous with overthrow
because this essay was devoted to the demolition of Hegel’s definition of the state,
and when Marx took this step he bade farewell to the Hegelian Center.
Marx could not make the transition to communism without activating the con-
cepts of civil society, proletariat and revolutionary critique. The absence of these
axial concepts during the 14 months from January 1842 to March 1843 substanti-
ates the claim that Marx stood in the Hegelian Center during this time.
Additionally, in his journalism Marx was still loyal to the Hegelian concept of
law. In a series of articles he wrote from October 1842 to November 1842, ‘Debates
on the Law on Thefts of Wood’, Marx wrote:
The customary rights of the aristocracy conflict by their content with the
form of universal law . . . The fact that their content is contrary to the form
of law . . . universality and necessity . . . proves that they are customary
wrongs . . . Right no longer depends on chance, on whether custom is rational
or not, but Custom becomes rational because right is legal . . .77
subjectivity and objectivity and giving its aim an objective instead of a subjective
character . . .’79 Right becomes law when the concept of right is extended to other
external beings.
Intersubjectivity is the presupposition of law because law establishes the guide-
lines by which a community interrelates. Will only relates to the ‘I’, while law
defines the relationship between the ‘I’ and the Other, and this is the universal.
In paragraph 24 Hegel wrote: ‘The will is the universal, because all restriction and
all particular individuality have been absorbed with it.’80
The development from the subjective will to the universality of law is an
example of the rationality of the concept of law. Rationality is also universality, is
also an attempt to unify the subjective and the universal. The inherent capacity
of mind was to seek the union of subject and object, the seeking of this union
was its inherent nature. The fulfillment of inherent nature was the necessity.
Consequently, the rationality of law was at the same time the necessity of law, or
the inner movement of subjective will to its universal form.
Right only becomes law when Subjective Spirit is transformed into Objective
Spirit. Law only appears at the level of objectivity, or civil society. It is only when
the particular Ego must recognize an Other, civil society, that subjectivity rises
to objectivity. The Objective Spirit is the level of mutual recognition, where an
‘I’ and an Other must interrelate. The need to codify this mutuality is the ground
out of which law emerges.
In the Third Part of The Philosophy of Right, the subsection dealing with ‘Civil
Society’, Hegel inserted a subdivision entitled ‘The Administration of Justice’. This
contained paragraph 211: ‘The principle of rightness becomes the law when in
its objective existence, it is posited, i.e. when thinking makes it determinate for
consciousness and makes it known what is right and valid; and in acquiring this
determinate character, the right becomes positive law in general.’81
Hegel’s description of the development of law, its evolution from the subjective
Ego to Objective Spirit, is as an unswerving philosophical process. It proceeds total-
ly in terms of his philosophic definition of universality, rationality and necessity.
Therefore, when Marx appropriated the logical methodology of universality,
rationality and necessity he demonstrated his consonance with Hegel’s theory of
law. The terms by which Marx defined the law in his essay ‘Debates on the Law
on Thefts of Wood’ were all Hegelian philosophical categories and established
that Marx during his Rheinische Zeitung period understood law as an expression of
philosophy. For Marx in 1842 the design of the real was the rational, an explicit
Hegelian position.
In order to further establish Marx’s concordance with Hegel’s philosophy of law
during Marx’s Rheinische Zeitung period, another long quote from Marx’s opinion
piece ‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’ is called for:
If the concept of crime involves that of punishment, the actual crime calls for
a measure of punishment. An actual crime has its limit. The punishment will
therefore have its limit. The punishment will therefore have to be limited in
order to be actual, it must be limited in accordance with a principle of law in
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 163
order to be just . . . Hence the limit of his punishment must be the limit of
his act . . . In the case of property this measure is its value. Whereas personal-
ity, whatever its limits, is always a whole, property always exists only within a
definite limit that is not only determinable but determined, not only measur-
able but measured. Value is the civil mode of existence of property, the logical
expression through which it first becomes socially comprehensible and com-
municable.82
The First Part of Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right is divided into three sections,
Property, Contract and Wrong, and it is in the subsection on Wrong that Hegel
discusses the interrelated issues of crime and punishment. Paragraphs 95 to 103
form the heart of this discussion.
Relating to the question of crimes against people, in paragraph 95 Hegel defined
crime as an infringement of a subjective will. The freedom to actualize the subjec-
tive will Hegel labeled a right. Any act that interferes with the actualization of a
right is a crime. When the subjective will is prevented by an external power from
realizing its own end a crime is committed.
Paragraph 99 analyses the Idea of punishment and asserts the aim of punishment
is not vengeance, or the prevention of crime, but rather the annulment of that act
of crime. The measure of punishment must be limited to the measure of the crime
and only on the basis of commensurability can punishment annul the crime.
In relating to the question of crimes against property Hegel employed the con-
cept of value. In paragraph 77 Hegel defined value as the universal measure – two
objects held in equal proportion. Two objects are equal, both contain the same
amounts of a desirable quality and this equality is the basis of exchange. Value is
the identity of commercial objects.
In crimes involving property, the domain of a mercantile society, in paragraph
101 Hegel proposed that the punishment of the crime must be dispensed in terms
of value. The punishment of a crime invading the right of property or contract
must be equal to the value of the transgressed object.
The passage I quoted from Marx’s ‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’ dis-
cusses the relationship between crime and punishment. Marx agrees with Hegel
that punishment must be commensurate with the crime. The degree of punish-
ment must equate, not exceed, the degree of the crime. On the issue of crimes
against property Marx was in total agreement with Hegel that value became the
standard of punishment. The value exacted as punishment for a crime against
property must be equal to the value lost to the property as a result of the crime.
This was exactly Hegel’s equation for assessing punishment in cases regarding
property. Marx’s commitment to Hegel’s theory of crime and punishment demon-
strates that he was a proponent of Hegel’s philosophy of law during the Rheinische
Zeitung period.
of the Correspondent from the Mosel’ January 15 to 20, 1843. While both articles
related to the issue of poverty each of the articles approached the problem from
a different direction.
In the ‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’83 Marx described how the defini-
tion of theft in the Rhine Provincial Assembly was manipulated by the owners of
private property, in particular the owners of forest lands. In order to reduce their
economic needs poor peasants in the Rhineland area were entering forest areas
claimed by landowners, taking branches fallen to the ground and bringing these
dead branches to their cottages in order to kindle fires and provide warmth for
their families. The landowners, who controlled the Rhine Provincial Assembly,
passed laws defining the taking of dead branches from the ground as theft and
thus a criminal offense. Marx’s article drew a distinction between dead branches
and living trees and argued the legal definition of theft could not be applied to
dead limbs. By extending the definition of theft to dead limbs the landowners
were perverting the law and using it as a protector of their private property.
Defending the needs of the economically deprived peasant, the ‘Debates on the
Law on Thefts of Wood’ was Marx’s first attempt at a class analysis of legal-political
action. On one side stood the owners of property (for whom Marx interchange-
ably used the terms aristocracy, class and estate), and on the other side were the
economically underprivileged. Legal-political power was always a property of the
propertied and Marx showed how the law itself became a weapon in the hands of
private interest; indeed, private interest ruled the administration of justice. The
‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’ represents Marx’s early insights into the
class divisions of society and the control of the state by property.
The ‘Justification of the Correspondent from the Mosel’84 did not address the
issue of law, but rather bureaucratic impotence in the face of economic distress.
Marx shows how the government bureaucracy, the ‘polizei’ in Hegelian language,
were totally incapable of responding to the economic impoverishment of the
Mosel winegrowers. He also demonstrates how the organs of public opinion,
the press, were under the control of the propertied estates. During a period of
economic degradation, when public discourse was necessary so public solutions
to this economic problem could be arrived at through public consent, the gov-
ernment passed laws restricting the powers of a free press. The ‘Justification of
the Correspondent from the Mosel’ was an expression of Marx’s insight into the
interconnections between private property, bureaucracy and ideological manipu-
lation. He gained insight into the division of politics between the economically
downtrodden and the economically empowered.
Nevertheless, in neither the ‘Debates of the Law on Thefts of Wood’ nor in the
‘Justification of the Correspondent from the Mosel’ did Marx call for the abolition
of property.
In terms of economic class the two articles concerned the agrarian populations,
peasants and small winegrowers. Marx was still unacquainted with the proletariat
and so the word does not appear in either of these texts.
These two articles represent the preliminary stages of Marx’s insight into class
struggle, even though he does not use this phrase. His sympathies were with the
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 165
poor and in ‘Justification of the Correspondent from the Mosel’ Marx called upon
the state bureaucracy to come to the aid of the economically disadvantaged.
Either the Christian state corresponds to the concept of the state as the realiza-
tion of rational freedom and then the state only needs to be a rational state in
order to be a Christian state and it suffices to derive the state from the rational
character of human relations, a task which philosophy accomplishes; or the
state of rational freedom cannot be derived from Christianity, and then you
yourself will admit that this deviation is not intended by Christianity, since
it does not want a bad state and a state that is not the realization of rational
freedom is a bad state.85
This paragraph reaffirms Marx’s conviction the state in-itself was the embodiment
of reason, but also pronounces ‘legal, moral and political freedom’ as particular
expressions of reason. In his November 10–11, 1837 letter to his father Marx
wrote: ‘From the idealism which, by the way, I had compared and nourished with
the idealism of Kant and Fichte, I arrived at the point of seeking the Idea in real-
ity itself.’ Five years after Marx wrote these words he continued to see ‘the Idea in
reality itself’. Marx’s political writings in the Rheinische Zeitung were reiterations
of Hegel’s philosophy of state.
An additional Hegelian Idea was implanted in this paragraph, the concept of the
organic. In itself the anatomical formula contained two other methodological prin-
ciples, the logics of universality and the particular. Organisms were universalities in
themselves, they were organizations operating in terms of a single ruling principle.
Like a center of gravity, this single governing principle compelled the particular
parts of the organism to gravitate toward this universality, or the particularities
became expressions of the universal. The methodology of universal–particular, or
whole and parts, was a dominant interpretive device in Hegel. The Mature Marx,
the Marx who studied political economy at the British Museum, referred to social
formations in the Hegelian formula of universality and the particular and it is
impossible to understand Marx’s Method of social analysis without applying these
two explanatory instruments.
In order to validate the interpretation I offered in the preceding paragraphs
I will quote again from Marx’s journalism. This quote is taken from his series of
articles entitled ‘On the Commission of Estates in Prussia’ which were published
between December 10 and 30, 1842.
At the same time, however, one would have to demand of the author that he
should make a more thorough study of nature and rise from the first sensuous
perception of the various elements to a rational perception of the organic life of
nature. Instead of the spectre of a chaotic unity, he would become aware of the
spirit of a living unity. Even the elements do not persist in an inert separation.
They are continually being transformed into one another and this transforming
alone forms the first stage of the physical life of the earth, the meteorological
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 167
process. In the living organism, all trace of the different elements as such have
disappeared. The difference no longer consists in the separate existence of the
various elements, but in the living movement of distinct functions, which are all
inspired by one and the same life, so that the very difference between them does
not exist ready-made prior to this life, but, on the contrary, continually arises out
of this life itself and as continually vanishes within it and becomes paralyzed.88
Marx judged the arguments over the theft of wood using a strictly Hegelian
lexicon. He placed these debates within the Hegelian methodology of universal–
particular, whole-parts, and saw the danger of private property dissolving the uni-
versality. Hegel provided Marx’s insight into social justice and the Hegel standing
for social justice was the Liberal Hegel. The ‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’
was Marx’s application of Liberal Hegelianism to the social question in Prussia.
The final words refer to the ‘free human being’. In another article, ‘Communal
Reform and the Kölnische Zeitung’, Marx alluded to the concept of equality:
. . . the Rheinische Zeitung wants an equal communal system for town and
countryside and even designates their equality expressly in the article quoted
as ‘equality of rights of urban and rural communities.94
When Marx wrote of the ‘free human being’ and ‘equality’ he did not use these
terms in a radical Jacobin democratic sense, or in the communist sense of social egal-
itarianism, but rather in the Liberal constitutional sense of the French Revolution
of 1830. The employment of the term ‘equality’ during the 1842 Rheinische Zeitung
period was not presented in the context of communist social egalitarianism, the
elimination of private property, but rather in the Liberal context of equality before
the law. Marx wanted equality between town and country because he did not want
artificial material privileges providing political advantages to the cities, but wanted
both town and countryside to have a universal standard, or law, applied equally
to these jurisdictions. In the Cologne period equality did not refer to the equaliza-
tion of possession or social status, but rather to constitutional guarantees that laws
would be universal in their application, or that laws would be applied equally to
each individual. The sphere to which Marx related the concept of equality was not
social, not to property, but constitutional and juridical.
In his days in Cologne Marx did not call for revolution, for the overthrow
of monarchy and state, nor for democracy. In fact, Marx was still loyal to the
Prussian Crown, still believed that the political reforms he advocated were achiev-
able within the Hohenzollern dynasty and in the article ‘On the Commission of
the Estates in Prussia’ praised the Prussian Crown because the universalism of the
state was the ‘free creation of the spirit of the Prussian state’.95
Even though Marx had not yet entered his democratic stage, a stage he reached
in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, or his communist stage, a stage
reached in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, the Rheinische
Zeitung period was a precursor to his later critique of the capitalist state. The two
articles from the Cologne days, ‘Communal Reform and the Kölnische Zeitung’96
and ‘On the Commission of the Estates in Prussia97 are preparatory experiments
for his later critique of the capitalist state as an instrument for the socio-political
domination of private property. Specifically, in ‘On the Commission of the Estates
in Prussia’ Marx recognized the interconnection between the social and political
and how the individual control of private property leads to the control of the
state by private property. An insight was dawning in Marx that the political could
become the slave of private property. Still a Liberal Hegelian, Marx was not yet
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 171
ready to subsume the state, the political, into the social; Marx still believed the
political enjoyed an existence outside of private property.
In order to solve this difficulty, therefore, the rulers and the ruled alike are in
of a third element, which would be political without being, hence not based
on bureaucratic premises, an element which would be of a civil nature with-
out being bound up with private interests and their pressing needs. This sup-
plementary element with the head of a citizen of the state and the heart of a
citizen is the free press . . . It alone can make a particular interest a general one,
it alone can make the distressed state of the Mosel region an object of general
attention and general sympathy on the part of the Fatherland, it alone can
mitigate the distress by dividing the feeling of it among All.98
This paragraph encapsulated the vision of the 24-year-old Marx into the com-
ponent parts of a government. Most importantly it expressed Marx’s incipient
insight that the political was one element of government. The political and gov-
ernment were not commensurate, but the political was a detachable component
of government.
In this paragraph Marx distinguished between four ‘elements’ of government.
One ‘element’ was ‘bureaucracy’ and a second ‘element’ was ‘private interest’, but
‘bureaucracy’ and ‘private interest’ were merely parts of a greater whole. The ‘third
element’ was of a ‘civil nature’ and the phrase ‘civil nature’ did not mean ‘civil
society’ but a general social realm distinct from ‘bureaucracy’ and ‘private interest’
and finding expression in a free press. The fourth ‘element’ was the ‘political’, or
the sphere of government in which decisions were concluded.
Marx’s division of the state, or governance, into four spheres testifies to his
adherence to the Hegelian notion of universality. When Marx drew a distinction
between these four spheres of the state he indicated each in-itself was not the
state, that the state could only exist as a whole, as an organic assembly of these
parts. Marx wrote that only the ‘civil’, or free press, could ‘make a particular inter-
est a general one’, and the term general was a synonym for universal, that is, only
when generality prevailed could a true state exist.
Marx wrote the ‘Justification of the Correspondent from the Mosel’ between
January 15 and 20, 1843; he resigned from the Rheinische Zeitung only two months
later on March 17 and he wrote his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ from
May to October, 1843. The ‘Justification of the Correspondent from the Mosel’ is an
anticipation of the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ because it adumbrates
the distinction between the political – state – and governance – the universal.
When Marx isolated four particularities comprising the state, or governance, he
utilized an insight detaching the ‘political’ particularity from the universality of
172 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
governance. The ‘Justification of the Correspondent from the Mosel’ was Marx’s
initial articulation that the ‘political’, the state, was a particularity separate from
the universality of governance. In his 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of
Right’ Marx called for the ‘abolition of the state’, but such a call was not a demand
for the abolition of all governance. Marx could only make this assertion because
he knew that the state, or politics, was only a detachable particularity and to elide
this particularity still left a universality in existence and that universality was
governance based on a democratic suffrage. Marx was not a Jacobin or Babouvist
during the Rheinische Zeitung period, but he acquired the insight that governance
was a conglomerate of particularities and that it was possible to delete one particu-
larity, the political, and still allow for a universality to survive.
Marx’s dissection of the universality of governance into four autonomous ele-
ments was an application of the Hegelian methodology of whole and parts. Marx
did not employ ‘civil society’ because he had not yet advanced to political econo-
my. The journalism of the Cologne period mostly used the term ‘estate’ and very
infrequently ‘class’. The reason Marx preferred the word estate and only sparingly
alluded to class was that he had not yet reached the realization that a new eco-
nomic order had conquered European civilization. This was the task he actualized
in the ‘The Manuscripts’.
During his time in Cologne the infrequent use of the word class signals Marx’s
lack of awareness that an economic revolution was overtaking Europe. He was not
yet cognizant that capitalism, no longer feudalism, was the new social order in
Europe and that ‘civil society’ must now be defined in terms of the capitalist social
formation. Marx’s engagement with political economy started only when he and
his new bride, Jenny, moved to Paris in October 1843 where he entered socialist
circles which served as the stimulus for his reading of List and Mill.
Furthermore, proof that during the Rheinische Zeitung period the anti-feudal
struggle took precedence over the anti-capitalist crusade is found in Marx’s article
‘Commission of the Estates in Prussia’ in which Marx wrote:
What makes the press the most powerful lever for promoting culture and the
intellectual education of the people is precisely the fact that it transforms the
material struggle into an ideological struggle, the struggle of flesh and blood
into struggle of minds, the struggle of need, desire, empiricism into a struggle
of theory, of reason, of form.99
This paragraph, written in December 1842, is extremely interesting for two rea-
sons: it contains Marx’s first use of the word ‘ideological’ and it indicates the
apparati Marx would use to bring about social change.
Marx’s first recourse to the term ‘ideological’ is presented in a distinctly Hegelian
framework. Marx does not employ the term in its 1845 ‘Leipzig Council’ definition
where Marx utilized the term ‘ideology’ in a negative sense, meaning an intellectual
dogma justifying class control. In 1845 ‘ideology’ was a class creed, a falsification
of social reality in the interests of a propertied class. However, in 1842 ‘ideological’
was presented in a positive manner. ‘Ideological’ was a synonym for an intellectual
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 173
interpretation and the 1842 phrase ‘ideological struggle’ meant a debate, a clash of
two conceptual representations. When Marx used the phrase ‘ideological struggle’
he had in mind a Hegelian debate between two opposing philosophical positions.
This December 1843 paragraph also situates ‘material struggle’ in a subordinate
position to ‘theory’ and reason’. The ‘struggle of flesh and blood’ is placed in an
inferior position to ‘theory’ and ‘reason’. In this paragraph Marx prioritizes the
concept of ‘struggle’ but was totally silent over the issues of productive forces and
the mode of production.
In the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ Marx under-
stood that ‘practical activity’ and ‘revolutionary praxis’ were the basic apparati of
social change. In the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’
he also made use of the idea of class, or class became the socio-economic group
activating ‘revolutionary praxis’. A year earlier in his December 1842 article
‘Commission of the Estates in Prussia’ the concepts of ‘revolutionary praxis’ and
‘practical activity’ were totally foreign to Marx. He did not even mention the word
class as an instrument of social transformation.
Changes in society would be necessitated by the ‘struggle of theory, of reason,
of form’. This was a totally Hegelian formula. In this paragraph Marx asserted that
revisions of the social would come after revisions of thought. The modification of
mind was a necessary precondition for the modification of the real. In 1842 Marx
continued to advocate a Hegelian prescription for change. Marx still looked upon
the pneumatic power of the idea as the precondition for the transformation of
social reality. These were the guidelines of the Hegelian Center.
here conforms all the more to nature because up to now the existence of the
poor class itself has been a mere custom of civil society, a custom which has not
found an appropriate place in the conscious organization of the state.101
create objective institutions which model, create, examples of ethical actions which
a personhood can imitate. The spiritual ancestor of Hegel’s political theory was the
Greek polis, Aristotle’s ideal of the ethical unity of the private and the public.
Liberal Hegelianism, in looking upon the state as the embodiment of right, of
morality, recognized the ethical duty of the state to prevent the less fortunate
from becoming economic slaves. Marx’s awareness that the state must act on
behalf of the poor accorded with Hegelian political principles. In 1842 Marx per-
petuated the Liberal Hegelian welfare state.
Moreover, we have never gone outside the terrain proper to a newspaper, but
have touched on dogmas such as church doctrines and conditions in general
only insofar as other newspapers make religion into constitutional law and
transfer it from its own sphere into that of politics. It will even be easy to cover
each of our utterances with the similar and stronger utterances of a Prussian
king, Frederick the Great, and we consider this authority to be one which
Prussian publicists may very well invoke.108
The most important part of this defense is Marx’s allusion to Frederick the Great,
who was the hero of German Liberal Monarchism. Marx’s close friend, Köppen,
wrote a biography of Frederick the Great and presented Frederick as the epitome
of a Liberal Monarchist. Marx was influenced by Köppen’s book and Marx’s dis-
sertation was dedicated to Köppen. Marx obviously shared Köppen’s admiration
of Frederick and when Marx noted in the above paragraph the adherence of
the Rheinische Zeitung to the political principles of Frederick, Marx enunciated
his loyalty to the theory of German Liberalism. In 1842 Marx hoped Frederick
176 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
would act as the archetype of monarchical rule. Marx did not seek an overthrow
of monarchy, but rather set forth an Enlightenment model of monarchical gov-
ernment. In the second document, ‘Marginal Notes to Accusations of Ministerial
Rescript’,109 Marx listed ten political issues on which the Rheinische Zeitung sup-
ported the governance of Frederick Wilhelm IV. Rather than seeking to undermine
the Hohenzollern dynasty, Marx catalogued the areas of support he extended to
the Hohenzollern dynasty.
In addition, Marx drew a distinction between North German Prussian Liberalism
and South German Liberalism.110 South German Liberalism tilted more to French
culture and politics, and it was anathema to Prussia because it followed the exam-
ple of French Liberalism, which still supported the anti-monarchical sentiments
of the Revolution of 1830. Marx in 1842 looked upon French and South German
Liberalism as potential threats to the government of Frederick Wilhelm IV.
Not only was Marx’s attack on South German Liberalism a defense of North
German Liberal Monarchy, but it was simultaneously an exoneration of Hegel.
The intellectual spokespersons of South German Liberalism were Karl von Rotteck
and Karl Theodor Welcker, who published the Staats-Lexicon, an annual dictionary
of political theory. Rotteck and Welcker castigated Hegel as a Prussian conserva-
tive, and as an apologist for Frederick Wilhelm IV, and this view flowed into the
work of Haym. For example, in The Philosophy of Right Hegel defended ‘Notrecht’,
or the ‘right of need’. As I indicated previously, Hegel defended the right of private
property, but in the case of extreme need, a case in which a person faced starva-
tion and death, Hegel judged it that person’s right to steal from another’s private
property as a life-preserving action. Notrecht was a means of preserving will, or
selfhood, over the claims of possession. Rotteck, a Liberal South German, upheld
the sanctity and inviolability of private property and rejected Hegel’s principle of
Notrecht.111 Marx denounced Rotteck and Welcker ‘s attack on Hegel and Marx’s
refutation of Rotteck and Welcker was a definitive statement of his own pro-
Hegelianism. Marx continued to play guardian to Hegel as late as 1870 and in a
letter to Engels in that year Marx vilified ‘the old Rotteck-Welcker dreck’ which
sought to blemish Hegel as a lackey of the Prussian dynasty. From Marx’s 1841
dissertation until 1870 Marx played the role of Swiss guard to Hegel.112
In ‘Renard’s Letter to Oberpräsident von Schaper’ Marx stated:
The Rh. Ztg. Has, on the contrary, made its main task to direct towards Germany
the glances which so many people still fastened on France, and to evoke a
German instead of a French liberalism, which can surely not be disagreeable to
the government of Frederick Wilhelm IV.113
Marx’s political self-definition in 1842 was directly in line with Hegel’s form
of German Liberalism. Marx’s German Liberalism of 1842 recapitulated Hegel’s
German Liberalism as set forth in The Philosophy of Right. Part IV of The Philosophy
of History is entitled ‘The German World’ and the last chapter of ‘The German
World’ is called ‘The Éclaircissement and Revolution’ and in this chapter Hegel
presents his views regarding Frederick the Great and German Liberalism. Among
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 177
their other areas of agreement, Hegel and Marx were in absolute accord on three
vital issues: Frederick the Great, French Liberalism and German Liberalism.
Hegel was an admirer of Frederick the Great. In The Philosophy of History Hegel
stated: ‘Frederick II merits special notice as having comprehended the general
object of the State, and as having been the first sovereign who kept the general
interest of the State steadily in view, ceasing to pay any respect to particular inter-
ests when they stood in the way of the common weal.’114
French Liberalism was a political expression of French national culture. Hegel
lived through the French Revolution and Napoleon and was aware that the
French, English and German cultures were properties of unique national spirits.
France was a part of the Catholic World, and the French Revolution was a defining
moment in the Gallic nation’s understanding of Freedom. French Liberalism exag-
gerated the autonomy of the individual will and, for Hegel, radical subjectivity
was always a cause of decay. French Liberalism provided proof of this instability
because even after the Napoleonic Wars it did not create a stable government, and
this was demonstrated in the Revolution of 1830.115
The product of a predominantly Protestant country, German nationality dif-
fered from that of the Catholic World of France, Spain and Italy. While avoiding
the radical subjectivity of French Liberalism German Liberalism did guarantee the
right of private property and personal freedom. German Liberalism widened the
accessibility of state employment to citizens. The government bureaucracy enjoyed
areas of autonomy, but the monarch constituted its apex. One of the major dif-
ferences between French and German Liberalism concerned the powers of the
Throne, and whereas the French sought to strip its monarchy of any decision-
making role, German Liberalism regarded the ‘personal decision of the monarch’
as the ultimate will of the state.116 According to Hegel, the Monarch embodied the
Will of the State. It was the center providing cohesiveness and universality to the
parts. German Liberalism retained the Monarch as a decision-making volition.117
Marx and Hegel were in agreement over the issues of Frederick the Great,
French Liberalism and German Liberalism. When Marx wrote that he espoused
German Liberalism he declared his adherence to the principles of North German
Liberalism as also espoused by Hegel.
7) Methodology
A central task of Marx’s Discourse with Hegel is to delineate the areas of continuity
and discontinuity between the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ and Marx. In the area of
Continuity the methodological apparati Marx appropriated from Hegel are vital.
The explanatory procedures Marx employed to analyze social formations are
derived from Hegelian methodology. These methodological categories Marx used
in his analysis in Das Kapital were already activated by Marx in his dissertation
and in his journalism for the Rheinische Zeitung. These methodologies were largely
derived from the ‘Book of Essence’ in Hegel’s The Science of Logic. Later sections in
Marx’s Discourse with Hegel will discuss in greater detail how these Hegelian meth-
odological categories determined Marx’s philosophy of social explanation, so at
this point I will only briefly enumerate the methodological categories present in
178 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
the Cologne days. The attempt here is to establish the line of continuity because if
it can be shown that Marx utilized Hegelian methodological categories both in his
dissertation and the Cologne journalism then the argument that these categories
were also present in the 1867 Das Kapital receives confirmation.
For the sake of clarity and emphasis I will single out the Hegelian methodologi-
cal categories used by Marx in the Rheinische Zeitung: a) Organic image; b) Whole–
parts; c) Universal–particular; d) Genus–species; e) Form–content; f) Essence;
g) Essence–existence; h) Determination; i) Contradiction;) In-Itself
a) Organic image
In his article, ‘On the Commission of the Estates in Prussia’, Marx wrote: ‘we
demand that the real organic life of the state should not be suddenly aban-
doned.’118 Replicating Hegel, Marx learned to view social formations as organic
units, that is, Marx borrowed Hegel’s holistic program of explanation. Both Hegel
and Marx understood explanation to mean approaching an object of study as a
totality of whole and parts.
b) Whole–parts
In his article ‘On the Commission of the Estates in Prussia’ Marx wrote: ‘the
particular in its isolated activity is always the enemy of the whole.’119 In Marx’s
holistic methodology the supplement to the organic image was the division of the
totality into whole and parts, that is, parts were seen as particularities that were
functions of the whole.
c) Universal–particular
In his article, ‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’,120 Marx repeatedly con-
trasts the particular interests of the landowners against the universal interests
of the peasants. Every totality possessed a universality, or end, shaping that
totality.
d) Genus–species
In his article, ‘Debates on Freedom of the Press’ Marx wrote: ‘the courts are all
species of one and the same genus.’121 The genus-species category continued the
principle of universality, but it was used as a form of classification. The methodol-
ogy of universal–particular, whole–parts, were categories defining the qualitative,
whereas genus–species defined kind, or classification. Capitalism was a genus, but
there were various species of capitalism, for example, agrarian or industrial.
e) Form–content
In his article, ‘In Connection with the Article “Failures of the Liberal Opposition
in Hanover”’, Marx applied the form–content methodology. Marx wrote: ‘As
regards its form, it is said the opposition is not liberal . . . As regards the content,
it further contended that the content of the opposition . . . is not the content of
freedom.’122 The analytic code of form refers to a configuration, while content
refers to the dynamics of that configuration. A configuration was a shape, while
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Three 179
the content was a power of predication. A form could be a legislature, while the
content could be the power of the legislature to make law. It was possible to
change the form but to retain the content. For example, a legislature could be
abolished and its function of making law transferred to a different embodiment.
f) Essence
In the article, ‘The Divorce Bill’, Marx wrote: ‘They have criticized not its
essence . . .’123 Essence was the implicit, the in-itself as a form. Essence was the end
or purpose toward which a form aspired.
g) Essence–existence
In ‘The Divorce Bill’ Marx wrote: ‘the existence of a moral relationship no longer
corresponded to its essence.’124 Since essence was end it must externalize itself as
existence. The existent is the external upon which essence inscribes itself.
h) Determination
In ‘The Divorce Bill’ Marx wrote: ‘and therefore puts determination from above
in place of self-determination.’125 Determination was the practical application
of essence. Essence was the purpose of the subject and determination was the
achievement of that purpose.
i) Contradiction
In his article, ‘Debates on the Law on Thefts of Wood’, Marx wrote: ‘But it is
not concerned about contradictions, for it never comes into contradiction with
itself.’126 Contradiction was a means to establish self-identity. The establishment
of self-identity meant that an Other was a limit to a subject, an ‘Other’ must
establish a barrier to a subject and in so doing a subject acquires a limit and an
identity.
j) In-Itself
In ‘The Divorce Bill’ Marx wrote: ‘Hegel says: In-Itself according to the concept,
marriage is indissoluble, but only in-itself.’127 The in-itself is the implicit, the
immanent. The in-itself is a synonym for essence.
180 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Marx’s ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ was a revocation of his 1837 let-
ter to his father. In that letter he described his need to find ‘the Idea in reality
itself’, but in his 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ he began his study
of how reality was the constitutive element in thought. It was an inversion that
determined his intellectual enterprise for the remainder of his life.
The years 1843 to 1844 are the borders of Marx’s delinking from Hegel. Prior to
his departure from the Rheinische Zeitung Marx was an exponent of Hegelian poli-
tics and theory of the state, he adhered to the principles of constitutional monar-
chy and was a loyalist of the Hegelian Center. After terminating his employment
with the newspaper the embittered Marx was more receptive to the Hegelian Left,
to Ruge and to Feuerbach, while continuing his commitment to Bauerian critique.
Ruge influenced him in terms of the theory–practice equation and Feuerbach
in terms of the concept of ‘social being’. As his receptivity to the Hegelian Left
advanced Marx divorced himself from the Hegelian Center and in his ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, during an intense study of the French Revolution in
Kreuznach, embraced democracy. But Marx’s adherence to the Hegelian Left was
short-lived and in his 1844 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’
he detached himself from the Hegelian Left and converted to communism and
began to develop interpretative principles that helped him in the maturation of
his theory of social explanation.
The year from 1843 to 1844 was thus a period of successive severances. However,
when I use the term severance I use it in a fashion totally different from the
manner in which Althusser employed ‘epistemological break’. In his two books,
Reading Capital1 and For Marx2 Althusser wrote of an ‘epistemological break’ erupt-
ing between Hegel and Marx in which Marx erased all contact with Hegelian
philosophy. My interpretation of the Hegel–Marx relationship is divided into
two categories, discontinuities and continuities. There were two areas of Hegelian
thought from which Marx delinked himself – discontinuities – basically in the
areas of philosophy and politics, but there were also areas of Hegelian thought
that Marx preserved – continuities – and these fell essentially in the domain of
methodology. Contrary to Althusser, the relationship between Marx and Hegel
was not defined by a surgical amputation, but rather by a perpetuation in the
thought of Marx of specific terrains of Hegelian Speculative philosophy.
The period 1843–1844 was the year of Marx’s passage from Hegelian Centrist
to communism. During this period Marx wrote six essays and several letters,
which I designate as the works of the passage, and these were: ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right’, ‘Letters from the German–French Yearbook’, ‘On The Jewish
Question’, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, ‘On James
Mill’, ‘Critical Notes on the Article “The King of Prussia and Social Reform” by
a Prussian’, and ‘Theses on Feuerbach’. Even though ‘Theses on Feuerbach’ was
written in Brussels in 1845, I include it in the works of the passage because it is
a continuation of the major ideas contained in the earlier five essays and letters
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 181
and because it provides insights into Marx’s early conversion to and definition of
communism.
This Phase, ‘Marx’s Development of Critique and His Delinking from Hegel’ has
two purposes: using the works of the passage as the primary source material to
map the evolution of Marx from the Hegelian Center to communism, and also
to document the Hegelianisms Marx discontinued and the Hegelianisms Marx
continued. I will accomplish both these purposes by employing the categories
of discontinuity and continuity as the perspectives from which to interpret the
works of the passage. However, the fact that Marx changed his position from
Hegelian Centrist to Left Hegelian to democrat to communist does not mean that
Marx modified his positioning of Hegel. Even though Marx traversed these four
philosophical positions from 1841 to 1850 he always located Hegel as belonging
to the Center. Marx underwent relocations, but in his mind Hegel was always
situated in the Center.
A) Discontinuities
I will apply the following categories as a means of isolating the discontinuities
between Marx and Hegel on the works of the passage: 1) State, politics and
democracy; 2) Philosophy; 3) Civil society.
Marx on civil society in greater detail below). The clearest exposition of the
reasons and consequences of the detachment of state/politics from civil society is
found in Marx’s August, 1844 article ‘Critical Notes on the Articles “The King of
Prussia and Social Reform” by a Prussian’.5
Civil society was the totality of a nation, whereas the state and politics were
the minority of a nation. Whether it was due to the monopolization of industry,
land, or military power the state and politics were a minority in a nation. The
state and politics were consequences of the separation between civil society and
the state/politics. If civil society, which was the totality of a nation, was separated
from the state/politics and the state/politics monopolized power, then civil soci-
ety was merely the bondsman of the state/politics, or the rule of a minority over
the vast majority.
Democracy enlarged the power of the majority, but it was not in itself the com-
plete conquest of human liberation. If democracy did not totally empower civil
society then democracy was not the total emancipation of humankind. It was pos-
sible for democracy to exist and at the same time still consent to the existence of
state/politics and this situation would only allow money to be the authoritarian.
When Marx called for the abolition of the state this was not a summons for
anarchy. Marx never called for the abolition of governance; laws were necessary.
The basic problem for Marx was to account for the institutions of governance.
That situation in which civil society became the universal of a nation, the insti-
tutions to make law emerged out of civil society, was governance. Civil society
would provide the governmental structures of society.
Marx’s redefinition of state, politics and governance was an expression of a more
fundamental discontinuity with Hegel, the rejection of Hegelian Speculative phi-
losophy. According to Hegel the state and its political subdivisions were predicates
of the Idea. According to Hegelian Idealism the subject in the universe was the
Idea and the state was merely an objectification of the Idea. Marx rejected Hegel’s
interpretation of the state/politics as manifestations of Speculative philosophy
and this was the central thesis of the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’.
The understanding of Marx’s repudiation of Speculative philosophy clari-
fies a sentence contained in his 1844 ‘Critique of the Hegelian Dialectic and
Philosophy in General’ in which Marx wrote:
This sentence makes two claims. First, that Hegel as a person made no ‘accommo-
dation’ to the Hohenzollern monarchy. As a person Hegel made no ‘accommoda-
tion’ and therefore such an imputation was a ‘lie’. However, the second claim that
Hegel’s ‘principle’ did make an ‘accommodation’ to Prussian authoritarianism was
true. In making this assertion Marx proposed that it was Hegelian philosophy, the
‘principle’, that led to such an ‘accommodation’. By turning the state/politics into
a projection of the Idea Hegelian Speculative philosophy created the foundation
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 183
for the belief that the monarchy was metaphysically justified and that therefore
acceptance of the status quo was proper.
Marx’s claim that philosophy could act as a tool of monarchical conservatism
was given its clearest expression in his essay ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of
Right: Introduction’. This essay demonstrated that philosophy could act as a jus-
tification of reality, as certifying that the existent was rational and therefore due
political loyalty and submissiveness.
2) Philosophy
The discontinuities between Marx and Hegel over the role of philosophy was com-
posed of many categories. I will divide my discussion into the following subdivi-
sions: A) Philosophy; B) Theory and practice; C) Subject–object; D) Form–content;
E) Essence; F) Substance; G) Subjective action.
Marx did divorce himself from the Hegelian purpose of philosophy and
this divorce was performed in the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right:
Introduction’. According to Marx the Germans lived their present in thought, that
is, the purpose of philosophy in Germany was an increased appetite for more phi-
losophy. The negative aspect of this addiction to philosophy was the incapacity of
the Germans to deal with the truth of the historical moment. Since the purpose of
Hegelian philosophy was the harmonization of the Idea and reality, the German
absorption of philosophy incurred a submissiveness to the real. Philosophy was
the opiate of the Germans and the hallucinations caused by this opiate made the
Germans blind to the reality of their oppression.
In the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ Marx did not seek
the abolition of philosophy, but rather the alteration of its goal. In Marx the end
of philosophy was not reconciliation, but rather the exposure of a fracture. The
purpose of philosophy in Marx was the revelation of how philosophy failed reality,
or the disjuncture between reality and human emancipation.
2B) Theory and practice Hegel’s discussion of theoretical and practical reason
begins with paragraph 445 of The Philosophy of Mind. These discussions are both
placed in the section on Psychology, or the last stage of Subjective Spirit.
The placement of theoretical and practical mind in the section on Psychology
itself reveals Hegel’s understanding of these terms. The theoretical and practical
were functions of mind, they were the apparati of mind. Philosophy in Hegel was
the culmination of the Absolute Mind and so the theoretical and practical were the
apparati of psychology, stages enabling mind to finally ascend to philosophy.
Theoretical mind is driven forward by intelligence, and the purpose of intelli-
gence is to form a cognition, or Idea, of the union of subject and object. The stages
of theoretical mind pass through sense perception, or intuition, the formation of
an image, or representation, and finally thought.9 The result of theoretical mind
is the attainment of the power of thought and thought was the presupposition
of a cognition, a knowledge of the finite. Theoretical mind in Hegel was separate
from philosophy and a preparation for philosophy.
Marx’s discussion of theoretical mind bore no resemblance to that of Hegel.
Marx spoke of theory and practice and when Marx used the term theory he meant
interpretation of the finite. Whereas in Hegel the theoretical referred to a capacity
or ability of mind in Marx, the theoretical meant a reading, a rational reflection, of
the finite. Whereas in Hegel theoretical mind was a preparation for philosophy, in
Marx theory was a synonym for a particular manifestation of philosophy, or philos-
ophy whose end was the practical. For Marx theory carried strategic implications.
The delinking of Marx and Hegel is emphasized by their contradictory ideas of
theoretical mind. Hegel thought of the theoretical as a development stage of the
mind. In Marx theoretical mind was not related to psychology, but was rather a par-
ticular appearance of philosophy, a philosophy aimed at exposing the disjuncture
between reality and the expectations of full human emancipation.
The delinking of Marx from Hegel is most graphically indicated in their oppos-
ing attitudes to the realm of practice. Hegel’s concept of practical mind concerned
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 185
the activities taken by mind to gratify the Self. The end of practical mind was
directed toward the acquisition of the happiness of the subject, and by happi-
ness Hegel meant self-gratification arising from food, shelter, to physical and
emotional satisfaction.10 The means to achieve this sense of well-being included
the gratification of sense and feeling11 and the recognition of the contingency of
impulse, inclination and passion.12 The most significant part of practical mind in
Hegel was the concept of will because will was the telos of the Self, the acquisition
of property, and the foundational principles of civil society, property and right.
The discontinuity between Hegel and Marx over the issues of theory and
practice were most clearly expressed in his September 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ and in his 1845 ‘Theses on Feuerbach’. Marx
explained his approach to theory when he wrote in the ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right: Introduction’:
This sentence serves two purposes. First, it notes that a negation of Speculative phi-
losophy, which Marx had performed in ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’,
was a necessary act before German philosophy could advance. Second, it also
focuses on theory as a ‘task’, or as a strategy. In Marx theory did not relate to human
psychology, but rather to formulas for action. If practice meant a revolution against
the despotism over civil society than theory was the formula by which revolution
was to unfold.
Marx realized, however, that theory in-itself would never change reality and the
only weapon that could change reality was practice. The outcome of theory must
be practice, because practice was the only way theory could be made an actuality.
Marx’s famous ‘Theses on Feuerbach’ not only decouples Marx from Hegel, but
also Marx from Feuerbach over the issue of practice. Although Feuerbach rebelled
against Hegel and substituted materialism for Speculative philosophy Feuerbach’s
materialism was essentially a ‘theoretical attitude’.14 Feuerbach’s transformative
method, of replacing theology with the human social essence was ‘contemplative
materialism’.15 Practice in Feuerbach was not Hegelian theoretical practice, of seek-
ing the Idea in the real, but rather ‘contemplative practice’, or finding the essence
of humanity in ‘species being’, or philosophical anthropology. Marx decoupled
himself from Feuerbach because Feuerbach did not ‘grasp the significance of
“revolutionary”, of “practical-critical activity”’.16
Marx ‘Theses on Feuerbach’ was also the primary site at which the dissemblance
between Marx and Hegel over practice was articulated. These famous theses by
Marx contain the following two sentences:
2) The philosophers have only interpreted the world in various ways; the point
is to change it.18
The September 1843 letter also reveals that Marx already differentiated between
‘theoretical and practical consciousness’, already saw that a critic could ‘interest a
great party in practice’.21 It must be borne in mind, however, that when Marx in
his September 1843 letter to Ruge used the term ‘theoretical’ he used it as a syno-
nym for philosophy and was not alluding to the section on ‘Theoretical Mind’
in Hegel’s The Philosophy of Mind. Similarly, the appearance of the term practice
in this September 1843 letter does not have the same meaning as the same word
has in ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’. In the September
1843 letter ‘practice’ meant behavior, or an activity, but in the 1844 ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ practice meant revolutionary activ-
ity. Nevertheless, by September 1843, as Marx’s Kreuznach period came to an
end, after the writing of ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, the concepts
of theory and practice were added to his intellectual weaponry as a preparation
for the writing of a ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’. In my
analysis of a ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ I will deal with
Marx’s use of the term philosophy.
At this point notice needs to be taken of the role Hess played in the formation
of Marx’s concept of theory and practice. Marx’s notion of critique, as already
indicated, derives from Bauer, but the theory–practice paradigm was influenced by
Marx’s knowledge of the work of Hess. In his ‘Introduction’ to ‘The Manuscripts’
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 187
If it is true that our time still suffers from the contrast between theory and prac-
tice, that the objective world, which the present has inherited from the past, is
in conflict with the subjective world of our modern feelings and ideas . . .’23
In this sentence Hess related to the question of social alienation, the opposition
between our ideas about reality and reality itself and the remaining parts of the
essay describe how praxis can overcome this alienation. The revolutionary praxis
of the proletariat will achieve communism and thereby end this bifurcation of
thought and reality.
While the essay ‘Socialism and Communism’ was Marx’s inauguration into
the theory–practice linguistics, Hess’s essay ‘The Philosophy of the Act’24 opened
Marx’s eyes to the theory of revolutionary practice. In ‘The Philosophy of the Act’
Hess refuted the Hegelian definition of Being as Idea and reinterpreted being as
action toward the reconstruction of the socio-political environment. Socio-political
action was a form of self-generation since the changing of social circumstances was
the necessary precondition for the changing of the Self.
Another vital influence on Marx in terms of his dissemblance from Hegel’s defi-
nition of philosophy was Ruge. Breaking with the stagnation of the Hohenzollern
monarchy, Ruge set an example for Marx on how the critique of politics was a
necessary precondition for the practice of reform.
Like Marx, Ruge himself was a victim of Prussian oppression. As editor of a
reformist journal, the Hallische Jahrbücher, Ruge suffered his first instance of
government repression when the Prussian authorities closed this publication
in 1841, the year Marx completed his dissertation. Undaunted, Ruge reset-
tled the journal in Dresden, changed the name to the Deutsche Jahrbücher, but
his second attempt at reformist journalism was again closed by the Prussian
bureaucracy in January 1843, about two months before Marx departed from the
Rheinische Zeitung. The association of Ruge and Marx dates from Marx in 1842
when Marx, as previously noted, wrote to Ruge about his interest in writing an
188 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
article about ‘constitutional monarchy’ in Prussia.25 Marx never wrote this article,
Prussian censorship was victorious, but the friendship between Marx and Ruge
continued because they both moved to Paris where they jointly published the
Deutsch-Französische Jahrbücher for only one issue before the journal fell victim
to French censorship and was shut down. Both Ruge and Marx were casualties of
Hohenzollern authoritarianism.
Five months after Marx’s March 5, 1842 letter to him, Ruge published a seminal
article, ‘Hegel’s “Philosophy of Right” and the Politics of Our Times’.26 This article
by Ruge, published in August 1842, came into print just as Marx began writing
for the Rheinische Zeitung. In terms of politics Ruge’s article became the bible of
the Hegelian Left, so Marx was cognizant of Ruge’s theory of politics by August
1842.
Ruge’s ‘Hegel’s “Philosophy of Right” and the Politics of Our Time’ established
three principles that were later absorbed by Marx. A philosophical interpretation
of politics, like Hegel executed in his The Philosophy of Right, was insufficient
because it did not change reality. The goal of political action must be to reform the
Prussian autocracy and a philosophical approach to politics could never reach this
denouement because it was caged in the prison of thought. The first step in the
reform of the actual was critique, or accentuating the divergence between reality
and thought. Critique must show that reality did not conflate with philosophy,
but rather that reality thoroughly diverged from philosophy. In order to surmount
this disparity, practical activity was necessary. Practice was an indispensible instru-
ment in the achievement of reform because only practice could change reality.
However, it is vital to remember that the reform Ruge advocated was limited to
the political, or the institutional structure of the state. Reform for Ruge meant
constitutional reapportionment, or the preservation of the state qua state. Ruge
never called for the overthrow of private property.
In a second essay, ‘A Self-Critique of Liberalism’, published in early 1843, while
Marx was Editor of the Rheinische Zeitung, Ruge continued his theme that true
human freedom could never be achieved in the realm of philosophy. To dem-
onstrate the influence Ruge exerted on Marx I will juxtapose two quotes. In ‘A
Self-Critique of Liberalism’ Ruge wrote, ‘the purpose of Theory is the practice of
Theory’.27 Written after the Ruge essay, Marx wrote in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right’: Introduction’ ‘as the determined opponent of the previous
form of German political consciousness, the criticism of the speculative philoso-
phy of law finds its progression not within itself but in tasks which can only be
solved in one way . . . through practice’.28 The two quotes are remarkably similar
and show the manner in which Ruge influenced Marx.
While he was editor of the Rheinische Zeitung, Marx ignored the Ruge program
of the Hegelian Left. But when Marx suffered a second instance of Prussian
oppression with the closing of the Rheinische Zeitung his movement toward the
Hegelian Left accelerated and the material Marx wrote to Ruge now assembled
as ‘Letters from the Franco-German Yearbook’ exemplifies his radicalization. In
his September 1843 letter to Ruge, Marx reiterates the theme that critique must
be applied to politics. Marx agreed with Ruge that philosophical consciousness
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 189
would leave the reality of Germany mired in the Middle Ages, or that philosophi-
cal consciousness was an extension of religion. But the letter was another stage
in Marx’s decoupling from Hegel because he substituted critique and practice for
Hegelian philosophy. Not only did the letter advocate critique, but also attacking
the state, which Marx first articulated in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of
Right’ when he called for the abolition of the state. But in September 1843, just
prior to his move to Paris, Marx was still not a communist because in that letter
he referred to communism as an ‘abstraction’.29 It was only a few months later,
in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ that Marx converts
to communism.
When Marx converted to communism his rupture with Ruge was assured.
Written on the occasion of the Silesian Workers uprising, Marx’s ‘Critical Notes on
the Article “The King of Prussia and Social Reform” by a Prussian’ marks Marx’s
detachment from Ruge on the grounds that the reform of the state was not suf-
ficient for true human emancipation. Whereas Ruge sought the enlargement of
human freedom through politics and the state, Marx saw the transcendence of
politics and the state as the only avenue to human freedom. In addition, Marx’s
conversion to practice and critique, his desire to extinguish both state and politics,
also continued the process of his delinking from Hegel.
2C) Subject–object Another idea attesting to the delinking of Hegel and Marx was
the idea of activity. Both Hegel and Marx agreed that activity was an inherent
force of the human organism, but for Hegel activity was associated with Subjective
Spirit. In Hegel Spirit as reason was the telos driving human beings to the Absolute
Idea and activity was already present in the anthropological stages of Spirit, the
stages which were the platform from which Spirit as reason began its ascent to
the Absolute Idea.
The area of subjective activity is a complex terrain between Hegel and Marx.
Hegel clearly influenced Marx regarding the inherent activity of the human
organism. However, Hegel defined activity as the monopoly of mind, or it was
thought which was the propellant of externalization. Whereas Hegel convinced
Marx regarding the immanent activity of the human organism, Marx understood
that activity as productive labor.
The divergence between Hegel and Marx over subjective activity centered on
their disagreement over the nature of labor. The source of labor in Hegel was
mind, whereas the source of labor in Marx was the need to provide human
sustenance.
Hegel’s The Phenomenology of Spirit offers the clearest explication of his ideas
regarding activity. This massive work is a history of the evolution of conscious-
ness to Absolute Knowledge. The energy to make this journey, the archeology of
the ascent of consciousness to Absolute Knowledge, comes from the self-activity
of consciousness itself.
The end of the self-education of consciousness is Absolute Knowledge, or
Absolute Spirit. In order to attain Absolute Spirit, the unity of Idea and reality,
Spirit must pass through an evolutionary process, or Spirit’s self-perfection must
190 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
transgress intermediate stages and each intermediary stage informed Spirit of its
own powers. The realization of Spirit must be grasped as an educational proc-
ess in which each grade in this educational ascent informed Spirit of its own
powers.
The chapter in The Phenomenology of Spirit called ‘The Actualization of Rational
Self-Consciousness Through Its Own Activity’30 describes the evolutionary stage
in which self-consciousness achieves an ‘I’. The attainment of an ‘I’ is an outcome
of a developmental series in which self-consciousness becomes aware of itself as
an ‘I’, or a subject. It is necessary for Spirit to achieve a subjectivity in order to
arrive at the capability of continuing its ascent to Absolute Knowledge.
The mechanism through which self-consciousness realizes itself as an ‘I’ is the
movement from the implicit to the explicit, from the potential to the actual,
from the in-itself to the for-itself. Self-consciousness is inherently objectifying,
it is an outpouring of the implicit into the explicit. What is potential in self-
consciousness must externalize itself in the ‘Thing’, or the ‘Thing’ must be made
actual when the ‘Thing’ is appropriated by self-consciousness.
This mechanism by which the ‘Thing’ is appropriated by self-consciousness
is described by ‘The Master’ as ‘work’ or ‘labor’. The chapter ‘The Actualization
of Rational Self-Consciousness through Its Own Activity’ contains the following
description of ‘work’ and ‘labor’:
The labor of the individual for his own needs is just as much a satisfaction of
the needs of others as of his own and by the satisfaction of his own needs he
obtains only through the labor of others. As the individual in his individual
work already unconsciously performs a universal work, so again he also per-
forms the universal work as his conscious object, the whole becomes, as a
whole, his own work, for which he sacrifices himself and precisely in so doing
receives back from it his own self.31
The chapter in The Phenomenology of Spirit which describes the evolution of the
ethical is entitled ‘Individuality Which Takes Itself To Be Real In and For Itself’. In
this chapter ‘The Master’ writes:
The work produced is the reality which consciousness gives itself; it is that in
which the individual is explicitly for himself what he is implicitly or in himself,
and in such a manner that the consciousness, for which the individual becomes
explicit in the work, is not the particular, but the universal consciousness. In
his work, he has placed himself altogether in the element of universality, in the
qualityless void of being.32
This paragraph is an antecedent of the civil society chapters in both The Philosophy
of Mind and The Philosophy of Right. This passage from The Phenomenology of Spirit
describes how a product objectified by a subjectivity assumes a social existence.
A singular object produced by a singular subjectivity cannot remain totally con-
fined to the Self, but inevitably acquires a social being, an object acted upon by
other subjectivities.
The chapter ‘Individuality Which Takes Itself To Be Real In and For Itself’ is a
precursor to Hegel’s later conception of the Objective Spirit. In the chapter ‘The
Actualization of Rational Self-Consciousness Through Its Own Activity’ Hegel out-
lines the labor of Subjective Spirit while in the chapter ‘Individuality Which Takes
Itself To be Real In and For Itself’ he charts Objective Spirit, and a major feature
of Objective Spirit was ethicality. Ethicality related to the individual obedience to
laws that made intersubjectivity the being of sociability.
In both Subjective Spirit and Objective Spirit, work and its products were solely
expressions of reason. In order to fully understand Hegel’s philosophy of labor it
is necessary to draw a distinction between agent and result. The agent of labor in
Hegel was always reason. The result of labor always became the substance of the
real and this substance was reason, or reason was a self-externalizing process.
The self-externalization of reason was the ground of the unity of subject and
object. In Hegel the subject was the Self, while the object was the reality that exist-
ed outside the Self. In the process of self-externalization reason entered, provided
a form to this object and the occupancy of reason in this object made the object
comprehensible to reason. When subjective reason recognized itself in an external
object the external object became understandable to the reason of the Self. The
unity of subject and object was presaged in the self-recognition of reason, or when
reason acknowledged its presence in an external object this was the ground of the
self-recognition, knowing Thyself.
2D) Form–content The schism between Hegel and Marx was also made apparent
in their discrepancies over the form–content methodology. For Hegel the unity
of subject and object was also the foundation of the unity of form and content.
Idea was always content, and form, or object, which was endowed with shape by
thought, was always a product of Idea.
192 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Marx disassociated himself from this aspect of the methodology of ‘The Master’.
For Marx, form was a socio-material object, or form was essentially presented to
individuals by their socio-material environment. Content, however, was human
labor, which provided the purpose and function of the form. For example, iron
ore was a form, a material object supplied by nature to the human. However, the
contents of the plow, or train, was composed of human labor since it was human
labor that constructed these objects from iron ore.
For Marx, labor as content was the basis of economic value. Value was equivalency
for Marx and labor was the only content that would supply the universality which
was the ground of equivalency.
2E) Essence Hegel defined essence in Aristotelian terms. For ‘The Master’, essence
was telos, or it was an inherent tendency of consciousness. Essence described the
properties of consciousness that were immanent, properties that compelled a
human to act in terms of specific principles and goals.
The fracture between Hegel and Marx was evidenced in Marx’s alteration of the
content of essence. Marx made essence a sociological term, a category by which
to understand how a social formation operated. Essence in Marx referred to the
repetitive behavior of a social system. Essence did not relate to consciousness, but
rather to the regularities of a social system.
2F) Substance Both Hegel and Marx transformed the Spinozist concept of sub-
stance. For Hegel, substance was the Idea. The Idea was the organizational principle
of reality and therefore the Idea was the source of substance.
Marx’s break from Hegel was also apparent in their discrepancies over sub-
stance. For Marx, human labor was substance. Since it was human labor that was
the architect of reality then human labor was substance.
Marx performed a Feuerbachian maneuver in relation to Hegel. Feuerbach invented
the transformative critique of Hegel, transferring the qualities Hegel attributed to
Ideas to the human species. Marx adopted Feuerbach’s transformative method and
applied it to the productive process. Rather than Idea being the source of content and
substance Marx transferred the source of content and substance to the predication
of human labor.
2G) Subjective activity The fracture between Hegel and Marx was again manifested
in their disagreement over subjective activity. For Hegel, subjective activity was
synonymous with the activity of the Idea. To speak of subjectivity in Hegel was
always to speak of the prius of thought. Conversely, subjective activity in Marx
was always social labor. To speak of the activity of a subject in Marx was always to
refer to economic productivity.
The decoupling between Hegel and Marx over the question of activity is more
coherently grasped by dividing activity into four parts: agency, productive process,
outcome and substance.
As I indicated above, agency in Hegel is synonymous with reason, but Marx
disassembled this association and substituted social labor. Whereas Hegel was
focused on the ascent of Spirit to Absolute Knowledge, the pantheism of reason,
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 193
Marx was primarily concerned with the agency, human labor, that formed the
foundation of the process of production.
The environment in which agency functioned in Marx was the production
process. Marx began his study of agency from the basis of political economy, that
is, since humankind must grow food, provide shelter and warmth for survival,
the environment in which agency functioned was economic. Whereas Marx was
concerned with human survival, Hegel was concerned with the ascent of mind to
Absolute Knowledge. Materialism was the context in which agency unfolded in
Marx, and by materialism Marx meant the interchange between man and nature
out of which humankind acquired its sustenance.
Not only did the question of agency adduce differences between Marx and
Hegel, but also divided them over the issue of the productive process. In Hegel
the productive process, or labor, resulted in the synthesis between Idea and reality,
whereas in Marx the productive process, labor, resulted in a material thing that
sustained or improved the existence of self and society. Marx and Hegel were in
opposition over the question of end. For Marx the end toward which individuals
or social classes labored was the realization of human needs. Even though Marx
and Hegel took opposing positions in terms of the productive process, Marx
continued the Hegelian leitmotif regarding labor. For humankind, labor, either
in the Hegelian form of Idea or Marx’s form of economic manufacture, was the
realization process of the human organism.
The outcome of the labor process was substance for both Marx and Hegel, but
whereas Hegel defined substance as the unity of Idea and reality, Marx defined
substance as economic value. Marx transmuted the Hegelian Spinozist con-
cept of substance and Marx’s metamorphosis turned substance into economic
value.
Primarily an attack on Hegel’s The Phenomenology of Spirit, Marx’s ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, the last part of ‘The Manuscripts’,
targeted Hegel’s theory of self-consciousness, of subjective activity, as agency.
The proper approach to ‘The Manuscripts’ is to read them as critique. In ‘The
Manuscripts’ Marx is presenting a critique of Hegel’s concept of subjective action
and civil society. While Marx perpetuated the Hegelian leitmotif of inherent
human activity, the dissimilarity between Hegel and Marx was revealed by Marx’s
substitution of economic labor for the activity of mind. Marx remained an expo-
nent of Hegel’s theory of labor, but he replaced the labor of self-consciousness and
Idea with social labor.
The existence of this delinking should not conceal the fact that Marx was guilty
of self-deception regarding Hegel’s appreciation of the metabolism between the
subject and the natural environment. Hegel’s awareness of the activity of the Self
as it labored to acquire sustenance from the natural environment is spelled out
in detail in his The Philosophy of Mind. Marx read this work, but closed his mind
to Hegel’s exposition of exchange, labor, between the human organism and its
materialist surroundings. Marx did not relate to the anthropological and psycho-
logical chapters in The Philosophy of Mind and I will discuss this self-deception in
Chapter Four.
194 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
3) Civil society
Another region of disassociation between Hegel and Marx was over the concept
of ‘civil society’. The fact that antinomies existed between Hegel and Marx in
their more comprehensive interpretation of ‘civil society’ does not change the
fact that it was Hegel who introduced the concept of ‘civil society’ to Marx. The
idea of ‘civil society’ is discussed in Part III of The Philosophy of Right, and when
Marx wrote his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ he not only familiarized
himself with this concept, but stated that he would subsequently return to this
subject. ‘On the Jewish Question’, written in late 1843 and early 1844 and pub-
lished in the Deutsch-Französische Jahrbücher, contains Marx’s first formulation of
the ‘civil society’ debate.
I will introduce my more detailed discussion of the antinomies between Hegel
and Marx on the issue of ‘civil society’ with a more general summary of their
oppositional positions.
In Hegel ‘civil society’ and the state were two distinct spheres within a national
community. The state reflected ‘civil society’. The ‘civil society’ of the Medieval
period was agrarian and the state structure of absolute monarchy accorded to the
feudal property relations of this form of ‘civil society’. After the oceanic explora-
tions of the 15th and 16th centuries the ‘civil society’ of Europe became commer-
cial and industrial, giving rise to the bourgeois class and the constitutional and
parliamentarian monarchies of the 18th and 19th centuries. However, in spite of
the fact that Hegel conceived the state as an outgrowth of ‘civil society’ he was
also convinced of its distinctiveness.
When Hegel defended the separation between ‘civil society’ and state he
unknowingly exposed himself to the attacks Marx launched in his August 1844
essay ‘Critical Notes on the Article “The King of Prussia and Social Reform” by a
Prussian’. As I indicated earlier, in this Phase Marx proposed that the separation
of ‘civil society’ and state was an invitation to the domination of ‘civil society’
by the state, or, alternatively, that the state was the cause for the impoverishment
of ‘civil society’. Although it is impossible to conclude that Hegel was the seed of
Marx’s conviction that the separation of ‘civil society’ and state led to the autoc-
racy of politics, it is a fact that Hegel was the primary source of Marx’s knowledge
regarding these two separate spheres of socio-political existence.
For Hegel ‘civil society’ was an expression of Objective Spirit. It was that arena
in which private wills took cognizance of an Other, or learned that intersubjectiv-
ity was the source of social cooperation. Private will, a self-determining ‘I’, was the
foundation of moral life and as a defense of private will Hegel upheld the right
of private property. According to Hegel, private property was a rampart behind
which the Self could secure its preservation. Hegel’s defense of individuality and
private property was the basis of his defense of capitalism. Although Hegel was
aware of some of the scourges of capitalism – poverty and unemployment – and
although Hegel was an advocate of a monarchical welfare state, in the last analysis
Hegel was an apologist for capitalism.
Hegel’s embrace of capitalism meant that he accepted the major principles of
English political economy. Hegel did not denounce Smith or Ricardo. Although he
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 195
The will is the unity of both these moments. It is particularity reflected into
itself and so brought back to universality, i.e. it is individuality. It is the self-
determination of the ego which means that at one and the same time the
ego posits itself as its own negative, i.e. as restricted and determinate, and yet
remains by itself, i.e. in its self-identity and universality.33
Will was the genesis of the personality, the substance of the Self. Will first made
its appearance at the level of subjective mind, most clearly manifesting itself
in practical mind. Will was a function of mind that appeared just prior to the
evolution of Subjective Spirit into Objective Spirit. Will created individuality so
when Subjective Spirit crossed over into ‘civil society’ then ‘I’ could enter into
relationship with other ‘I’s.
Right was the underpinning of individuality. Right meant the philosophical justi-
fication for individuality to determine itself. Freedom meant the allowance of self-
determination, within ethicality, and right was the protection of that freedom.
One expression of right was private property and property came into existence
when will took possession of or occupied an object.
‘Civil society’ in Hegel, the opening stages of Objective Spirit, was an intersub-
jective space. ‘Civil society’ was a community and the community was constituted
of personalities and families who possessed property and the interaction of these
particular units acted as the transmission belt of mutual recognition.
196 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Hegel looked upon ‘civil society’ as the initial stages of ethicality. Whereas
morality concerned the behavior of the individual ethicality concerned the
intersubjectivity of the community. Hegel glorified the Greek polis, the political
instance in which private man compromised his own subjectivity for the benefit
of the larger community. Ethicality was based upon mutual recognition, the
respect for the Other. The polis was the most perfect example of mutual recogni-
tion because it was the community in which private interest was sacrificed in the
interests of the welfare of the totality.
Marx’s redesign of Hegel’s concept of ‘civil society’ was called into being by
his rejection of private property and individualism. Marx’s renunciation of pri-
vate property essentially begins when he moves to Paris in October 1843 and
joins the discussions of communist groups in Paris, the city of François Babeuf.
Marx’s conversion to communism taught him that private property is not the
protector of will, or Self, but the basis of social classes and consequently of social
oppression.
When Marx rejected property as the content of ‘civil society’ he also rejected
individuality as a component of his own version of ‘civil society’. In this regard
Hegel spoke the language of European Liberalism and Marx rejected this politi-
cal ideology and chose to speak the idiom of social community, Attic democracy.
Marx kept the Hegelian form, but supplied a new content, a content comprised
of collective property and collective labor. The end of ‘civil society’ in Hegel was
ethicality whereas the end of ‘civil society’ in Marx was the transcendence of
poverty, or the satisfaction of universal human needs.
Not only did Marx perform a form–content analysis of Hegel’s concept of ‘civil
society’, but of Feuerbach’s as well. In Feuerbach the content of ‘civil society’ was
‘species being’,34 a natural harmony between members of the human species.
Feuerbach spoke the language of an anthropological metaphysics, that cooperation
between individuals was a natural expression of their biological nature.
Marx applied to Feuerbach the same strategy of critique he marshaled against
Hegel. He accepted the concept that man as a social being was a foundational
form of human existence, but negated the Feuerbachian content of a metaphysics
of anthropology. Rather than a natural law of sociability as content Marx sub-
stituted the content of the interaction of men in the process of production.
Sociability was not a human substance, but a result of social conditioning through
the process of production.
Nevertheless, Feuerbach must be credited with supplying Marx with a vision of
‘civil society’ as essentially cooperative. Even though Marx by late 1843 was in
the process of substituting political economy for anthropology, the Feuerbachian
notion of ‘species being’ was an important factor in Marx’s interpretation of ‘civil
society’. Feuerbach wrote of an ‘I’ and a ‘Thou’, or an immanent tendency of the
‘species’ toward mutual recognition and interactive fraternity. When Marx wrote
of ‘civil society’ he meant Feuerbachian ‘civil society’. Later portions of this book
will refer to the disparities between Marx and Feuerbach, but in the works of the
passage, Feuerbachian ‘civil society’ was the model in Marx’s mind when he pre-
sented ‘civil society’ as the foundation of communism.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 197
It regards civil society, the world of needs, of labor, of private interests and of
civil law as the foundation of its existence, as a presupposition which needs
no further grounding, and therefore as its natural basis. Finally, man as he is a
member of civil society is taken to be real man, man as distinct from citizen,
since he is man in his sensuous, individual and immediate existence . . .35
In the Fall of 1843, Marx did not think of society in the anthropological terms of
Feuerbach, but rather as the domain of the process of economic production. In
‘On The Jewish Question’ Marx disaffirmed Feuerbach’s conjunction of ‘species
being’ and ‘civil society’ and altered the content of ‘civil society’ to ‘needs’, ‘labor’
and ‘private interest’. The content in ‘civil society’ in Marx was the Industrial
Revolution.
Marx’s application of a form–content critique to the idea of ‘civil society’ in
Hegel and Feuerbach left further questions. Marx abided by the form of ‘civil soci-
ety’, but rejected the contents of individuality, property, will and ‘species being’,
and the question Marx was required to answer concerned the contents of his
form of ‘civil society’. Marx was under the obligation to put forth new contents.
Since property was the major source of disharmony in ‘civil society’, in order to
establish the mutual cooperation of ‘civil society’ it was first necessary to eradicate
private property.
In terms of the works of the passage, two essays explicate Marx’s departure from
Hegel, as well as Feuerbach, in the content of civil society. These essays are ‘On
The Jewish Question’36 and ‘Critical Notes on the Article ”The King of Prussia and
Social Reform” by a Prussian’.37
‘On the Jewish Question’ was written at the end of 1843. His ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ was written after ‘On The Jewish
Question’, between late 1843 and early 1844. Marx’s transition to communism
was announced in the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ and
so ‘On the Jewish Question’ can be looked upon as a preparatory statement to
Marx’s conversion to communism.
Marx’s ‘On the Jewish Question’ was written as a rebuttal to an essay Bauer
wrote on the question of Jewish emancipation. Bauer’s essay placed the possi-
bilities of equal rights for Jews as solely a political question, and Marx rebutted
Bauer’s confining of the conundrum of emancipation to the political sphere alone
and averred that the full overcoming of anti-Semitism could only occur within
‘civil society’ after ‘civil society’ replaced the state.
In order to understand Marx’s argument in ‘On the Jewish Question’ it is nec-
essary to divide his usage of ‘civil society’ into two parts: ‘civil society’-under-
capitalism and ‘civil society’-after-capitalism.
Full Jewish emancipation, much less full human emancipation, was impos-
sible in ‘civil society’-under-capitalism. The existence of private property, the
198 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
was insufficient because what survived was a ‘civil society’ still dominated by
capitalism. When Ruge and Bauer stopped short of carrying the revolution into
‘civil society’, into the cleansing of ‘civil society’, they still left the institutions
of private property and capitalism intact. Bauer and Ruge never advanced to the
concept of a ‘political revolution with a social soul’.41
Although the concept of ‘civil society’ played a vital role in the thought of
both Hegel and Marx, neither of these great thinkers were originators of this
social science construct. The center of research on the history and sociology
of ‘civil society’ was the Scottish Enlightenment of the 18th century, thinkers
such as Ferguson, Steuart and Smith, although the Frenchman Montesquieu in
his 1748 The Spirit of the Laws is looked upon as one of the initial purveyors of
this concept.42 Hegel himself expressed his own indebtedness to Montesquieu43
for enlightening him about the concept of ‘civil society’. When he was a tutor
in Berne from 1793 to 1796 Hegel familiarized himself with the writings of the
Scottish Enlightenment on ‘civil society’.44 In addition, Rousseau expounds on
‘civil society’ in The Social Contract which Hegel read and to which Marx refers in
his ‘On the Jewish Question’.45
In addition to Hegel, both Montesquieu and the Scottish Enlightenment
exerted independent influences on Marx. Marx made exzerpte from Montesquieu’s
The Spirit of the Laws in 1842 and both Ferguson and Steuart, as I will point out
in Phase Six, were mentioned by Marx in the 1847 The Poverty of Philosophy.
Marx was therefore exposed to the concept of ‘civil society’ from several sources,
although Hegel was most important.
Marx’s relation to Feuerbach was also filled with continuities and discontinuities.
In terms of continuities Feuerbach was one of the theoreticians who persuaded
Marx to repudiate Hegelian Speculative philosophy. The writings of Feuerbach
persuaded Marx to focus on naturalism (I will describe the difference between
naturalism and materialism in Phase Six), or the activity of humankind in society.
Marx also continued the Feuerbachian transformative method which was based
on replacing the Hegelian Idea with human social existence. Whereas Hegel saw
Idea as subject, the engine of activity, Feuerbach transformed the subject into
naturalistic humankind: the prius of activity for Feuerbach was ‘species being’.
The discontinuities between Feuerbach and Marx arose over the nature of ‘civil
society’. Whereas Feuerbach looked upon humankind in ‘civil society’ as a ‘species
being’, as a species with an immanent essence, Marx learned to regard ‘civil soci-
ety’ as the area of political economy. Feuerbach was mired in an anthropological
ontology and Marx substituted political economy for anthropology.
The disjuncture of Marx from Feuerbach is visible in the works of the passage.
Marx perpetuated the Feuerbachian concentration on social existence as the center
of gravity of human activity, but Marx replaced anthropological metaphysics with
political economy. Whereas Feuerbach thought of a permanent ontology, Marx
thought of historical development as driven forward by the human productive
process. Nevertheless, the two currents are present in the works of the passage.
Lastly, the works of the passage disprove the Althusserian thesis regarding
the temporal starting point of the supposed ‘epistemological break’ between
200 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
B) Continuities
This discussion of the continuities between Hegel and Marx will be divided into
three subdivisions: 1) Master and slave; 2) History; 3) Methodology.
As I previously noted, Marx had read The Phenomenology of Spirit by 1841 and
when he, at the end of 1843, began to search for a locution to describe the rela-
tionship between capitalists he reverted to ‘The Master’. In his late 1843-early
1844 exzerpte ‘On James Mill’ Marx made the following comment: ‘If then our
mutual thralldom to the object at the beginning of the process is now seen to
be in reality the relationship between master and slave that is merely the crude
and frank expression of our essential relationship.’49 Marx’s attempt to define the
class warfare under capitalism within the methodology of Hegel was again docu-
mented in his 1844 ‘Critique of Hegelian Dialectic and Philosophy in General’
when he wrote a brief outline of the chapters contained in The Phenomenology
of Spirit and described Hegel’s chapter on ‘Self-Consciousness’ as ‘The Truth of
certainty of Self. A) Independence and dependence of self-consciousness; lordship
and bondage’.50
Marx used Hegelian methodology to characterize class relationships under capi-
talism. The struggle of the proletariat against the propertied classes was perceived
by Marx in terms of the master–slave modality.
But in order to render the master–slave paradigm appropriate to the slavery
of wage labor, to transfer it from the realm of self-consciousness to the political-
economic battlefield of the factory, it was first necessary for Marx the change the
content of the master–slave metaphor. The form remained the same, it was the
struggle to overcome domination. Marx, however, transformed the content and
replaced Hegelian self-consciousness with the theory of labor of Smith, Ricardo
and Mill. The struggle was not over self-consciousness, but over the conditions of
labor of the proletariat.
Marx’s change of content was also an exercise in his adoption of the Feuer-
bachian transformative tactic. Whereas Hegel situated the master–slave combat
in consciousness, Marx resituated the location. Rejecting master–slave warfare as
unfolding in self-consciousness Marx repositioned this combat in the sphere of
labor.
2) History
Historicity gave rise to three levels of philosophy: the history of philosophy, the
science of philosophy and methodology.
Historicity was a foundational principle in Hegelian thought. The Idea of
historical development lay at the center of his definition of philosophy. In the
‘Introduction to Volume I of The History of Philosophy, Hegel defined philosophy as
‘self-conscious reason’.51 And in order to understand this statement it is necessary
to first elaborate Hegel’s concept regarding the inherent activity of thought. On
the first level Marx considered Hegel as the father of the history of philosophy.
Thought possessed an immanence. The process whereby thought developed
from the esoteric to the exoteric involved the movement of the Idea to the objec-
tive. An Idea internal to the subject must surround itself with an external object.
Hegel wrote of the objectification process of thought, and by objectification
he meant the inherent energy of thought to make itself external in a material
object.
202 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The creative power of the active subject populated the world with thoughts, or
great temples of thought. The great monuments of thought were the objectifica-
tions of the implicit powers of reason. In-itself philosophy was the observation of
such a ‘temple’52 of thought.
This self-observation resulted in the mind’s self-knowledge. The observation of
the results of active subjectivity was a form of self-knowledge, for the vision of
what active subjectivity produced provided active subjectivity with a greater grasp
of its own powers. Observing the product was a means to gain knowledge of the
producer. When Hegel described philosophy as ‘self-conscious reason’ he meant
that in philosophy thought became self-conscious of itself, or thought became
aware, gained an insight into its own powers by recognizing itself in the objects it
brought into existence, and this self-consciousness was philosophy.
The second level of Hegel’s theory of historicity concerns the science of phi-
losophy, of the various schools of philosophy that evidenced themselves in time.
In terms of the science of philosophy Hegel isolated three predominant schools
of thought, Greco-Roman, Medieval and Germanic, the Germanic relating to
European philosophy since the Renaissance. These three schools formed the
analytic framework for his three-volume The History of Philosophy compiled by
Michelet.
Even though The History of Philosophy narrates the progression of philosophy in
terms of brief summaries of the accomplishments of individual thinkers, Thales,
Plato, Aristotle, the science of philosophy actually concerned national minds.
The deepest probes of the science of philosophy were into national minds, or that
part of national consciousness that concerned philosophy. Hegel’s division of the
science of philosophy into Greco-Roman, Medieval and Germanic schools dem-
onstrates that he conceptualized the evolution of philosophy in terms of qualities
of mind embedded in a nationality – the science of philosophy delved into the
inherent characteristics of groups, or collective minds.53
Collective consciousness was itself a historical phenomenon. The philosophy
of a nationality was determined by its temporality, that is, a national collective
consciousness was a reflection of its time. The philosophical consciousness of a
nationality was a reflection of the social, economic, political and religious cir-
cumstances in which a people lived. Consequently, a philosophy of a people was
always the ‘spirit of its time’;54 the science of philosophy was always contemporary
because it was an image of the historical moment that gave it birth.
The fact that the science of philosophy was always contemporary did not mean
that philosophy was stagnant. The science of philosophy demonstrated advance-
ment. The problems debated by the moderns were not the same problems debated
by the ancients. The contemporary did not exclude advancement and the key to
the superiority of modern thought over Greco-Roman speculation lies in the Idea
of freedom. Freedom, or self-determination, was the distinguishing feature of
modern thought. And individual freedom was a concept unfamiliar to the ancient
nationalities.
In his concerns for national consciousness and freedom Hegel was a child of
his times. Hegel was 18 years old when the French Revolution broke out and 45
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Four 203
when Napoleon was finally defeated in 1815. He lived 27 years through all the
upheavals and tergiversations of the era of the French Revolution and Napoleon
and concepts such as freedom inundated all of Europe. In addition, the Wars of
Liberation against Napoleon not only freed Germany from French control and
gave rise to the reform movement of Stein and Hardenberg, but also witnessed the
incubation of nationalism throughout all ethnicities of Europe.
The third level of Hegel’s theory of historicity concerned methodology. In order
to grasp the presence of Hegelian methodology in Marx it is necessary to draw a
distinction between System and Method. System was the universal principle of a
philosophy. For Marx the Hegelian System was reducible to ‘logical pantheism’;
every aspect of Hegel’s thought was subsumed by the Idea. Method concerned the
internal functioning of a System. Method comprised those operative elements,
those instruments, which permitted a System to fulfill its purpose. If System was
generality, Method was the particularities which sustained the System.
The central image in understanding the Method of philosophy was the organic
analogy.55 Hegel believed that every science must be systematic. In Hegel Method
and System were synonyms. Hegel meant that to understand the internal struc-
ture of a particular science it was necessary to think of that science in organic
terms.
For Hegel every science was a System, or the truth of a science related to its sys-
tematization, and this systematization followed the organic model. The understand-
ing of every science, philosophy, history, aesthetics, theology, political theory, logic,
was related to its systematic organization, and the meaning of a science related to its
correspondence to the anatomical image. Hegel proposed a universal methodology
of the human sciences, and the core principle of this universal methodology was
explanation in terms of organic structures.
In the above description of Hegel’s universal methodology I selected only three
features, organicism, universal–particular and whole–parts. In fact, Hegel’s Method
of explanation in the human sciences was composed of many more elements and
many of these will be discussed in later pages of this monograph. At this point,
however, in terms of Hegel’s definition of philosophy it is only necessary to define
these three components.
Hegel primarily mapped the historiography of Spirit and therefore his method-
ology focused upon the functional procedures of Spirit. Marx was absorbed with
the anatomy of social formations and therefore his methodology outlined the
functional procedures of social formations.
The developmental paradigm also dominated Marx’s methodology, only Marx
directed this theory of becoming at social formations. Marx’s theory of devel-
opment was not concerned with Spirit, but rather with the sequence of socio-
economic formations. Each socio-economic system must be seen as an economic
productive organism.
A social scientist, Marx described the relationship between the means and mode
of production. Marx concentrated upon social formations and how the productive
process was imbued with unique characteristics determined by how the means
and mode of production interconnected. A social formation was a collectivity, for
204 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Marx, a totality. A social formation was an organic structure and the determin-
ing telos inside the organic system was the political economy of the process of
production.
These economic production formations were also determined by historicity.
Change was endemic to productive formations and as the means and mode of
production developed the different levels of the means and mode of production
imparted unique characteristics to the social formations. Marx was one of the
inventors of economic historicity, or the historiography of social formations;
according to Marx, economic becoming gave rise to three periods of the process
of production – agrarian, commercial and industrial. Marx invented the histo-
riography of the productive process as determined by the means and mode of
production.
Consistent with Hegel, some of the functions of Marx’s organic systems were
whole–parts, universal–particular and subsumption. Just as Hegel used these
physiological functions to explain a culture-philosophic System, so Marx used
these functions to explain a productive social formation. Although the substance
by which Marx and Hegel defined an organic totality differed, the methodologies
inherent in these systems were the same.
Additional methodologies that evidenced the continuity between Hegel and
Marx were essence and substance. Previous paragraphs in this Phase illuminated
the fracture between Hegel and Marx over the content of essence and substance.
Acknowledging these contradictions, I nevertheless will use essence and substance
as examples of how Marx utilized these methodologies in his analysis of capi-
talism. Assuming the lacuna between form and content, I will briefly illustrate
how Marx was able to transplant these methodologies, lift them out of Hegel’s
Speculative System and use them as explanatory protocols in social explanation.
In Hegel essence is the implicit and substance is the explicit. Essence is the
potentiality, the telos that propels a subjectivity forward. Essence is inherent pur-
pose and end. In Hegel, substance is not an inherent energy, but the product of
the labor of thought. Substance is the fulfillment of essence, the result produced
by essence as it moves toward self-realization. Substance is the actualization of
essence.
Marx employed these Hegelian methodologies in his analysis of the productive
process. In terms of the capitalist system, essence was the function of capitalism
for endless profit. The essence of capitalism was limitless valorization, or the
ceaseless acquisition of profit.
Substance in Marx was value. If the essence of capitalism was perpetual val-
orization, then the outcome produced by essence was surplus-value. Substance
was the end result of essence; in order to have endless acquisition there must be
something to acquire and this entity was surplus-value.
Marx inherited Hegel’s methodology of explanation. Marx adopted the meth-
odology of ‘The Master’, but jettisoned the System.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 205
his 1841 dissertation. In addition, in a letter he wrote to Ruge on March 13, 1843
Marx uses the ‘The Unhappy Consciousness’ section of The Phenomenology of Spirit
to satirize a work by Bauer.3
More importantly, in his early 1844 draft ‘On James Mill’ Marx employed
two crucial concepts from The Phenomenology of Spirit: first, he makes reference
to the master–slave4 relationship contained in the chapter ‘Independence and
Dependence of Self-consciousness: Lordship and Bondage’;5 second, he employs
the Hegelian notion of ‘mutual recognition’6 as a means of criticizing economic
relations based on private property.7 Prior to his exercises in ‘The Manuscripts’,
Marx was already employing Hegelian paradigms as tools for a critique of political
economy.
The year 1844 represented a fundamental change in Marx’s relation to Hegel,
or, rather, the content of the relationship altered. Marx and his new wife Jenny
moved to Paris in October 1843 and Marx immediately entered into proletarian
and socialist circles. His brief friendship with Proudhon begins in 1843. The center
of gravity of Marx’s intellectual interests was modified and his immersion into
classical political economy began. In his 1841 dissertation Marx critiqued Hegel’s
The History of Philosophy and in 1843 he critiqued Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right,
but by late 1843 his curiosities had moved from Hegelian philosophy to econom-
ics. Smith and Ricardo replaced Speculative philosophy. ‘The Manuscripts’ are a
demonstration of this conversion. They illustrate how Marx experimented with
Hegelian methodology as an instrument of the critique of political economy.
For the purposes of this book it is necessary to divide ‘The Manuscripts’ as con-
tained in Mega2, Section I, Volume 2 into three parts. The first part includes the man-
uscripts Marx wrote dealing with the issues of labor and private property, labor and
rent, and labor, money, civil society and communism, while the second part consists
of his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, and the third part
is a summary of ‘The Absolute Knowledge’ chapter of The Phenomenology of Spirit.
I draw this distinction because the three parts represent three different approaches
Marx took to the philosophy of The Master, because the first part concerns Marx’s
application of his theory of labor to English political economy, while the second is
Marx’s attempt at a summary of the entirety of Hegel’s thought and the third is an
indication of Marx’s interest in Hegel’s definition of the role of philosophy.
Part One comprises self-examination and includes singular examinations of the
theory of ‘The Profit of Capital’, ‘Rent of Land’ and ‘Private Property and Work’.
Part Two, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, although
consisting of only approximately twenty pages, which I take as a coherent manu-
script, and is Marx’s summation of the philosophic enterprise of ‘The Master’. Part
Three contains an ‘Outline to Georg Wilhelm Friedrich Hegel’s “Phenomenology
of Spirit”’ and the notation ‘Absolute Knowledge’ which is a summary of the con-
cluding chapter of The Phenomenology of Spirit.
‘The Manuscripts’ represent a different period in the Hegel–Marx relationship.
Marx’s 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ and the early-1844 ‘Critique
of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’ are emblematic of Marx’s severance
from Hegel’s political theory and definition of philosophy, while Marx’s ‘The
208 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
1) Under Subjective Spirit I will discuss a) The feeling soul/desire; b) Will; and
c) Consciousness, self-consciousness, reason;
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 209
The Phenomenology of Spirit was published in 1807, while the Encyclopedia of the
Philosophical Sciences made its appearance in 1817. A ten-year hiatus separates
these works. I mention this time gap because the two works represent Hegel at dif-
ferent stages of his development. The structure of The Phenomenology of Spirit is not
divided in terms of Subjective, Objective and Absolute Spirit. In The Phenomenology
of Spirit the genealogy of consciousness, self-consciousness and reason are pre-
sented as preludes to the level of culture.9 Conversely, the structure of the 1817
The Philosophy of Mind, the third book of Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences,
is divided in terms of Subjective, Objective and Absolute Spirit. The Philosophy of
Mind represents the more Mature Hegel, the Heidelberg Hegel when his system
ripened, and so in discussing Hegel’s ideas concerning Subjective, Objective and
Absolute Spirit I will adhere to the architecture of The Philosophy of Mind. At this
point I will begin my analysis of Hegel’s theory of subjective productivity with The
Philosophy of Mind because I first wish to call attention to Hegel’s understanding of
the ascent of mind out of nature. When I discuss The Phenomenology of Spirit I will
focus on the ascent of mind in the socio-cultural world.
1) Subjective Spirit
1a) The feeling soul/desire
In Section I of The Philosophy of Mind the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ deals with the
‘Physical Soul’, which deals with humankind’s external relation to nature as
well as the internal physiology of the human subject. Hegel entitles this section
‘Anthropology. The Soul’ and I will describe in succeeding pages Hegel’s portrayal
of ‘The Physical Soul’ which was derived from Aristotle’s ‘The Soul’.10
The primary anthropological nature of the species at this level of subjectivity
was ‘sentience’.11 The human animal must feel hunger if it is to survive, for it
must feel the need for food in order to intervene in nature to provide food for
itself. I will label ‘sentience’ and the capacity of the species to intervene in its
natural surroundings to satisfy its need for sustenance as ‘desire’.
In order to satisfy its needs, its urge to sustain its existence, the species is
driven outward to transform the external world to produce objects it must use its
desire for self-preservation. No separation has opened between the ‘I’ and nature.
A metabolism exists between man and nature as nature must make available to
human activity those objects from which human labor produces the sustenance
of the species.
1b) Will
The impulse to preserve a subject’s existence leads to the development of will.
Every individual organism within the species possesses a will, a self-purpose. Will
210 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
is the urge internal to the organism to achieve its own end and the ultimate end
of all organisms is to continue life.12 Will plays a vital role in the system of ‘The
Master’ because it is a major factor in his political philosophy. Will not only
appears at the subjective level but also on the objective level, because when the
individual enters the social realm, will is the force seeking the maintenance and
protection of individual rights, will is the foundation of right and freedom.
2) Objective Spirit
Whereas Subjective Spirit concerns the potentialities of the ‘Self’, the level of
Objective Spirit concerns the productivity of reason. Objective Spirit essentially
concerns the external objects reason produced. Objective Spirit relates to the proc-
ess of externalization, the movement from internal reason to an external form.
In my discussion of Objective Spirit I will change the text from which I extrapo-
late Hegelian thought. I will work from The Phemonenology of Spirit because it
offers far more extensive Hegelian comments on the productive powers of reason.
The Objective Spirit is a universe populated by objects generated by reason.
The object, or the explicit, existed independently of the subject, but was pro-
vided a form by the subject. The object was a reflection of the subject because it
carried a form bestowed upon it by the subject.
The process by which the implicit realized itself in the explicit was called
objectification. The appearance of an object, sense-perception responding to an
identifiable form, an identity, was objectification.
Subjective outpouring was a basic principle of Hegel’s theory of Subjective,
Objective and Absolute Spirit. The ‘I’ was an instrument of intervention. On the
level of Subjective Spirit the ‘I’ intervened, interjected itself in the natural envi-
ronment to extract sustenance from nature and on the level of Objective Spirit the
‘I’ intervened in the social environment to produce a community and ultimately
a state. All three levels of Spirit were phenomenological expressions of the ‘I’, the
‘I’ was pneumatological.
The labor of the individual for his own needs is just as much a satisfaction of
the needs of others as of his own, and by the satisfaction of his own needs
he obtains only through the labor of others. As the individual in his indi-
vidual work already unconsciously performs a universal work, so again he also
performs the universal work of his conscious object . . .18
The work produced is the reality which consciousness gives itself, it is that in
which the individual is explicitly for himself what he is implicitly in himself,
and in such a manner that the consciousness, for which the individual becomes
explicit in the work, is not the particular, but the universal, consciousness. In
his work, he has placed himself altogether in the element of universality, in the
qualityless void of being.19
Work and labor were the expressions of the inherent tendencies of the Self, the
movement from the implicit to the explicit, or the impetus from potential to
actual.
212 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
2c) Substance
In Hegel substance means universality. Substance is the ground for the unification
of accidents, it is the cohesiveness which coagulates accidents into a universal.
The role of universalizing force is fulfilled by reason. The power combining the
particular into a generality is reason. In Hegel substance was reason.
The labor of reason created substance. The activity of reason brings forth a
whole, and totality is substance.
Ultimately,, however, substance is subject. It is subject that is the source of the
outpouring of reason. Subjectivity is the origin of reason and therefore of sub-
stance as well.20
2d) Ethicality
A major accomplishment of Objective Spirit is the construction of a society, or the
progress out of the individualism of Subjective Spirit into a community. Following
Aristotle, Hegel looked upon humanity as a zoon politikon, as political animals, or
as beings who naturally gravitated toward community.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 213
In the 1817 The Philosophy of Mind Hegel designated family, civil society and
state as three ascending levels of ethical life.21 This was the same hierarchy he
described in the 1821 The Philosophy of Right.22 A community, be it family, polis or
state, was the ground of intersubjectivity, the ground compelling an ‘I’ to relate to
an Other. Ethicality, for Hegel, was an expression of mutual respect, the awareness
that the Other must be endowed with the same rights as the ‘I’.
Ethicality could emerge only out of community because it was only in sociabil-
ity that interdependence was universal. A community could not survive without
interdependence, without the specialization of farmers, merchants, artisans,
because each division of labor made the members dependent on each other
for the satisfaction of needs. Economic interdependence was the basis for the
universalization of rights.
of men and women and their objectifications. Alienation meant duality, two
spheres opposed to each other, or the contradiction between the nature of the
human and the codes of belief and behavior created by culture.
Humankind suffered from a pan-tragic existence and this cultural schizophrenia
was a result of the dualistic realms in which humanity dwelled. At one pole was
the Self, the individual conscience and values, and at the other pole were the
demands of the social and of religion. Humanity was always beset by an Antigone
moment, the bipolarity between competing loyalties, honesty to the Self, or to
the social-moral.
Culture, for Hegel, was an example of the pan-tragic, that is, culture exempli-
fied the dualism of human existence. Culture was the inverted world. Mind gave
rise to culture, to family and community and the moral, but these objectifications
of mind were inevitably alienated from the subject. The fate of culture was to
become an object created by self-conscious reason which was eventually alienated
from the Self. Culture was an expression of stages two and three of the theory of
production, the predication of the Self and the destiny of alienation. Living in
culture, according to Hegel, was living in an inverted world, a world whose incep-
tion arose from the subject, but whose continuity brought about the alienation
of this object.
In culture humankind is lost to itself. Hegel admired the novel Rameau’s Nephew
by Diderot. The novel describes how the main character experiences self-alienation
by becoming a slave to wealth. Money is a power in culture and Rameau’s Nephew,
in order to gain social recognition, willingly becomes a bondsman to wealth.24
Wealth becomes the lord and Rameau’s Nephew the court jester.
3) Absolute Spirit
3a) Historicity
The pneumatic power of reason was the ground of Hegel’s theory of historicity.
The nature of reason was its continuous outpouring, its perpetual intervention
into the external world, and the consequences of this intervention was the cease-
less modification of appearance. The subject–object model was central to Hegel’s
philosophy, it was the paradigm for understanding the relationship between the
subject and the world, and because the subject unremittingly streamed outward,
objectivity was in an endless current of reformulation.
The labor of reason was the basis of Hegel’s productive model, the production
of the external world, or an image projected on the external world by the labor
of reason. The title The Phenomenology of Spirit was a four-word synopsis of Hegel’s
productive model, the cultural phenomena finding existence through reason’s
labors.
3b) Philosophy
Again repeating the productive model, Hegel defined philosophy as the self-
knowledge of the subject. Since objectivity was the outcome of the labor of reason
the knowledge of reason was best acquired through the observation of the object
thereby produced.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 215
The basic movement of philosophy was from the potential powers of reason to
their actualization, or the process of realization. Philosophy observed the realiza-
tion of reason in the multitude of shapes and forms this realization assumed in
history. In this manner the subject gained self-knowledge, it became aware of
what it was in-itself.
Hegel wrote a philosophy of identity. He recognized the unity of subject and
object and therefore was cognizant of the similarity between reason and actu-
ality. Hegel’s philosophy of identity did not mean that actuality was perfectly
symmetrical to reason, but rather that actuality was a reflection of reason,
that actuality became recognizable to reason because reason was embedded in
actuality. Hegel’s philosophy of identity did not mean a perfect correspond-
ence between reason and actuality but rather the means by which reason could
comprehend actuality, the reason why actuality could be comprehended by
reason.
The philosophy of identity also involved the reconciliation between reason and
actuality. Hegel did not believe that the world would ever become fully rational,
but he did believe that the improvement of the world would only come if the
world was made more rational. The metric of the reconciliation between reason
and actuality was progress, improvement, but not perfection.
Marx’s idea of critical praxis was foreign to Hegel. The instrument of change for
Hegel was not the practice of class opposition but rather the labor of reason upon
reality. The theory of reconciliation of ‘The Master’ called for the harmonization
between reality and philosophy while Marx’s critique called for philosophy to
revolutionize reality.
3c) Method
I will not discuss the question of Hegel’s Method at this point. This is a vast topic
and requires a chapter in itself. Chapter Five will be devoted to a discussion of
Method in ‘The Master’ and Marx.
3d) Spirit
The preceding exegesis of Hegel’s concept of Spirit into the three divisions of
Subjective, Objective and Absolute was intended to highlight the developmental
nature of Spirit. The purpose was to underline Spirit as ascent and as dynam-
ics. My purpose in emphasizing the hydraulic entelechy of Spirit has two goals:
1) To focus attention upon a vital dimension of Hegel’s System; 2) To emphasize
the nature of Spirit as labor and productivity in Hegel as the source of Marx’s
definition of labor.
Spirit and mind are synonyms in Hegel, he used them interchangeably, but
I will employ the term Spirit because this word accentuates the dynamic quality
of this concept. Spirit was a continuous activity of thought, it was the propellant
driving forward the subject’s appropriation of the object. Subjectivity perpetually
manifested itself; in its desire to appropriate external nature, subjectivity objec-
tified forms that were methods of absorbing the external. The source of this prius
that sustained the subject’s acquisition of the object was Spirit.
216 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
In the chapter ‘Spirit’ in The Phenomenology of Spirit Hegel offered this definition
of potency:
Reason is Spirit when its certainty of being all reality has been raised to truth,
and it is conscious of itself as its own world, and of the world as itself. The
coming-to-be of Spirit was indicated in the immediately preceding movement
in which the object of consciousness, the pure category, rose to the Notion of
Reason. In reason as observer, this pure unity of the I and being, of being for
itself and being in itself, is determinateness as the in-itself or as being, and the
consciousness of Reason finds itself.25
Hegel differentiated between Spirit and reason. Whereas reason was the rational,
Spirit was an ascent over the rational to self-recognition. The realization that the
potentiality of reason and its actualization in the object were a unity was Spirit.
The self-identity of subject and object was Spirit.
Another quote from the chapter on ‘Spirit’ accentuates the interconnection
between labor, substance and Spirit:
Spirit, being the substance and the universal, self-identical, and abiding essence,
is the unmoved solid ground and starting-point for the action of all, and it is
their purpose and goal, the in-itself of every self-consciousness expressed in
thought. This substance is equally the universal work produced by the action
of all and each as their being-for-self, the self, action. As substance, Spirit is
unshaken righteous self-identity.26
In this quote Hegel demonstrates his awareness that labor and substance were
self-expressions of Spirit. Work and labor were synonyms for manifestation
because they drew attention to the craftsmanship of reason, to the activity of
reason that produced material objects. Furthermore, the activity of reason also
culminated in substance. All material objects crafted by reason shared a common
identity, they were the outcomes of the practical activity of reason. Substance was
reason’s imprint on material objects, substance was embedded in these material
products. Therefore, substance was universality.
Spirit was a perpetual emission of labor, but the comprehension of Spirit could
only be won by approaching it from a historical perspective. Spirit never ceased
its acts of production, and to grasp its immanence these products must be seen
as parts of a developmental process. Only by placing the products of Spirit in
a development chain was it possible to summarize the individual properties of
Spirit’s creations and thus the inherent nature of Spirit itself.27
The cultural productions of Spirit, art, religion and philosophy could only be
grasped as organic systems. This meant that art, religion and philosophy, and
national cultures must be perceived as totalities in which the particular parts
were unified inside the whole. One of Hegel’s methodological categories was
whole–parts and he applied this methodology to the interpretation of cultural
formations. His History of Philosophy, Philosophy of Art and The Philosophy of History
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 217
The book of Aristotle on the Soul, along with his discussions on its special
aspects and states, are for this reason still by far the most admirable, perhaps,
even the sole, work of philosophical value on this topic. The main aim of a
philosophy of mind can only be to reintroduce unity of idea and principle into
the theory of mind, and so reinterpret the lesson of those Aristotle books.32
It adds to the general thesis of this book, the relationship between Marx and
Hegel, if I momentarily interrupt my analysis of the developmental quality of
Spirit in Hegel and comment on the importance of this quote.
First, Hegel’s return to Aristotle’s The Soul33 marked a revolution in the under-
standing of anthropology and psychology. He rebelled against the previous
metaphysical and empirical presentations of anthropology and psychology.
The metaphysical method in philosophy employed the concept of the soul, but
characterized the soul ontologically. In metaphysical philosophy the soul was
interpreted dogmatically, as fixed, as possessing adamantine qualities.34 The
empirical method abandoned the concept of the soul and interpreted human
psychology solely in terms of sensations. Empirical philosophy eliminated the
concept of the eternal, divine soul and reduced anthropology and psychology
to sense perception.35 Hegel resuscitated Aristotle’s concept of the soul because
the Greek philosopher provided a developmental interpretation of the soul. For
Aristotle the soul was the point of transition between nature and consciousness;
for him soul related to the developmental process by which the human animal
separated itself from nature and evolved in consciousness. Hegel borrowed the
Aristotelian definition of the soul because it corresponded to his idea of histori-
zation, that the self itself was also a historical process. I offer a deeper description
of the reading by ‘The Master’ of Aristotle’s ‘The Soul’ in Chapter 4, ‘Marx’s Mis-
Reading of Hegel’.
Second, Marx also read Aristotle’s The Soul. Marx’s exzerpte from the year 184136
contains an exzerpte of this text. It is impossible to ascertain if Marx read Aristotle’s
manuscript because of Hegel’s influence, or the importance Hegel ascribed to
the text, but it is important to note that Marx was also interested in this text.
However, whereas Hegel understood Aristotle’s soul as a stage in the evolution
218 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
1) Let us take a look at the Hegelian system. One must begin with Hegel’s
Phenomenology, the true point of origin and the secret of the Hegelian
philosophy.45
2) The first emerges most clearly in the Phenomenology, the birthplace of the
Hegelian philosophy.46
Marx looked upon the The Phenomenology of Spirit as an indispensible text because
it contained the key to the proper ‘method of criticizing’.47 In order to arrive at a
proper ‘method of criticizing’ it was necessary to answer the following question:
‘what is our position in relation to the Hegelian dialectic? This lack of understand-
ing about the relationship of modern criticism to the Hegelian philosophy gen-
erally and to the Hegelian dialectic specifically has been so great that critics like
Strauss and Bruno Bauer . . . still remain trapped within the confines of Hegelian
Logic . . .’48
‘The Critique of Hegelian Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ is additionally a
struggle for the Hegelian heritage against Bauer and the Young, or Left, Hegelians.
Marx’s attack on the Young Hegelians, his break with the Young Hegelians, did
not wait until the 1845 The Holy Family, or the 1846–1847 ‘The Leipzig Council’,
but was already asserted in ‘The Critique of the Hegelian Dialectic and Philosophy
in General’, which was written in 1844. In it Marx wrote:
. . . even now, after all these delightful antics of idealism expiring in the guise of
criticism [i.e. of Young Hegelianism] . . . has Feuerbach not once expressed the
suspicion that it is time to become critical of the origins of his own thought, to
introduce a dialogue, but Feuerbach has not begun any form of self-criticism.
Feuerbach still maintains a complete uncritical attitude to his own thought.49
In the 1845–1846 ‘The Leipzig Council’ Marx lumped the ‘Old Hegelians’ and the
‘Young Hegelians’ together because both deflected their attention away from the
materiality of life. For the Old Hegelians reality was shrouded in logical categories,
while for the Young Hegelians the world was buried beneath religious fantasies.
Both the Old Hegelians and the Young Hegelians were united by the fact that they
222 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
lost contact with materiality even though they achieved their blindness coming
from different directions.50
Marx attacked both the Young Hegelians and the Old Hegelians because they
were still tainted by Hegelian Speculative philosophy. They had not conducted a
critique of Hegel in order to elicit a valid ‘method of criticism’ which was con-
tained in Hegel. Marx’s program was clear: he would criticize Hegel not in order
to abandon him, but to tease out of Hegel the most constructive part of Hegel,
a creative form of non-congruence. When Marx wrote the ‘Critique of Hegelian
Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ he was no longer a Young Hegelian, but he
embarked on the process of bringing his own form of Hegelianism into existence.
Marx claimed the Hegelian legacy for himself: Hegel lived on in him. Marx did
battle against the preemption of Hegel by Bauer.
If one were to penetrate to the ‘genuine criticism’ of Centrist Hegelianism then
it was necessary to comprehend the ‘genuine criticism’ in The Phenomenology of
Spirit. It was necessary to detach Centrist Hegelianism’s ‘genuine criticism’ from
the Old Hegelian ‘uncritical idealism’ and this process of constructing the major
procedures of ‘genuine criticism’ could only be conducted within the pages of
The Phenomenology of Spirit. The structures of ‘genuine criticism’ could only be
retrieved from the book which presented the perfect exposition of ‘genuine criti-
cism’, and this source was The Phenomenology of Spirit. In ‘The Leipzig Council’
Marx referred to The Phenomenology of Spirit as ‘the Hegelian Bible’.51
The pages of the ‘Critique of the Hegelian Dialectic and Philosophy in General’
contain many passages in which Marx emphasized the creative and liberating
aspects of Hegel’s ‘method of criticizing’, and in which he specified his design for
his critique of Centrist Hegelianism.
The stages of Marx’s program can be summarized in the following manner:
The process I will employ ‘to grasp the positive aspects of the Hegelian dialectic
within the realm of estrangement’ is to analyze Marx’s commentary on specific
sections of The Phenomenology of Spirit. In ‘The Critique of the Hegelian Dialectic
and Philosophy in General’ for the most part, as well as in other writings, Marx
refers to singular sections in The Phenomenology of Spirit, and it is only by scrutiniz-
ing these particular passages that it is possible to mine the ‘genuine criticism’ out
of The Phenomenology of Spirit. In the following paragraphs I will define what Marx
regarded as ‘genuine criticism’ in these particular sections from Hegel: 1) Substance:
2) Form–content; 3) Hegel’s Theory of Production; 4) Labor as the self-creation of
humankind; 5) History as the production of spiritual totalities; 6) The inverted world;
7) ‘Unhappy Consciousness’; 8) ‘Noble and Base Consciousness’; 9) Supersession and
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 223
1) Substance
In order to understand Hegel’s definition of content it is first necessary to fathom
his concept of substance. Particularities were connected by substance into a whole;
substance was a product which amalgamated particularities into a whole. Substance
was generality, substance was the adhesive, the link that bound particularities
together. It was the universal.
For Hegel the substance of an object, art, religion, ethics, was Spirit, or the content
of a form was Spirit. Content was always the result of the pneumatology of Spirit.
Marx executed a Feuerbachian transformative critique of the Hegelian idea of
substance. Whereas Hegel thought of substance as the product of Spirit Marx
redefined substance as labor. For Hegel, substance was a product of Spirit, but for
Marx substance became human labor.
2) Form–Content
Marx thus performed a form-content dissection of Hegel’s theory of the labor
of Spirit. Applying the transformative strategy of Feuerbach, Marx accepted the
Hegelian concept of form – material or social appearance – but he refuted the
Hegelian content. Marx performed a theoretical amputation by replacing labor
for Hegel’s Spirit.
Marx appropriated the Hegelian methodology of form and content. He was a
practitioner of this aspect, and others, of Hegelian methodological forms. Marx
borrowed the form–content methodological paradigm but replaced the Hegelian
content of Spirit with the economic content of labor.
parts which concentrated on the sociological or political reasons for the alienation
of man. Certain aspects of Hegel carried out this program, but in the last analysis
Centrist Hegelianism had recourse to spiritual powers or entities. When Centrist
Hegelianism abandoned the socio-political and embraced the spiritual and
Speculative it ceased being both destructive and therefore productive. Although
Hegel pointed to certain socio-political factors which led to human estrangement,
in the last analysis Hegel judged mind, self-consciousness, as the source of human
estrangement.
Marx continued the Hegelian theme that history was the process through which
humankind created itself. The Hegelian theory of creation was itself a product
of the transformative method. In the Western religious tradition God was the
creator of the universe, but Hegel took the creative energy out of the divine and
repositioned it in Subjective Spirit. Following the Hegelian initiative Marx also
applied the transformative method, this time in the Feuerbachian mode, to Hegel,
resulting in the following proposition: the evolutionary force was not Spirit, but
rather social labor.
Marx’s conversion to the Hegelian idea that labor, Spiritual or social, was the
source of the autogenesis of humankind also led Marx to redefine the relationship
between nature and the human species. A son of the 18th century, Hegel defined
nature in terms of Locke and Hume, as an object external to Spirit, but as an object
emitting sense impressions stimulating mind into thought. For Marx, however,
nature was an extension of the body of humanity. Nature was the objective form
of human labor, it was the objective body of species labor and consequently spe-
cies labor endowed nature with a history. Nature was not stationary, but species
labor made it historical. Historicity emerged from the metabolic relation between
social humankind and nature
when Hegel uses the terms ‘shapes and forms’ he means cultural expressions such
as Greco-Roman philosophy, the Enlightenment and Absolute Monarchy.
Hegel iterates a similar theme in the ‘Preface’ to his The History of Philosophy.55
In that ‘Preface’ Hegel divides the history of Western philosophy into three forms,
Greco-Roman, Medieval and Germanic-Christian. Each of these forms possessed
a unique essence, a cultural in-itself, and depicted a specific period in the self-
education of philosophy.
In order to provide a foundation for the self-manifestation of Spirit Hegel
required the presupposition of history. Spirit could not develop, could not tran-
scend previous objectification, could not learn from its previous incarnations
unless history existed. A past and a future was necessary if Spirit was to retrospect,
to reflect on its previous manifestations. This past and future was time and time
made history possible thus satisfying the needs of Spirit. Retrospection was the
basis of the self-knowledge of Spirit.
The history that Hegel studied was the movement of cultural totalities. Even
though Hegel did not believe that China and India gave rise to philosophy, his The
History of Philosophy traverses the development of human thought from Confucius
and the Vedas through Plato and the Roman Stoics until Kant and Schelling.
Marx adopted the Hegelian concept of historicity, but here again Marx trans-
formed the form–content method. The forms whose historicity Marx studied were
socio-economic formations. Whereas Hegel concentrated upon spiritual expressiv-
ism, Marx concentrated upon socio-economic organic systems. Marx wrote of the
historicity of social formations.
In addition, whereas Hegel conceived of the content of these cultural structures
as Spirit, Marx conceived of the content as social labor.
It is thus absolute and universal inversion and alienation of the actual world
and of thought; it is pure culture. What is learnt in this world is that neither
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 227
the actuality of power, wealth, nor their specific Notions, ‘good’ and ‘bad’, or
the consciousness of ‘good’ and ‘bad’(the noble and ignoble consciousness)
possesses truth; on the contrary, all these moments become inverted, one
changing into the other, and each is the opposite of the other.58
in accordance with either the laws of the family or of the state. The laws of the
family and state were in strict opposition regarding burial procedures and no
matter which law Antigone chose she would have to leave one brother without a
proper burial. The plight of Antigone, a human being caught in a self-contradiction
due to her desire to obey the law, was a model of inversion. Antigone’s desire to
do justice to her brothers was thwarted by the bipolarity of law in the socio-politi-
cal. The ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ did not believe in a universal divine morality, but
rather in moral ambiguity, the sadness that in the social world people were torn
between equally binding but contradictory loyalties.
The ethical universe for Hegel was the pan-tragic. Commenting on the role of
tragedy within the ethical Jean Hyppolite wrote: ‘This divergence between the orig-
inal aim of the heart and actual action in the universal element of being expresses
the tragedy of human action.’59 The pan-tragic served as a rubric for Hegel’s
negative evaluation of capitalist civil society. The themes of the pan-tragic, of self-
contradiction, were also applied to the commercial society of the bourgeoisie.
Early European capitalist societies were bifurcated in terms of state and wealth.
The monarchies of Western Europe that ruled over the commercial societies of the
bourgeoisie extolled state and wealth, or what Hegel referred to as the ‘noble’ and
‘base’, the politico-economic expressions of the ‘good’ and the ‘bad’.
During the early centuries of the rise of the monarchical order, nobility was
an honored virtue, a ‘good’ ethic. As monarchies evolved out of the chaos of the
medieval period nobility stood for service, honor, sacrifice and loyalty. These were
virtues voluntarily given and were social ideals. However, by the 18th century, in
the decades prior to the French Revolution, nobility had decayed and it was now
associated with obsequiousness to the Crown and currying favor and status at
the Court. The nobility of the early bourgeois era was alienated from the heroism
and duty of the medieval knighthood and in pre-revolutionary France had been
inverted to mere followers of custom and manners. Along with his condemnation
of the 18th-century nobility and state Hegel outspokenly ridiculed the worship of
wealth by the bourgeoisie of nascent capitalism. While the state was reduced to
the worship of grandiose palaces, Hegel referred to the deification of wealth on the
part of bourgeois culture as the ‘base’, a civilization of the ‘bad’. Hegel condemned
wealth because it encouraged self-indulgence. Wealth led to the cultivation of
extreme egoism.
Sensitive to the use of language, Hegel recognized how it contributed to the
degeneration of state and wealth. The language of the obsequious nobility and
the narcissistic commercial classes was reduced to flattery. In order to main-
tain its position at court the de-nobled aristocracy deployed flattery to gain
continued entrance into the Royal Palace while the greedy merchants used it
as a means of improving profits. Language also became the slave of personal
aggrandizement.60
Hegel’s repudiation of the bourgeois world of culture also included the
Enlightenment. Although Hegel recognized that the Enlightenment liberated
reason from enslavement to religion he looked upon the Enlightenment as also
possessing a ‘base’ aspect, and for Hegel the nadir of the Enlightenment was its
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Five 229
because he illustrated how his concepts of the inverted world could shed light
on the shallowness of the bourgeois world. Looking at the bourgeois world from
the perspective of alienation, Hegel did not hesitate to uncover the vacuity of
bourgeois existence.
In 1844, as Marx moved toward communism, he attacked the bourgeois world.
He agreed with Hegel’s criticisms of bourgeois existence. When Marx spoke of
the proper ‘method of criticizing’ he meant that Hegel had perceptively saw, and
illustrated, the superficiality of bourgeois being. Marx did not mean that Hegel
practiced critique, but did mean that Hegel had uncovered the exact target, for
anyone, like himself, who wished to engage the ‘method of critique’.
Marx was part of the history of critique. The opening chapter of this history
was written by Kant in his critiques of pure, practical reason and judgment. The
next chapters were written by Strauss and his criticism of religion. As we have
seen Hegel was not part of the ‘method of critique’ but identified the subject of
critique. Bauer saw critique as a method for enlarging individual autonomy. Marx
understood critique as a philosophical weapon in the struggle against capitalism.
civil society and the state, in which the state was presented as the embodiment of
the ethical Idea.68 Human fulfillment arose when the individual was joined with
the universal and this was accomplished in the realm of actuality when the private
subject involved himself in the public activities of the state – the Objective Spirit.
Marx’s approach to Hegel’s concept of the ‘unhappy consciousness’ must be
divided into two parts: a) ‘genuine criticism’; and b) ‘estranged form’.
b) The ‘estranged form’ of this ‘genuine criticism’ derived from Hegel’s assump-
tion that it was possible to overcome this ‘unhappy consciousness’ in the higher
stages of the activity of consciousness. The ‘estranged form’ of Hegelian ‘genuine
criticism’ flowed from Hegel’s insistence that the ‘unhappy consciousness’ could
overcome its atomization in Objective Spirit.
‘Genuine criticism’ for Marx meant that the solution to the ‘unhappy conscious-
ness’ entailed the overthrow of capitalism. ‘Genuine criticism’ must always refer
to the material, or sociological, causes of an individual’s sociological malaise and
this meant that only changes in the material or sociological conditions were
capable of surmounting the individual’s exploitation and estrangement.
The ‘genuine criticism’ of Hegel related to the form, or ‘the unhappy conscious-
ness’. Marx meant that there were particular forms, types, classes, of alienation.
When Marx used the phrase ‘estranged form’ he meant that Hegel had properly
penetrated to a specific form of exploitation in capitalist society, but was encum-
bered with an improper content to overcome this form of exploitation. The con-
tent that Hegel put forward as a cure for ‘the unhappy consciousness’ was Idealism.
This was a content Marx rejected. Marx borrowed the form of ‘the unhappy con-
sciousness’, a minimal Self in capitalist social relations, but rejected the Hegelian
content, Idealism, and replaced Speculative philosophy with sociological content,
capitalist social relations.
that ridiculed capitalism. The Centrist Hegelianism Marx embraced was destructive,
that is, made public the horrors of capitalism.
Marx felt closest to the Young Hegel, the Hegel of The Phenomenology of Spirit,
who attacked bourgeois capitalist society. Marx looked upon The Phenomenology
of Spirit as the first book Hegel wrote; it was the book from which Marx began his
study of Hegel and because the Young Hegel exposed the malignancies of capital-
ism in its pages it was the Hegel manuscript that exerted the greatest influence
on Marx.
this was the epitome of the ‘estranged form’ in Hegel: it was a primary source of the
‘uncritical positivism and equally uncritical idealism of Hegel’s later works’. It was
a dividing line between two eras in the life of the Centrist Hegel, the Young anti-
bourgeois Hegel and the more Mature Hegel of Speculative philosophy.
Marx wrote: ‘We shall now demonstrate in detail Hegel’s one-sidedness and
limitations as they are displayed in the final chapter of the Phenomenology,
‘Absolute Knowledge’ . . . a chapter which contains the concentrated Spirit of
the Phenomenology, the relationship of the Phenomenology to speculate dialectic,
and also Hegel’s consciousness concerning both of their relationship to one
another.’71
In this last chapter of The Phenomenolgy of Spirit, Hegel presented a definition
of ‘Absolute Knowledge’, or the knowledge of Spirit. According to Hegel, three
forms of knowledge existed, empirical, religious and philosophical, and ‘Absolute
Knowledge’ was the comprehension of Spirit.
‘Absolute Knowledge’ was the recognition of the final unity of subject and
object, the awareness that Mind was the creative force of all historical appear-
ances. ‘Absolute Knowledge’ was the final recognition that ‘I=I’, the phenomenon
brought forth in history, were products of the Self. ‘Absolute Knowledge’ taught
that the Self was the in-itself of history, that history was merely the self-recognition
of the Self and this identity was Spirit.
The ‘Absolute Knowledge‘ chapter also epitomized the Hegelian System and
Method. The chapter was a synopsis of the Hegelian System because it enshrined
Speculative philosophy. The Hegelian System was constructed on the belief that
mind was ultimately the prius of all creativity and the ‘Absolute Knowledge’ chap-
ter confirmed this axiom of the System. The Hegelian System was predicated on
the presupposition that knowledge was mind’s knowledge of itself, the ground of
the identity between subject and object.
Marx’s attitude toward the chapter on ‘Absolute Knowledge’ summarized his
general evaluation of The Phenomenology of Spirit. In his ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ he wrote:
rejected the content of Hegel’s theory of creation. Rather than Spirit acting as
content and subject Marx made human social labor the content and subject.
Marx saw The Phenomenology of Spirit as the birthplace of Centrist Hegelianism
because he thought of it as symmetrical to political economy. The Phenomenology
of Spirit and English political economy were complementary because they both
assumed human labor as the dynamics of creation; there was only disagreement
over content and subjectivity. Smith, Ricardo and Hegel shared a corresponding
vision of human productivity.
The books of Hegel which exemplified his Speculative philosophy were The
Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, in particular The Philosophy of Nature
and The Philosophy of Religion. In addition, The Philosophy of Right was another
illustration of the Mature ‘Parmenides of Berlin’.
The books by Hegel which were the clearest expositions of Centrist Hegelianism,
the early Hegel who was opposed to bourgeois society, were The Phenomenology
of Spirit and The Science of Logic, as Marx mentioned in the ‘Introduction’ to the
‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’.73 Later portions of this
chapter will provide the justification for looking upon these works as the epicenter
of Centrist Hegelianism.
Marx looked upon Hegel as a German Liberal. The seeds of Liberal Hegelianism
were the theories of creativity and the dialectic of negativity. The failure of Liberal
Hegelianism was its Speculative philosophy, Hegel’s assumption that Spirit was
both content and subject.
The Marxist revision of Liberal Hegelianism stemmed from Marx’s substitution
of content and subject. Marx replaced Hegel’s Speculative content and subject with
human social labor and he also relocated the negative dialectic from Spirit to the
transformation of political economic conditions. By performing this substitution
Marx transformed Liberal Hegelianism into Marxist critique.
Marx never believed that Liberal Hegelianism was accommodationist, that
Liberal Hegelianism was merely an apology for Prussian conservatism. In his
‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ Marx wrote: ‘There can
therefore no longer be any question about an act of accommodation on Hegel’s
part vis-à-vis religion, the state, etc, since this lie is the lie of his principle.’74 As
I pointed out in previous paragraphs Marx attributed the ‘lie’ to the Hegelian
System of Speculative philosophy. Hegel in-himself was not an ‘accommodation-
ist’; rather the Hegelian System in-itself served to support the Prussian autocracy.
Hegel has already proved in his Phenomenology how this theory of mutual exploi-
tation, which Bentham expounded ad nauseam, could already at the beginning
of the present century have been considered a phase of the previous one. Look
at his chapter on ‘The Struggle of the Enlightenment with Superstition’, when
the theory of usefulness is depicted as the final result of enlightenment. The
apparent stupidity of merging all the manifold relationships of people in the
one relationship of usefulness, this apparently metaphysical abstraction, arises
from the fact that, in modern bourgeois society all relations are subordinated
in practice to the one abstract monetary-commercial relation . . .76
Marx interpreted ‘The Master’ correctly. Hegel’s chapter ‘The Struggle of Enligh-
tenment with Superstition’ is an attack on utilitarianism as a theory of human
exploitation. To evaluate a person solely in terms of their usefulness served as
a justification for expropriating their labor: if the utility of a person resided
solely in his labor then a manufacturer was legally permitted to use that labor,
even in an unpaid form, for his own advantage. In addition to rejecting utili-
tarianism because it provided the rationale for exploitation, Hegel also repudi-
ated the Enlightenment because it was the birthplace of excessive individualism.
Enlightenment philosophy brought utilitarianism into existence and therefore
Enlightenment philosophy in itself was corrupt: the product inherited the seeds
of corruption from the cause.77
Marx’s commentary on ‘The Struggle of Enlightenment with Superstition’ dem-
onstrates that he read The Phenomenology of Spirit as a attack on capitalist culture.
Since utilitarianism acted as the theoretic ground for English political economy then
Hegel’s negation of utilitarianism was simultaneously a rebuttal of classical political
economy. Marx saw The Phenomenology of Spirit as the ‘bible’ of Hegelianism and his
attachment to this book stemmed from the fact that he evaluated it as a critique of
capitalist capital. Capitalism was a form of the inverted world.
The Phenomenology of Spirit was the ‘bible’ of Liberal Hegelianism and Liberal
Hegelianism as it existed in 1807 was a condemnation of capitalist culture. A sym-
metry existed between certain parts of the Hegelian tradition and the intent of Marx:
those parts of Hegel that assaulted the bourgeois world corresponded to Marx’s
intention to uncover the exploitative nature of capitalist practice.
Marx’s outline of The Phenomenology of Spirit makes note of the ‘Mind in Self-
Estrangement . . . Culture’ chapter and ‘Absolute Freedom and Terror’ is the final
subdivision of that chapter.
Even though the Young Hegel supported the early stages of the French Revolution
when he was at Tübingen, as it evolved into the Terror Hegel saw it as an extension
of the excessive individualism of the Enlightenment. Just as Hegel looked upon
Utilitarianism as an expression of the Enlightenment, so he saw the Terror as the
culmination of the excessive individualism championed by the Enlightenment.
In particular, the Enlightenment gave rise to the absolute self-certainty of indi-
vidualism. Similar to the Greco-Roman Stoics and Epicureans, the Enlightenment
accorded the individual the highest value.
The Enlightenment set the stage for the Terror because it allowed individuality
to represent itself as the supreme embodiment of truth. The Enlightenment not
only enthroned individuality but endowed individuality with a supreme conceit –
absolute faith in its own convictions.
It was Robespierre’s certainty of his own infallibility that laid the foundation of
the Terror, and Hegel condemned this attitude.
The Terror was thus the lie of the Enlightenment. The misjudgment about the
supremacy of individual self-certainty brought forth the rule of the guillotine. The
Enlightenment figuratively beheaded itself.
Fundamental disagreements over the Enlightenment and the French Revolution
separated Marx and Hegel. Marx was generally an acolyte of the Enlightenment
because of its opposition to religion. Most importantly, Marx embraced the
materialism and social-scientific outlook of the Enlightenment. The materialism
of the Enlightenment drew attention to social labor while the rise of the social
sciences, the development of political economy and the Scottish Enlightenment’s
explorations of the history of civil society illuminated the rise and decline of
social formations. While Hegel disapproved of excessive individualism, embodied
in Robespierre, he nevertheless saw the necessity of an autonomous Self; Marx
wished for the elimination of economic individualism and the emergence of com-
munitarian mutual recognition.
Marx’s embrace of the French Revolution began during his Kreuznach period.
Marx read deeply about the French Revolution during these months and as a result
converted to democracy. In Marx’s 1843 essay ‘A Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of
Right: Introduction’ his conversion to communism took place. ‘The Manuscripts’
further evidenced his commitment to communism.78
Three of Marx’s clearest interpretations of the French Revolution were made
in 1844 and 1845 and these were all post-Kreuznach articulations. In 1844 Marx
wrote ‘Critical Notes on the Article “The King of Prussia and Social Reform” by a
Prussian’, and in 1845 he wrote the ‘Theses on Feuerbach’ and The Holy Family,
which contains the chapter ‘Critical Battle against the French Revolution’,79
which is Marx’s most extensive commentary on Robespierre and the Jacobins.
Not only were all these works the expressions of Marx post-Kreuznach, but
they were also written after Marx’s conversion to becoming a revolutionary
and a communist and these transitions took place when Marx moved to Paris.
238 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
of Marx’s thought the combat between ‘Lordship and Bondage’ was not over con-
sciousness, but over labor: the capitalist, the lord, sought to expropriate the labor
of those in ‘bondage’, or the proletariat.
Marx’s reading of the Phenomenology of Spirit must be divided into two parts; as
a condemnation of capitalist society and as a rejection of the System of Hegel.
Marx read Phenomenology of Spirit as a condemnation of bourgeois society and
capitalism. He rejected the Speculative integument of Hegel and read The Pheno-
menology of Spirit as an uncovering of the dehumanization of capitalist exploitation.
In commenting on Marx’s rejection of the System of Hegel, I remind the reader
to draw a distinction between System and Method. Although the ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ negates the Hegelian System, it
defends the Hegelian Method.
Marx’s rejection of the Hegelian System is contained in his attacks on the
‘Absolute Knowledge’ chapter of The Phenomenology of Mind.82 According to Marx, in
the ‘Absolute Knowledge’ chapter Hegel subsumes the history of self-consciousness
into Spirit. ‘Absolute Knowledge’ is a demonstration of the supersession of the
multifarious expressions of self-consciousness, the self-education of mind, into
Speculative philosophy. The Hegelian System was merely a projection of Speculative
philosophy. The System was the universal, the System was the teleological principle
and since Speculative philosophy was the teleological propellant, then System was
synonymous with Speculative philosophy. Marx’s fear was that the Hegelian System
would crowd out Hegelian revelations about the decadence of bourgeois society.
240 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
In this Phase I will discuss the following three texts of Marx, The Holy Family,
‘The Leipzig Council’ and The Poverty of Philosophy. A common theme connects all
three books and so it is best to discuss them as a unit. However, before I begin my
exegesis it is necessary that I first outline the structure of this chapter.
As I previously stated I will not become entangled in the philological disputes
surrounding the ‘I. Feuerbach’ chapter, but I do think ‘The Leipzig Council’ dis-
plays a consistent theme, is a text, and I will refer to it extensively in this Phase.1
In addition, before discussing The Holy Family, ‘The Leipzig Council’ and The
Poverty of Philosophy in themselves, I will introduce these works with a more gen-
eral interpretation of the philosophical background of these books. As a prepara-
tion for a more comprehensive understanding of these works I will introduce my
discussion with three prefaces: A) The Evolution of critique; B) The Meaning of
emancipation; C) Marx and philosophy. I will situate them at the beginning to
provide the theoretic presuppositions of these works as a way of clarifying the
particular meaning of each of these monographs.
2) Individuality
Bauer, and after him Stirner, were primarily concerned with the freedom of the
individual. For Bauer, freedom was symmetrical with individuality and critique
was directed at achieving the maximum freedom for self-consciousness. Bauer
reduced the role of the social to a minimum, and he was a critic of Feuerbach’s
species being.
Marx rejected Bauer’s reliance on individual autonomy. In 1845–1846, still
influenced by Feuerbach’s concept of species being, Marx saw humankind as
inherently social beings. Humankind was not an autonomous subjectivity, but
rather a class, group, community that was determined by the social environment.
Sociological conditioning was a major principle of Marx’s critique.
In addition, Marx was not concerned with individual freedom, but with class
freedom. Since humankind was by nature social, freedom must be defined in
terms of the social. Humankind was free when all of the productive forces of a
social totality was administered mutually by every member of that society, when
nature was merely the metabolic other of the human body.
4) Materialism
An analysis of the different aspects of materialism is necessary before I proceed to
a further discussion of Marx’s relation to Bauer and Feuerbach.
Different kinds of materialism Materialism in-itself was divided into two schools,
materialism-as-positivism and materialism-as-sociology.
Materialism-as-positivism was mostly concerned with the genesis of ideas.
Materialism-as-positivism concentrated upon the process by which sense stimula-
tion acted as the foundation for human thoughts. It was a positivism because it
assumed that sense-sensation was the absolute determinate.
As a separate disciplines, materialism-as-sociology comprised two compo-
nents, labor and sociological conditioning. Marx is most definitively associated
with materialism-as-labor and this component analyzed the human labor proc-
ess. Materialism-as-labor was the study of how the productive capacities of the
human were the pivotal force in the creation of the social universe. While mate-
rialism-as-labor concerned the externalization of human labor, materialism-as-
sociology concerned the influence the social environment exerted on humanity.
Materialism-as-sociology was directed at the social conditioning of humankind,
or how environmental forces, such as family, community, education and employ-
ment, shaped human thought. Materialism-as-sociology did not believe in an
adamantine human anthropology, but in a humanity whose conduct was condi-
tioned by the environment. Marx’s materialism-as-sociology was an early form of
behavioralism.
When I speak of Marx’s materialism I will, for the most part, presuppose that
Marx synthesized materialism-as-labor and materialism-as-sociology. Materialism-
as-positivism was the province of Engels.
Marx’s basic critique of Bauer was over the issue of materialism. For Marx cri-
tique was not primarily directed toward art, religion, philosophy, but over the
material determinants of life. For Marx freedom was not won by proving that
Hegelian Speculative philosophy restrained individuality, but by changing the
conditions of labor so that the wages of a factory worker could provide a humane
existence for his family. Critique was destroyed if confined to the theoretical level
and could only be realized on the practical level.
The chapter in The Holy Family entitled ‘Critical Battle against French Materialism’
is vital for three reasons: it continued Marx’s attack on the Old Hegelianism of
Bauer; it attacked Hegel’s presentation of 18th-century materialism as contained
in the third volume of The History of Philosophy; and it documented Marx’s con-
gruence with Feuerbach in 1845 over the issue of materialism, although Marx
was moving away from Feuerbach’s anthropological naturalism and embracing
the sociological materialism of Etienne Bonnot de Condillac, Helvétius and
d’Holbach.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 243
5) Defender of Feuerbach
Marx’s attack on the Hegelian system mirrored Feuerbach’s attack on Hegelian
Speculative metaphysics. The Holy Family contains this important statement:
The positive critique was the source of the critique of national economy
and Feuerbach was the true discoverer of this critique. From Feuerbach there
emerged the first positive humanistic and naturalistic critique. Even though
reserved, the effect of Feuerbach’s critique was more certain, deeper, inclusive
and lasting was the effect of Feuerbach’s writing, the only writing . . . since
Hegel’s Phanomenologie and Logic . . . in which a true theoretic revolution is
contained.14
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 245
I take the ‘Vorläufige Theses zur Reform der Philosophie’ as the more important
source because it was published earlier and contains all the innovative ideas that
were simply repeated in the 1843 ‘Grundsätze der Philosophie der Zukunft’. In his
‘Vorläufige Theses zur Reform der Philosophie’, Feuerbach continued his attack on
Old Hegelianism and speculative philosophy. He claimed that Spinoza ‘was the
originator of speculative philosophy’15 and that the Hegelian system was simply
a form of theology. The salvation of philosophy lay in the abandonment of Old
Hegelianism and the embrace of the Fichtean ‘I’ and naturalism.
Feuerbach was instrumental in turning Marx’s attention to materialism. Indeed,
Feuerbach’s 1833 Geschichte der neuern Philosophie von Bacon von Verulam bis
Benedict Spinoza was read by Marx in the preparation of his 1841 dissertation, but
lacked a nullification of Hegelian Speculative philosophy as well as any presenti-
ment of Feuerbach’s conversion to materialism. But Volume III of Hegel’s The
History of Philosophy devotes only a short single paragraph to Gassendi,16 while
Feuerbach’s Geschichte der neuern Philosophie von Bacon von Verulam bis Benedict
Spinoza devotes 15 pages to a discussion of Gassendi.17 Gassendi was an important
figure in the history of Western philosophy, particularly in regard to the rebirth
of Greek atomism during the Renaissance. Gassendi was a scholar of antique
atomism, specifically of the work of Epicurus, Leucippus and Democritus. The
resurrection of atomism in early 17th-century Europe was indebted to Gassendi.
Marx read Feuerbach’s summary of Gassendi and through Feuerbach’s Gassendi
comments on Epicurus and Democritus gained insight into Gassendi’s assessment
of these Greek scientific titans. The ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ also dealt with Greek
atomism in Volume I of The History of Philosophy, and although it is impossible to
determine if Marx followed Gassendi’s interpretation of antique atomism certainly
Feuerbach’s own interest in Gassendi and the onset of Renaissance materialism in
Bacon and Gassendi was a factor that cemented Marx’s interest in materialism.
The chapter ‘Critical Battle against French Materialism’ was part of Marx’s strat-
egy of disqualification against Bauer because it presented a history of European
materialism that contradicted the view of both the Speculative Bauer and Hegel.
For Bauer, Spinozism was the dominant influence on French 18th-century mate-
rialism18 and by privileging Spinoza, Bauer replicated the mistake committed
by Hegel in Volume III of The History Of Philosophy. Speculative philosophy in its
Hegelian and Bauerian form was simply incapable of presenting an accurate his-
tory of the development of materialism.
Marx’s detachment from Hegelian Speculative theory was additionally mani-
fested in his negation of Volume III of Hegel’s The History of Philosophy. In this
volume Hegel offered an account of modern philosophy from Bacon to Schelling.
However, Hegel’s account of modern philosophy was not a history, but rather
a demonstration of the contradictions between Thought and Being, or of the
metaphysics of Hegel’s dialectics. Section Two of Part Three is entitled ‘The
Metaphysics of the Understanding’ and a subsection of Chapter Two is entitled
‘Opposition between Sensation and Thought’. Rather than narrating the evolu-
tion of Enlightenment materialism, Volume III of Hegel’s The History of Philosophy
was an exhibition of the contradiction between Thought and Being. ‘The Master’
246 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
used The History of Philosophy to provide proof of the basic foundations of his
‘logical pantheism’.
Rejecting the Speculative side of Hegelian philosophy, Marx carried out the mis-
sion Feuerbach intimated in his ‘Vorläufige Theses zur der Reform der Philosophie’
and his ‘Grundsätze der Philosophie der Zukunft’ and replaced ‘logical pantheism’
with materialism. However, Feuerbach articulated an anthropological naturalism
and Marx rejected Feuerbach’s anthropological naturalism and substituted socio-
logical materialism. Even though Marx also divorced himself from Feuerbach’s
brand of naturalism he did, nevertheless, see materialism as the philosophy of the
future, the path he chose to explore.
In the chapter ‘Critical Battle against French Materialism’, Marx showed his
adherence to Feuerbach’s Geschichte der neuern Philosophie von Bacon von Verulam
bis Benedict Spinoza, particularly Feuerbach’s regard for Gassendi’s and Epicurean
materialism. The battle in the 18th century was between metaphysics and materi-
alism, and Marx demonstrated his adherence to the Gassendi–Epicurean tradition.
He wrote:
6) Practice
Marx’s commitment to the change of socio-productive relationships, the method
of labor and the ownership of property, as the only means by which to re-
appropriate the human essence, inclined him to embrace practical philosophy.
Following Aristotle, Kant and Hegel, Marx divided philosophy into two divisions,
theoretical and practical. While theoretical philosophy was the exclusive preserve
of thought, for Marx the domain of practical philosophy concerned the subjective
actions of individuals or classes in changing their material environment.
Bauer’s critique was theoretical. Lacking an appreciation of the importance of
materialism, the only target to which Bauer could direct his critique was the theo-
retical. Since it was, according to Bauer, the theoretical that dominated humankind,
then the only way to expand the kingdom of individual freedom was through a
critique of the theoretical.
7) Political economy
Marx’s commitment to materialism cemented his interest in political economy.
Marx’s recognition that human freedom could increase only through the trans-
formation of social conditions led him to the study of the forces shaping society –
and these were the forces of political economy. While ‘The Manuscripts’ of 1844
were an imaginative blend of philosophy and political economy, as Marx moved
to the 1845 The Holy Family, the 1845–1846 ‘Leipzig Council’ and the 1847 The
Poverty of Philosophy, his writing showed an increasing concentration on political
economy. The period 1845–1847 was one of transition, the time of Marx’s move-
ment away from philosophy to political economy as the major focus of his inter-
ests. When Marx reached London in 1849 he was intellectually ready for his vast
study in political economy as a preparation for the writing of Das Kapital.
Marx’s movement toward political economy allowed him to see how economic
doctrine could become an ‘ideology’. The first person to use the term ‘ideology’
was the Frenchman Destutt de Tracy, who in 1817 published a book called The
Elements of Ideology. A psychologist, de Tracy gathered a small group of thinkers
around himself to study the human mind; they became known as ‘Ideologues’.
The goal of the ‘Ideologues’ was to study the origin of ideas. De Tracy and his circle
studied the brain and nerve functions and the connection between the senses of
a person and his ideas. The ‘Ideology’ of de Tracy was positivist, with its attempt
to reduce ideas to sense perception, a radical version of British empiricism. In the
hands of de Tracy ‘ideology’ concerned the neurological genesis of thought.
Marx redefined the term ‘ideology’ when he detached it from its neurological
origins and located it in a political context. For Marx, ‘ideology’ was still con-
cerned with ideas, but with ideas that served a political or class function. In the
political sense an ‘ideology’ was not concerned with an idea’s correspondence
to reality, but rather when used in a political framework ‘ideology’ meant ideas
248 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Marx’s liberation from Speculative Hegelianism opened space for him to rede-
fine the nature of critique. Marx wrote The Holy Family in 1845, the same year
that he wrote the ‘Theses on Feuerbach’, only the ‘Theses on Feuerbach’ was
not published until 1885 by Engels. In fact, Marx’s project for the redefinition
of critique was composed of five literary endeavors, ‘On the Jewish Question’,
published in 1844, a ‘Contribution to a Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Law:
Introduction’, published in 1844, The Holy Family, ‘The Leipzig Council’ and the
‘Theses on Feuerbach’.
Hegel stated that rationality was the basic force in the sculpting of actuality, that
rationality was an instrument in the realization process of Spirit. Marx stated that
human emancipation would be achieved only when reality became a realiza-
tion of philosophy. For both Hegel and Marx reason and philosophy penetrated
into the external and for Hegel this penetration led to the Spirit while for Marx
this penetration led to reality becoming philosophical, or to the actualization of
human freedom.
In Marx, however, in distinction to Hegel, this intervention of philosophy into
reality could be accomplished only by a class. Marx again demonstrated an under-
standing of praxis since he was aware that the philosophical remodeling of soci-
ety could be accomplished only by class action, or specifically by the proletarian
250 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
I begin my interpretation of these quotes by first reminding the reader that Marx
considered The Phenomenology of Spirit and The Science of Logic as the two most
important texts of Hegel, texts that contained ‘a real theoretical revolution’.29 Of
these two texts, the former was primary, it was, as I previously mentioned, the
‘Bible’ of Hegelian thought.
The first three quotations are connected by common themes. All point to the
fact that one aspect of Hegel’s thought was his awareness of the material condi-
tions of capitalist ‘civil society’. In my previous Phase on The Phenomenology of
Spirit, I discussed Hegel’s denunciation of Benthamite Utilitarianism and the domi-
nation of greed and self-indulgence in capitalist society as portrayed by Diderot in
Rameau’s Nephew. In the third quotation listed above, Marx made reference to The
Philosophy of Right, specifically paragraphs 242–247, in which Hegel discusses the
problem of poverty, or ‘the rabble’. All three quotes establish beyond a doubt that
Marx saw in Hegel a side that was aware that the problems of ‘civil society’ were
materialistic, or arose from the socio-economic conditions of ‘civil society’ and not
Speculation. Hegel was not Bauer; for him all problems of ‘civil society’ were not
reducible to self-consciousness or reason.
Hegel’s mission was the empowerment of Speculative thought with the highest
capability, but this does not mean he was totally blind to the materialistic aspects
of human existence. There is no inherent contradiction in believing that mind
was the ultimate determination of reality and an awareness of the materialist
contribution to existence prior to the final cooption of materialism in thought.
Hegelian materialism existed and The Philosophy of Nature, The Philosophy of
Mind and The Philosophy of History were encyclopedias regarding the mechanis-
tic, chemical, organic and geographic influences on the development of human
societies, as well as commentaries on anthropology, on Aristotle’s ‘The Soul’, sen-
suous consciousness, and sense perception and psychology. Hegel never denied
his materialism, but he obscured it in the integument of Speculative theory and
his arcane language. Hegel was cognizant of the ‘massy’, but this ‘massy’ aspect of
Hegel must be extracted from its Speculative imprisonment.
This extraction was Marx’s task. This extraction was the core of Marx’s appro-
priation of Hegel and the basis of his continuation of Hegelian methodology.
Even though Hegel himself never engaged in critique, it was Marx’s belief that
the hidden nuggets of the ‘massy’ Hegel, the Hegel aware of the reality of the
252 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
specifically over the confrontation between Marx and Bauer over the question of
the emancipation of the Jews. In order to grasp the essentials of Bauer’s thought
it is best to divide it into two dominions, philosophy and politics. In both domin-
ions Bauer radicalized the philosophy and politics of Hegel.
Philosophically, Bauer radicalized the Hegelian ideas of self-consciousness, indi-
viduality and the unity of the particular and the universal. Bauer remained loyal,
or so he maintained, to Hegel throughout his entire life and the radical interpreta-
tion he attributed to Hegel became the foundation, excluding Feuerbach, of Left
Hegelianism.
Bauer’s radicalization of Hegel was most prominently displayed on his Die
Posaune des jüngsten Gerichts über Hegel, den Atheisten und Antichristen.31 In this
work Bauer presented Hegel as a prophet of free self-consciousness. Hegel was the
evangelical who announced the conjunction of self-consciousness and individual-
ity, or a personality entitled to exercise individual critique against any normative
principle. Bauer’s Hegelianism accentuated the freedom of self-consciousness.
However, Bauer was not an anarchist in the style of Stirner. Like Hegel, Bauer
recognized Thought as Being. Like Hegel, Bauer recognized that particularity must
eventually be subsumed into a universality. Nevertheless, Bauer accentuated the
role of self-conscious free choice in the selection of the universal into which the
individual would be sublated.
Politically, Bauer’s radicalization of Hegel was manifested in his rejection of
The Philosophy of Right. Hegel’s program of constitutional monarchy was rejected
by Bauer in favor of a democratic republic. Hegel was fearful of totally free self-
consciousness and attacked Socrates as a cause of the decline of the Athenian polis,
and consequently in The Philosophy of Right confined free self-consciousness within
the boundaries of corporative institutions. Bauer rejected this confinement and
advocated the replacement of constitutional monarchy by a democratic republic,
a form of government which corresponded to the universal exercise of free con-
sciousness. In Vormärz Germany Bauer was a voice of political emancipation.
The definition of political emancipation constituted the line of battle between
Bauer and Marx. For Bauer emancipation was associated with the Hegelian prin-
ciple of a universality. Members of a society were emancipated if they all adopted
the universal principles of that nation. In terms of religion the appeal to universal-
ity meant that every denomination must surrender its doctrinal particularity and
accede to the political universality of a nation. Bauer did not think Jewish eman-
cipation was possible because Jews could not be treated according to a universal
standard since they insisted on retaining their particularity and thereby excluded
themselves from the universal.32
Marx’s ‘On the Jewish Question’ was a denunciation of Bauer’s definition of
emancipation. For Marx emancipation did not mean adherence to a universal
principle, but rather a revolution in social conditions. Bauer’s definition of free-
dom, Marx argued, remained confined to the political realm. True liberation, for
Marx, could only result from a social revolution, the eradication of capitalism.
In a series of articles published in the Allgemeine Literatur-Zeitung in 1843–1844,
Bauer defined Jewish emancipation almost totally in terms of the political and
254 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
failed to address the issue of social emancipation. In his response to Bauer’s articles
in his 1844 ‘On the Jewish Question’, Marx criticized Bauer for not understanding
that full emancipation could be achieved only when implemented on both levels,
political and social, or with the overthrow of capitalist ‘civil society’. Starting with
‘On the Jewish Question’, Marx continued his engagement with this issue in the
1845 ‘Theses on Feuerbach’, and arrived at a final determination of this problem-
atic in the 1845 The Holy Family and the 1845–1846 ‘The Leipzig Council’.33
‘Civil society’ was that stage of historical development in which private prop-
erty was the pre-eminent controlling factor. ‘Civil society’ derived from private
property and as long as private property existed so would ‘civil society’, and the
enslavement caused by ‘civil society’. The viewpoint that private property was
the cause of enslavement was an idea borrowed from Proudhon’s 1841 What Is
Property?. For Marx emancipation was impossible within ‘civil society’; the ‘massy’
circumstances of ‘civil society’ were the cause of bondage.
In order to postulate a social situation in which emancipation could be realized
Marx needed a vision of social life possessing the conditions productive of emanci-
pation and in this quest he relied upon Proudhon and Feuerbach. From Proudhon
he learned of the necessity to abolish private property and that the extinction of
private property would be the basis of a new social man, and from Feuerbach he
learned that social man was inherently a cooperative social being. Marx called for
the overthrow of ‘civil society’ and the construction of a ‘human society’. The tenth
of the ‘Theses on Feuerbach’ read: ‘The standpoint of the old materialism is ‘civil
society’; the standpoint of the new is human society, or socialized humanity.’34
Marx’s final rupture with Proudhon occurred in his 1847 The Poverty of
Philosophy, but Marx recognized his indebtedness to Proudhon in both The Holy
Family and ‘The Leipzig Council’. In both these books Marx acted as a defender
of Proudhon.
The Holy Family was a screed against Bauer. The book was a continuation of
Bauer’s and Marx’s view of the question of liberation, specifically over that of
Jewish liberation, and was devoted totally to invalidating Bauer’s Old Hegelianism.
In his journalistic articles Bauer attacked Proudhon and in The Holy Family Marx
defended Proudhon. Marx recognized that Proudhon was not a communist, that
Proudhon drew a distinction between property and possession, but, neverthe-
less, praised Proudhon because he made the issue of equality a central concern
of social liberation. By focusing on the material, on the ‘massy’ presence of prop-
erty, Proudhon added a dimension to the question of liberation to which the Old
Hegelianism of Bauer remained blind. In praise of Proudhon vis-à-vis Bauer, Marx
called attention to the fact that the Frenchman made two vital changes to the
dialogue of the Hegelian Left. First, he moved the discourse away from Bauer’s Old
Hegelian Speculative philosophy toward the ‘massy’ issue of private property as
the primary cause of human enslavement. Second, Proudhon revolutionized the
perspective from which the social question was addressed. Bauer’s perspective was
that of a Professor of German Idealism, while Proudhon’s viewpoint was that of a
proletarian. Proudhon was epochal because he inserted the language of the French
proletariat into the political debates of the time.35
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 255
In addition to his defense of Proudhon Marx also praised Feuerbach in The Holy
Family against the assaults Bauer launched. Before I begin to document Marx’s
defense of Feuerbach vis-à-vis Bauer, a few lines of introduction are necessary.
Feuerbach was a major figure in the early development of Marx and both positive
and negative aspects existed in this intellectual relationship. At this point, although
I will have more to say about this contradictory relationship in later portions of this
book, I will limit my remarks to the Feuerbach as presented in The Holy Family, even
though the reader should be aware that this is only a partial interpretation. It is
worth repeating here that the complexity of the Marx–Feuerbach connection is the
major reason that I forgo becoming mired in analyzing the Ryazanov ‘I. Feuerbach’
chapter of ‘The Leipzig Council’. It would lead Marx’s Discourse with Hegel astray.
As a way of clearly outlining Marx’s defense of Feuerbach I will oversimplify
Feuerbach’s thought into three categories: 1) naturalism as anthropological
essence or communitarian humanism; 2) naturalism as sensuousness; 3) natural-
ism as social humankind.
Category 1, naturalism as anthropological essence and communitarian human-
ism, related to the terrain of Feuerbachian thought that privileges the idea of a
human substance that is inherently social. The term ‘anthropological essence’
refers to Feuerbach’s assertion that the human species was characterized by an
immanent tendency toward cooperation and mutual understanding. Feuerbach
encapsulated this belief in the phrase ‘I=I’.
Category 2, naturalism as sensuousness, related to Feuerbach’s awareness and
receptivity to human sensuousness, including sexuality. Investigating the physi-
ological aspects of human existence, Feuerbach looked upon sensuality as a source
of human bonding, and desire not as conflict but as a basis of love. In this respect
Feuerbach was a naturalist because he positioned nature as a major determinant
of the behavior of the species.
Category 3, naturalism as social man, understood that the species was not only
determined by nature but also by social existence. One of the major areas of con-
frontation between Marx and Feuerbach concerned the presupposition of social
existence as Marx accentuated the socio-economic, the learned responses of the spe-
cies, while Feuerbach highlighted the naturalistic, the physiological inherency of
the species. Putting that issue aside, Feuerbach at least shifted attention away from
Speculative philosophy’s absorption into self-consciousness to the awareness that
the anthropological was the major determinant of the behavior of the species.
Within the context of The Holy Family, Marx did not address Category 1, natu-
ralism as anthropological essence and communitarian humanism, and these were
the problematics with which he deals in the ‘Theses on Feuerbach’. But within
The Holy Family Marx does address Categories 2 and 3, naturalism as sensuous-
ness and naturalism as social humankind, and praises Feuerbach’s championing of
these categories. Naturalism as sensuousness and naturalism as social humankind
strengthened critique because they drew attention to the ‘massy’ dimensions of
human liberation. By drawing attention to the fact that the enslavement of the
species was caused by material social conditions, naturalism opened up the possi-
bility that practice by reconstructing social conditions could liberate the species.
256 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Marx’s defended Feuerbach in The Holy Family on the grounds of his advocacy
of naturalism 2 and naturalism 3 because these principles negated the form of
critique advocated by Bauer. The form of critique espoused by Bauer was impris-
oned in self-consciousness,36 but Feuerbach’s principles 2 and 3 expanded critique
beyond mind to the material world. Feuerbach’s principles 2 and 3 remained theo-
retical, were devoid of practice, but they prepared the way for French and English
socialism and communism by demonstrating that the material world must be the
foundation of true humanism.37
As I indicated previously, Marx’s relation to Hegel was composed of continuities
and discontinuities, and the fact that Marx disavowed Hegel’s presentation of the
history of materialism did not mean that Marx was unaware that there were areas
of Hegel’s thought that were in themselves materialistic. Marx recognized that his
preference for Feuerbach’s history of materialism did not preclude that material-
ism did exist in certain domains of Hegelian thought and it was these domains
to which Marx wished to defend and establish his continuity. Marx’s defense of
Hegel consisted of two levels: a direct defense of the materialist dimensions of
Hegel’s thought as opposed to the Speculative in the work of Hegel himself; and
an indirect defense of Hegelian materialism by defending writers who perpetuated
the ‘massy’ aspects of Hegel. By demonstrating that writers who were influenced
by Hegel continued the ‘massy’ Hegel, Marx indirectly hoped to confirm that a
‘massy’ Hegel was indeed a fact. This was Marx’s strategy in relation to Proudhon
and Feuerbach, but Marx’s tactic stretched beyond Proudhon and Feuerbach and
included such figures as Hinrichs, Rotteck and Welcker and, as I will point out
when I discuss ‘The Leipzig Council’, also Michelet and Bayrhoffer.
In the realization of this purpose Marx would rebuff the Speculative philosophy
of Hegel, but champion Hegelian materialism. The Holy Family still presents Hegel
as a member of the Hegelian Center. In addition, Marx would defend other mem-
bers of the Hegelian Center, such as Hinrichs, Michelet and Bayrhoffer. The Holy
Family and ‘The Leipzig Council’ must also be read as justification of the Hegelian
Center, pivoting around Hegel but including his subordinates.
In Chapter Three, Phase One, ‘Hegel and Marx in the Center’, I introduced the
works of Hinrichs and placed him in the Hegelian Center along with Gans and
Michelet. Interestingly, Hinrichs reappears in The Holy Family, but as a foil for
Bauer. Readers of The Holy Family will recall that on several occasions Marx either
wrote ‘Help Hinrichs’38 or ‘Hinrichs! Hinrichs!’39 What is the meaning of this
satirical appeal for help?
In the articles in the Allgemeine Literarur-Zeitung, Bauer asserted that Hinrichs,
in his book Politische Vorlesungen, omitted reference to the social dimensions of
human liberation. According to Bauer, Hinrichs in this book focused totally on
the political aspects, whereas Bauer had discerned the vital social horizon.
Marx’s riposte to Bauer consisted of three tactics: aa) Nullification of Bauer’s
claim; bb) Bauer’s entrapment; and cc) The salvation of the Hegelian Center.
aa) Marx’s defense of Hinrichs rested on the repudiation of Bauer, and throughout
the text of The Holy Family, Marx refers repeatedly to Bauer’s lack of understanding
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 257
of the social space of liberation. Marx repeated the claims he first made in ‘On
the Jewish Question’. In short, without concretely repudiating the claims of Bauer
regarding Hinrichs, Marx sought to redirect the accusations on to Bauer himself.
bb) Assuming that he had to exonerate Hinrichs, Marx felt he should call upon
Hinrichs for ‘Help’. The appeals Marx makes to Hinrichs in The Holy Family are
attempts to use the supposedly exonerated Hinrichs as a voice to rectify the errors
of Bauer. Marx calls upon Hinrichs for ‘Help’ because he wants the exonerated
Hinrichs to reveal that Bauer-in-himself was entrapped within the Speculative
philosophy of Old Hegelianism.
cc) By employing Hinrichs as the annulment of Bauer, Marx upheld the correctness
of the Hegelian Center. The subterranean battle in The Holy Family was between Old
Hegelianism and the Hegelian Center, which included both Hegel and Hinrichs. The
Hegelian Center, both in terms of methodology and materialism, opened up practical
ways to alter politics and society and thus increase the social extent of liberation.
of the German philistines, or rather the German bourgeoisie would use Bauer and
Stirner to refute the claims of socialism or communism.
When Marx included in his strategy of disqualification both Bauer and Stirner
he was guilty of mis-reading Stirner. Marx’s central concern, the operational axis
of ‘The Leipzig Council’, was to portray Bauer and Stirner as personifications of
Old Hegelianism, and so he mis-read Stirner as being in total agreement with
Bauer. This was, in fact, not the case because there were instances in ‘The Leipzig
Council’ in which Stirner criticized Bauer, but Marx remained blind to or chose
to remain silent about them.
However, in ‘The Leipzig Council’, Marx continued to act as a defender of
Hegel. This role that Marx took upon himself as advocate of the Hegelian Center
is most clearly demonstrated in the following three quotes, although there are
many others, but the remit of this book restricts me to three:
1) The prototype of the entire structure of human age groups has already been
depicted in the third part of Hegel’s Encyclopedia and in various transfor-
mations in other passages in Hegel as well . . . Whereas Hegel, for example,
takes so much account of the empirical world that he portrays the German
burgher as the slave of the world around him.41
2) Hegel has already proved in his Phenomenology how this theory of mutual
exploitation, which Bentham expounded ad nauseam, could already at the
beginning of the present century have been considered a phase of the previous
one. Look at his chapter on ‘The Struggle of Enlightenment with Superstition’,
where the theory of usefulness is depicted as the final result of enlightenment.
The apparent stupidity of merging all the manifold relationships of people
in one relation of usefulness, this apparently metaphysical abstraction, arises
from the fact that, in modern bourgeois society, all relations are subordinated
in practice to the one abstract monetary-commercial relation.42
3) So says Hegel (Philosophy of Right. Para. 209 Addition) from whom our saint
derived the hierarchy of concepts in the modern world. Hegel, therefore,
explains the existence of right from the empirical requirements of individu-
als and rescues the concept only by means of a simple assertion. One can
see how infinitely more materialistically Hegel proceeds than our ‘corporeal
ego’ Saint Sancho.43
a) Excessive individualism
Marx demonstrates how excessive individualism, initially identified by Hegel, can
be manipulated by capitalism into an instrument for the furtherance of commerce
and exchange. Marx not only defends Hegel, but applauds Hegel for identifying
how Benthamite individualism could be programmed by capitalism into an argu-
ment for ‘possessive individualism’.45
b) Social relations
In this paragraph Marx begins to make use of the concept of ‘social relations’, and
in this paragraph he wrote: ‘this apparently metaphysical abstraction arises from
the fact that, in modern bourgeois society, all relations are subordinate in practice
to the abstract money-commercial relation.’ ‘The Leipzig Council’ is important in
the evolution of Marx’s thought because it identifies a new stage in the develop-
ment of Marx’s thought, the awareness that ‘social relations’ determine individual
and social behavior.
Furthermore, Marx gave credit to ‘The Master’ for his consciousness that social
practices were determining influences on personality. Hegel did not invent the
idea of social relations and, indeed, Marx acquired this idea from other authors.
Nevertheless, Hegel did recognize how the universal value of a society, consumer-
ism, could mold the beliefs and actions of individuals in that society. In Hegel
societies were universalities that conditioned human behavior and Marx praised
Hegel for this insight.
In quote 3 Marx commended Hegel in three areas: a) ‘empirical requirement’;
b) ‘infinitely more materialistically’; and c) Hegel’s paragraph 209 in The
Philosophy of Right.
3a) Marx asserted that Hegel explained the ‘existence of right’, law, by reference
to ‘empirical requirements’. Marx claimed that Hegel did not account for the
260 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
3b) Marx specifically affirmed that ‘One can see how infinitely more materialisti-
cally Hegel proceeds’. By making this affirmation Marx wanted to emphasize the
materialistic dimension of Hegel’s thought.
3c) Marx refers to paragraph 209 in The Philosophy of Right in order to invalidate
Stirner’s description of the genesis of law. In other words, Marx uses Hegelian
materialism to nullify Stirnerian egoism and self-consciousness.
‘The Leipzig Council’ was not only a defense of Hegel, but of Hegel’s cohorts
in the Hegelian Center. The grand design of Marx was intended to prove that
Old Hegelianism ran from the Speculative aspects of Hegel himself through
Marheineke into Bauer and Stirner, an inheritance of decay. The grand design was
also intended to establish that Hegel-in-himself and the Hegelian Center retained
the materialistic viewpoints of Hegelian thought and this Hegelian Center includ-
ed Michelet, Bayrhoffer and Hinrichs, among others.
Chapter Three, Phase One discussed the work of the Hegelian Centrists Gans
and Michelet. Gans’s work in the philosophy of law, his co-editorship with Hegel
of The Journal of Scientific Criticism and the leading role he took in the organization
of the first collected works of Hegel, bestowed the role of successor of Hegel upon
him. Gans’s death in 1839 left a vacuum in the Hegelian Center, but Michelet
subsequently filled the role as chief spokesperson of this school.
In three quotes in ‘The Leipzig Council’, Marx demonstrated both his respect
for Michelet and his belief that the Hegelian Center was the true heir of the legacy
of Hegel.
1) The youth who thus ‘deports’ himself, instead of chasing after young
women and other earthly things, is no other the young ‘Stirner’, the studi-
ous Berlin youth, busy with Hegel’s logic and gazing admiringly at the great
Michelet.49
The first two quotes are illustrations of Marx’s high regard for Michelet. To Marx,
Michelet was ‘great’ and this appellation shows both Marx’s respect for Michelet
as well as his belief that the Hegelian Center was the true heir of Hegel.
The third quote accomplishes two objectives. First, Marx repeats his assertion
that Michelet was ‘great’. Second, Marx also praises Bayrhoffer for his history of
Hegelian philosophy. As I indicated in Chapter Three, Phase One, Bayrhoffer was
a member of the Hegelian Center and the commendations Marx extended to
Bayrhoffer were also meant as support for the role of the entire Hegelian Center.
Not only did Marx come to the defense of Michelet and Bayrhoffer but also of
Hinrichs. In ‘The Leipzig Council’ Marx championed Hinrichs’ embrace of political
awareness as opposed to the sterility of Bauer’s addiction to self-consciousness.52
In order to understand this assertion it is necessary to first understand that it
was constructed by Marx, but that Marx included a quote from Stirner against
Bauer. Even though Stirner and Bauer were in agreement in their opposition to
Marx, and to socialism or communism, Stirner and Bauer disagreed amongst
262 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
marks a departure in the thought of Marx, as I shall discuss when I analyze this
work in later pages of this Phase. At this point I want only to alert the reader to
the fact that in The Poverty of Philosophy Marx abandons his direct assaults on the
Speculative philosophy of Bauer and Stirner and immerses himself in questions
regarding the forces and relations of production.
The strategy in The Holy Family was the negation of the Speculative philosophy
of Bauer and the strategy in ‘The Leipzig Council’ was the discrediting of Stirner.
It is important to recall the differences separating Bauer and Stirner. Bauer was
a continuation of the Speculative philosophical side of Hegel, with its conviction
that the projection of self-consciousness was the foundation of the unity of the
subject and object. Stirner was not a Speculative philosopher; indeed, in The Ego
and Its Own he criticized the Speculative thought of Hegel. Rather than the unity of
subject and object, Stirner extolled the total freedom of the Self. It was not thought
that defined humankind for Stirner but the ‘I’, which knew no constraints. In
spite of these differences, Bauer and Stirner did not give sufficient weight to
materiality. Bauer and Stirner, although one believed in the predicating power of
self-consciousness and the other in the boundless acquisitiveness of the Self, both
agreed that materiality did not play a decisive role in the sculpting of actuality.
Marx executed his assault on Stirner’s intellectual abilities in two ways: 1) by
showing that Stirner’s account of the early history of mankind derived from
Hegel; and 2) by showing that Stirner distorted, misrepresented, Hegel’s narra-
tive of the early history of mankind. Marx sought to undermine the intellectual
competence of Stirner by proving that Stirner misconstrued the sources of ‘The
Master’ that he relied upon.
In his attempt to prove Stirner’s intellectual incapacities, Marx was simultane-
ously asserting Hegel’s superiority to Stirner. Marx was indirectly claiming that
Hegel was superior to the picture of Hegel presented by Stirner. In adopting this
stance Marx also assumed the role of Hegelian advocate. He rescued Hegel from
the simplicities attributed to the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ by Stirner.
Finally, even though divergences separated Stirner and Bauer, Marx’s negation
of Stirner was also an attack on Old Hegelianism and the resurrection of Old
Hegelianism in the Left Hegelianism of Stirner and Bauer. The point of agreement
between Stirner and Bauer was that the Self was supreme, either as critical self-
consciousness or as the Ego without boundaries. In Bauer and Stirner materiality
was evaporated. Marx identified the invisibility of materiality in Bauer and Stirner
as a perpetuation of Old Hegelianism and he denounced both of these men on
this score. Both Bauer and Stirner, regardless of their differences, were Speculative
philosophers.
In order to clearly follow Marx’s strategy of disqualification against Stirner it is
necessary to divide it into two parts: I) Establish Stirner’s dependency upon Hegel;
II) Demonstrate Hegel’s superiority to Stirner.
the Old Time and the New’ is called ‘The Hierarchy’ and it is in this subsection
that Marx’s strategy of proving Stirner’s insufficiency as an interpreter of Hegel is
concentrated.
Attention needs to be directed to the fact that The Ego and Its Own contains refu-
tations of Hegel. Stirner attacked Hegel as one of the originators of Speculative phi-
losophy, which reduced existence to the Idea. Stirner was opposed to Speculative
philosophy because it presented the Idea as the pneumatic force in the universe,
whereas Stirner wished to privilege the ego. The Ego and Its Own was intended as
a nullification of Speculative philosophy and in Marx’s critique of Stirner in ‘The
Leipzig Council’ Marx overlooked this fact.
Furthermore, in the subsection on ‘The Hierarchy’, Stirner advances his idea
that human history has passed through three periods, the Negroid, the Mongolian
and the Caucasian. Stirner advanced a racial interpretation of world history.
Stirner does not allude to Hegel anywhere in his manuscript, and nowhere in The
Ego and Its Own does Stirner acknowledge that he incorporated the three-stage
racial interpretation of world history from Hegel. The writer who claims that
Stirner derived this ethnic historiography from Hegel is Marx.
In the section in ‘The Leipzig Council’ entitled ‘The Impurely Impure History of
Spirit: a) Negroes and Mongols’56 Marx asserted that Stirner borrowed the princi-
ple of ethnic historiography from Hegel’s The Philosophy of History.
In terms of the thesis of the racial genesis of civilizations, Marx referred to
the chapter in Hegel’s The Philosophy of History called ‘The Geographical Basis
of History’.57 In this chapter Hegel divides global history into three eras, the
African or Negro, the Mongolian (the Chinese were included in the Mongolian
race) and the Caucasian, which included Greek, Roman and Germanic. Hegel’s
The Philosophy of History was the source of Stirner’s racial interpretation of global
history.
In this regard it is surprising that Marx did not allude to Hegel’s The Philosophy
of Mind, the third volume of The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences. This
work was published as a part of Hegel’s Collected Works and Marx included The
Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences in the bibliography to his dissertation. In
paragraphs 393 and 394 Hegel set forth a brief description of the various racial
components of the human species and divides the three largest racial groupings
into Negroid, Mongol and Caucasian. Hegel wrote of the Negro race: ‘Negroes
are to be regarded as a race of children who remain immersed in their state of
uninterested naiveté.’58 Stirner had the same view of the Negro and in The Ego
and Its Own he wrote: ‘Negroidity represents antiquity, the time of dependence
on things (on cocks eating, birds flight, on sneezing, on thunder and lightning,
on the rustling of sacred trees and so forth).’59 Regardless of these forays by Hegel
into anthropology, Marx omits any reference to The Philosophy of Mind in ‘The
Leipzig Council’.
Marx’s aim was to show that Stirner copied Hegel. This does not exclude the fact
that Stirner in certain cases descended to the level of misrepresenting Hegel.
Marx’s subdivision ‘The Impurely Pure History of Spirits: a) ‘Negroes and
Mongols’ contains eight ‘historical reflections’. In each of these Marx quotes
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 265
a statement from Stirner and then shows, by referring to the corresponding pas-
sages from Hegel, how Stirner used Hegel as a textbook from which to copy. One
such non-factual replication occurred in the area of attributing morality to the
North Americans and Chinese. On page 63 of The Ego and Its Own, Stirner wrote
that ‘pure moral action, clear, unadulterated morality, is most straitforwardly
practiced in China’.60 In the ‘Fourth Historical Reflection’ Marx again quoted
Stirner as maintaining that ‘pure, moral behavior in the plainest form is practiced
in China’.61
However, in the following paragraph from ‘The Leipzig Council’, Marx demon-
strated that Stirner misinterpreted Hegel. Marx’s refutation of Stirner was intend-
ed not only to prove Stirner’s dependency of Hegel, but also Stirner’s distortion of
Hegel. The paragraph I am referring to reads:
Saint Max is unfortunate in his examples. On page 116 in just the same way
he attributes to the North Americans the ‘religion of uprightness’. He regards
the two most scoundrelly nations on earth, the patriarchal swindlers . . . the
Chinese and the civilized swindlers . . . the Yankees, as ‘plain’, ‘moral’ and
‘upright’. If he looked up his crib he could have found the North Americans
classed as swindlers on page 81 of the Philosophie der Geschichte and the Chinese
ditto on page 130.62
Marx was correct. The Philosophy of History contains the following two paragraphs
relating to the dishonesty of the North Americans and the Chinese.
Contrary to the impression given by Stirner, the references supplied by Marx por-
tray a Hegel in opposition to Stirner, a Hegel who was cognizant of the immorality
of the North Americans and Chinese.
Marx’s ‘The Leipzig Council’ was dedicated to an invalidation of Stirner; on
another occasion Marx illustrates how Stirner set forth an erroneous portrait of
Hegel’s comprehension of Bacon. In The Ego and Its Own Stirner wrote:
On this ground Bacon was turned out of the realm of philosophers. And cer-
tainly what is called English philosophy seems to have got no further than to
the discoveries of so-called clear heads such as Bacon and Hume.65
266 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
It is clear that in this quote Stirner is drawing upon Hegel’s The History of Philosophy.
On page 78 of The Ego and Its Own, Stirner quotes from Hegel’s The Philosophy of
Right that ‘the rational is the actual and what is actual is rational’.66 In addition,
this entire section in The Ego and Its Own is an attack on Hegelian rationalism, an
attempt to show Hegel’s Speculative philosophy as another ecclesiastical form of
domination over the Ego. Stirner wrote in The Ego and Its Own:
This is the religious world to which Hegel gave systematic expression, bring-
ing method into the nonsense, and completing the conceptual precepts into a
rounded, firmly based dogmatic.67
In contradiction to Stirner, Marx in ‘The Leipzig Council’ gives the relevant quote
from Hegel’s The History Of Philosophy, Volume III:
Since Bacon has ever been esteemed as the man who directed knowledge to its
true source, to experience, he is, in part, the special leader and representative
of what is in England called Philosophy, and beyond which the English have
not advanced.68
Contrary to Stirner’s implication, Hegel never claimed that ‘Bacon was turned out
of the realm of philosophers’. Indeed, unlike in Stirner’s denigration of Bacon,
Hegel noted that ‘Bacon has ever been esteemed as the man who directed knowl-
edge to its true source, experience’. Although Hegel was aware of the limits of
Baconian empiricism, Hegel also recognized that knowledge began from sense
perception and credited Bacon with leading a revolution in the history of phi-
losophy.69
As I stated previously, one of Marx’s aims in ‘The Leipzig Council’ was to ‘estab-
lish Stirner’s dependency on Hegel’. The proof of this claim did not exclude the
fact that Stirner frequently misrepresented Hegel, it only showed that Stirner
had a need for recourse to Hegel in either an honest or dishonest fashion. Marx
accused Stirner of plagiarizing Hegel,70 of ignoring the factual depth of Hegel’s
writing on history71 and of a superficial reading of Hegel’s The Philosophy of History
which turned Stirner into a mere imitator of the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’.72
Marx portrayed Stirner as a ‘copier’ of Hegel. Furthermore, Hegel was the ‘crib’
from which Stirner drew his information, honestly or dishonestly. Stirner was
guilty of ‘glancing over’, or in ‘clumsy’ iteration of Hegel’s thought. With these
evaluations of Stirner, Marx wished to characterize Stirner as an Old Hegelian, and
aver that Stirner, although negating Hegel in the areas of Speculative thought, was
still perpetuating Old Hegelianism.
In addition, one of the central points of Marx’s strategy of disqualification was
to document Stirner’s failure to recognize the materialist aspects of Hegel. In this
regard Stirner continued the mission of Bauer. By choice Stirner remained igno-
rant of the historic-materialist aspects of Hegel’s thought and he was then free to
project a Hegel who was prisoner to philosophy. In this area as well Stirner, like
Bauer, was a descendent of Old Hegelianism.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 267
Stirner. The twelve quotes were intended to prove that Hegel was aware of the
nature of cultural hierarchies far in advance of Stirner and that Hegel was the source
from which Stirner borrowed. The intent of the use of these citations was affirmed
by Marx himself when he made this comment in ‘The Leipzig Council’: ‘. . . and
here again we will “include” a brief “historical reflection” on the origin of Stirner’s
“hierarchy”.’76
In addition, Hegel was also the teacher of Marx and this tutorship took two
forms. First, Hegel acquainted Marx with the concept of superstructure. Hegel
taught Marx that every society constructed a system of belief, canonical belief that
not only embodied the values of that society, but also sustained the functioning
of that society.
Second, the last quote that Marx copied from Hegel was from The Philosophy of
History:
In his response to Stirner, Marx set out to show that Hegel was both the source of
Stirner’s ideas and also intellectually the superior to Stirner. In addition, the above
quotes reveal Marx’s relation to Hegel in 1845–1846 and these quotes reveal two
attitudes Marx held toward Hegel at this time.
First, Hegel helped Marx see that Speculative philosophy was the ecclesiastical
dogma of the Left Hegelians, of Bauer and Stirner. This part of Hegelianism, Old
Hegelianism, the part of the Hegelian tradition that embraced Speculative phi-
losophy, was the new ‘Hierarchy’.
Second, that all the advancement of human emancipation required the replace-
ment of philosophy as metaphysics-in-general with critique and praxis. The
overthrow of the re-created Middle Ages could only be achieved through the
substitution of philosophy by praxis.
Not only was ‘The Leipzig Council’ a defense of Hegelian methodology, but it
was also a work in transition. Faintly, merely a presence, concepts such as ‘rela-
tions of production’ and ‘productive forces’ began to surface in Marx’s texts. ‘The
Leipzig Council’ was a signal of the transference of Marx’s major concern away
from philosophy to political economy.
In ‘The Leipzig Council’ the concepts of property, the division of labor, the
relations and mode of production were frequent presences. Increasingly, Marx
became aware that consciousness was partially shaped by the relations of produc-
tion,78 that juridical decisions were the outcome of the division of labor as well
as those who controlled the forces of production,79 that will was not the sole
source of human motivation, but the mode of production also determined human
action, and that the mode of production was the real basis of the state,80 and that
property was not an eternal feature of human history, but rather a projection of
the relations of production.81
Marx’s use of such terms as ‘material forces’, ‘social relations’, ‘modes of produc-
tion’, ‘relations of production’, ‘civil society’ and ‘ideology’ is evidence that by the
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 269
time he wrote ‘The Leipzig Council’, Marx was at the preliminary stage of com-
mencing a study of political economy. Marx already recognized that the system of
political economy as developed by Smith and Ricardo was merely an ‘ideology’ of
the capitalist class and he was at the initial stages of awareness that the proletariat
must be provided with its own form of political economy.
In particular, the phrases ‘relations of production’ and ‘mode of production’ are
conjoined by Marx in the famous 1859 ‘Preface’ to his Critique of Political Economy.
In this ‘Preface’, Marx presented the dialectic of the ‘relations of production’ and
the ‘mode of production’ as the driving force of history, the engine that propelled
human history through its four-stage development – tribal life, antique, feudal
and bourgeois. I am not saying that Marx had arrived at his mature 1859 view of
historical evolution in 1845–1846. I am saying that he had acquired the concep-
tual methodologies in 1845–1846 which later, after his deep immersion in politi-
cal economy, did form the basis of his view of social explanation.
However, the above paragraphs still leave open the question of when and who
precipitated this transformation. At what period did Marx’s materialism become
political economy?
The transition begins in the 1844–1845 time period. Paris and Brussels were the
sites of his transition and the agents that gave rise to Marx’s shift of interest were
List, Ferguson and Steuart. My intent at this point is just to identify the moment
at which Marx began to acquire some of the intellectual building blocks for his
later proletarian system of political economy and not to excavate the deeper
meanings of List, Ferguson and Steuart. This book is about Hegel and Marx and
not about Marx, List, Ferguson or Steuart.
While in Paris Marx read List’s book The National System of Political Economy,
published in 1841, and he and Engels thought that a thorough critique of this
book was required. Both Marx and Engels advocated free trade while List was a
Mercantilist, a defender of protectionist tariffs. Marx was expelled by the French
government in February 1845 and resettled in Brussels. While in the Belgian
capital in March 1845 he outlined an attack on List entitled ‘An Article on
Friedrich List’s book The National System of Political Economy’ which was never
published.82
From the perspective of the present discussion, List was important to Marx’s
development because he drew attention to ‘productive forces’. The central debate
in Marx’s incomplete article concerned the economic priority between ‘exchange
value’ and ‘productive forces’. List favored the ‘productive forces’ and Marx’s
familiarity with List drew Marx’s attention to the importance of ‘productive
forces’.83
Ferguson’s An Essay on the History of Civil Society exerted a tremendous influence
on Marx because it was from Ferguson primarily that Marx first came into contact
with the four-stage theory of historical evolution. It was Ferguson who taught
Marx that social evolution progressed through the social formations of tribalism,
the antique, feudal and bourgeois. In The Philosophy of Mind and The Philosophy
of History Hegel also sketched a four-stage theory of historical development. The
primary voice in alerting Marx to the fact that historicity was a determining factor
270 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
in the course of human existence was Hegel’s. Marx did not learn historicity from
Ferguson, but what he did learn from Ferguson were the actual social formations,
the four basic social morphologies, through which the course of economic evolu-
tion passed.
Danga Vileisis, in an excellent article that opened new horizons in the study
of the Young Marx,84 surmises that Marx purchased a copy of Ferguson’s book
in Paris in the summer of 1844 prior to his departure to Brussels. The document
upon which Vileisis bases her dating is Marx’s Notizbuch 1844–1847 (which is
contained in Mega2, Abteilung IV, Band 3) in which Marx made notations regard-
ing Ferguson’s book. The notation simply states Ferguson’s name, when he pur-
chased Ferguson’s book, but offers no information as to when Marx actually read
the book, although it was before he wrote The Poverty of Philosophy in Brussels
in 1847 because Ferguson is quoted in this manuscript. The Poverty of Philosophy
fulfills the transition initiated in ‘The Leipzig Council’.
By 1847 Marx had realized that classical English political economy, personified
by Smith and Ricardo, was merely an ‘ideology’ of the capitalist class. By 1847
Marx matured into his own self-consciousness and defined his personal mission as
providing the proletariat with a political economy articulating the interests of this
exploited class. In the 1844 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’
Marx stated that the emancipation of the proletariat required a theory, and that
such a theory would provide the proletariat with a weapon that legitimized
the impoverished working class in its struggle against capitalism. In the years
1846–1847, from ‘The Leipzig Council’ to The Poverty of Philosophy, to Marx’s let-
ter to Annenkov and to his 1847 speeches to the German Workers Association in
Brussels, Marx fulfilled the program he initially outlined in his 1844 ‘Critique of
Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’.
The ideas contained in Marx’s 1846 letter to Annenkov, the 1845–1846 ‘The
Leipzig Council’, the 1847 The Poverty of Philosophy and the 1847 lectures to the
German Workers Association in Brussels formed the basis of his 1859 ‘Preface’ to
The Critique of Political Economy. The 1859 ‘Preface’ contained no idea that had not
already been formulated in the above mentioned writings and these writings are
early exercises for this renowned ‘Preface’.
The abovementioned writings indicate that Marx was ready to leave for London
and his studies at the British Museum in 1849. Marx had made his transition to
political economy, had embarked upon his transformation as a theorist for the
proletariat, but needed to acquire expertise in the science of political economy.
Marx’s exile in London, his self-imprisonment in the British Museum, offered him
the time and resources to attain that expertise needed to write Das Kapital.
The main work of the 1845–1847 period of transition was The Poverty of
Philosophy and this book can be conceived as Marx’s farewell to Hegel. By the
phrase farewell to Hegel, I do not mean that Hegel ceases to be a vital influence
on the methodology of Marx. I mean that the center of Marx’s preoccupations
shifts to political economy. The last time that Hegel plays a significant role in
Marx’s thought is in The Poverty of Philosophy, in which Hegel plays a supportive
role to the main character Proudhon. After The Poverty of Philosophy the attacks
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 271
‘It is the absolute method that Hegel speaks in these terms: ‘Method is the
absolute, unique, supreme infinite force, which no object can resist: it is the
tendency of reason to find itself again, to recognize itself in every object.’
(Logic. Vol. III) All things being being reduced to a logical category, and every
272 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
1) Thus, these ideas, these categories, are as little eternal as the relations they
express. They are historical and transitory products. There is a continual
movement of growth in productive forces, of destruction in social rela-
tions, of formation in ideas; the only immutable thing is the abstraction of
movement . . . ‘immortal death hath taken away mortal life’.87
2) Is not this as good as saying that the mode of production, the relations in
which productive forces are developed, are everything but eternal law, but
that they correspond to a definite development of men and their productive
forces, and that a change of these productive forces necessarily brings about
a change in their relations of production.88
Steuart’s An Enquiry into the Principles of Political Economy has a vastly different
purpose than Ferguson’s An Essay on the History of Civil Society. Steuart’s book is
essentially a catechism for good political economic government. Written in the
18th century at the beginning of the capitalist revolution, Steuart’s book is the
political-economic equivalent to Machiavelli’s The Prince. In its pages Steuart
lauds the governance of Lycurgus of Sparta because his understanding of politi-
cal economy created a society of ‘reciprocal obligation’, or an economics of what
Hegel referred to as ‘mutual obligation’. Steuart’s work is not primarily a study of
the laws of economics in the genre of Smith and Ricardo, but rather a study of
how the correct manipulation of economics serves as the basis of political recon-
ciliation. From this perspective Steuart himself was an 18th-century Lycurgus of
political economy.95
This Scottish Lycurgus looked upon Sparta as a social model to be emulated.
Private property existed in Sparta, so it was not communist, and inequality existed
in Sparta so it did not meet the Rousseau–Proudhon ideal of complete equality.
The historical Lycurgus of Sparta supervised the economy so it produced a society
of equivalence, of economic balance, which served to encourage social coop-
eration and, in the words of Hegel, ‘mutual recognition’. Steuart’s research was
clearly driven by moral aspirations.
Regardless of his moral goals, Steuart was aware of the historicity of social for-
mations. Steuart’s work outlined the evolution of social formations from agricul-
ture to capitalism and in this regard replicated the insights of Ferguson.
An Enquiry into the Principles of Political Economy described the evolution of
European social formations from agriculture to the 18th-century commercial rev-
olution. Abetting this economic transformation was the advancement of industry
and the growth of population. Barter and handicrafts were supplanted by inter-
national trade and factories. The greater productivity of industry meant that more
needs could be satisfied, more wants gratified but, concomitantly, self-interest and
the love of luxury emerged as engines of decay.96
For the Lycurgus of political economy the remedy for decay entailed the return
to the morality of Sparta, the resurrection of the catechism of ‘reciprocal obliga-
tion’.97 Capitalism had produced the multiplication of wants,98 the sanctioning of
self-indulgence, and to Steuart the only escape from the threat of moral decline
was the renewal of the ethics of the antique world.
In the section entitled ‘Seventh and Last Observation’ Marx is already employ-
ing concepts which were to become the architecture of his Method of social
explanation brought to fruition in Das Kapital. Central to his Method of social
explanation was his jettisoning of the eternal economic laws of Smith and Ricardo
and his awareness that historical ‘relations of . . . production’99 were the decisive
factors in social evolution. By 1847 Marx not only thought in terms of ‘relations
of production’ but also of the ‘mode of production’100 and he was also aware that
he had to develop a ‘method’101 of social analysis.
Later in The Poverty of Philosophy, in the section entitled ‘Division of Labor’,
Marx commented on the work of Ferguson.102 He also observed that ‘a social
276 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Thus the social relations within which individuals produce, the social relations
of production change, are transformed, with the change and development of
the material means of production, the productive forces. The relations of pro-
duction in their totality constitute what are called the social relations, society,
and, specifically, a society at a definite stage of historical development, a society
with a peculiar distinctive character. Ancient society, feudal society, bourgeois
society are such totalities of production relations, each of which at the same
time denoted a special stage of development in the history of mankind.109
I present the 1859 ‘Preface’ as Marx’s clearest abbreviation of the theory of his-
torical explanation. Based on the data I have presented in my discussion of The
Poverty of Philosophy, the Letter to Annenkov and his 1847 lectures I take the 1859
‘Preface’ as a copy, a replication, of the general principles contained in the works
of 1845–1847.
From the point of view of interpretation Marx was equipped to move on to the
Second Period, 1848–1883, of his appropriation of ‘The Master’ and in this second
period he would apply these methodologies as interpretative devices by which to
understand the functioning of social formations. This is the Marx of Das Kapital,
using the application of Hegelian methodologies as a means to grasp the history
and functioning of capitalism.
The Works of Hegel that Marx Knew: Phase Six 277
A major theme of Marx’s Discourse with Hegel concerned the distinction Marx drew
between the System and Method of Hegel. I defend the thesis that whereas Marx
negated the System he appropriated the Method.
Marx associated the Hegelian System with Speculative philosophy. When Marx
attacked Hegelian philosophy as ‘logical pantheism’ he meant both Hegelian
Idealism and System. The Hegelian System was deficient because it was entrapped
in the limitations of Speculative philosophy, that is, Hegel sought to explain the
total phenomenon of human creativity as essentially projections of mind. In his
‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’ Marx referred to The
Phenomenology of Spirit as Hegel’s greatest work, but claimed that the final chap-
ter, ‘Absolute Knowledge’, summarized Hegel’s vast achievements.1 The ‘Absolute
Knowledge’ chapter was the epitome of Hegelian Speculative philosophy.
This present chapter does not deal with the problematic of methodology, but
rather with the topic of subjective activity. I have a strategic goal in shifting the
focus of ‘Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel’ to the question of subjective activity and
the purpose is to present the reader with a full overview of Marx’s relation to
Hegel. Although Marx appropriated Hegelian methodology he evaded the theme
of subjective activity in ‘The Master’. In order to be in a position to make a well-
informed evaluation of the intellectual interchange between these two giants it is
necessary to have recourse to all the factual evidence.
By the terms subjective activity and materio-practice, which I use interchange-
ably in this chapter, I mean those aspects of Hegel’s writings in which he detailed
the metabolism between the human species and nature. Hegel possessed substan-
tial knowledge of the empirical, anthropological, psychological and subjective
activities of humanity. Empirically, Hegel agreed that sense perception was the
origin of mind, anthropologically Hegel recognized the evolution of the species
from hunters to the imperialistic lords of the globe, psychologically he was con-
vinced that the human mind developed from drive, urge, instinct to rational self-
consciousness, and in terms of subjective action Hegel was cognizant that human
work and labor was the source of economic productivity. Marx’s mis-reading of
Hegel stemmed from the fact that he remained blind to the materio-practical
aspects of Hegelian philosophy.2
278
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 279
Subjective activity
The book of Aristotle on the Soul, along with his discussion on its special
aspects and states, are for this reason still by far the most admirable, perhaps
even the sole, work of philosophical value on this topic.5
In De Anima (‘On the Soul’) Aristotle describes the soul as the ‘actualization of a
body’.6 The soul is the essence of a body, or it is the energy that sustains the body.
In order to survive the body must eat, receive sensations and think, and the soul
is the dynamic that propels the body to perform all these functions. Aristotle’s
definition of the soul is a naturalistic one and he divides the operations of the soul
into four parts, ‘by the powers of self-nutrition, sensation, thinking and motivity’7
and in The Philosophy of Mind Hegel copies Aristotle’s paradigm. Although in
greater detail and with the purpose of grafting his concept of Spirit onto Aristotle’s
characterization of soul, Hegel’s enumeration of the phylogeny of Absolute Spirit
in The Philosophy of Mind copies in broad outline Aristotle’s model.
It is important to note that Hegel’s reference to Aristotle’s ‘On The Soul’ in
The Philosophy of Mind is not his only allusion to this manuscript. Hegel’s discus-
sion of Aristotle in Volume II of his The History of Philosophy and the third divi-
sion of ‘The Philosophy of Aristotle’ is entitled ‘The Philosophy of Mind’ and
this division is almost totally devoted to a summary of ‘On the Soul’. The title
Hegel assigned to this subdivision, ‘The Philosophy of Mind’, is exactly the same
title Hegel assigned to the third volume of The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical
Sciences. Hegel’s description of mind in the section ‘The Philosophy of Mind’,
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 281
After Aristotle the scientist who exerted the greatest impact on Hegel was the
Frenchman Georges Cuvier. A zoologist, Cuvier was the originator of comparative
anatomy. Hegel depicted Cuvier’s genius in the following words:
Hegel’s reading of Aristotle, zoology, his familiarity with Goethe’s study of plants,
his knowledge of Schultz, Linnaeus, Lamarck, Jussieu, Treviranus and particularly
Cuvier formed the basis of his interpretation of the organic world. From his immer-
sion into the organic world Hegel embraced the theory of comparative anatomy
which then acted as the inspiration for his methodology of explanation.
Comparative anatomy persuaded Hegel that the study of universal types was
the best method by which to understand the sciences. As a means of explicating
the meaning of a universal type Hegel reverted to the language of Cuvier:
Every organized creature forms a whole, a unified and closed system, all the
parts of which mutually correspond, and by reciprocal action on one another
contribute to the same purposive action. None of these parts can alter with-
out the others altering too, and consequently each of them, takes in its own,
suggests and gives all the others.14
Hegel’s view of the natural world provided him with a model, the dissection of
socio-historico-philosophical actualities onto organic units of whole and parts,
that he applied to historic-philosophical analysis.
Hegel’s study of the organic world also provided him with a theory of production.
At the phylogenetic level of ‘Organics’ Hegel’s paradigm of production only related
to the animal world.
In the animal world the preservation of life unfolded in the opposition between
the organic and the inorganic. In order to survive the organic portion of nature
seized the inorganic portion and sublated, or turned the inorganic into material it
could digest.15 Whereas the inorganic was the object the organic was the subject.
Hegel called this seizure of the inorganic ‘digestion’, or ‘assimilation’,16 but syno-
nyms for ‘digestion’ and ‘assimilation’ are consumption and appropriation. Hegel
was aware that in order to complete this consumption and appropriation the
organic must turn itself against the inorganic, the organic must become ‘actively
hostile to the non-organic’.17
The productive model outlined at the level of the organic was not as advanced
as the one contained in The Phenomenology of Spirit. In The Philosophy of Nature the
‘Parmenides of Berlin’ wrote only of the stage of consumption. But he did grasp
the metabolic relation between the organic and the inorganic. He did appreciate
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 283
that the natural subject must be active, that its activity must be directed outside
itself in order to acquire the necessities of existence.
The model of animal activity that Hegel outlined in the ‘Organics’ section of
The Philosophy of Nature became the model for his paradigm of self-conscious
subjective production in The Phenomenology of Spirit.
The ascent to Absolute Spirit begins with the particularization of an ‘I’. The history
of the Self is also developmental ascent and this ascent can only commence when
the animal is transcended. The phenomenology of the Self can only appear when
subjectivity presents itself and this stage is only reached when the evolutionary
process is liberated from nature.
The origination of the subject requires a materialist foundation. Hegel was aware
that subjectivity was a response to materialist surroundings. The first level of Spirit
was subjectivity and subjectivity itself was a configuration of geographical, racial,
cultural and political factors. According to Hegel’s The History of Philosophy, The
Philosophy of History, The Philosophy of Art and The Philosophy of Religion subjectiv-
ity made its appearance in Greece, and in order to account for the qualities of
subjectivity Hegel set forth the materialist precondition of subjectivity.
In The Philosophy of Mind Hegel depicts geography as one of the determinants
of subjectivity. In paragraph 392 of this work Hegel wrote:
While still a substance (i.e. a physical soul) the mind takes part in the general
planetary life, feels the difference of climate, the changes of the seasons, and
the periods of the days, etc.18
The references to geography are brief in The Philosophy of Nature and it was in The
Philosophy of History that Hegel put forth a fuller description of how geography
contributes to the development of human culture. In the ‘Introduction’ to The
Philosophy of History he included a subdivision entitled ‘Geographical Basis of
History’ and there declared his awareness of the materialist basis of subjective
activity and the politico-cultural world:
. . . the natural connection that helps to produce the Spirit of a People appears
an intrinsic element; but in as much as we must regard it as the ground on
which that Spirit plays its part, it is an essential and necessary basis.19
Hegel begins his geographical description of the earth by dividing the globe into
Frigid, Torrid and Temperate Zones. The severity of cold and heat in the Frigid
and Torrid Zones proved to be insurmountable barriers to the advancement of the
human species in these areas and consequently it was only in the Temperate Zone
that civilization began. Hegel divided the Temperate Zone into two parts, the
New World, the Western Hemisphere and the Old World, stretching from China
to the Mediterranean. Hegel divided the Old World into three geographic typolo-
gies, The Elevated Land, The Valley Plains and the Coastal Land.
The Elevated Land spanned the lands from the Caspian Sea to the Black Sea and
this geography was the condition that supported Genghis Khan and Tamerlane.
284 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
The Valley Plains were the Indus and Ganges in India, the Tigris–Euphrates in
Babylonia and the Nile in Egypt. The Valley Plains were the geographical supports
for the beginning of human civilization. The Coastal Lands were also those earth-
ly regions that enjoyed access to the seas and in this regard the Mediterranean was
crucial. The Old World, Southern Europe, Greece and Italy enjoyed the benefits
offered by the Mediterranean Sea because it permitted them to come into contact
with North Africa and Spain. The Mediterranean was a geographical blessing to
Greece and Italy because it opened the possibilities of communication and trade
with lands far from their centers, Athens and Rome. Geography was a primary
reason for the cultural greatness of Greece and the Athenian invention of subjec-
tivity. The natural environment was one of the factors that gave rise to the culture
of subjectivity.20
Into the geographical domains Hegel inserted what he referred to as ‘races’, and
in order to follow his genealogy of ‘races’ it is necessary to leave The Philosophy of
History and turn to the subsection on ‘Anthropology’ in The Philosophy of Mind. In
paragraph 393 Hegel listed five distinct ‘races’, Negro, Mongol, Asiatic, Caucasian
and the natives of the New World. However, he divided the Caucasians into two
parts, the Western Asians and the Europeans. Each of these ‘races’ inhabited
a specific geographical location: the Negro ‘race’ was situated in sub-Saharan
Africa, the Mongol ‘race’ in the elevated lands of Middle Asia, the Asiatic peoples
in China, India and Central Asia, the Natives in North and South America, the
Western Asians were composed of Islamic peoples and the Europeans, particularly
the Athenians and Romans in which the philosophy of the subjective activity was
born.21
Each of these ‘races’ displayed specific intellectual abilities. A child of his time,
mirroring the ideas of anthropological science in the early 19th century, Hegel
judged the Negro as ‘childish’, the Mongol as impetuous, the Asiatic as sunken in
nature, the aborigines of the New World as inferior, the Islamic peoples as cling-
ing to the ‘limited principle’ the Jews attributed to God as the ‘Abstract One’, and
the Europeans as those who first gave recognition to the development of Spirit.22
In The Philosophy of Mind Hegel displayed a more refined understanding of eth-
nological groups and passed from the ‘racial’ to the national. Hegel’s ethnology
began with five global ‘races’, but The Philosophy of Mind advanced to a discus-
sion of ‘local minds’23 by which Hegel meant the various national minds within
the European demography. In particular, he singled out the national mind of
the ancient Athenians, who, abetted by their geography, racial composition and
political structure, were the discoverers of subjective activity.24 The national mind
of the Italians was characterized by a feminine attribute and this culture glorified
the beauty of the female.25 The French national mind was noted for the acuteness
of its intellect and in the political sphere the French because of their revolution
engendered a new political age in Europe. The English national mind devoted itself
to empirical research, its politics emphasized individuality and political economy
was also a product of the English type of self-consciousness. The Germans were
the nation of inwardness and Speculative philosophy was an invention of the
German type of self-consciousness.26 Hegel’s depiction of French, English and
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 285
and that it must relate to these subjective Others. The ‘I’ learns to define itself as
an intersubjective being, its ‘I’-ness is a reflection of the multiplicity of ‘I’s.
The second stage in the odyssey of subjectivity is the attainment of a will. The
will is the prius of the subject, it is the determining energy of the subject. To
extinguish the will is to extinguish the subject. The anatomical expression of the
will is instinct and desire. Will is the basis of freedom. In order for a subject to be
free it must be allowed to express its will.
The third stage in the odyssey of the subject is practical mind. A difference exists
between theoretical and practical mind for whereas theoretical mind is absorbed
in thought, the inner, practical mind concentrates on the external. Practical mind
relates to the subject’s involvement with the material, external world. Whereas
the will is defined as end or purpose, practical mind is the instrumentality of
the will.
The power of determination by practical mind brings subjectivity to the domain
of labor, or work. In Hegel labor was a property of the subject, or the subject
labored in order to determine a material environment that sustained the life of
the subject. Activity was inherent in the subject, or an immanent quality of the
subject was activity.29
The laboring subject plays a predominant role in Hegelian philosophy because it
is the seed of his vision of family and civil society. The vision of ‘The Master’ of civil
society is constructed upon the paradigm of a laboring subject who is compelled
into sociability because of its need to provide for sustenance and survival and this
imposed sociability is the sinew of the social and eventually the political. Hegel’s
theory of the state finds its origins in subjective activity and the materio-practical.
Since my main purpose in discussing the Hegelian materio-practical was to
document the importance of the empirical world in Hegel’s Speculative philoso-
phy I will end my analysis on this issue at this point. Even though I did not isolate
every dimension of the materio-practical in Hegel, I feel that I did illuminate the
importance that sentience played in Hegel’s view of the evolution of the subject.
In order to reach the rational it was necessary to turn to mind’s determinative
abilities. Truth was a result of the faculties of mind, but the starting point of
Speculative thought was the materio-practical and subjective activity.
The conclusions that I made regarding Marx’s ignoring subjective activity in Hegel
are also valid in regard to the ethical nature of the state. Just as Marx was blind
to the materio-practical in Hegel so he evaded the ethical nature of Hegel’s theory
of the state. Just as Marx viewed Hegel’s philosophy of nature as a projection of
‘logical pantheism’ so he perceived Hegel’s political philosophy as an expression
of ‘logical pantheism’.
The ethical for Hegel was a result of the union of the universal and particular,
or the action of an individual must reflect the end of the universality, or com-
munity. Hegelian ethics disavowed Kantian ethics, for whereas the prophet of
Königsberg understood ethical acts as an adherence to universal legal principles,
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 287
1) Will was the foundation of individuality. Will was the Self’s self-identity. As the
foundation of a personhood will was the inception of subjective activity.
2) Personhood needed to be created and it was brought into existence when will
took possession of the body. Personhood was the result of the act of occupancy,
the will claiming possession of the body.
3) Right was an entitlement of personhood. Right was the license for the Self’s
expression of its activities. Right was the basis of the freedom of the subject.
Hegel’s advocacy of right did not mean he believed in the theory of natural
rights. Natural right theory proposed that nature endowed all of humanity with
certain rights. Hegel’s approach to rights was psychological as opposed to meta-
physical. A right was due to the Self so that the Self was free to express its individ-
uality. For Hegel right belonged to individual psychology and not to natural law.
The title of Hegel’s foray into political theory, The Philosophy of Right, describes
his intellectual intent. The primary purpose of The Philosophy of Right was not the
design of the structure of a state constitution, but rather how best to protect free-
dom of the will. Displaying his understanding of historicity, Hegel was aware that
the protection of individual rights varied in terms of the historical conditions in
which a Selfhood found itself, but the goal of the philosophy of the political was
the defense of individual subjective activity.
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 289
4) Freedom meant the guarantee for right to be expressed. If right was to be actual-
ized, if it were to enter the external world, freedom must exist; freedom was the
necessary passageway for the realization of right.
6) Mutual recognition and intersubjectivity. As the will penetrated into the exter-
nal world, as it acquired possessions, it also discovered the Other. This discovery
of the ‘Other’ was the process of mutual recognition and intersubjectivity. As
the will as a singular Ego announced itself into the external world it invariably
collided with the will of the ‘Other’ and this collision was mutual recognition and
intersubjectivity.
7) Morality was the result of this learning process. Morality was the application
of reciprocity, it was the granting of the same rights to the ‘Other’ that the Self
claimed for itself. Morality was thus a stage in the developmental process leading
to the state and it was the grade at which mutuality was accepted as the safeguard
of right and freedom. Right and freedom could not exist without the recogniz-
ing of the rights of the ‘Other’, otherwise the relation between Selfs would capitu-
late to Thomas Hobbes and the war of all against all.
8) Sociability. The historicity of ethicality and the state advances through the
grade of sociability. In the phylogeny of ethics the awareness of human sociability
is a necessary prelude to society.
Sociability was the result of mutual recognition and intersubjectivity. Sociability
was the outgrowth of the acceptance that the Other possessed rights.
Hegel was not Feuerbach; Feuerbach maintained that humankind was inherently
social. For Feuerbach the species as social being was an anthropological ontology.
Feuerbach did not need to account for morality or ethicality because he postulated
the inherent social being of humankind and this inherent social being in itself
contained the love of the Other. The ontology of social being in Feuerbach, love as
the natural condition of the species, obviated any need to put forth ethics.
9) Ethicality. The family, springing out of marriage, was the training ground
out of which the social proceeded. The family was the primary learning process
290 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
11) The state. The consummation of the historicity of ethicality was the state.
Beginning with will, ethicality progressed through an ascending series of stages
and the ultimate actualization of the ethical was the state. In paragraph 257 of The
Philosophy of Right Hegel wrote: ‘The state is the actuality of the ethical Idea.’35 The
purpose of the state was to protect right and ethical behavior and in the fulfill-
ment of these goals the state also rose to an ethical organism.
Just as ethicality was a historical product so the forms of state were also histori-
cal products. States were reflections of the historical stage in which they arose,
they mirrored the evolutionary grade in which they were formed.
Hegel articulated the historicity of the state in his Zusatz to paragraph 273 in
The Philosophy of Right:
in other words this free maturation in course of which the Idea realizing ration-
ality in the external, releases its moments (and they are only its moments) from
itself as totalities, and just for that reason still retains them in the ideal unity
of the concept . . . the history of this genuine formation of ethical life is the
content of the whole course of world history.36
The purpose of The Philosophy of Right was not to outline the historicity of the
state, but rather to map the progressivity of the ethical. Nevertheless, the pages of
The Philosophy of Right are rife with comments, although condensed, about vari-
ous state forms that were exhibited in history. In particular, paragraphs 273 to
279 contain perceptive observations on the varieties of state forms that surfaced
in the course of time.
Hegel’s regard for subjective activity required him to discourse on ethics.
Subjective activity was the source of historical creativity; the dynamic of the
modifications of the external found its origins in the materio-practical. But
subjective activity must accept interdependence. Its own knowledge of itself
was a result of its negation of an Other. Ethics were necessary to the Hegelian
System because the System was based on the mutual interaction of independent
subjects.
Rather than draw his inspiration from the theory of natural rights and the
Enlightenment, which he rejected because of their excessive concentration on indi-
vidualism, Hegel drew his political spirit from Plato and Aristotle. Hegel’s approach
to Plato and Aristotle comprised areas of refutation and areas of affirmation.
In relation to Plato, specifically The Republic, Hegel refuted the Platonic idea of
communism. As I previously noted, Hegel considered private property as an indis-
pensible safeguard of individuality. In the area of refutation Hegel also rejected
the Platonic idea of the destruction of the family. Hegel considered the family as
an educational prelude to civil society.
The domain of subjectivity was a perplexing issue for Hegel. On the one
hand he defended the Ego because the Self represented the beginning of Spirit.
Individualism, Luther, were a historic product of the Germanic World. On the
other hand, Hegel denounced excessive egoism on the grounds that total obedi-
ence to self-gratification was destructive. In the area of refutation Hegel attacked
Plato’s complete negation of subjectivity. One of the faults of The Republic, in his
view, was its complete erasure of personality.37
Relating to Aristotle, the area of refutation lay in his tripartite typology of
governments into democracy, aristocracy and monarchy. In his refutation of this
Aristotelian typology Hegel made a profound comment:
. . . for us, respecting the inward elements of a state, and a description of its
various constitutions . . . the latter, however, has no longer the same interest,
on account of the different principles at the base of the ancient and modern
states . . . but the Greeks were still unacquainted with the abstract right of our
modern states, that isolates the individual, allows of his acting as such, and yet
as an invisible spirit, holds all its parts together.38
292 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
In the above paragraph Hegel not only claimed that Aristotle’s typology of
democracy–aristocracy–monarchy no longer carried any historical relevance,
but that the this atavism was caused by the socio-economic changes within
civil society. He advanced the idea that sociological forces determined political
philosophy. The changes in socio-economic forces operative in civil society were
not only the basic propellants of historical evolution, but were also the substruc-
ture of the theories of the state.
In the area of affirmation Hegel adopted the Platonic and Aristotelian principle
that universality took precedence over personhood. The Platonic and Aristotelian
visions of the state embodied the ethical because both upheld the privileges of the
universal over the Ego. Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right was an attempt to resurrect
the Greek ethical vision of the state within the social conditions of the German
restoration. Community must limit the self-indulgence of personhood.
Hegel was a critic of the abstract subjectivity unleashed by the Enlightenment.
He condemned excessive individuality because ‘it proved itself to be what had
wrought ruin to Greece’.39 Abstract subjectivity was also the cause of some of the
malignancies of pan-European society. Borrowing from Rousseau, Hegel was of the
opinion that abstract subjectivity de-politicized the members of the state: ‘. . . in
modern times the individual is only free for himself as such, and enjoys citizen
freedom alone . . . in the sense that of a bourgeois and not a citizen.’40 In this
sentence Hegel drew attention to the de-politicization of the constituents of the
state due to their total fixation on their private interests. Whereas the member of
the Athenian polis was a citizen, was an active political participant, the member
of modern European society was amputated into a bourgeois who was severed
from political life and addicted to self-aggrandizement. Hegel drew a distinction
between the Self and the citizen.
Hegel sought to resurrect modern political life through a rebirth of the polis ideal
within the content of 19th-century European society. The polis ideal was built on
an organic principle, the sublimation of the individual into the universal. The
linking of the individual and the community, the recreation of the conditions by
which the individual could again assume the practice of politics, would subsume
abstract subjectivity into the universal and such a subsumption was the condition
of ethicality. The Philosophy of Right was a 19th-century version of the ethics and
the polis definition of citizenship as the active participation in the affairs of the
community.
Preoccupied with the ‘logical pantheism’ of Hegel, Marx remained blind to the
Hegelian enterprise of reconstructing Athens under the political-economic condi-
tions of Germany in the 1820s. It is obvious that Marx read the entirety of The
Philosophy of Right including the early chapters dealing with the issues of right,
will, individuality, property and freedom. He was familiar with Hegel’s thinking
on these problems relating to practical philosophy and ethics and made the deci-
sion to ignore them and limit his interpretation to the question of the state. In
order to document beyond question that Marx was familiar with Hegel’s presenta-
tion of the historicity of ethicality I will single out citations from On the Difference
between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature and the ‘Critique of
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 293
In this sentence Marx inserted a footnote and the footnote reads: ‘G. E. Hegel,
System der Philosophy. Dritter Teil. “Die Philosophie des Geistes” paragraph
552.’42 The paragraph that Marx refers to appears in the third volume of The
Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, The Philosophy of Mind. Section II of
The Philosophy of Mind is entitled ‘Mind Objective’, and it contains a subsec-
tion called ‘The Moral Life, or Social Ethics’. Paragraph 552 not only shows
‘The Master’ as a student of Plato, asserting the superiority of universality
over particularity, the community over subjective wantonness, but also briefly
comments on the reciprocity between religion and philosophy and how the
state receives the sanction of the religio-philosophical. Marx completed his
dissertation in 1841, two years before writing his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy
of Right’ and by 1841 Marx was in contact with Hegel’s convictions regarding
ethics and politics.
In addition, the 1843 ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’43 Marx made
note of paragraph 12 in The Philosophy of Right. Paragraph 12 is located in the
‘Introduction’ to The Philosophy of Right and in itself is a part of Hegel’s discussion
of will. This citation to paragraph 12 is definitive regarding Marx’s knowledge of
Hegel’s theory of will, but it also confirms that Marx read the entire ‘Introduction’
which summarizes the thinking of ‘The Master’ on the evolution of ethicality
from will to personhood to right to property and to civil society. Marx’s knowl-
edge of the ‘Introduction’ informed him that Hegel’s The Philosophy of Right was
basically an exposition on ethics and that the state was one form, although the
highest form, of ethical realization.
Furthermore, the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ mentions paragraphs
65 and 66.44 These paragraphs appear in the First Part of The Philosophy of Right,
‘Abstract Right’. They occur in division one of ‘Abstract Right’, the division given
over to a discussion of ‘Property’; the ‘Property’ division is itself subdivided into
three parts, ‘Taking Possession,’ ‘Use of the Thing,’ and ‘Alienation of Property’,
and paragraphs 65 and 66 are in the part on ‘Alienation of Property’.
The fact that Marx singled out these paragraphs verifies that he was acquainted
with the complete section on ‘Abstract Right’ and consequently he was knowl-
edgeable regarding Hegel’s view of the practical activity of will as it moved from
establishing personality to the acquisition of property and its realization of the
294 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
But it is also an existent as an embodiment of the will, and from this point
of view the ‘other’ for which it exists can only be the will of another person.
This relation of will to will is the true and proper ground on which freedom
can exist.46
These two sentences are a condensation of the phylogeny of the ethical in the
Parmenides of Berlin. It began with will, calls attention to intersubjectivity and
realizes that it is only through mutual respect of individuality that freedom is
guaranteed. Freedom is a constituent of Hegelian ethics because only in freedom
can a will actualize itself and this actualization is a right that must be reciprocated
by an ‘Other’.
All three references certify beyond doubt that Marx was aware of the ethi-
cal theory of Hegel, but he made a conscious decision to overlook it and so he
remained blind to the ethical content of the Hegelian state. Marx chose to regard
‘logical pantheism’ as the substance of Hegelian Speculative philosophy and so
he totally undervalued the importance of materio-practical philosophy in Hegel.
Marx disabled the Hegelian subject. For Hegel ethics was an emanation from
materio-practical activity, the will taking control of personality, and when Marx
devalued the materio-practical he also crippled the importance of subjectivity
activity in Hegel. In Marx’s interpretation of Hegel the subject, for the most part,
did not act, materio-practical intervention into the external did not take place and
the source of intervention into reality was omitted by Speculative logic.
Marx’s insistence on seeing The Philosophy of Right as an extension of Hegel’s
The Science of Logic is made explicitly clear in his ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy
of Right’ in which he repeatedly draws this association. To prove this point I will
list four short quotes from the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ in which
Marx comments on the Hegelian idea of the state:
2) With the exclusion of these concrete determinations, which can just as well
be exchanged for those of another sphere such as physics which has other
concrete determinations, and which are accordingly unessential, we have
before us a chapter from the Logic.48
3) Hegel’s true interest is not the philosophy of right, but logic. The philosoph-
ical task is not the embodiment of thought in Determinate political realities,
Marx’s Mis-reading of Hegel 295
4) Hegel gives his logic a political body; he does not give the logic of the
political body.50
Even though this section, ‘The Ethical Nature of the State’, was primarily devoted to
Marx’s neglect of the ethical content of the political philosophy of ‘The Master’ this
is the place to re-affirm that in 1843 Marx still looked upon Hegel as a constitution-
al monarchist. In the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ Marx identified Hegel
as a constitutional monarchist and two quotes from the text itself prove this:
************
The invisible Hegel made his appearance in the 1836–1848 writings of Marx.
The disappearance of the Hegel who wrote extensively on subjective activity
and the materio-practical took place during Marx’s First Appropriation of Hegel.
Marx was conscious that the proper ‘method of criticizing’ was indebted ‘to the
Hegelian philosophy as a whole and especially to the Hegelian dialectic’53 and
‘that it was now time to grasp the positive aspects of the Hegelian dialectic’,54 but,
nevertheless, in the final analysis Marx cloaked the subjective activity and the
materio-practical aspects of Hegel in invisibility.
During his First Appropriation of Hegel Marx summarized the ‘Parmenides of
Berlin’ as the epitome of Speculative philosophy. According to Marx, Hegel’s The
Science of Logic was the point of origination for all the post-1807 writings of ‘The
Master’. For example, Marx looked upon The Philosophy of Right as a predication of
The Science of Logic55 and Marx also concluded that Hegel’s Speculative philosophy
was also the founding presupposition for all of Hegel’s post-1806 authorship.
Uninformed of the writing of Michelet, Rosenkranz, Bayrhoffer and Hinrichs,
Marx remained blind to the importance of subjectivity in Hegel. Distorting Hegel,
Marx believed that the true subject was the Idea.
Marx remained a prisoner to the distortion of Hegel as a Speculative philosopher
and this blindness first became apparent in the 1841 exzerpte when he wrote that
Hegel believed that the ‘Idea was Subject’ and that ‘The real subjects are reduced
to empty words’.56 Marx wrote this exzerpte in 1841 approximately two years
before he wrote the ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’ and the exzerpte was
the first articulation of the vision of Hegel contained in the ‘Critique of Hegel’s
Philosophy of Right.’ Furthermore, the misperception to which he fell victim in
296 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
the exzerpte, when Hegel was an invisibility, was the myopia that inflicted Marx
throughout his entire life.
It is necessary to pursue two lines of investigation into the question of Hegel
and political ethics in order to properly grasp Marx’s comprehension of this issue:
1) Marx’s myopia; 2) The continuation of the polis ideal.
1) Marx’s myopia
Marx totally ignored the role of the ethical in Hegel and therefore distorted his
presentation of ‘The Master’. The disappearance of Hegel is most apparent in
Marx’s refusal to deal with the ethical dimensions of Hegelian thought, particu-
larly in the area of political philosophy.
For Hegel, however, the journey back to Aristotle and the polis was through
ethics; Hegel saw ethics as the most effective means to re-establish the unity of
zoon oikonikon and zoon politikon. The state as an ethical organism was the only
possible instrument in the 19th century to reconstruct man as the oneness of the
private and public.
For Hegel the links that would reconnect the private and public were mutual
recognition and the reciprocal nature of need. Although Hegel defended private
property and capitalism he hoped that an ethic based on mutual recognition and
the reciprocity of need would provide the ethical canons for social cooperation.
Another source of Marx’s mis-reading of Hegel was that Marx allowed Hegelian
political ethics to fall into a black hole. Marx’s mis-reading of Hegel arose because
he allowed for an Invisible Hegel. When Marx permitted the disappearance of
aspects of The Master’s philosophy he created the conditions for his own distorted
reading of Hegel.
The fact that Marx distorted Hegel is no reason for modern students to dis-
tort Marx. Aristotle was a presence in Marx’s wish for the extinction of private
property. Marx’s theory presupposed that the end of capitalism would render
Aristotelian ethics an actuality.58
Communism, for Marx, was not economic egalitarianism. Communism, for
Marx, was based on the principles of the reciprocity of needs and how this reci-
procity laid the foundation for mutual recognition. Private property was the basic
deterrence to mutual recognition and when this deterrence was eliminated the
reciprocity of need would act as the breeding ground for the re-unification of
homme and citoyen.59
Chapter Five
Marx’s Method
In Marx’s January 24, 1873 – ten years before his death – ‘Postface’ to the Second
Edition of Das Kapital, he wrote:
Marx did exactly what this statement said should be done with Hegelian thought.
This statement is a guide to how Marx used Hegelian philosophy.
I take these three sentences as Marx’s self-declaration that he discontinued the
Hegelian System, but continued the Hegelian methodology. Marx states that in
his relationship with Hegel he repudiated the ‘mystical shell’, or Speculative phi-
losophy. He then confirms that his continuity with Hegel was the maintenance of
the ‘rational kernel’, its methodology. He self-confesses that he ‘inverted’ Hegel,
moved its main principles from thought to a methodology by which to compre-
hend social formations. Marx understood his relation to ‘The Master’ perfectly
and in Das Kapital he fulfilled his mission of demonstrating how the ‘rational
kernel’ was a methodology of social explanation.
In order to definitively understand Marx’s use of Hegelian methodology it is
first necessary to grasp the revolution Hegel effected upon traditional Western
logic. Hegel initiated a dual revolution and I will now indicate how these recon-
structions formed the basis of Marx’s methodology of social explanation.
In Volume One, ‘Logic,’ of The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Hegel
rejected four previous schools of philosophy and logic; metaphysics, empiricism,
critical philosophy and intuition.
Metaphysics, the belief that the external, the thing-in-itself, could be known,
spanned Western philosophy from Plato through medieval Scholasticism to the
mathematical ruminations of Isaac Newton and Descartes. Metaphysics asserted
the existence of an eternal substance, be it Idea, God or Physics, and affirmed
mind’s ability to know these substances. Metaphysics was static, ahistorical, devoid
298
Marx’s Method 299
of Locke and Hume,11 French materialism of the 17th and 18th centuries, culmi-
nating in German 18th and 19th-century philosophy, which was the breeding
ground of Kant’s critical philosophy as an emancipation from metaphysics, thus
setting the stage for the thought of Speculative philosophy.
The history of philosophy rested upon the notion of organic units. Each of
these systems of thought, Greco-Roman, Medieval and Modern-Germanic, were
organic structures composed in terms of biological entities. In the ‘Preface’ to The
Phenomenology of Spirit, Hegel refers to the history of philosophy as a museum of
‘shapes’, ‘forms’, meaning that the Greco-Roman, Medieval and Modern-Germanic
were configurations produced by thought in its drive to unify subject and object in
terms of the time-zone in which it was located.12
Further proof of Hegel’s adoption of the organic Method of explanation is found
in the chapter on ‘Reason’ in The Phenomenology of Spirit. In a subsection ‘Observing
Reason’, Hegel as early as 1806 looked upon holistic explanation as putting forth
the most accurate account of nature. The Phenomenology of Spirit is the curriculum
vitae of the career of mind and in the early grades of this career reason can best
appropriate the truth of nature by applying the organic Method.13
The organic units of the history of philosophy corresponded to a biological pro-
totype. Hegel belonged to generation of German thinkers who rebelled against the
mechanistic model of explanation found in the works of Newton and Descartes.
Living during a period which witnessed the explosion of the biological and zoo-
logical sciences, the work of Cuvier, Linnaeus and Buffon, Hegel, like Goethe,
replaced the mechanistic paradigm with the model of organism.
In this regard Hegel was influenced by the work of Kant. In his The Critique of
Judgement, Kant also saw the advantages of organic explanation over the mecha-
nistic. The Critique of Judgement provided logical support for organic explanation
and Hegel built on this tradition.14
Hegel’s employment of the organic Method of explanation is not only demon-
strated in The Phenomenology of Spirit, The History of Philosophy and The Philosophy
of History but also in The Philosophy of Nature. Hegel divides nature into three parts,
mechanics, physics and organics, and presents each of these divisions as parts of
a holism. Nature itself is a cosmic organism, it is possessed of three parts, it is not
static and it develops from the mechanical through physics to the organic.15
The clearest expression of Hegel’s embrace of organism is found in Section
Three of The Philosophy of Nature, ‘Organics’. In the preceding sections Hegel dealt
with physics and chemistry, but in Organics Hegel deals with the appearance of
life. The inherent development in this section is from the earth to plants to ani-
mals and to human life. Hegel’s design is Aristotelian; the purpose of the organic
sphere is to reach its end in the human genus. Hegel was not Charles Darwin, he
did not believe in the evolution of the human genus from the animal genus. Each
genera was separate and distinct, a part of the whole of the organic sphere.16
The organic Method was central to the Hegelian definition of science. In this
domain, as well, Hegel broke with the empirical definition of science. Rather than
characterize science as a Method to achieve the correspondence between the exter-
nal world and the internal ideas by means of sense perception, Hegel thought of
302 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
science as System. For Hegel System was a holism, or a universality in which all
particulars were unified. Hegel not only revolutionized the ideas of philosophy and
logic but also the idea of science. Hegel’s The Science of Logic was really the enthrone-
ment of systematic explanation, a demonstration that the Absolute Idea was the
whole, the synthesis of the particular determinations of mind into a holism.
Hegel’s Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences offers a clear articulation of his
understanding of science. It is an ontological syllogism. It begins with a notion
of logic which experiences dialectical negation in the notion of nature and
concludes with a dialectical synthesis in mind. Logic is ultimately subsumed in
mind. Paragraphs 575, 576 and 577 of volume three of the Encyclopedia of the
Philosophical Sciences, The Philosophy of Mind, presents the syllogism as the ontol-
ogy of mind.17 The syllogism is the ontological form followed by mind, nature’s
negation of logic and mind’s negation of nature, which brings forth a holism.
The movement from logic to nature and then to mind demonstrates the inherent
developmental prius of mind and how teleological movement ultimately results
in a universal System, the Absolute Idea.
The revolutions Hegel effected in the definitions of philosophy, the history of
philosophy and science he extended to the meaning of logic. Overthrowing all
past characterizations, Hegel did not understand logic as correspondence, either
in the empiricist sense of the congruence between sense perception and Idea or
in the metaphysical sense of an eternal external Idea Platonically imaged in the
human mind. For Hegel logic was the function, the method, the determinations
of thought.
It is necessary, at this point, to distinguish between System and Method. As
I indicated above, System relates to an organic unit, a whole. Conversely, Method
relates to the procedures of mind which sustain the whole. While System relates
to the universality, Method deals with the functions of thought which preserve
the totality. Method is those patterns of thought which give rise to a System.
Regardless of the distinction between these two categories both System and
Method are reflections of thought. Hegel began his Encyclopedia of the Philosophical
Sciences with a volume on logic because he wanted to show how the methods of
thought determine the understanding of nature, ethics, morality, art and reli-
gion. Method was the procedures of thought, while System was the result of this
Method.
The ‘Preface’ to The Phenomenology of Spirit is one of the great documents in
philosophical literature. It is a prelude to Hegel’s later mature System. In the
‘Preface’ Hegel abjured acting as a revolutionary, but, in fact, The Phenomenology
of Spirit was the source of a revolution in the discipline of philosophy. One aspect
of this upheaval was Hegel’s reformulation of the rules of logic. Hegel replaced
logic with Method. He nullified all previous forms of logic, empirical, mathemati-
cal, metaphysical and theological, and substituted Method for all these moribund
forms. The new Method of philosophical inquiry promised to open new conti-
nents of knowledge that the dead logic was incapable of exploring. Amongst other
innovations Hegel believed that his new pneumatology required a new methodol-
ogy to organize the new objectifications of Spirit.18
Marx’s Method 303
It thus appears that the Method is not an extraneous form, but the soul
and notion of the content, from which it is only distinguished, so far as the
dynamic elements of the notion even on their own part come in their own
specific character to appear as the totality of the notion. This specific character,
or the content, leads itself with the form back to the idea; and thus the idea is
presented as a systematic totality which is only one idea, of which the several
elements are each implicitly the idea, which they equally by the dialectic of the
notion produce the simple independence of the idea.19
Hegel’s conviction that every idea was the outcome of a particular method was
repeated consistently throughout the ‘Logic’ of the Encyclopedia of the Philosophical
Sciences. One function of thought was to arrive at the concrete and this form of
comprehension was analytical thought. But the attainment of the concrete would
only be achieved by an analytical modus operandi and in paragraph 227 Hegel
called this function ‘the analytical method’.20 However, in the attainment of the
Idea it was necessary to move from the concrete to universality and in paragraph
222 Hegel referred to this universalizing function as the ‘synthetic method’.21 As
the advance of thought continued beyond the analytic and the synthetic stages it
ultimately arrived at the Absolute Idea, and the Absolute Idea itself was a product
of Method. In paragraph 237 Hegel wrote: ‘All that is at this stage left as form
for the idea is the Method of this content . . . the specific consciousness of the
value and currency of the “moments” of its development.’22 In distinction to the
metaphysical, empirical, critical and intuitive System, Speculative philosophy
304 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
had its own Method. In paragraph 238 Hegel wrote: ‘The several steps or stages
of the Speculative Method are first of all (a) the Beginning, which is Being, or
immediacy . . .’23
It is in the pages of The Science of Logic that Hegel offers his most complete dis-
cussion of methodology. However, I propose that it is necessary to change the title
of this revolutionary treatise. It is necessary to keep in mind that Hegel redefined
the term science to mean a System, or a totality. In addition it is also necessary to
recall that Hegel redefined the term logic to mean methodology, or the functional
regime of the Idea. With these two redefinitions in mind I propose it is necessary
to change the title of The Science of Logic to ‘The System of Methodology of the
Idea’. Hegel’s discourse on methodology was a transforming moment in the his-
tory of the discipline of logic.
Hegel announced his reconstruction of logic in the ‘Introduction’ to his ‘The
System of Methodology of the Idea’. In this ‘Introduction’ he notes that the need
to reformulate logic was a long-standing conviction among philosophic practi-
tioners.24 He claimed that until the publication of ‘The System of Methodology of
the Idea’, philosophy was estranged from its proper Method.25 He then proceeds
to express his own revolutionary goal.
I could not pretend that the Method which I follow in this system of logic . . .
or rather which this system in its own self follows . . . is not capable of greater
completeness, if much elaboration in detail; but at the same time I know that
it is the only true Method.26
The culmination of Hegel’s rebellion against traditional logic occurs in the second
volume of ‘The System of Methodology of the Idea’, ‘Subjective Logic, the Doctrine
of Reason’. In ‘Subjective Logic’ Hegel distinguishes between the methodology of
mechanism, or physics, and the methodology of Subjective Spirit, or the activity
of the human mind as it attains the Idea. As Hegel makes the transition from the
mechanistic-chemical to the subjective he designates the teleological Method as
the distinguishing feature of subjectivity as it evolves the Idea. Only subjectivity
is capable of achieving the Idea.
Hegel’s insurrection against traditional mechanistic-chemical versions of logic
was mostly demonstrated by his inclusion of a chapter on ‘Life’ in his ‘The
System of Methodology of the Idea’. Hegel included this chapter to accentuate
the dynamic aspect of methodology, the constant outpouring of thought in the
attempt of mind to infiltrate reality.
The consummation of ‘The System of Methodology of the Idea’ was the Absolute
Idea. However, the Absolute Idea was not eternal, not immobile, but rather was
result, the outcome of the previous stages of methodology. The Absolute Idea
Marx’s Method 305
was the product of the stages of thought, the forms of thought out of which the
Absolute Idea was an effect.28
Hegel captured his belief in the impermanence of the Absolute Idea by referring
to it as cyclic. The Absolute Idea was not Platonic, but rather a cycle, and this meant
that after the methodological construction of the Absolute Idea it re-submerged
itself again in nature. Like philosophy, Method was a cycle. Philosophy must be
reconstructed depending upon the period of history in which it was situated and
the Absolute Idea, after its completion, returned to reality and again began its
cyclic construction as a new Absolute Idea. The Absolute Idea experienced con-
stant rebirth and the instrument of its reincarnation was the Method. For Hegel,
methodology was the law of eternal return.29
Within the organic holism of the Hegelian System the primary methodology
was the dialectic, or the determining influence of negativity. Influenced by the
Greek Sceptics and Spinoza’s proposition that to negate was to define, Hegel main-
tained there could be no specificity without the power of negation. Specificity
only arose when negation, or limitation, the separation from the Other, acted to
create a boundary, or identity.
The syllogism was Hegel’s major dialectical instrument. The formula of the syl-
logism, the negation of universality by particularity, which found a synthesis in
the individual, was the syllogism’s core methodological procedure. In ‘The System
of Methodology of the Idea’ Hegel devoted Chapter Three of the ‘Subjective Logic’,
or ‘The Doctrine of the Notion’, to a discussion of the syllogism and claimed that
rationality in-itself was reducible to the syllogism.30 The notion was the outcome
of the mediation between the universal and the particular.
However, the methodology of the Hegelian System was restricted to thought.
‘The Master’ wrote a methodology of Speculative Idealism. The functional pat-
terns, the dialectic of the syllogism as the axial one, were descriptions of the
behavior of thought.
My assessment of Marx’s relationship to Hegel was divided into two parts, dis-
continuities and continuities. As I proceed to finalize this assessment I will start
with the discontinuities.
Marx rejected the Hegelian System because in his reading of ‘The Master’ he
believed it to be a ‘logical pantheism’. The dynamic of the Hegelian System was
mind and Marx rebuffed this presupposition. A tribune of materialism, Marx’s
goal was to locate the sources of human alienation in political economy and soci-
ology. Hegel’s point of origination was mind, he carried on the tradition of Kant
and Fichte in ascertaining the operational modes of thought.
Marx divided Hegelian Speculative philosophy in two parts, System and
Method. He rejected the systematic aspects of Hegelian Speculative philosophy,
but Continued the methodological aspects.
However, it is necessary to draw a distinction between the purposes of meth-
odology in Hegel and Marx. As I mentioned previously the primary methodology
of the ‘Parmenides of Berlin’ was the dialectic; the goal of methodology in Hegel
was to discover the genesis of the Absolute Idea. Encased inside a Speculative
306 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Idealist framework, the basic purpose of methodology was to map the procedural
determinism of thought.
As I will point out below Marx did appropriate many of the procedural cat-
egories of Hegel and this appropriation was the basis of his continuity with the
‘Parmenides of Berlin’. But the end toward which this methodology was directed
differed from that of Hegel. Whereas the purpose of methodology in Hegel was
the description of the procedural determinism of thought, a rational teleology,
the purpose of methodology in Marx was the construction of a model by which
to explain social systems.
Marx’s grand design of creating a new methodology for the explanations of
social formations entailed that he borrow specific methodological categories from
Hegel. Marx’s continuity with Hegel lies in the fact that he utilized Hegelian
categories, but it must be remembered that the purpose to which he put these
Hegelian categories differed from the Hegelian purpose and in this disparity lay
one of the reasons for the discontinuity between Marx and Hegel.
In order to establish the methodological continuity between Hegel and Marx
I will discuss eight categories Marx borrowed from Hegel, although Marx incorpo-
rated more than eight methodological categories from Hegel. Even though I have
discussed some of these categories in previous parts of this book I will repeat them
in this chapter on Marx’s Method as a means of definitively outlining his meth-
odology. The categories I will analyze are: 1) The productive model; 2) Historicity;
3) Organism; 4) Universal–particular; 5) Essence; 6) Immanent development;
7) Relation; 8) Abstract–concrete.
2) Historicity
a member of the human body. Humankind and nature were interactive agencies.
The history of human labor, its advancement to higher forms of productivity, was
the ground upon which social formations were transformed over time. In a paral-
lel fashion, nature itself became historical as human productivity modified the
resources nature made available to labor.
3) Organism
Human anatomy contains a key to the anatomy of the ape. The intimations
of the higher development among subordinate animal species, however, can
be understood only after the development is already known. The bourgeois
economy thus supplies the key to the ancient, etc.33
Even though Marx embraced the anatomical category of Hegel he applied that
model to a different realm. Whereas Hegel applied the organic image to philoso-
phy, art and religion, Marx applied the organic model to the realm of political
economy. In Marx the term social formation was a synonym for the organic.
In the course of human history four social formations make their appear-
ance, the tribal gens, the agrarian, the feudal and the capitalist as represented
in 17th and 18th-century commercialism and the early 19th-century Industrial
Revolution. Each of the social formations was organized on the organic model.
For Marx a social formation, arising out of the ground of political economy, was a
holism. In addition to the universal an anatomical totality was also composed of
308 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
particularities and these particularities sustained the universal because they repli-
cated, performed in coordination, with the universal mode of operation.
4) Universal–particular
Major categories of Marx’s Method of social explanation are drawn from Book
Two of Hegel’s, The Science of Logic, ‘The Doctrine of Essence’. The Science of Logic
was a necessary prerequisite for Marx’s Method of social explanation; Hegel was
the originator of most of the methodological categories adopted by Marx. ‘The
Doctrine of Essence’ was the primary source of the categories incorporated by
Marx into his Method of social explanation.
‘The Doctrine of Essence’ is divided into three sections, ‘Essence as Reflection
within Itself’, ‘Appearance’ and ‘Actuality’. The third chapter of section two,
‘Appearance’ is entitled ‘The Essential Relation’ and includes the following para-
graph:
The relation thus contains the subsistence of the sides and equally their sublat-
edness, and it contains both simply in one relation. The whole is the self-sub-
sistent, the parts are only moments of this unity; but equally they, too, are the
self-subsistent and their reflected unity only a moment; and each is, in itself
subsistence, simply the relative of an other. This relation is therefore in its own
self immediate contradiction, and sublates itself.34
5) Essence
Marx was introduced to the notion of essence in his reading of Hegel’s The Science
of Logic. Book Two of The Science of Logic is entitled ‘The Doctrine of Essence’ and
is an in-depth discussion of this pivotal Hegelian concept.35
Marx’s Method 309
In Hegel essence was the in-itself, it was the universal quality of an organic
totality. Continuing an Aristotelian tradition, essence was the quality that pro-
duced the identity of the holism.
Marx borrowed the concept of essence from Hegel and relocated the domain of
its operations. Whereas Hegel located essence as a methodology of the logic, Marx
transplanted essence to the domain of political economy.
For Marx the essence of capitalism was the drive toward valorization. Capitalism
was the limitless quest for relative surplus value and as long as capitalism func-
tioned according to this principle it functioned in terms of its essence. Marx was
the first to utilize the concept of essence as an explanatory methodology in politi-
cal economy and Marx thereby revolutionized the nature of political economy.
6) Immanent development
Again following Aristotle, Hegel’s ‘The Doctrine of Essence’ charts the movement
from essence to actuality.36 Within the realm of the methodology of the Idea,
Hegel maintained that the movement of the in-itself, the identity of a notion,
developed into actuality. The coming to be of actuality was the immanent devel-
opment of the essence.
Another way to describe immanent development was the movement from the
potential to the actual. Essence was also potential, it was the in-itself that pos-
sessed the potential to expand. Actuality was the realization of this potential.
Marx related to the Aristotelian-Hegelian formula of political economy. Since
the essence of capitalism was the continuous appropriation of relative surplus
value then the immanent development of capitalism meant that every new fron-
tier that the capitalist social formation encountered would be transformed into a
reflection of that capitalist organism.
Imperialism was an example of immanent development. The economic crisis of
1857 validated Marx’s belief that Western European capitalism required colonial
markets as a means of expanding its acquisition of relative surplus value. Focusing
on British India as reported in London newspapers, Marx learned that the ancient
Indian gens based on collective property was demolished by English capitalism
which found a greater profit in the collection of rent from private property owners.
The immanent development of capitalism planted the seeds of capitalism in British
colonial possessions and the gens was being replaced by individual ownership.
7) Relations
This passage is highly characteristic for it shows how Marx approached the
basic idea of his entire ‘system’ . . . namely the concept of the social relations
of production.38
8) Abstract–concrete
In Hegel the abstract was a universal which was assembled from a perceptible
reality. Hegel discussed his notion of the abstract in his subsection on Identity in
Chapter Two, ‘The Essentialities or Determinations of Reflection’ in The Science of
Logic.39
The practice of abstraction entailed the redaction of difference. The exercise of
abstraction is simultaneously the achievement of identity, or sameness. By elimi-
nating difference, by redacting the inconsistent, the universal can be attained.
In the practice of abstraction the universal was the generality, the universal tran-
scended all distinctiveness and separateness and established an identity.
Abstraction was an initial process and it unfolded in thought. In order to
reach the universal it was necessary that the process of transcending difference
Marx’s Method 311
operate in the realm of thought. The creation of the concrete entailed an inver-
sion of this process. The delineation of the concrete meant the re-submergence
into reality.
The concrete was the achievement by reality of an identity. The concrete did
not exist in the world of thought like the abstract, but the concrete was the appli-
cation of the abstract to reality. The concrete was the reversal of abstraction, the
entrance of thought into reality and the endowment of reality with an identity
which because it was a generalizing definition was also a universality.
The ‘Introduction’ to The Master’s The History of Philosophy contains a subsec-
tion entitled ‘The Notion of the Concrete’ and in this subsection Hegel defined
the concrete in the following terms:
In-itself the Idea is really concrete, for it is the union of the different determi-
nations. It is here that reasoned knowledge differs from mere knowledge of the
understanding, and it is the business of Philosophy as opposed to understand-
ing, to show that the truth or the Idea does not consist in empty generalities,
but in the universal; and that is within itself the particular of the determined.
If the Truth is abstract it must be untrue . . . philosophy is what is most antago-
nistic to abstraction and it leads back to the concrete.40
Philosophy was the eternal process, with the infinite obligation to ‘Know Thyself’,
but philosophy could only gain self-knowledge in the concrete. The Greek discov-
ery of the power of subjectivity was an instance of the concrete. Subjectivity was
a moment of identity, the determinations of philosophy into an in-itself thereby
defining Greek culture and also educating philosophy as to an irreplaceable qual-
ity of its own education.
Marx borrowed the Hegelian methodology of abstract and concrete and applied
it as an instrument of social explanation. In his analysis of social formations Marx
began his inquiry with a search for the abstract. By comparing alternatives, Marx
was able to abstract the universality within each of these forms.
By comparing agricultural, commercial and capitalist social formations, Marx
abstracted the essence of capitalism. Unlike agrarian societies capitalist societies
were defined by the universality of valorization. Abstraction, the comparison of
divergent social organisms as a means to uncover the in-itself of each social organ-
ism, provided Marx with the intellectual tools to discover the essential determina-
tion of that social anatomy.
The movement to the concrete required that Marx detail how the abstract
realized itself inside a social formation. The abstract of capitalism, valorization,
found its concrete reality in money. If valorization was the determinate essence of
capitalism, then money, relative surplus value, labor time, were concretes within
the System. The concrete was the realization of the abstract, it was the abstract
fulfilling itself in a social formation.
Marx’s Method was constructed upon the methodological categories he bor-
rowed from the Parmenides of Berlin. Marx’s Method was a formula for social
explanation, a procedure for understanding how a social formation functioned.
312 Marx’s Discourse with Hegel
Chapter One
1. Marx-Engels Gesamtausgabe (Berlin: Dietz Verlag, 1975) (henceforth Mega2). The publica-
tion of the Mega2 started in the German Democratic Republic (GDR) before the 1991 col-
lapse of the Soviet Union. The citation listed above relates to the appearance of the first
volume of this vast publishing project, which, fortunately, is still in process. Dr Manfred
Neuhaus, the former Director of the Mega2 project at the International Marx-Engels
Stiftung, Berlin, recently retired and his place has been taken by Gerald Hubmann.
2. In relation to The Economic-Philosophic Manuscripts of 1844 (hereafter referred to as
‘The Manuscripts’), see the following essays by Jürgen Rojahn. a) ‘Marxismus-Marx-
Geschichtswissenschaft-1844’, International Review of Social History, Vol. 28 (1983),
pp. 2–49; b) ‘Die Marxschen Manuscript aus dem Jahre 1844 in der Neuen Marx-Engels
Gesamtausgabe’, Archive für Sozialgeschichte, Vol. 25 (1985), pp. 647–663.
3. In relation to the ‘I. Feuerbach’ chapter of The German Ideology see the essay co-
authored by Inge Taubert, Hans Pelger and Jacques Grandjonc, ‘Karl Marx, Friedrich
Engels, Joseph Weydemeyer: Die Deutsche Ideologie. Manuscript und Drucke’, Mega-
Studien, Vol. 2 (1997). Also see the illuminating comments on Die Deutsche Ideologie
(hereafter referred to as ‘The Leipzig Council’) contained in the Marx-Engels Jahrbücher
2003 (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 2003) published in cooperation with the International
Marx-Engels Stiftung, Amsterdam. On the issue of the ‘I. Feuerbach’ chapter atten-
tion should also be brought to the work of Terrell Carver, particularly ‘The German
Ideology Never Took Place’, History of Political Thought, Vol. XXXI, No. 1, Spring 2010,
pp. 107–127.
4. Gisela Schüler, ‘Zum Chronologie von Hegels Jugendschriften’, Hegel-Studien, Vol. 2,
1963, pp. 11–159.
5. Georg Wilhelm Friedrich Hegel, The History of Philosophy, trans. E. S. Haldane (Lincoln:
University of Nebraska Press, 1995), Vol. I, p. 253.
6. Karl Marx On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
Marx-Engels Collected Works (New York: International Publishers, 1975) (henceforth
MECW), Vol. I, p. 438.
7. Norman Levine, Divergent Paths: Hegel in Marx and Engelsism (Lanham; Rowman and
Littlefield, 2006). See also the anthology edited by Tony Burns and Ian Fraser, The Hegel-
Marx Connection (Basingstroke: Macmillan Press, 2000). This collection of essays repre-
sents the continuity theses and is one of the earliest assemblages of essays to advance
and defend the School of Hegelian Marxism. The contributions of the participating
scholars are all of high quality. The reader’s attention is drawn to the following four
essays because they offer penetrating insights into specific aspects of the Hegel–Marx
relationship: 1) Joseph McCarney’s ‘Hegel’s Legacy’, focusing on the aporia between
Hegel’s Spirit and Marx’s anthropology and economic sociology; 2) Andrew Chitty’s
‘Recognition and Social Relations of Production’, which emphasizes the priority Marx
ascribed to social relations, a viewpoint with which I concur; 3) Christopher Arthur’s
‘From the Critique of Hegel’s to the Critique of Capital’, which is an introduction the
School of Hegelianized Marxism; 4) Howard Williams’ ‘The End of History in Hegel and
Marx’, a discussion of how the Enlightenment theory of progress continued on in Hegel
and Marx.
8. Levine op. cit., pp. 153–234.
9. Ibid., pp. 127–128.
314
Notes 315
10. Earlier research looked upon Marx’s exzerpte ‘On James Mill’ as his earliest expression
of interest in political economy. But more recent studies establish that Marx read List
in late 1843 a short time before his study of Mill. Gareth Stedman Jones and Eric
Hobsbawm both claim that Engels’ essay ‘Outline of a Critique of Political Economy’
was the initial impetus for Marx’s turn to political economy. But Engels’ ‘Outlines of a
Critique of Political Economy’ was published in the Deutsch-Französische Jahrbücher in
early 1844. Engels arrived after List and the fact that Marx had already read List in late
1843 indicates his interest in political economy blossomed before the arrival of Engels.
Marx’s involvement in political economy preceded the advent of Engels and was inde-
pendent of the influence of Engels. See Engels’ own recognition that Marx’s interest
in political economy began in 1843, prior to the publication of his article ‘Outlines
of a Critique of Political Economy’, in his ‘Foreword’ to his publication of the second
volume of Das Kapital: Engels, ‘Vorwort’, Das Kapital, Marx-Engels Werke (Berlin: Dietz
Verlag, 1985) (henceforth MEW), Vol. 40, Part 2, p. 14.
Gareth Stedman Jones and Eric Hobsbawm both propose that Engels’ article ‘Outlines
of a Critique of Political Economy’ supplied the impetus for Marx’s involvement
in political economy. I dispute this assertion. Engels’ article ‘Outlines of a Critique
of Political Economy’ was published in the Deutsch-Französische Jahrbücher in early
1844. However, the documents I listed in the text, one by Engels himself, certify that
Marx’s turn to political economy began in the Fall of 1843, or after his arrival in Paris.
Therefore, Marx’s study of political economy predated the arrival of Engels’ essay. It is
true, as Marx himself states in the ‘Preface’ to ‘The Manuscripts’, that Engels’ article
served as a demonstration as to how critique could be applied to political economy, but
this is vastly different than claiming that Engels was the first to ignite Marx’s involve-
ment this subject. Additionally, the form of the critique of political economy employed
by Engels was totally different than the form of critique of political economy applied by
Marx. Engels showed Marx that critique was applicable to political economy and Marx
acknowledged this debt, but Marx’s methodology of critique bore no resemblance to
Engels’ methodology.
11. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, MECW, Vol. 3, p. 179.
12. Marx, Zur Kritik der politischen Oekonomie: Vorwort, MEW, Vol. 13, p. 8.
13. Hegel, Gesamelte Werke (Berlin: Verlag Duncker und Humblot, 1832–1845). In addition
to the Gesamelte Werke, the two-volume work by Carl Ludwig Michelet, Geschichte der
Letzten System der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis Hegel, was extremely helpful
in assembling these Hegel essays that appeared in Volume One of Hegel’s Gesamelte
Werke which Michelet edited. In his Geschichte der Letzten Michelet discussed Hegel’s
early essays from the Jena period. I followed Michelet’s compilation because I did not
think he would select an essay for analysis unless he thought it important enough to
include in the volume for which he was responsible. I accepted Michelet’s listings of the
essays because I did not think he would discuss material he had not already included in
Volume One.
14. Marx, MECW, Vol. I.
15. Karl Rosenkranz, Georg Wilhelm Friedrich Hegels Leben (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot,
1844).
16. Ibid, p. 206.
17. Friedrich Engels, ‘Schelling and Revelation’, MECW, Vol. 2, pp. 195.
18. Engels, ‘Schelling on Hegel’, MECW, Vol. 2, pp. 181–188.
19. Engels, ‘Schelling and Revelation’, MECW, Vol. 2, pp. 189–240.
20. Engels, ‘Schelling, Philosopher in Christ’, MECW, Vol. 2, pp. 241–246.
21. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. 1, pp. 103–105.
22. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, ed. S. Ryazanskaya (London: Lawrence and Wishart, 1965),
pp. 141, 208, 552.
316 Notes
23. Arnold Ruge ‘Die Hegelsche Rechtsphilosopie und die Politik unsrer Zeit’, in Heinz
and Ingrid Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelsche Linke (Leipzig: Verlag Philipp Reclam, 1985),
pp. 443–471.
24. Karl Löwith, From Hegel to Nietzsche, trans. David E. Green (New York: Holt, Rinehart and
Winston, 1964).
25. John Toews, Hegelianism (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1980).
26. Löwith, op. cit., p. 10.
27. Toews, op. cit., p. 301.
28. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, MECW, Vol. 3, pp.
175–187. For a different perspective on the relationship between philosophy and praxis
in Marx, see Harold Mah, The End of Philosophy, the Origin of Ideology (Cambridge, MA:
MIT Press, 1966). I fundamentally disagree with Mah’s thesis that Marx sought to abol-
ish philosophy. I agree that Marx broke with the Hegelian definition of philosophy as
retrospection, but I maintain, contrary to Mah, that Marx still saw the need for philo-
sophic thinking to establish social goals, as a basis of critique, and to project strategies
for praxis. Philosophy set the purpose of praxis and without philosophy praxis would
be errant and random.
29. Georg Lukács, The Young Hegel, trans. Rodney Livingstone (Cambridge, MA: MIT Press,
1966).
30. Herbert Marcuse, Reason and Revolution (Boston: Beacon Press, 1960).
31. Warren Breckmann, Marx, the Young Hegelians and the Origins of Radical Social Theory
(Cambridge; Cambridge University Press, 1999). An interesting book written after all the
Hegel and Marx manuscripts were discovered and made known, but Breckman does not
deal with how Marx’s ignorance of the Jena manuscripts may have influenced Marx’s
perception of Hegel.
32. Stathis Kouvelakis, Philosophy and Revolution; From Kant to Marx (London: Verso,
2003).
33. Marx, The Holy Family, trans. R. Dixon (Moscow: Foreign Language Publishing House,
1956), pp. 167–178.
34. David Leopold, The Young Karl Marx (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2007).
35. Refer to previous footnote 2. For the German edition of ‘The Manuscripts’ see Mega2
(Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 2009) Abteiling I, Band II, pp. 323–464. For the ‘Kritik des
Hegelschen Staatsrechts’, see Mega2, Abteiling I, Band II, pp. 3–138.
36. I have written two articles concerning the influence of the Scottish School of
Historiography on Marx. See Norman Levine, ‘The German Historical School of Law
and the Origins of Historical Materialism’, The Journal of the History of Ideas, Vol. 48,
No. 3, July–Sept. 1987, pp. 431–452. Also see Norman Levine, ‘The Myth of the Asiatic
Restoration’, The Journal of Asian Studies, Vol. 37, No. 1, Nov. 1977, pp. 73–85.
37. Norbert Waszek, The Scottish Enlightenment and Hegel’s Account of Civil Society (Dordrecht:
Kluwer Publishers, 1988). Professor Waszek is not only an internationally recognized
scholar on Hegel and the Scottish Enlightenment but also on the work of Eduard Gans.
Anyone writing on German intellectual history in the first half of the 19th century
will gain enormously by reading his work. See his Eduard Gans (New York: Peter Lang,
1991).
38. Hegel, The Philosophy of History, trans. J. Sibree (Buffalo: Prometheus Books, 1991),
pp. 250–255, 258–265).
39. Hegel, Lectures on the Philosophy of Religion, ed. Peter Hodgson (Berkeley; University of
California Press, 1983–1987), 3 Vols.
40. Christopher J. Arthur, Engels Today (Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1996).
41. See the following two works by Georg Lasson: 1) Schriften zur Politik und Rechtsphilosophie
(Leipzig: 1923); 2) Jenenser Logik, Metaphysik und Naturphilosophie (Leipzig: 1923). In
addition see the following two works by Johannes Hoffmeister: 1) Jenaer Realphilosophie
(Leipzig: 1931); 2) Dokumente zu Hegels Entwicklung (Stuttgart: 1936).
42. Levine, Divergent Paths, pp. 190–240.
Notes 317
43. Christopher J. Arthur, The New Dialectic and Marx’s Capital (Boston: Brill, 2004),
pp. 118–119. I draw attention to an early essay by Terrell Carver which contributed to
the discussion of the relationship between Hegel and Marx. Carver was an early pioneer
in this field and his work should be recognized. See his ‘Marx and Hegel’s Logic’, Political
Studies, Vol. 24, No. 1 (1976), pp. 57–67.
44. Arthur, ibid., pp. 108–109. Those who wish additional explications of the School of
Systematic Dialectic are encouraged to read the work of Tony Smith. See his The Logic of
Marx’s Capital (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1990) as well as his Dialectical
Social Theory and Its Critics (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1993).
45. Christopher J. Arthur, The Dialectics of Labor (Oxford: Blackwell, 1986).
46. Marx, The Holy Family, p. 50.
47. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, pp. 101, 110.
48. Douglas Moggach, The Philosophy and Politics of Bruno Bauer (Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 2003).
49. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, trans. A. V. Miller (Oxford: Oxford University Press,
1977), p. 218.
50. Ibid., p. 219.
51. Ibid., p. 362.
52. Hegel, The Philosophy of Mind, trans. A. V. Miller (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1971), p. 257.
53. Ibid.
54. Hegel, The Philosophy of History, p. 39.
55. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, pp. 90–91.
56. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, p. 315.
57. Ibid., pp. 298, 318.
58. Marx, The Holy Family, p. 175.
59. Marx to Engels, 15 April 1869, MEW, Vol. 32, pp. 302–303.
60. Norman Levine, Dialogue within the Dialectic (London: George Allen and Unwin, 1984),
pp. 257–316. In addition to this chapter on Leninist Bolshevism this work also contains
a chapter on the revolutionary theory of Mao Zedong. Furthermore, in additional
essays I have written on the philosophical presuppositions of the politics of Marx.
See Norman Levine, ‘Toward the Repotentializiation of a Marxist Theory of Politics’,
Praxis International, Vol. 8, No. 2 (July 1988), pp. 237–249. See also Norman Levine,
‘Jacobinism and the European Revolutionary Tradition’, History of European Ideas, Vol. II
(1989), pp. 157–180.
61. I have written extensively on the continuity between Hegel and Marx and this book is
the culmination of long years of study in this topic. For these prior essays see Norman
Levine, ‘Hegel and the 1861–63 Manuscripts of Das Kapital’, Rethinking Marxism, Vol. 14,
No. 4 (2002), pp. 47–58; ‘Marx’s First Appropriation of Hegel’, Critique, No. 36–37 (March
2005), pp. 125–156; ‘Corruption and Fate of Left-Wing Hegelianism’, Critique, Vol. 35,
No. 1 (April 2007), pp. 79–102; ‘Hegelian Continuities in Marx’, Critique, Vol. 37, No. 3
(August 2009), pp. 345–370. An excellent discussion of Marx’s methodology of social
explanation is Heinz-Dieter Kittsteiner’s Natur-Absicht und Unsictbar Hand (Frankfurt-am-
Main: Ullstein, 1980). Kittsteiner’s book makes a clear distinction between synchronic
and diachronic explanation and correctly understands Marx as a practitioner of the
synchronic model. In addition, Kittsteiner offers an extremely perceptive explication of
the development of the science of history in the 18th century, the line running from
Herder to Hegel to Kant and correctly assesses Marx’s position in this evolution. In the
historiography of history Marx is an extension of the Enlightenment.
Chapter Two
1. Georg Wilhelm Friedrich Hegel, Hegel’s Werke (Berlin: Verlag von Duncker und Humblot,
1832–1845).
318 Notes
44. Peter F. Stuhr, Die Staaten des Alterthums und die christlichen Zeit in ihrem Gegensätze
(Heidelberg: Mohr und Zimmer, 1811).
45. Hegel, The Philosophy of Right, pp. 120–121.
46. Gans, Das Erbrecht in weltgeschichtliche Entwicklung, Vol. I, p. 120.
47. Ibid., p. 150.
48. Ibid., p. 170.
49. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 127.
50. Ibid., p. 196.
51. Ibid., p. 197.
52. Carl Ludwig Michelet, Geschichte der letzten Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von
Kant bis Hegel (Berlin: Verlag von Duncker und Humblot, 1837), Vol. I, p. 9.
53. Carl Ludwig Michelet, Geschichte der letzten Systeme der Philosophie in Deutschland von
Kant bis Hegel; Anthropologie und Psychologie der Subjektiv Spirit (Berlin: Sanderschen
Buchhandlung, 1840); Naturrecht oder rechts-philosophie als die praktische Philosophie
(Berlin: Nicolai’sche Verlagsbuchhandlung, 1866), 2 Vols; Die Ethik der Aristotle in ihrem
Verhältnisse zum Systeme der Moral (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot, 1829); Die Lösung der
gesellschaftliche Frage (1849).
54. Michelet, Geschichte der letzten Systeme der Philosophie, Vol. 3, p. 669. In addition to
Michelet and from a contemporary perspective, Herbert Schnädelbach’s Hegels prak-
tische Philosophie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 2000) is an outstanding exposition
of Hegel’s concept of practical activity. Any scholar investigating the thought of Hegel
should consult this book. My reading of Schnädelbach confirmed my own impres-
sions of the importance of subjective activity in the philosophy of ‘The Master’. The
question of subjective activity is one of the centers of contemporary Hegel studies and
Schnädelbach is not alone in his explorations in this field. For additional penetrating
studies of subjective activity in Hegel, see Adrian Peperzak, Hegels praktische Philosophie
(Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Frommann-Holzboog, 1991); Ludwig Siep, Anerkennung als
Prinzip der praktischen Philosophie (Munchen: Verlag Alber Freiburg, 1979); Lothar Eley,
Hegels Theorie der subjektiven Geistes (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Frommann-Holzboog,
1990); Dirk Stederoth, Hegels Philosophie der subjektiven Geistes (Berlin: Akademie Verlag,
2001).
55. Ibid., p. 611.
56. Ibid., p. 669.
57. Ibid., p. 611.
58. Ibid., p. 612.
59. Ibid.
60. Ibid., p. 613.
61. Ibid.
62. Ibid., p. 619.
63. Ibid., p. 622.
64. Ibid., pp. 611–627.
65. Ibid., p. 602.
66. Ibid., p. 623.
67. See Note 53.
68. Hegel, The Philosophy of History, p. 456.
69. Michelet, Naturrecht oder rechts-philosophie, p. 158.
70. Ibid., pp. 159–175.
71. Michelet, Geschichte der letzten System, Kapital 14.
72. Ibid., Vol. 3, p. 590.
73. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 410–494.
74. Michelet, Geschichte der letzten System, Vol. 3, pp. 243–245.
75. Ibid, p. 625.
76. Ibid., pp. 604–605.
324 Notes
77. Karl Theodor Bayrhoffer, Beiträge zur Naturphilosophie (Berlin: Otto Wigand, 1839),
2 Vols.
78. Karl Theodor Bayrhoffer, Die Idee und Geschichte der Philosophie (Marburg, 1838).
79. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 197.
80. Bayrhoffer, Die Idee und Geschichte der Philosophie, p. 108.
81. Ibid.
82. Leopold von Henning, Prinzipien der Ethik in historischer Entwicklung (Berlin: Friedrich
August Herbig, 1824). In his book Hegelianism, Toews places Henning on the
Hegelian Right. Toews feels that the views of the Hegelian Right were ‘best exempli-
fied in the viewpoints of Marheineke and Henning’ (p. 87). I disagree with Toews’
judgment since Henning employed the concept of historicity in his investiga-
tion of ethics. Historicity was a vital concept for Hegel and the Hegelian Center in
general and Henning’s utilization of this methodology qualifies him to belong to that
Center.
83. Ibid., p. xii.
84. Ibid., pp. 204–216.
85. Ibid., p. 217.
86. Hermann Friedrich Hinrichs, Geschichte der Rechts- und Staatsprinzipien (Leipzig: Verlag
Gustav Mayer, 1850).
87. Hermann Friedrich Hinrichs, Politische Vorlesungen (Halle: G. U. Schwelschte und Sohn,
1843), 2 Vols.
88. Hermann Friedrich Hinrichs, Das Leben in der Natur (Halle: Verlag von H. M. Schmidt,
1854).
89. Toews, Hegelianism, p. 85.
90. Philipp Marheineke, Bedeutung des Hegelschen Philosophie in der christlichen Theologie
(Berlin: Verlag Th.Chr.Fr. Enslen, 1842), p. 14.
91. Philipp Marheineke, System der christlichen Dogmatik (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot,
1847), pp. 590–593.
92. Ibid., p. 2.
93. Marheineke, Bedeutung des Hegelschen Philosophie, pp. 52–58.
94. Marx to Arnold Ruge, March 5, 1842, quoted in Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelsche Linke,
p. 843.
95. Marx to Arnold Ruge, July 9, 1842, ibid., p. 850.
96. Marx, ‘The Historical School of Law’, MECW, Vol. I, p. 209.
97. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 101.
98. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 240–245.
Phase Two
1. Marx to His Father, 10 November, 1837, MEW, Vol. 40, p. 10.
2. Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelschen Linke, Bauer to Marx, December 11, 1839, p. 193; Bauer
to Marx, April 5, 1840, p. 795; Bauer to Marx, June 5, 1842, p. 845; Bauer to Marx,
December 13, 1842, p. 861.
3. Marx to Jenny, MEW, Vol. 40, pp. 613–615.
4. Marx to His Father, 10 November, 1837, MEW, Vol. 40, p. 8.
5. Ibid., p. 9.
6. Ibid., p. 5.
7. Ibid.
8. Ibid., p. 9.
9. Ibid., p. 4.
10. Ibid., pp. 6–7.
11. Ibid., p. 6.
12. Ibid., p. 5.
Notes 325
13. Ibid., p. 8. On the relationship between Fichte and Marx see Tom Rockmore, Fichte and
Marx and the German Philosophical Tradition (Carbondale: Southern Illinois University
Press, 1980). Rockmore was one of the first to describe the continuity between Fichte
and Marx over the issue of subjective activity. Additionally, Rockmore traces a continu-
ity between Aristotle and Marx, running through Fichte, on the powers of subjective
practice. Prior to the work of George McCarthy (see Bibliography), Rockmore initiated
the rethinking of Marx as an embodiment of the philosophy of praxis which found
its origin in the thought of Aristotle. From this perspective Rockmore also recognized
the disjuncture between Engels and Marx on the grounds that Engels ignored the
philosophy of practice and embraced the metaphysics of natural science.
14. Ibid., pp. 5–6.
15. Marx to Ferdinand Lassalle, February 22, 1858, MECW, Vol. 40, p. 268.
16. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. I, pp. 110–114.
17. Ibid., pp. 109–11.
18. Ibid., p. 163.
19. Ibid., Vol. III, p. 546.
20. Ibid., p. 547.
21. Ibid., Vol. II, pp. 246–247.
22. Ibid., pp. 277–278.
23. Ibid., Vol. III, p. 161.
24. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 104–138.
25. Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelschen Linke, Bauer to Marx, 11 December, 1839, p. 794.
26. Hegel, The Science of Logic, pp. 824–844.
27. Marx to Ruge, 5 March, 1842, Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelschen Linke, pp. 843, 900.
28. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, p. 29.
29. Ibid., p. 30.
30. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature, MEW,
Vol. 40, p. 306.
31. Ibid., p. 367.
32. Marx, MECW, Vol. I, p. 29.
33. Ibid., p. 35.
34. Ibid., p. 105.
35. Ibid.
36. Ibid., p. 500.
37. Ibid., p. 784.
38. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 168.
39. Marx, ‘Kritik der Hegelschen Dialectik und Philosophie überhaupt’, Mega2, Abteiling I,
Band II, p. 400.
40. Marx, The Holy Family, trans. R. Dixon (Moscow: Foreign Languages Publishing House,
1956), p. l70.
41. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, pp. 510–514.
42. Marx, The Holy Family, pp. 167–178.
43. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, pp. 423–424.
44. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. I, p. 300.
45. Ibid., p. 298.
46. Ibid., Vol. II, p. 291.
47. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
p. 50.
48. Hegel, The Science of Logic, pp. 164–167.
49. Ibid., pp. 141–142.
50. Ibid., p. 157.
326 Notes
51. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, pp. 61–62.
52. Hegel, The Science of Logic, pp. 479–496.
53. Hegel, ‘Logic’, The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Vol. I, pp. 186–188.
54. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, pp. 38–45.
55. Hegel, The Science of Logic, p. 542.
56. Ibid., pp. 541–553.
57. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, p. 506.
58. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. II, p. 20.
59. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, pp. 85–86.
60. Ibid., pp. 84–86.
61. Ibid., pp. 438–439.
62. Ibid., p. 439.
63. Marx, MEW, p. 29.
64. Ibid.
65. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 149.
66. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. II, p. 100.
67. Ibid., Vol. I, pp. 149–162.
68. Ibid., pp. 367–371.
69. Ibid., pp. 265–281.
70. Hegel, The Philosophy of Mind, The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Vol. III, p. 495.
71. Ibid., pp. 289–291.
72. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature, MECW,
Vol. I, p. 18.
73. Ibid., pp. 423–424.
74. Joe McCarney has written extremely perceptive books detailing the difference between
the definitions of Marx and Hegel attributed to philosophy. See his Social Theory and
the Crisis of Marxism (London: Verso Press, 1990) and his Hegel on History (London:
Routledge, 2000). Also see Robert B. Pippin, Hegel’s Idealism (Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1989). In this book I particularly suggest pp. 130–170 in which Pippin
offers a precise exposition of Hegel’s understanding of the activity of self-consciousness.
75. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature,
MECW, Vol. I, p. 441.
76. Hegel, The Philosophy of Nature, The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Vol. II, p. 34.
77. Ibid.
78. Ibid., p. 37.
79. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature, MECW,
Vol. I, p. 441.
80. Ibid., pp. 510–514.
Phase Three
1. Marx, On the Difference between the Democritean and Epicurean Philosophy of Nature, MECW,
Vol. I, pp. 109–376.
2. Marx to Ruge, February 10, 1842, MECW, Vol. 1, p. 381.
3. Marx, ‘Zur Kritik der Hegelschen Rechtsphilosophie’, Mega2, Abteiling IV, Band I, p. 368.
4. Ibid.
5. Ibid.
6. Andrew Chitty, ‘The Basis of the State in the Marx of 1842’, in Douglas Moggach (ed.),
The New Hegelians (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2006), pp. 220–241.
Notes 327
7. Ibid., p. 231.
8. Ibid., p. 232.
9. Michael Löwy, The Theory of Revolution in the Young Marx (Leiden: Brill, 2003), pp. 27–28.
10. Hegel, The Philosophy of Right, p. 156.
11. Marx to Ruge, March 5, 1842, MECW, Vol. I, p. 382.
12. Marx to Ruge, March 5, 1842, Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelsche Linke, pp. 843–844.
13. Marx to Dagobert Oppenheim, August 25, 1842, MECW, Vol. I, p. 393.
14. Marx, ‘Zum Ehescheidungsgesetzenentwurf. Kritik der Kritik’, MEW, Vol. 40, p. 389.
15. MECW, Vol. I, pp. 382–383.
16. Ibid., p. 393.
17. Ibid., p. 400.
18. Ibid., p. 608.
19. Arnold Ruge, ‘Die Hegelsche Rechtsphilosophie und die Politik unserer Seit’, in Pepperle
(eds), Die Hegelsche Linke, pp. 462–463.
20. Ibid., p. 464.
21. MECW, Vol. I, p. 201. Although Warren Breckman’s book, Marx, the Young Hegelians and the
Origins of Radical Social Theory is a significant contribution to the study of the rise of Young
Hegelianism and Marx, I disagree completely with his assessment of Marx’s attitude toward
Hegel while Marx was at the Rheinische Zeitung. On page 272 of his book Breckman wrote
that Marx ‘was embarked upon a critique of Hegel’s treatment of the domestic constitu-
tion’. I reject Breckman’s judgment and the remaining portions of this Phase will prove
that Marx was a defender of Hegel during his association with the Rheinische Zeitung.
22. MECW, Vol. 1, pp. 361–362.
23. K.-H. Ilting is an outstanding scholar on the political thought of Hegel. For penetrating
insights into the political theory of both Hegel and Marx see the following two essays:
‘Hegel and the Concept of the State and Marx’s Early Critique’ and ‘The Dialectic of Civil
Society’, both of which are in Z. A. Pelcznski’s The State and Civil Society (Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1984).
24. Marx, MECW, Vol. I, pp. 181–194.
25. Ibid., p. 391.
26. Ibid., pp. 215–221.
27. Ibid., Vol. I, p. 272.
28. Schlomo Avineri, Moses Hess (New York: New York University Press, 1985), pp. 14–15.
29. Marx, MECW, Vol. I, p. 232.
30. Ibid., pp. 391, 393.
31. Ibid., p. 287.
32. Ibid., p. 394.
33. Ibid., p. 283
34. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, p. 493. See Schlomo Avineri, The Social and Political
Thought of Karl Marx (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1968). Avineri’s book
is indispensible to all those investigating the political philosophy of Marx. The book
accomplishes three tasks: 1) It belongs to the camp of those who maintain that major
differences separated Engels and Marx; 2) It belongs to the School of Continuity, or those
who see a continuity between Hegel and Marx; 3) It refutes the theses that Marx per-
petuated Babouvist and Blanquist revolutionary strategy. Avineri refutes J. Talmon’s The
Origins of Totalitarian Democracy, or the totalitarian camp in general, who claim that Marx
believed in the ‘dictatorship of the proletariat’ in the style of Stalin. Rather, Avineri cor-
rectly sees Marx’s political theory as an outgrowth of Hegelian ethics. The Marx of August
1843 broke with Hegelian Liberal Monarchism, but Avineri recognized that Marx’s com-
munism continued the polis ideal that informed the theories of Hegel and Rousseau.
35. MECW, Vol. I, pp. 195–202.
36. Ibid., p. 175.
37. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. I, pp. 27–29.
38. MECW, Vol. I, pp. 294–306.
328 Notes
Phase Four
1. Louis Althusser, Reading Capital, trans. Ben Brewster (London: New Left Books, 1970).
2. Louis Althusser, For Marx, trans. Ben Brewster (New York: Vintage Books, 1970).
3. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, MECW, Vol. III, p. 94.
4. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, MECW, Vol. III, p. 187.
5. Marx, ‘Critical Notes on the Article “The King of Prussia and Social Reform” by a
Prussian’, MECW, Vol. III, pp. 189–206.
6. Marx, ‘Kritik der Hegelschen Dialektik und Philosophie überhaupt’, Mega2, Abteiling I,
Band II, p. 411.
Notes 331
43. Hegel, The Philosophy of Right, pp. 16, 161, 177–178, 292.
44. Waszek, The Scottish Enlightenment and Hegel’s Account of Civil Society. Professor Waszek
is the leading scholar of the influence of the Scottish Enlightenment in Germany and
he is also recognized as an expert on the life of Eduard Gans, who was a close colleague
of Hegel’s. His knowledge of Gans and the impact of the Scottish Enlightenment in
Germany put him in a unique position to trace these vital influences in the develop-
ment of Hegelian thought. On the life of Gans see his Eduard Gans (Frankfurt-am-Main:
Peter Lang, 1991), as well as his essay ‘Eduard Gans, die “Jahrbücher für wissenschaft-
liche Kritik” und die französisiche Publizistik der Zeit’, in Christoph Jamme (ed.), Die
Jahrbücher für Wissenschaftliche Kritik: Hegels Gegenakademie (Stuttgart: Frommann-
Holzboog, 1994), pp. 93–119.
45. Marx, ‘On the Jewish Question’, in Colletti (ed.), Karl Marx, Early Writings, p. 234.
46. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, MECW, Vol. III,
p. 329.
47. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 111–119.
48. Ibid., p. 112. Alexandre Kojève’s Introduction to the Reading of Hegel (Ithaca: Cornell
University Press, 1969) is an extended analysis of the master–slave paradigm in Hegel.
Kojève was one of the founders of the Hegel renaissance in France in the 1930s
and he singled out the master–slave methodology as a salient element in Hegelian
philosophy.
49. Marx, ‘On James Mill’, MECW, Vol. III, p. 227.
50. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Dialectic and Philosophy in General’, MECW, Vol. III,
p. 330.
51. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. I, p. 35.
52. Ibid.
53. Ibid.
54. Ibid., p. 54.
55. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. I, p. 7.
Phase Five
1. Karl Marx-Friedrich Engels Gesamtausgabe (Mega2) (Berlin; International Marx-Engels
Stiftung, 1982).
2. Marx, The Holy Family, p. 189.
3. Marx to Ruge, March 13, 1843, in Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelsche Linke, p. 872.
4. Marx, ‘On James Mill’, MECW, Vol. III, p. 227.
5. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 111–119.
6. Ibid., p. 112.
7. Marx, ‘On James Mill’, MECW, Vol. III, p. 226.
8. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right’, MECW, Vol. III, p. 81.
9. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 46–263.
10. Hegel, The Philosophy of Mind, pp. 29–147.
11. Ibid., pp. 71–98.
12. Ibid., p. 185.
13. Ibid., pp. 153–164.
14. Ibid., p. 165.
15. Ibid., p. 178.
16. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, p. 105.
17. Ibid. Hegel research, particularly since the 1960s, has focused on the issues of labor and
subjective activity in Hegel. A new Hegel has emerged since the 1960s, a Hegel totally
different from the image of the 19th century, an image unfortunately adhered to by
Marx. On the issue of work and labor, see Hans-Christoph Schmidt am Busch, Hegels
Begriff der Arbeit (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 2002).
Notes 333
59. Jean Hyppolite, Genesis and Structure of Hegel’s Phenomenology of Spirit (Evanston:
Northwestern University Press, 1974). Hyppolite was a member of the Hegel renais-
sance in France prior to the outbreak of World War II. He was also one of the first to
begin to explore the continuity between Hegel and Marx. Genesis and Structure of Hegel’s
Phenomenology of Spirit is particularly strong in analyzing Hegel’s denunciation of the
bourgeoisie as well as drawing attention to Hegel’s theory of work and labor. In his
analysis of the Marx–Hegel relationship, see his Studies on Marx and Hegel, trans. John
O’Neill (New York: Basic Books, 1969).
60. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 310–315.
61. Ibid., pp. 355–363.
62. Diderot, Rameau’s Nephew.
63. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 298, 318, 332.
64. Mega2, Abteilung I, Band II, p. 413.
65. Ibid., p. 402.
66. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 119–138.
67. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. II, pp. 314–316.
68. Hegel, The Philosophy of Right, pp. 105–160.
69. Mega2, Abteiling I, Band II, p. 413.
70. Ibid., p. 413.
71. Ibid., p. 405.
72. Ibid., p. 404.
73. Ibid., p. 399.
74. Ibid., p. 299.
75. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 460.
76. Ibid, p. 460.
77. Ibid., pp. 355–364.
78. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, in Colletti (ed.), Karl
Marx: Early Writings, p. 256.
79. Marx, The Holy Family, pp. 160–167.
80. Marx, ‘Critical Notes on the Article “The King of Prussia and Social Reform”, by a
Prussian’, in Colletti (ed.), Karl Marx, Early Writings, p. 420. For further insights into
Marx’s political views, consult the following books: Francis Furet, Marx and the French
Revolution, trans. Deborah Kan Furet (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1984);
Richard Hunt, Marxism and Totalitarian Democracy and The Political Ideas of Marx and
Engels; Michael Löwy, The Theory of Revolution in the Young Marx.
81. Mega2, Abteilung I, Band II, p. 402.
82. Ibid., p. 405.
Phase Six
1. The work of Terrell Carver should be consulted regarding the issue of whether ‘The
Manuscripts’ or the ‘I. Feuerbach‘ chapter in ‘The Leipzig Council’ should be considered
actual texts. Carver himself is a deconstructionist, as he seeks to de-certify these writ-
ings as texts. His work provides interesting insights into the gains to be won by deep
philological probes, and ultimately give rise to the question of meaning and language.
See his essay, ‘The German Ideology Never Took Place’, History of Political Thought,
pp. 107–127.
2. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. III, pp. 162–164.
3. Ibid., pp. 157–161.
4. Marx, The Holy Family, p. 177.
5. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 351–352.
6. Ibid., p. 352.
7. Marx, The Holy Family, p. 190.
Notes 335
8. Ibid., p. 139.
9. Ibid., p. 165.
10. Ibid., p. 168.
11. Ludwig Feuerbach, ‘Zur Kritik der Hegelschen Philosophie (1839)‘, Sämtliche Werke, ed.
Friedrich Jodl and Wilhelm Bolin (Stuttgart: Frommann Verlag, 1959), Vol. II, pp. 159–203.
12. Ibid., p. 203.
13. Ibid., p. 201.
14. Marx, ‘Kritik der Hegelschen Dialektik und Philosophie überhaupt’, Mega2, Abteilung I,
Band II, p. 236.
15. Feuerbach, ‘Principles of the Philosophy of the Future’, in Stepelevich (ed.), The Young
Hegelians, p. 156.
16. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. III, p. 112.
17. Feuerbach, Geschichte der neuern Philosophie von Bacon von Verulam bis Benedict Spinoza,
Sämtliche Werke, Vol. III, pp. 111–126.
18. Marx, The Holy Family, p. 167.
19. Ibid., p. 170.
20. Ibid., p. 105.
21. Ibid., p. 115.
22. Hegel, The Philosophy of Right, p. 10.
23. Marx, ‘Critique of Hegel’s Philosophy of Right: Introduction’, MECW, Vol. III, p. 181.
24. Ibid., p. 187.
25. Marx, The Holy Family, p. 255.
26. Ibid., p. 82.
27. Ibid., p. 51.
28. Ibid., pp. 253–254.
29. Marx, Mega2, Abteiling I, Band II, p. 326.
30. Douglas Moggach, The Philosophy and Politics of Bruno Bauer (Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 2003).
31. Ibid., p. 85.
32. Ibid., p. 144.
33. Breckman, Marx, The Young Hegelians and the Origin of Radical Social Theory, pp. 292–295.
34. Marx, ‘Theses on Feuerbach’, in Colletti (ed.), Karl Marx, Early Writings, p. 423.
35. Marx, The Holy Family, pp. 58–59.
36. Ibid., p. 56.
37. Ibid., pp. 168–169.
38. Ibid., pp. 187, 188.
39. Ibid., p. 189.
40. Ibid., p. 166.
41. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 135.
42. Ibid., p. 460.
43. Ibid., p. 354.
44. Hegel, The Philosophy of Mind, pp. 55–75.
45. C. B. MacPherson, The Political Theory of Possessive Individualism (Oxford: Oxford
University Press, 1964).
46. Hegel, The Philosophy of Right, p. 134. Also see Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 354.
47. Hegel, The Philosophy of Right, p. 134.
48. Marx, ‘The Leipzig Council’, p. 214.
49. Ibid., p. 127.
50. Ibid., p. 196.
51. Ibid., p. 197.
52. Ibid., p. 120.
53. Ibid., p. 409.
54. Max Stirner, The Ego and Its Own, ed. David Leopold (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1995), pp. 221–222.
336 Notes
104. Ibid.
105. Ibid., 126.
106. Ibid., p. 135.
107. Marx to Annenkov, December 28, 1846, in The Poverty of Philosophy, p. 180.
108. Ibid., p. 190.
109. Marx, ‘Lohnarbeit und Kapital’, MEW, Vol. 6, pp. 407–408. This is the author’s
translation.
Chapter 4
1. Marx, ‘Kritik der Hegelschen Dialektik und Philosophie überhaupt’, Mega2, Abteilung I,
Band II, p. 405.
2. Josep Derbolev, ‘Hegels Theorie der Handling’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.), Materialen zur
Hegel’s Rechtsphilosophie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1975), pp. 201–215. This essay
is an excellent study of the role played by subjective activity in the thought of Hegel.
In terms of contemporary studies it is one of the more insightful treatments of this
neglected area in Hegelian thought and I recommend it highly to all those who seek a
more penetrating analysis of Hegel’s thought. Another essay that should be consulted
is Michael Theunissen, ‘Begriff und Realität Hegels Aufhebung der metaphysischen
Wahrheitsbegriff’, in Rolf-Peter Horstmann (ed.), Seminar; Dialektik in des Philosophie
Hegels (Frankfurt-am-Main; Suhrkamp, 1978), pp. 100–120. Theunissen agrees with the
opinion expressed in this book that Hegel rebelled against the metaphysical definition
of truth and logic. Another prominent German philosopher has also emphasized the
role of subjective activity in Hegel’s philosophy. See Ernst Tugendhat, Self-Consciousness
and Self-Determination, trans. Paul Stern (Cambridge, MA: MIT Press, 1986). Tugendhat
stressed the important of self-consciousness in the determination of the Self, a vital
concept Marx missed. Tugendhat is part of contemporary Hegel scholarship that rejects
the notion that Hegel was a Speculative philosopher.
3. Marx, ‘Kritik der Hegelschen Dialektik und Philosophie überhaupt’, Mega2, Abteilung I,
Band II, pp. 402–403.
4. Ibid., p. 404.
5. Hegel, The Philosophy of Mind, p. 3.
6. Aristotle, ‘On the Soul’, in The Basic Works of Aristotle, ed. Richard McKeon (New York:
The Modern Library, 2001), p. 555. For a comprehensive overview of Hegel’s relation
to Aristotle see Alfredo Ferrarin, Hegel and Aristotle (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 2001). Ferrarin devoted an entire chapter to Hegel and Aristotle’s De Anima and
describes in depth Hegel’s understanding of subjective action.
7. Ibid., p. 558.
8. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. II, pp. 180–202.
9. Hegel, The Philosophy of Nature, p. 422.
10. Ibid., p. 311.
11. Ibid., p. 422.
12. Ibid., pp. 307–309, 314.
13. Ibid., pp. 415–416.
14. Ibid., p. 419.
15. Ibid., p. 399.
16. Ibid., p. 404.
17. Ibid.
18. Hegel, The Philosophy of Mind, p. 36.
19. Hegel, The Philosophy of History, p. 79.
20. Ibid., pp. 80–102.
21. Hegel, The Philosophy of Mind, pp. 40–45.
22. Ibid., pp. 46–51.
338 Notes
Chapter 5
1. Marx, Das Kapital: A Critique of Political Economy, trans. Ben Fowkes (New York: Vintage
Books, 1977), p. 103. In terms of the origins of Marx’s revolution in the methodology
of social explanation it is important to read the work of D. R. Kelley. See his book,
Historians and the Law in Post-Revolutionary France (Princeton: Princeton University Press,
1980) and his article ‘The Metaphysics of Law’, American Historical Review (No. 83, 1978),
pp. 350–367. Along with Gareth Stedman Jones, Kelley was one of the first interroga-
tors who properly surmised the influence of early 19th-century legal theory on Marx.
I met Kelley when I was at the Institute for Advanced Study at Princeton and although
our meeting was brief his remarks focused my attention on the proto-Marxism that was
gestating in the late 18th century and early 19th century. I wish to acknowledge my
debt to him.
2. Hegel, ‘Logic’, The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Vol. I, p. 52.
3. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 58–103.
4. Hegel, ‘Logic,’ pp. 93–94.
5. Hegel, ‘The Philosophy of Mind’, The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Vol. III,
pp. 20–23. Marx himself was familiar with Aristotle’s The Soul. In Berlin in 1840 he took
about 25 pages of exzerpte from The Soul. These exzerpte are located in Mega2, Abteilung
IV, Band I, pp. 155–180. Marx was well read in Aristotle and in Volume One of Das
Kapital quotes from the Nicomachean Ethics.
6. Hegel, The Philosophy of History, Vol. III, pp. 545–554.
7. Ibid., Vol. I, p. 546.
8. Ibid., Vol. III, p. 552.
9. Hegel, The Philosophy of History, pp. 341–357.
10. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. I, p. 319–349.
11. Ibid., Vol. III, pp. 217–220.
12. Hegel, ‘Preface’, The Phenomenology of Spirit, pp. 1–45.
13. Ibid., pp. 147–179.
14. Immanuel Kant, Critique of Judgement, trans. J. H. Bernard (Buffalo: Prometheus Books,
2000).
15. Hegel, ‘The Philosophy of Nature,’ Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Vol. II,
pp. 11–27.
16. Ibid., pp. 273–441.
17. Hegel, ‘The Philosophy of Mind’, Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, Vol. III,
pp. 314–315.
18. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, p. 28.
19. Hegel, ‘Logic,’ Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Sciences, p. 296.
20. Ibid., p. 285.
340 Notes
21. Ibid.
22. Ibid., p. 292.
23. Ibid., p. 293.
24. Hegel, The Science of Logic, p. 52.
25. Ibid., p. 53. Heinz Röttges agrees with my thesis that Marx borrowed the methodol-
ogy of Hegel. Röttges concurs with my idea that Hegel jettisoned traditional logic
and replaced this antiquated logic with method. Although I came to my conclusions
independently of Röttges, before I read Röttges, it is still rewarding to know that others
have also followed the same line of argument. See Röttges, Der Begriff der Methode in der
Philosophie Hegels (Meisenheim-am-Glan: Verlag Anton Hain, 1976).
26. Ibid., p. 54.
27. Ibid., p. 57.
28. Ibid., pp. 825–841.
29. Ibid., pp. 841–844.
30. Ibid., p. 665.
31. Hegel, The Phenomenology of Spirit, p. 2.
32. Ibid. In addition the reader’s attention is drawn to the work of Allen W. Wood, who cor-
rectly sees that Hegel drew his preference for organic explanation from Kant’s Critique
of Judgement. Wood wrote: ‘The conception to which Hegel is referring is that of a living
organism or “organized being” through which Kant introduces the idea of natural tele-
ology.’ See Wood’s Karl Marx (New York: Routledge, 2005), p. 200. I also call attention to
another Wood contribution to the Hegel–Marx debate, an article he published entitled
‘Hegel and Marxism’, which appeared in Frederick C. Beiser’s The Cambrige Companion to
Hegel (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2005), pp. 414–441. In this article Wood
draws attention to Hegel’s awareness of some dangers within the capitalism system,
such as the impoverishment of the working class. Hegel does not become a revolution-
ary like Marx, but he was sensitive to the economic problems created by capitalism.
33. Marx, Grundrisse, trans. Martin Nicolaus (New York: Penguin Books, 1973), p. 105.
34. Hegel, The Science of Logic, p. 514.
35. Ibid., ‘The Doctrine of Essence’, pp. 389–569.
36. Ibid., pp. 393–529.
37. Ibid., pp. 512–528.
38. V. Lenin, ‘Conspectus of the Book The Holy Family by Marx and Engels’, in Collected
Works (Moscow: Progress Publishers, 1976), Vol. 38, p. 30.
39. Hegel, The Science of Logic, pp. 411–412.
40. Hegel, The History of Philosophy, Vol. I, pp. 24–25.
41. Friedrich Engels, Ludwig Feuerbach and the End of Classical German Philosophy’, MEW,
Vol. 21, p. 267.
42. Engels, Anti-Dühring, trans. C. P. Dutt (New York: International Publishers, 1966),
pp. 131–157.
43. Engels, The Dialectics of Nature, MEW, Vol. 20, p. 348.
44. Marcello Musto, Karl Marx’s Grundrisse (New York: Routledge, 2008). In this anthology
the essays by Ellen Meiksins Wood, Moishe Postone and Joachim Biscoff/Christoph
Lieber all denounce the linear-stage theory of history.
Bibliography
Collections
Hegel, G. W. F., Gesamelte Werke, 18 Vols (Berlin: Verlag Duncker und Humblot,
1832–1845).
Hegel, G. W. F., Sämtliche Werke, ed. Hermann Glockner, 20 Vols (Stuttgart: F. Frommann,
1928).
Hegel, G. W. F., Werke, ed. Eva Moldenhauer and Karl Markus Michel, 20 Vols (Frankfurt-am-
Main: Suhrkamp, 1971).
Marx-Engels Collected Works, 50 Vols (New York: International Publishers, 1975). Referred to
as MECW in this Bibliography and in Notes.
Marx-Engels Gesamtausgabe (Berlin: Dietz Verlag, 1976). Referred to as Mega2 in this
Bibliography and in Notes.
Marx-Engels Werke, 50 Vols (Berlin: Dietz Verlag, 1988). Referred to as MEW in this
Bibliography and in Notes.
Journals
Hegel-Studien (Bonn: Bouvier), 1961–Present.
341
342 Bibliography
Diderot, Denis, Rameau’s Nephew, trans. Leonard Tancock (New York: Penguin Books,
1966).
De Vos, Lu, ‘Hegels Systemkonzeption in der Phänomenologie des Geistes’, in Heinz
Kimmerle (ed.), Die Eigenbedeutung der Jenaer Systemkonzeptionen Hegels, pp. 239–256.
Draper, Hal, Karl Marx’s Theory of Revolution: State and Bureaucracy (New York: Monthly
Review Press, 1977), Vol. I.
Draper, Hal, Karl Marx’s Theory of Revolution: The Dictatorship of the Proletariat (New York:
Monthly Review Press, 1986), Vol. III.
Düsing, Klaus, ‘Endliche und absolute Subjectivität’, in Lothar Eley (ed.), Hegels Theorie des
subjectiven Geistes (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Frommann-Holzboog, 1990), pp. 36–160.
Düsing, Klaus, ‘Von der Substanzmetaphysik zur Philosophie der Subjektivität’, in Heinz
Kimmerle (ed.), Die Eigenbedeuting Der Jenaer Systemkonzeption Hegels (Berlin: Akademie
Verlag, 2004), pp. 185–199.
Duquette, David A., Hegel’s History of Philosophy (Albany: State University of New York Press,
2003).
Eley, Lothar, Hegels Theories des subjektiven Spirit (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Frommann-
Holzboog, 1990).
Elster, Jon, Making Sense of Marx (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1985).
Engels, Friedrich, Anti-Dühring, trans. C. P. Dutt (New York: International Publishers, 1966).
Engels, Friedrich, Dialektik der Natur, MEW, Vol. 20, pp. 307–568.
Engels, Friedrich, Ludwig Feuerbach und der Ausgang der Klassischen deutschen Philosophie,
MEW, Vol. 21, p. 267.
Engels, Friedrich, ‘Schelling and Revelation’, MECW, Vol. 2, p. 195.
Engels, Friedrich, ‘Schelling on Hegel’, MECW, Vol. 2, pp. 181–188.
Engels, Friedrich, ‘Schelling, Philosopher in Christ’, MECW, Vol. 2, pp. 241–246.
Ferguson, Adam, An Essay on the History of Civil Society, ed. Fania Oz-Salzberger (Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1995).
Ferrarin, Alfredo, Hegel and Aristotle (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2001).
Fetscher, Iring, ‘Zur Aktualität der politischen Philosophie Hegels’, in Reinhard Hiede and
Joachim Ritter (eds), Hegel-Bilanz (Frankfurt-am-Main: Vittorio Klostermann, 1973),
pp. 193–213.
Feuerbach, Ludwig, Geschichte der Neuern Philosophie von Bacon von Verulam bis Benedict
Spinoza, in Sämtliche Werke, Vol. III, ed. Friedrich Jodl and Wilhelm Bolin (Stuttgart:
Frommann Verlag, 1959).
Feuerbach, Ludwig, ‘Grundsatze der Philosophie der Zukunft’, in Sämtliche Werke, Vol. II, ed.
Friedrich Jodl and Wilhelm Bolin (Stuttgart: Frommann Verlag, 1959), pp. 245–265.
Feuerbach, Ludwig, The Essence of Christianity, trans. George Eliot (New York: Harper and
Row, 1957).
Feuerbach, Ludwig, ‘Vorläufige Theses zur Reform der Philosophie’, in Sämtliche Werke,
Vol. II, ed. Friedrich Jodl and Wilhelm Bolin (Stuttgart: Frommann Verlag, 1959),
pp. 224–243.
Feuerbach, Ludwig, ‘Zur Kritik der Hegelschen Philosophie’, in Sämtliche Werke, Vol. II, ed.
Friedrich Jodl and Wilhelm Bolin (Stuttgart: Frommann Verlag, 1959), pp. 159–203.
Fourier, Charles, The Theory of Four Movements, trans. Gareth Stedman Jones (Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1996).
Franco, Paul, Hegel’s Philosophy of Freedom (New Haven: Yale University Press, 1999).
Fulda, Hans Friedrich, ‘Hegels Dialektik als Begriffsbewegung und Darstellungsweise’, in
Rolf-Peter Horstmann (ed.), Seminar: Dialektik in der Philosophie Hegels (Frankfurt-am-
Main: Suhrkamp, 1978), pp. 124–176.
Fulda, Hans Friedrich, ‘Zum Theorietypus der Hegelschen Rechtsphilosophie’, in Rolf-Peter
Hortsmann (ed.), Hegels Philosophie des Recht (Stuttgart: Klett-Cotta, 1982), pp. 412–427.
Furet, François, Marx and the French Revolution, trans. Deborah Kan Furet (Chicago: University
of Chicago Press, 1984).
344 Bibliography
Gadamer, H. G., Hegel’s Dialectic: Five Studies, trans. P. Christopher Smith (New Haven: Yale
University Press, 1976).
Gans, Eduard, Das Erbrecht In weltgeschichtlicher Entwicklung, 2 Vols (Berlin: Maurerschen
Buchhandlung, 1824).
Gans, Eduard, ‘Erwidering auf Schubarth’, in Manfred Reidel (ed.), Materialen zu Hegels
Rechtsphilosophie, 2 Vols (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1975).
Gans, Eduard, Naturrecht und Universalrechtsgeschichte, ed. Johann Braun (Berlin: Mohr
Siebeck, 2005).
Gans, Eduard, ‘Vorwärts zur 2 Ausgabe der Rechtsphilosophie’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.),
Materialen zu Hegels Rechtsphilosophie, 2 Vols (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1975).
Gould, Carol, Marx’s Social Ontology (Cambridge, MA: MIT Press, 1978).
Gregoire, Franz, ‘Is the Hegel State Totalitarian?’, in Jon Stewart (ed.), The Hegel Myths and
Legends (Evanston: Northwestern University Press, 1996), pp. 104–108.
Halper, Edward, ‘The Logic of Hegel’s Philosophy of Nature’, in Steven Houlgate (ed.), Hegel’s
Philosophy of Nature (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1998), pp. 29–51.
Hardimon, Michael, O., Hegel’s Social Theory (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
1994).
Harris, Henry Silton, Between Kant and Hegel (Albany: State University of New York Press,
1985).
Harris, Henry Silton, Hegel’s Development toward the Sun, 1770–1801 (Oxford: Oxford
University Press, 1972).
Harris, Henry Silton, Hegel’s Development, Night Thoughts, 1801–1806 (Oxford: Oxford
University Press, 1983).
Harris, Henry Silton, ‘How Final Is Hegel’s Rejection of Evolution’, in Stephen Houlgate
(ed.), Hegel and the Philosophy of Nature (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1998),
pp. 189–208.
Hartmann, Klaus, Die Marxsche Theorie (Berlin: Walter de Gruyter, 1970).
Haym, Rudolf, Hegel und Seiner Zeit (Berlin: Rudolf Gaertner, 1857).
Hegel, G. W. F., Die Philosophie des Rechts: Vorlesung Von 1821/1822, ed. Hans Georg Hoppe
(Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 2005).
Hegel, G. W. F., Kritische Journal der Philosophie (Hildesheim: Georg Olms Verlagsbuchhandlung,
1967).
Hegel, G. W. F., Hegel: Early Theological Writings, trans. T. M. Knox (Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 1948).
Hegel, G. W. F., Die Philosophie des Rechts (1818-1819), ed. Karl-Heinz Ilting (Stuttgart/Bad
Cannstatt: Klett-Cotta, 1983).
Hegel, G. W. F., Dokumente zu Hegels Entwicklung, ed. Johannes Hoffmeister (Stuttgart:
Frommann Verlag, 1936).
Hegel, G. W. F., Hegel’s ‘Encyclopedia der Philosophischen Wissenschaften’ (1830), ed. Herbert
Schnädelbach (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 2000).
Hegel, G. W. F., Faith and Knowledge, trans. Walter Cerf and H. S. Harris (Albany: State
University of New York Press, 1977).
Hegel, G. W. F., Grundlinien des Philosoophie des Rechts, ed. Ludwig Siep (Berlin: Akademie
Verlag, 1997).
Hegel, G. W. F., Gesamelte Werke (Berlin: Verlag Duncker und Humblot, 1832–1845).
Hegel, G. W. F., Hegel: Political Writings, ed. Laurence Dickey and H. B. Nisbet (Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1999).
Hegel, G. W. F., Hegel’s Political Writings, trans. T. M. Knox (Chicago: University of Chicago
Press, 1964).
Hegel, G. W. F., ‘How the Ordinary Understanding Takes Philosophy’, trans. H. S. Harris, in
George Di Giovanni and H. S. Harris (eds), Between Kant and Hegel: Texts in the Development
of German Idealism (Albany: State University Press of New York, 1985).
Hegel, G. W. F., Jenenser Logik, Metaphysik, und Naturphilosophie, ed. Georg Lasson (Leipzig:
F. Meiner, 1923).
Bibliography 345
Hegel, G. W. F., Jenaer Realphilosophie, ed. Johannes Hoffmeister, 2 Vols (Leipzig: F. Meiner,
1931).
Hegel, G. W. F., Lectures on Fine Arts, trans. T. M. Knox, 2 Vols (Oxford: Clarendon Press,
1979).
Hegel, G. W. F., Lectures on the Philosophy of Religion, ed. Peter C. Hodgson (Berkeley:
University of California Press, 1988).
Hegel, G. W. F., Logic, trans. William Wallace (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1975).
Hegel, G. W. F., Philosophie des Recht: Die Vorlesung von 1819/1820, ed. Dieter Heinrich
(Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp Verlag, 1983).
Hegel, G. W. F., ‘On the Relationship Between Skepticism to Philosophy’, in H. S. Harris (ed.),
Between Kant and Hegel (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1985).
Hegel, G. W. F., ‘On the Essence of Philosophical Criticism in the Present State of Philosophy’,
in H. S. Harris (ed.), Between Kant and Hegel (Albany: State University of New York Press,
1985).
Hegel, G. W. F., Sämtliche Werke, ed. Hermann Glockner (Stuttgart: F. Frommann, 1956–1965),
26 Vols.
Hegel, G. W. F., Schriften zur Politik und Rechtsphilosophie, ed. Georg Lasson (Leipzig:
F. Meiner, 1923).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Difference between Fichte’s and Schelling’s ‘System der Philosophie’, trans.
Walter Cerf and H. S. Harris (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1977).
Hegel, G. W. F., The History of Philosophy, trans. E. S. Haldane (Lincoln: University of
Nebraska Press, 1995), 3 Vols.
Hegel, G. W. F., The Phenomenology of Spirit, trans. A. V. Miller (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1977).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Philosophy of History, trans. J. Sibree (Buffalo: Prometheus Books, 1991).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Philosophy of Nature, trans. A. V. Miller (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 2004).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Philosophy of Mind, trans. A. V. Miller (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1971).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Philosophical Propaedeutic, trans. A. V. Miller (Boston: Basil Blackwell, 1986).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Philosophy of Religion, ed. Peter Hodgson (Berkeley: University of
California Press, 1983–1987).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Philosophy of Right, trans. T. M. Knox (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1942).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Science of Logic, trans. A. V. Miller (Atlantic Highlands: Humanities Press,
1989).
Hegel, G. W. F., The Scientific Ways of Treating Natural Law, trans. T. M. Knox (Philadelphia:
University of Pennsylvania Press, 1975).
Hegel, G. W. F., System of Ethical Life and the First Philosophy of Spirit, trans. T. M. Knox, ed.
H. S. Harris (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1979).
Hegel, G. W. F., Three Essays, trans. Peter Fuss and John Dobbins (Notre Dame: University
of Notre Dame, 1984).
Hegel, G. W. F., Vorlesungen über Naturrecht und Staatswissenschaft: Heidelberg Vorlesungen
1817/1818, ed. Otto Pöggeler (Hamburg: Felix Meiner Verlag, 1983), Vol. 1.
Hegel, G. W. F., Vorlesungen über Rechtsphilosophie, ed. Karl-Heinz Ilting, 6 Vols (Stuttgart-Bad
Cannstatt: Friedrich Frommann Verlag, 1973).
Heine, Heinrich, Religion and Philosophy In Germany, trans. Howard Pollack-Milgate
(Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2007).
von Henning, Leopold, Prinzipien der Ethik in historische Entwicklung (Berlin: Friedrich August
Herbig, 1829).
Henrich, Dieter, Between Kant and Hegel, ed. David S. W. Pacini (Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press, 2008).
Henrich, Dieter, ‘Logische Form und reale Totalität’, in Dieter Henrich und Rolf-Peter
Horstmann (eds), Hegels Philosophie des Rechts (Stuttgart: Klett-Cotta, 1982), pp. 428–450.
Hess, Moses, ‘Die Eine und Ganze Freiheit’, in Georg Herwegh (ed.), Einundzwanzig Bogen aus
der Schweiz (Zurich: Verlag des Literarischen Comptoirs, 1843), pp. 93–97.
Hess, Moses, ‘Die Philosophie der Tat’, in Georg Herwegh (ed.), Einundzwanzig Bogen aus der
Schweiz (Zurich: Verlag der Literarischen Comptoirs, 1843), pp. 309–334.
346 Bibliography
Jones, Gareth Stedman, ‘Introduction’ to K. Marx and F. Engels, The Communist Manifesto
(New York: Penguin Publishers, 2003), pp. 3–185.
Kelley, D. R., Historians and the Law in Post-Revolutionary France (Princeton: Princeton
University Press, 1984).
Kelley, D. R., ‘The Metaphysics of Law: An Essay on the Young Marx’, The American Historical
Review, Vol. 83, No. 2 (1978), pp. 350–367.
Kelly, George Armstrong, Hegel’s Retreat from Eleusis (Princeton: Princeton University Press,
1978).
Kelly, George Armstrong, Idealism, Politics and History (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1969).
Kimmerle, Heinz, Die Eigenbedeuting der Jenaer Systemkonzeptionen Hegels (Berlin: Akademie
Verlag, 2004).
Kittsteiner, Heinz-Dieter, ‘Logische und Historisch’, International Wissenschaft zur Geschichte
der deutschen Arbeiterbewegung, No. 13 (1977), pp. 93–153.
Kittsteiner, Heinz-Dieter, Natur-Absicht und unsichtbare Hand (Frankfurt-am-Main: Ullstein
Verlag, 1980).
Koeppen, K. F., ‘Über Schubarths Unvereinbarkeit der Hegelschen Lehre mit dem Preussischen
Staate’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.), Materialen zu Hegels Rechtsphilosophie (Frankfurt-am-Main:
Suhrkamp, 1975), Vol. I.
Kojève, Alexandre, Introduction to the Reading of Hegel, trans. James H. Nichol Jr (Ithaca:
Cornell University Press, 1969).
Köppen, Carl Friedrich, Freidrich der Grosse (Leipzig: Verlag von Otto Wiegand, 1840).
Kosík, Karel, The Dialectic of the Concrete, trans. Karl Kovanda (Dordrecht: Reidel Publishing,
1970).
Kouvelakis, Stathis, Philosophy and Revolution from Kant to Marx, trans. G. M. Goshgarian
(London: Verso, 2003).
Krahl, Hans-Jürgen, ‘Bemerkung zum Verhältnis von Kapital und Hegelscher Wesenslogik’,
in Oskar Negt (ed.), Aktualität und Folgen der Philosophie Hegel (Frankfurt-am-Main:
Europaischer Verlag, 1970), pp. 137–150.
Lange, Ernst Michael, ‘Wertformanalyse, Geldkritik und die Konstruction des Fetischismus
bei Marx’, Neuen Hefte für Philosophie (Göttingen: Vandenhoeck und Ruprecht), No. 13
(1978), pp. 1–46.
Lenin, Vladimir, ‘Conspectus of the Book The Holy Family by Marx and Engels’, in Lenin:
Collected Works (Moscow: Progress Publishers, 1976), Vol. 38, p. 30.
Leopold, David, ‘The State and I: Max Stirner’s Anarchism’, in Douglas Moggach (ed.), The
New Hegelians (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2006), pp. 176–199.
Leopold, David, The Young Karl Marx (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2007).
Levine, Andrew, The End of the State (London: Verso, 1987).
Levine, Norman, Dialogue within the Dialectic (London: George Allen and Unwin, 1984).
Levine, Norman, Divergent Paths: Hegel in Marxism and Engelsism (Lanham: Rowman and
Littlefield, 2006).
Levine, Norman, The Process of Democratization (Albany: State University of New York Press,
1989).
Levine, Norman, The Tragic Deception: Marx contra Engels (Santa Barbara: Clio Books, 1975).
Levine, Norman, ‘Anthropology in the Thought of Marx and Engels’, Studies in Comparative
Communism, Spring, 1973, pp. 105–120.
Levine, Norman, ‘Corruption and Fate of Left-Wing Hegelianism’, Critique, Vol. 35, No. 1
(April 2007), pp. 79–103.
Levine, Norman, ‘Das Kapital: A Critique of the Labor Theory of Value’, Critique, Vol. 36,
No. 1 (April 2008), pp. 91–107.
Levine, Norman, ‘Bloch and Lukács’, in Michael Löwy (ed.), De-Hegelianizing Marx (Paris:
Editions Sud, 1986), pp. 22–45.
Levine, Norman, ‘The Discovery of “Das Vollendete Geldsystem”’, Central European History
(September 1976), pp. 301–320.
348 Bibliography
Levine, Norman, ‘Hegel and the 1861–1863 Manuscripts’, Rethinking Marxism, Vol. 14, No. 4
(Winter 2002), pp. 47–58.
Levine, Norman, ‘Hegelian Continuities in Marx’, Critique, Vol. 37, No. 3 (August 2009),
pp. 345–370.
Levine, Norman, ‘Jacobinism and the European Revolutionary Tradition’, History of European
Ideas, Vol. 11 (1989), pp. 157–180.
Levine, Norman, ‘Marx’s First Appropriation of Hegel’, Critique, No. 36–37 ( June 2005),
pp. 125–156.
Levine, Norman, ‘The German Historical School of Law and the Origins of Historical
Materialism’, The Journal of the History of Ideas, Vol. 48, No. 3 ( July–September 1987),
pp. 431–452.
Levine, Norman, ‘The Myth of the Asiatic Restoration’, The Journal of Asian Studies, Vol. 37,
No. 1 (November 1977), pp. 73–85.
Levine, Norman, ‘Toward the Repotentialization of a Marxist Theory of Politics’, Praxis
International, Vol. 8, No. 2, ( July 1988), pp. 237–249.
Liedman, Sven-Eric, The Game of Contradictions: The Philosophy of Friedrich Engels and the
Science of the 19th Century (Lund: Cavefors, 1977).
Löwith, Karl, Die Hegelsche Linke (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Friedrich Frommann Verlag, 1962).
Löwith, Karl, From Hegel to Nietzsche, trans. David E. Green (New York: Holt, Rinehart and
Winston, 1964).
Löwy, Michael, The Theory of Revolution in the Young Marx (Boston: Brill, 2003).
Lübbe, Hermann, Die Hegelsche Rechte (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Friedrich Frommann Verlag,
1962).
Lucas, Hans-Christian, ‘Der Junge Hegel Zwischen Revolution und Reform’, in Martin
Bondeli and Helmut Linneweber-Lammersketten (eds), Hegels Entwicklung in der Berner und
Frankfurter Zeit (Munich: Wilhelm Fink Verlag, 1999).
Lucas, Hans Christian and Pöggeler, Otto, Hegels Rechtsphilosophie (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt:
Frommann-Holzboog, 1986).
Lucas, Hans-Christian and Planty-Bonjour, Guy, Logik und Geschichte in Hegels System
(Stuttgart: Frommann-Holzboog, 1989).
Lucas, Hans-Christian, ‘Wer hat die Verfassung zu machen, das Volk oder wer Anders?’,
in Hans Christian Lucas and Otto Pöggeler (eds), Hegels Rechtsphilosophie (Stuttgart-Bad
Cannstatt: Frommann-Holzboog, 1986).
Lukács, Georg, The Young Hegel, trans. Rodney Livingstone (Cambridge, MA: MIT Press,
1975).
MacGregor, David, Hegel, Marx and the English State (Boulder: Westview Press, 1992).
MacPherson, C. B., The Political Theory of Possessive Individualism (Oxford: Oxford University
Press, 1964).
Mah, Harold, The End of Ideology, the Origin of Ideology (Berkeley: University of California
Press, 1987).
Marcuse, Herbert, Hegel’s Ontology and the Theory of Historicity, trans. Seyla Benhabid
(Cambridge, MA: MIT Press, 1987).
Marcuse, Herbert, Reason and Revolution (Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1941).
Marcuse, Herbert, Soviet Marxism (New York: Columbia University Press, 1958).
Marheinecke, Philipp, Bedeuting der Hegelschen Philosophie in der Christlichen Theologie (Berlin:
Verlag Th. Chr. Fr. Enslen, 1842).
Marheinecke, Philipp, System der Christlichen Dogmatik (Berlin: Verlag Duncker und
Humblot, 1847).
Markov, Walter, Jacques Roux und Karl Marx (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 1965).
Maruhn, Jürgen, Die Kritik an der Stirnerschen Ideologie im Werk Karl Marx und Friedrich Engels
(Frankfurt-am-Main: R. G. Fischer Verlag, 1982).
Mauer, Reinhart, ‘Die Aktualität der Hegelschen Geschichtsphilosophie’, in Reinhard Hiede
and Joachim Ritter (eds), Hegel-Bilanz (Frankfurt-Am-Main: Vittorio Klostermann, 1973),
pp. 166–174.
Bibliography 349
Marx, Karl, Aristotle’s ‘The Soul’, Mega2, Abteiling IV, Band II, pp. 155–180.
Marx, Karl, Early Writings, ed. Lucio Colletti (London: Penguin Publishers, 1974).
Marx, Karl, Early Political Writings, ed. Joseph O’Malley (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1984).
Marx, Karl, Economic and Philosophic Manuscripts of 1844, ed. Dick J. Struik, trans. Martin
Milligan (New York: International Publishers, 1964).
Marx, Karl, Das Elend der Philosophie, ed. Hans Pelger (Berlin: Verlag J. H. W. Dietz, 1979).
Marx, Karl, Das Capital, trans. Ben Fowkes (New York: Random House, 1976).
Marx, Karl, Grundrisse, trans. Martin Nicolaus (New York: Penguin Books, 1973).
Marx, Karl, Later Political Writings, ed. Terrell Carver (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1996).
Marx, Karl, The German Ideology, trans. S. Ryazanskaya (London: Lawrence and Wishart,
1965).
Marx, Karl, The Holy Family, trans. R. Dixon (Moscow: Foreign Language Publishing House,
1956).
Marx, Karl, The Poverty of Philosophy (New York: International Publishers, 1963).
Marx, Karl and Engels, Friedrich, Marx-Engels Collected Works (MECW), 50 Vols (New York:
International Publishers, 1975).
Marx, Karl and Engels, Friedrich, Marx-Engels Gesamtausgabe (2) (Mega2) (Berlin: Dietz
Verlag, 1976).
Marx, Karl and Engels, Friedrich, Marx-Engels Werke (MEW), 50 Vols (Berlin: Dietz Verlag,
1988).
Marx, Karl and Engels, Friedrich, ‘Die Deutsche Ideologie’, ed. Hans Pelgar and Inge Taubert,
Marx-Engels Jahrbüch (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 2003).
McCarney, Joseph, Hegel on History (New York: Routledge, 2007).
McCarney, Joseph, Social Theory and the Crisis of Marxism (New York: Verso, 1990).
McCarthy, George C., Marx and the Ancients (Savage, MD: Rowman and Littlefield, 1990).
McCarthy, George C., Marx and Aristotle (Savage, MD: Rowman and Littlefield, 1992).
McCarthy, George C., Marx’s Critique of Science and Positivism (Boston: Kluwer, 1988).
Meany, Mark E., Capital as Social Unity (Dordrecht: Kluwer Publishers, 2002).
Meikle, Scott, Essentialism in the Thought of Karl Marx (London: Duckworth, 1985).
Meikle, Scott, ‘History of Philosophy: The Metaphysics of Substance in Marx’, in Terrell
Carver (ed.), The Cambridge Companion to Marx (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
1991), pp. 196–320.
Michelet, Carl Ludwig, Anthropologie und Psychologie oder die Philosophie der subjectiven Spirit
(Berlin: Sanderschen Buchhandlung, 1840).
Michelet, Karl Ludwig, Die Ethik der Aristotles in Ihrem Verhältnisse zum System der Moral
(Berlin: Duncker und Humblot, 1829).
Michelet, Karl Ludwig, Die Lösung der gesellschaftlichen Frage (Berlin: Verlag von Trowitgsch
und Sohn, 1849).
Michelet, Karl Ludwig, Entwicklungsgeschichte der neuen deutschen Philosophie (Berlin: Duncker
und Humblot, 1843).
Michelet, Karl Ludwig, Geschichte der letzten System der Philosophie in Deutschland von Kant bis
Hegel, 2 Vols (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot, 1837).
Michelet, Karl Ludwig, Naturrecht oder Rechts-Philosophie als die praktische Philosophie, 2 Vols
(Berlin: Nicolaische Verlagsbuchhandlung, 1866).
Michelet, Karl Ludwig, ‘Zur Verfassungsfrage’, in Hermann Lübbe (ed.), Die Hegelsche Recht
(Stuttgart-Bad Cannstaat: Friedrich Frommann Verlag, 1962), pp. 180–191.
Moggach, Douglas, The Philosophy and Politics of Bruno Bauer (Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 2003).
Moggach, Douglas, The New Hegelians (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2006).
Moggach, Douglas, ‘Republican Rigorism and Emancipation in Bruno Bauer’, in Douglas
Moggach (ed.), The New Hegelians (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2006),
pp. 114–135.
350 Bibliography
Montesquieu, Charles Louis de Secondat, The Spirit of the Laws, ed. David Wallace Carrithers
(Berkeley: University of California Press, 1977).
Moseley, Fred, Marx’s Method in Capital: A Reexamination (Atlantic Highlands: Humanities
Press, 1993).
Moseley, Fred and Campbell, Martha, New Interpretations of Marx’s Method (Atlantic
Highlands: Humanities Press, 1997).
Moser, Matthias, Hegels Schüler C. L. Michelet (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot, 2003).
Mueller, Gustav, ‘The Hegel Legend of Theses-Antitheses-Syntheses’, in Jon Stewart (ed.), The
Hegel Myths and Legends (Evanston: Northwestern University Press, 1996), pp. 300–305.
Murray, Patrick, Marx’s Theory of Scientific Knowledge (Atlantic Highlands: Humanities Press,
1988).
Nancy, Jean-Luc, The Restlessness of the Negative, trans. Jason Smith and Steven Miller
(Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 2002).
Neuhouser, Frederick, Foundations of Hegel’s Social Theory (Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press, 2000).
Negt, Oskar, Aktualität und Folgen der Philosophie Hegel (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp,
1970).
Offe, Klaus, Modernity and the State (Cambridge: Polity Press, 1996).
Oisermann, Teodor, ‘Zür Frage einer positive Bewertung der Widerspruche der
Rechtsphilosophie Hegels,’ in Dieter Henrich and Rolf-Peter Horstmann (eds), Hegels
Philosophie des Rechts (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Klett-Cotta, 1980), pp. 180–210.
Ottmann, Henning, ‘Hegel and Political Trends’, in Jon Stewart (ed.), The Hegel Myths and
Legends (Evanston: Northwestern University Press, 1996), pp. 53–68.
Oz-Salzberger, Fania, Translating the Enlightenment (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1995).
Pelczynski, Z. A., Hegel’s Political Philosophy (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1971).
Pelczynski, Z. A., The State and Civil Society (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1984).
Pelger, Hans and Taubert, Inge, ‘Karl Marx, Friedrich Engels, Joseph Weydemeyer; Die
Deutsche Ideologie’, Mega-Studien, Vol. 2 (Berlin: Dietz Verlag, 1997).
Peperzak, Adriaan, Hegels praktische Philosophie (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Frommann-
Holzboog, 1991).
Peperzak, Adriaan, Modern Freedom (Dordrecht: Kluwer Publishers, 2001).
Pepperle, Heinz and Ingrid, Die Hegelsche Linke: Dokumente zu Philosophie und Politik Im deut-
schen Vormärz (Leipzig: Verlag Philipp Reclam, 1985).
Pinkard, Terry, Hegel (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2000).
Pippin, Robert, Hegel’s Idealism (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1989).
Plenge, Johann, Marx und Hegel (Tübingen: Verlag H. Lauppschen Buchhandlung, 1911).
Pocock, John G. A., The Machiavellian Moment (Princeton: Princeton University Press,
1975).
Pöggeler, Otto, ‘Die “Phänomenologie” . . . Konsequences oder krise in der Entwicklung
Hegels’, in Heinz Kimmerle (ed.), Die Eigenbedeuting der Jenaer Systemkonzeptionen Hegels
(Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 2004).
Pöggeler, Otto, ‘Hegels Begegnung mit Preussen’, in Hans-Christian Lucas and Otto Pöggeler
(eds), Hegels Rechtsphilosophie (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt; Frommann-Holzboog, 1986),
pp. 311–352.
Proudhon, Pierre-Joseph, What Is Property?, trans. Donald R. Kelley and Bonnie G. Smith
(Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1994).
Proudhon, Pierre-Joseph, The Philosophy of Poverty, trans. Benjamin Tucker (Boston, 1888).
Reichelt, Helmut, ‘Warum hat Marx seiner dialektische Methode Versteckt?’, Beiträge zur
Marx-Engels Forschung (Berlin: Argument Verlag, 1996), pp. 73–110.
Riedel, Manfred, ‘Anthropologie bei Hegel und Marx’, in Mandred Riedel (ed.), System und
Geschichte (Frankfurt: Suhrkamp, 1973), pp. 131–156.
Riedel, Manfred, Between Tradition and Revolution, trans. Walter Wright (Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1984).
Riedel, Manfred, Bürgerliche Gesellschaft und Staat (Berlin: Hermann Luchterhand, 1970).
Bibliography 351
Riedel, Manfred, ‘Die Vermittlungsformen mit dem Staat: Polizei und Korporation’, in
Manfred Riedel (ed.), Materialen zu Hegels Rechtsphilosophie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp,
1975), Vol. 2, pp. 54–70.
Riedel, Manfred, ‘Einleitung’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.), Materialen zu Hegels Rechtsphilosophie
(Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1975), Vol. I, pp. 15–40.
Riedel, Manfred, ‘Hegels Begriff des Arbeit’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.), System und Geschichte
(Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1973), pp. 14–38.
Riedel, Manfred, ‘Hegels Begriff der bürgerlichen Gesellschaft und das Problem seines
geschichtlichen Ursprung’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.), Materialen zu Hegels Rechtsphilosophie
(Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1975), Vol. 2, pp. 247–275.
Riedel, Manfred, Hegel und die antike Dialektik (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1990).
Riedel, Manfred, Materialen zu Hegels Rechtsphilosophie, 2 Vols (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp,
1975).
Riedel, Manfred, Naturrecht und Universalrechtsgeschichte (Hamburg: Klett-Cotta, 1990).
Riedel, Manfred, ‘Objective Geist und praktische Philosophie’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.),
Studien zu Hegels Rechtsphilosophie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1969), pp. 11–41.
Riedel, Manfred, Studien zu Hegels Rechtsphilosopie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1969).
Riedel, Manfred, System und Geschichte (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1973).
Rigby, S. H., Engels and the Formation of Marxism (Manchester: Manchester University Press,
1992).
Ritter, Joachim, Hegel and the French Revolution, trans. Richard Dien Winfield (Cambridge,
MA: MIT Press, 1982).
Ritter, Joachim, ‘Moralität und Sittlichkeit’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.), Materialen zu Hegels
Rechtsphilosophie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1975), pp. 217–230.
Rockmore, Tom, Fichte and Marx and the German Philosophical Tradition (Carbondale:
Southern Illinois University Press, 1980).
Rockmore, Tom, Before and after Hegel (Berkeley: University of California Press, 1992).
Rojahn, Jürgen, ‘Die Marxschen Manuscript aus dem Jahre 1844 in der neuen Marx-Engels
Gesamtausgabe’, Archive für Sozialgeschichte, Vol. 25 (1985), pp. 647–663.
Rojahn, Jürgen, ‘Marxismus – Marx – Geschichtswissenschaft . . . 1844’, International Review
of Social History, Vol. 28 (1983), pp. 2–49.
Rosdolsky, Roman, Zür Entstehungsgeschichte des Marxschen ‘Kapital’ (Frankfurt-am-Main:
Europäischer Verlagsanstalt, 1969).
Rosen, Zvi, Bruno Bauer and Karl Marx (The Hague: Nijhoff, 1977).
Rosenkranz, Karl, Hegels Leben (Berlin: Duncker und Humblot, 1844).
Rosenkranz, Karl, ‘Einleitung [Foreword]’ to Philosophische Propadeutic, in Hegels Sämtliche
Werke (Stuttgart: F. Frommann Verlag, 1929), Vol. 18.
Rosenkranz, Karl, Psychologie: oder die Wissenschaft vom subjectiven Geist (Königsberg: Verlag
der Gebruder Borntrager, 1837).
Röttges, Heinz, Der Begriff der Method in der Philosophie Hegels (Meisenheim am Glan: Verlag
Anton Hain, 1976).
Röttges, Heinz, Dialektik und Skeptizismus (Frankfurt: Suhrkamp, 1987).
Rousseau, Jean-Jacques, The Social Contract and the Discourses, trans. G. D. H. Cole (New York:
Alfred A. Knopf, 1975).
Rubel, Maximilien and Manale, Margaret, Marx without Myth (New York: Harper Torchbooks,
1976).
Ruge, Arnold, ‘Die Hegelsche Rechtsphilosophie und die Politik unserer Zeit’, in Heinz and Ingrid
Pepperle (eds), Die Hegelsche Linke (Leipzig: Verlag Philipp Reclam, 1985), pp. 443–472.
Ruge, Arnold, ‘Eine Selbstkritik des Liberalismus’, in Heinz and Ingrid Pepperle (eds), Die
Hegelsche Linke (Leipzig: Verlag Philipp Reclam, 1985), pp. 546–569.
Sayers, Sean and Norman, Richard, Hegel, Marx and Dialectic (Sussex: The Harvester Press,
1980).
Sayers, Sean, ‘Freedom and the Realm of Necessity’, in Douglas Moggach (ed.), The New
Hegelians (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2006), pp. 261–274.
352 Bibliography
Schmidt am Busch, Hans-Christoph, Hegels Begriff der Arbeit (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 2002).
Schmidt, Alfred, History and Structure, trans. Jeffrey Herf (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1983).
Schmied-Kowarzik, Wolfdietrich, ‘Die Bedeutung der “Mitten” des Bewusstseins (Sprach,
Arbeit, Familie) in Hegels Systementwurf von 1803/04 und die spätere verändete
Konzeption’, in Heinz Kimmerle (ed.), Die Eigenbedeutung der Jenaer Systemkonzeptionen
Hegels (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1985), pp. 135–147.
Schnädelbach, Herbert, ‘Die Verfassung der Freiheit’, in Ludwig Siep (ed.), Grundlinien der
Philosophie des Rechts (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 1997), pp. 243–265.
Schnädelbach, Herbert, System der Sittlichkeit (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1976).
Schrader, Fred E., Restauration und Revolution (Bonn: Gerstenberg Verlag, 1980).
Schubarth, K. E., ‘Über die Unvereinbarkeit der Hegelschen Staatslehre mit dem ober-
sten Lebens- und Entwicklungprinzip der Preussischen Staats’, in Manfred Riedel (ed.),
Materialen zu Hegel’s Rechtsphilosophie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1975), Vol. 1,
pp. 80–95.
Schüler, Gisela, ‘Zur Chronologie von Hegels Jugendschriften’, Hegel-Studien, Vol. 2, 1963,
pp. 111–159.
Schulz, Wilhelm, Die Bewegung der Produktion (Zurich: Zurich und Winterthur, 1843).
Shaw, William, Karl Marx’s Theory of History (Stanford: Stanford University Press, 1978).
Sheehan, Helena, Marx and the Philosophy of Science (Atlantic Highlands: Humanities Press,
1993).
Siep, Ludwig, Anerkennung als Prinzip der praktische Philosophie (Munich: Verlag Karl Alber
Freiburg, 1979).
Siep, Ludwig, Grundlinien der Philosophie des Rechts (Berlin: Alademie Verlag, 1997).
Siep, Ludwig, ‘Hegels Theorie der Gewaltenteilung’, in Hans-Christian Lucas and Otto
Pöggeler (eds), Hegels Rechtsphilosophie (Stuttgart-Bad Cannstatt: Frommann-Holzboog,
1986), pp. 387–420.
Siep, Ludwig, ‘Intersubjectivität, Recht und Staat in Hegels Grundlinien der Philosophie des
Rechts’, in Dieter Henrich und Rolf-Peter Horstmann (eds), Hegels Philosophie des Rechts
(Stuttgart: Klett-Cotta, 1982), pp. 255–276.
Siep, Ludwig, ‘Vernunftrecht und Rechtsgeschichte’, in Grundlinien der Philosophie des Rechts
(Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 1997), pp. 6–29.
Smith, Steven, Hegel’s Critique of Liberalism (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1989).
Smith, Tony, The Logic of Marx’s Capital (Albany: State University of New York Press, 1990).
Smith, Tony, Dialectical Social Theory and Its Critics (Albany: State University of New York
Press, 1993).
Stederoth, Dirk, Hegels Philosophie der subjektiven Geistes (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 2001).
Stepelevich, Lawrence, The Young Hegelians (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1983).
Steuart, James, An Enquiry into the Principles of Political Economy [1767], ed. Andrew S. Skinner
(Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1966).
Stewart, Jon, The Hegel Myths and Legends (Evanston: Northwestern University Press, 1996).
Stillman, Peter G., Hegel’s Philosophy of Spirit (Albany: State University of New York Press,
1987).
Stirner, Max, The Ego and Its Own, ed. David Leopold (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1995).
Stuhr, Peter, Die Staaten des Alterthum und die christliche Zeit (Heidelberg: Mohr und Zimmer,
1811).
Taylor, Charles, Hegel and Modern Society (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1980).
Taylor, Charles, Hegel (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1979).
Theunissen, Michael, Sein und Schein (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1980).
Theunissen, Michael, ‘Begriff und Realität Hegels Aufhebung der Metaphysische
Wahrheitsbegriff ’, in Rolf-Peter Horstmann (ed.), Seminar: Dialektik in der Philosophie
Hegels (Frankfurt-am-Main: Suhrkamp, 1978), pp. 100–120.
Bibliography 353
Thibaut, Anton Friedrich Justus, Über die sogenannte historische und nicht-historische
Rechtsschule (Heidelberg: 1838).
Toews, John, Hegelianism (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1980).
Tugendhat, Ernst, Self-Consciousness and Self-Determination, trans. Paul Stern (Cambridge,
MA: MIT Press, 1986).
van Parijis, Philippe, Marxism Recycled (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1993).
Van Parijis, Philippe, Evolutionary Explanation in the Social Sciences (Totowa: Rowman and
Littlefield, 1981).
Waszek, Norbert, ‘Das Gemüth der Menschen Retten … zu Hegels Verschollen Kommentar
über Sir James Steuart’, in Martin Bondeli und Helmut Linneweber-Lammersketten (eds),
Hegels Denkenwicklung in der Berner und Frankfurter Zeit (Munich: Wilhelm Fink Verlag,
1999), pp. 277–294.
Waszek, Norbert, ‘Eduard Gans, die “Jahrbüch für wissenschaftliche Kritik” und die fran-
zösische Publizistik der Zeit’, in Christoph Jamme (ed.), Die Jahrbüch für wissenschaftliche
Kritik: Hegels Berlin Gegenakademie (Frankfurt-am-Main: Frommann und Holzboog, 1994),
pp. 93–119.
Waszek, Norbert, ‘Eduard Gans’, in Spekulation und Erfahrung (Frankfurt-am-Main: Frommann
und Holzboog, 1995), Section I, Band I.
Waszek, Norbert, Eduard Gans (Frankfurt-am-Main: P. Lang, 1991).
Waszek, Norbert, The Scottish Enlightenment and Hegel’s Account of ‘Civil Society’ (Dordrecht:
Kluwer Publishers, 1988).
Weitling, Wilhelm, Garantien der Harmonie und Freiheit (Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 1955).
Wood, Allen W., Karl Marx (New York: Routledge, 2004).
Wright, Erik Olin, Levine, Andrew and Sober, Elliot, Reconstructing Marxism (London: Verso,
1992).
Yovel, Yirmiahu, ‘Hegel’s Dictum that the Rational Is Actual and the Actual Is Rational: Its
Ontological Content and Its Function in Discourse’, in Jon Stewart (ed.), The Hegel Myths
and Legends (Evanston: Northwestern University Press, 1996), pp. 26–40.
Zelený, Jindřich, The Logic of Marx, trans. Terrell Carver (Totowa: Rowman and Littlefield,
1980).
Index
actuality 15, 24–26, 44, 54, 62, 67, 85, capitalism 18–20, 23, 59–60, 108, 160,
118–119, 122, 126–127, 144, 165, 185, 172, 178, 194–195, 197–199, 201, 204,
215, 219, 225–227, 231, 234, 249, 263, 227–228, 230–233, 236, 239, 248, 250,
285, 290, 297, 299–300, 308–309 253, 259, 267, 270, 275–276, 297,
Adoratskii V. V. 2, 205 309–313
alienation 5, 16, 19, 39, 126–127, 187, Cart, J. J. 41–42, 54, 70–71
209, 212–214, 223–227, 230–231, Carver, Terrell 2
233–234, 293, 305 Cieszkowski, August 101, 187
Althusser, Louis 4, 180, 199–200 Chitty, Andrew 144
Annenkov, P. V. 276 citoyen (Rousseau) 44, 49, 51, 198, 296–297
Antigone 214, 227–228 de Condillac, Bonnet 242, 246
appearance 84–85, 125–127, 132, 156, Continuity 1, 4, 12–19, 23, 49, 85, 103,
183, 214, 217, 234, 308 121, 130, 137, 144–145, 177–178, 180,
Aristotle 14, 29, 50, 69, 80, 102, 104, 181–183, 185, 195, 200–204, 208, 214,
115–117, 128, 133, 136, 140, 186, 202, 219, 252, 256, 298, 306
247, 287, 291–292, 300, 309, 323–325, Cuvier, Georges 282, 301
339
politics 44–49, 50–51,69, 86,91, 102, Darwin, Charles 301
123, 175, 212, 287, 292, 296–297 Democritus 4, 114–116, 118, 120,
The Rhetorik 50 122–124, 127–128, 138, 245–246
The Soul 49–50, 57, 67, 97, 140, 209, Descartes, René 120, 243, 246, 290, 298,
217–218, 251, 280–282, 337 300–301, 307
Arthur, Christopher 18–24 Dezamy, Theodor 246
The Dialectic of Labor 23 determination 21–22, 49, 100, 112, 122,
The New Dialectic and Marx’s Capital 127, 145, 148, 178–179, 183, 251, 286,
23–24 302, 310, 311
dialectic 3, 18, 20, 37, 67, 79, 86, 100,
Babeuf, Francois 196 108, 131, 136, 235, 245, 269, 272, 281,
Bacon, Francis 82, 112, 117, 120–121, 299, 302–305, 312–313
139, 243–246, 265–266, 300 dialectical materialism 31, 139, 312–313
Bauer, Bruno 5–7, 10–11, 24–25, 78–84, Diderot, Denis 30, 39, 214, 229, 251, 296
104, 106, 109, 112–114, 117–118, 121, Discontinuity 1, 4, 13, 19, 177, 180,
124, 130–131, 134, 137–139, 142, 181–183, 185–195, 199, 220, 252, 306
144–145, 180, 186, 197–199, 207,
220–222, 226, 230, 240–243, 245–248, Engels, Friedrich 4–5, 15, 18–19, 30, 54,
250–258, 261–263, 266, 268, 271 64–66, 82, 139, 147, 176, 242, 249,
Bayrhoffer, Theodor 103, 256, 261, 279, 269, 274, 310, 312–313
295 Enlightenment, the 59, 61–62, 76–77,
Bentham, Jeremy 229, 236, 251, 258–259 86, 90, 105, 114, 116–118, 148, 176,
Börne, Ludwig 142 223, 226, 228–229, 235–237, 243–245,
Boumann, Ludwig 38 258–259, 291–292, 299–300
Breckmann, Warren 13, 316 Epicurus 4, 112–120, 122–128, 130,
Buffon, Francis 301 134–135, 137–138, 240, 245–246
essence 12, 20–23, 26, 32, 95, 108, 116,
contradiction 11, 15, 21, 77, 79, 83–85, 126–127, 129–132, 138–139, 141,
112, 125–127, 129–130, 136, 140, 154, 156–157, 179, 183, 192, 195, 199,
156–157, 167, 178–200, 204, 212, 214, 204, 216, 224–226, 232, 234, 246–247,
227–229, 232, 243, 245, 251, 281 308–313
354
Index 355
Ferguson, Adam 16, 46, 52, 58–59, 199, Haym, Rudolf 3, 14, 42, 54, 66, 69–71,
269–270, 273–276 176
Feuerbach, Ludwig 2, 5–6, 10–11, 17–18, Heine, Heinrich 142, 285
25, 50, 84, 108, 120–121, 139–140, Heinrich, Dieter 3
180, 185, 192, 196–197, 199–201, 206, Hegel, Georg W. F.
208, 221, 223–225, 237, 240–246, 249, Absolute Spirit 24, 27, 97, 136,
253–256, 262, 271, 277, 289, 312 189–190, 208–209, 211, 214, 218, 241,
The Essence of Christianity 200, 206 280, 283, 288
Geschichte der neuern Philosophie von Bacon anthropology and psychology 67, 68,
von Verulam bis Benedict Spinoza 120, 96–98, 208, 217–218, 251, 259, 264,
139, 244–246 273, 284–285
Grundsätze der Philosophie der civil society 14–16, 28, 44–48, 174,
Zukunft 246 194–196, 286, 290–292
transformative critique 223–225 Critical Journal of Philosophy 7–9, 38–40,
Vorläufige Theses zur Reform der 92
Philosophie 120, 244–245 ethics 16, 29, 49, 51, 69, 72, 98, 103,
Zur Kritik der Hegelschen Philosophie 116, 135, 137, 223, 227, 252, 275,
244–245 279, 286–287, 289, 291–294, 296–297,
302
Fichte, Johann 3, 8, 24–26, 38–39, 73, Freedom of Self–Consciousness:
78, 82, 92–94, 108, 110–111, 166, 210, Stoicism, Scepticism and the Unhappy
219, 245, 299, 305 Consciousness 26, 117, 119, 124, 230,
First Appropriation of Hegel 4, 5, 31, 74, 240, 253
250, 295 Hegel’s Views on Education and
form–content 111, 178, 183, 191, Instruction 40, 42, 68, 70
195–197, 200, 222–224, 226 Hegelian Center 55, 65, 70, 74–86,
Frederick the Great 175–177 88–93, 95–96, 98–105, 107, 111–114,
French Revolution 14, 55, 60–61, 71, 177, 122–124, 128, 130–131, 134, 141–143,
180, 186, 1789 223; 90, 202; 146–151, 155, 159–161, 173, 180–181,
1793 238 219, 224, 256–258, 261–262, 279
1830 56, 65, 85, 101, 169–170 Hegelian Left 8, 65, 78, 84, 95, 105,
Jacobins 15, 64, 237–238, 290 107, 119, 130–131, 180, 188, 198, 219,
Reign of Terror 55, 60–61, 229 221, 240, 254, 268
Robespierre 14–15, 55, 60–61, 64–65, Hegelian Right 70, 79, 105–107, 148,
229, 237–238 150–151
Independence and Dependence of
Gans, Eduard 6, 9, 13, 36–38, 47, 53, 56, Self–Consciousness: Lordship and
65–66, 74–77, 80, 83–89, 90–92, 95, 99, Bondage 207
110–111, 114, 141, 153–154, 158, 164, intersubjectivity 19, 27–28, 43–44,
181, 256, 261 97–98, 101, 116, 135, 156, 162, 191,
Das Erbrecht in weltgeschichtlicher 194–196, 198, 209–210, 213, 262,
Entwicklung 88, 90 288–290, 294
Introduction: The Philosophy of History 84 inverted world 205, 209, 213–214, 222,
Introduction: The Philosophy of Right 84, 226–227, 230, 236
86, 154–155 Lectures on Aesthetics 34
Gassendi, Pierre 118, 120, 245–246 On the Recent Domestic Affairs of
Gay, Jules 246 Württemberg 41–42, 71
genus–species 178 In the Scientific Ways of Treating Natural
von Goethe, Johann Wolfgang 281–282, Law 46–47
301, 313 Objective Spirit 26–28, 96–98, 136,
162, 191, 194–195, 208–213, 218, 231,
Hardenberg, Karl August 4, 55–56, 76, 288
107, 149, 203 Philosophical Propaedeutic 42, 53, 59, 66,
Harris, Henry Selton 3, 69 67
356 Index
Hegel, Georg W. F. – continued 73, 86, 100, 108, 116, 152, 189–191,
Proceedings of the Estates-Assembly in the 193, 200–201, 205–209, 211–214,
Kingdom of Württemberg 9, 40, 42, 53, 216–217, 219–227, 229–239, 243,
59–60, 65, 70, 92–93 250–252, 259, 278, 282–283, 296,
productive model 211, 212–214, 282, 3–1–302, 307
306 The Philosophy of History 6, 16, 28,
self–consciousness 97, 108, 112, 115, 36–37, 39–40, 49–50, 76, 84, 87, 95, 99,
125, 128–129, 131–134, 138, 190–191, 119, 137, 154, 176–177, 216, 240, 251,
193, 201–202, 207–213, 216, 220, 264–269, 273, 280, 283–284, 287–288,
230–232, 238–239, 240–241, 248–249 290, 300–301
Speculative philosophy 10–12, 17, 20, The Philosophy of Mind 24–27, 35–36,
24, 46, 107–108, 120, 122, 130, 139, 38, 49–50, 57, 67–68, 80, 96, 137, 184,
143–145, 148, 165, 180, 182, 185, 186, 191, 193, 209–210, 213, 283–285,
188, 199, 207, 218–220, 222, 224, 287, 293, 302
231, 234–235, 239, 242–245, 248, 250, The Philosophy of Nature 6, 10, 35–36,
252, 254–257, 260, 262–264, 266–268, 38, 67–68, 76, 92, 96, 118, 121, 123,
271–272, 278, 280–281, 284, 286–287, 138, 140, 235, 251, 281–283, 303
294–296, 298–299, 301, 303, 305 The Philosophy of Religion 16, 36, 40,
Spirit 26, 62, 72, 94, 97, 108, 115, 136, 105, 235, 267
152, 183, 189–190, 202–203, 206, 208, The Philosophy of Right 3, 6–7, 14, 16,
213, 215–219, 223–227, 232–234, 288, 34–36, 38, 40–41, 44, 46–48, 50–51,
300, 306–307 58–60, 62, 64, 76, 83–87, 90, 94–95,
State 28–29, 43–66, 69, 72, 98–103, 108, 134, 137, 143–145, 147, 149,
135–137, 143, 152, 157–160, 165–176, 152–158, 161–163, 165–166, 168–169,
174–175, 181–183, 194, 208, 211, 213, 174, 176, 181, 188, 191, 194–195, 207,
228, 230–232, 260, 280–281, 286–296 213, 230, 235, 249, 251–253, 259–260,
Subjective Spirit 26–27, 42, 53, 67–68, 266, 274, 280, 287–288, 290–295
96–98, 136, 161–162, 184, 189–191, The Science of Logic 2, 7, 18–19, 23, 32,
195, 206, 208–212, 217–218, 225, 288, 35–39, 54, 66–67, 103, 117, 124–128,
304 140, 177, 235, 251, 294–295, 302–304,
subjectivity 19, 24, 49–50, 55–56, 72, 308, 310
79, 87, 89, 91, 93–94, 98–105, 115–117, The Truth of Self–Certainty 116–117, 211
123, 125, 136–138, 162, 177, 190–191, Yearbook of Scientific Criticism 9, 75, 92
192, 202, 204, 209–212, 215, 235, 238, Helvétius, Claude 114, 232, 242, 246
241, 279–288, 291–295, 300, 304, 311 Hengstenberg, Ernest Wilhelm 106
The Actualization of Rational von Henning, Leopold 37–38, 76, 89–90,
Self–Consciousness Through Its Own 95, 99, 102–103
Activity 190–191, 212 Herwegh, Georg 151, 187
The Encyclopedia of the Philosophical Hess, Moses 81, 150–151, 186–187
Sciences 7, 23, 27, 32, 34–37, 39–40, Hinrichs, Hermann 76, 104, 114,
59, 96, 103, 121, 124, 137, 140, 209, 256–257, 261–262, 279, 295
235, 264, 280, 293, 298, 302–303 historical materialism 18, 31–32, 312–313
The English Reform Bill 9, 40, 42, 53, historicity 13, 21, 32, 40, 54, 57, 61, 76,
63–65, 70–72, 92 85–86, 88–90, 94–95, 98–100, 103, 111,
The German Constitution 9, 41–42, 53, 113, 129–130, 201–204, 209, 214, 218,
66, 70, 158 225–226, 269–270, 273–274, 287–292,
The History of Philosophy 29, 34–37, 303, 306
39–40, 48–50, 76, 90, 99–100, 102–103, Hobbes, Thomas 82, 246, 289
113–119, 121–122, 124, 129–130, Holbach, Paul Henri 114, 232, 242, 246
135–137, 140, 152, 201–202, 207, 226, holism 77–78, 107, 167, 174, 301–302,
230, 242–243, 245–246, 266–267, 273, 305, 307–309
280–281, 283, 287, 300–302, 307, 311 homme (Rousseau) 44, 49, 51, 198, 298–297
The Phenomenology of Spirit 5, 7–8, Horstmann, Rolf–Peter 3
18–19, 23–27, 30, 34–36, 39, 44, 55, 62, Hugo, Gustav 47, 82, 155
Index 357
natural law 8, 39, 42, 44–49, 51–52, 59, von Rotteck, Karl 176, 256–257
72, 82, 145–146, 150, 154, 166, 196, Rousseau, Jean-Jacques 42–44, 46, 50, 55,
288 60–61, 69, 82, 86, 94, 98, 102, 104,
naturalism 199, 241–242, 244–246, 134–135, 150, 154, 165, 198–199,
255–256, 271, 277, 281 274–275, 292, 296, 300
Neuhouser, Frederick 174 Ruge, Arnold 6–7, 10–11, 65–66, 81–82,
Newton, Isaac 298, 301, 307 84, 87, 106, 142–143, 145–146, 148,
Nohl, Hermann 41 150–151, 180, 186–189, 198–199, 207
non-congruence 77–80, 83–85, 94, 96, 100, ‘Hegel’s Philosophy of Right and the
112–114, 130, 152, 154, 157, 226, 229 Politics of Our Time’ 147
‘Self–Criticism of Liberalism’ 188
organic 22, 31–32, 57, 76, 89, 90, 98–100, Rutenberg, Adolf 74, 81–82, 109, 151
107, 129, 140–141, 153, 165–167, 171, Ryazanov, David 2, 15, 19, 205, 255
178, 203–204, 216, 218, 226, 232,
281–282, 292, 301–302, 305, 307–309 Say, Jean-Baptiste 59, 146, 161
von Savigny, Friedrich Carl 34, 46–47, 53,
philosophy 4, 9, 10–12, 15, 18, 20, 24, 27, 60, 65, 74–75, 81, 87–89, 94, 98, 102,
29, 40, 42, 46–47, 49, 72, 74, 76–84, 104, 110–111, 155, 158, 165
89, 93–96, 111–116, 118–119, 121, 124, scepticism 7–8, 26, 39, 92, 117, 133, 230
128–136, 139, 143–148, 150–152, Schelling, Friedrich 3, 7–9, 38–39, 54–55,
154–156, 160, 162, 177, 180–181, 57, 92–93, 142, 147, 226, 245
183–184, 188–189, 191, 198–199, Schulz, Wilhelm 48
201–202, 207, 209, 214–216, 220, 226, Scientific Revolution 82, 122, 139, 300
239–242, 245, 247–250, 257, 261, 271, Schüler, Gisela 4
273, 279, 281, 286, 288, 292–293, Schultz, C. H. 281–282
299–307 Scottish Enlightenment 59, 199, 273, 300
Greco–Roman 113, 119, 218, 226 Second Appropriation of Hegel 4–6, 9, 31
Medieval 77 Siep, Ludwig 3
Modern 115, 117, 245, 280, 299–300 Smith, Adam 5, 13–14, 16, 18, 32, 46,
Western 112–114, 117, 119, 130, 226, 48, 52, 58–59, 146, 161, 194–195, 199,
243, 245, 298 201, 206–207, 224, 235, 269–270, 275
Plato 29, 43, 50, 58, 69, 86, 114–117, 123, Socrates 69, 79, 115–117, 133, 136–137,
133,136, 202, 226, 267, 291–293, 298, 253
302, 305 Spinoza, Baruch 3, 24–25, 82, 100, 108,
Plekhanov, Georgii 313 120, 137, 139, 219, 243–246, 305
Plutarch 118, 128 Stahl, Friedrich Justus 106, 149
Pöggeler, Otto 3 Stalin, Joseph 31, 205, 310, 313
polis 14, 17, 29, 44, 49–51, 69, 116, 136, von Stein, Lorenz 4, 55–56, 76, 107, 149,
161, 175, 196, 213, 227, 253, 287, 292, 203
296–297 Steuart, James 16, 42, 46, 52–53, 57–59,
Proudhon, Pierre-Joseph 5, 37, 101, 207, 70, 199, 269, 273–275
254–256, 262, 270–272, 275 Stirner, Max 5, 91, 240–241, 248, 253,
257–258, 260–268, 271
Ricardo, David 5, 14, 16, 32, 48, 59, 146, Stoics 112–113, 115–119, 123, 226, 230,
161, 194–195, 201, 207, 224, 235, 237
269–270, 275 Strauss, David Friedrich 24, 40, 78–79,
Rojahn, Jürgen 2, 15, 205 104–105, 148, 220–221, 230
Rosenkranz, Karl 3, 8–9, 42, 53–59, 63, Stuhr, P. F. 90
65–66, 68–71, 76, 83, 93, 295 subject–object 183–189, 210, 214
‘Hegel’s Life’ 42, 53, 57, 66, 69, 92 substance 12, 20, 24–25, 77–78, 80, 94,
‘Philosophical Propaedeutic’ 8–9, 42, 107–107, 115, 134–137, 139, 145, 147,
53, 66 183, 190–193, 195–196, 204, 208–209,
‘Psychology, or the Science of Subjective 212, 216, 219, 222–223, 238, 244, 255,
Spirit’ 9, 42, 53, 67–68 257, 283, 287, 289, 294, 298, 300
360 Index
subsumption 204, 212, 223, 233, 292, 312 Treviranus, Ludolf Christian 281–282
supersession 77–78, 83, 108, 218, 222,
232–233, 239 universal–particular 21–23, 153, 166–168,
synchronic–diachronic 22–23 178, 203–204, 287, 306, 308
System 7, 10, 12, 23, 31–32, 37, 39, 66,
72–74, 86, 103, 107–108, 117, 129–131, Utilitarianism 77, 229, 236–237, 250–251
133–134, 167–168, 200, 203–205, 208,
219–221, 227, 234–235, 239, 243, 278, Visible Bibliography 1–2, 28, 260
281, 291, 298, 302–307, 311 Vileisis, Danga 270